|
Home | Switchboard | Unix Administration | Red Hat | TCP/IP Networks | Neoliberalism | Toxic Managers |
(slightly skeptical) Educational society promoting "Back to basics" movement against IT overcomplexity and bastardization of classic Unix |
|
Most profitable investing take place in the area of medium risk. With higher risks investors often can't stomach losses and sale in the most opportune time. In low risk area you can't beat inflation.
Investors in junk bonds need to deal with Wall Street. The sad truth is, however, that many investors are not well served in their dealings with Wall Street; Wall street in first and foremost is a huge propaganda machine that acts against the interests of common investors in order to enrich the Wall Street Firms. They regularly advice to take too much risk. that means that investors, especially 401K investors they would benefit from developing a greater understanding of the way Wall Street works. That means that they need to stady such social system as corporatism and its latest incarnation -- neoliberalism
|
The problem is that what is good for Wall Street typically is not so good for investors. As for high quality bonds they sell the general rule is "Interest rate risks can always exceed an investor's time frame in most fixed-income sectors." And Junk bonds is no exception.
But they have contain advantages, if you buy then as specialized mutual funds, not as individual issues. firs of all they have shorter duration, so this risk is proportionally less then for 30 years Treasury bonds. But with junk funds like with stocks timing is everything: they are not suitable target for cost averaging. As PIMCO Gross notes by simply researching historical annual high yield default rates (5%), multiplying that by loss of principal in bankruptcy (60%), and coming up with an expected loss of 3% over the life of future loans. So fair return for junk bonds is LIBOR + 300 or more. In other words as Gross stresses "for LIBOR+250 high yield lenders are giving away money!"
High yield issuance topped $300 billion in 2012. The majority of that was used to refinance existing debt and by the end of 2012, 80 percent of market volume ($1.13 trillion) consisted of bonds sold since 2009. Thirty-two issuers defaulted on $20.5 billion in bonds in 2012, compared with 29 issuers and $15.9 billion in 2011. Fitch believes that the default rate on high yield debt in 2013 would “at least double if the economy slides back into recession or very low growth.” Last year’s riskiest sectors were the paper and pulp industry (7.7% default rate), utilities (10.5%), consumer products (4.7%), transportation (4.4%) and banks (3.3%). From July to year-end, the volume of ‘CCC’ rated new bond issues rose 54 percent and made up 18 percent of overall junk bond issuance.
Beyond pushing out debt maturities last year, high yield borrowers in 2012 saw a decline in their interest rates as demand for their bonds rose and interest rate dropped.
The key question here is whether the economy will go into double dip (as was widely expected in 2010) or not. Junk like some other credit markets have signs of overheating as investors take larger risks in response to the persistence of low interest rates... Recent Fed speech underscored that the Fed increasingly regards bubbles, rather than inflation, as the most likely negative consequence of its efforts to reduce unemployment by stimulating growth with money printing. ...
|
Switchboard | ||||
Latest | |||||
Past week | |||||
Past month |
May 08, 2021 | www.moonofalabama.org
Zeb LongThese articles are great at describing the problem, but not so great at suggesting what investors ought to do to protect themselves.J James RobertsonTIPS are sometimes suggested, but if the govt is manipulating the reporting of inflation then TIPS aren't going to be much help. Gold and blue chip stocks... "diversify"? how about some articles that will explore strategies.
There are no safe options. TIPS are indexed to the CPI. The CPI is "adjusted" by weighting, substitution, and hedonics to preserve the mirage of low inflation. We are being forced to either speculate in the market or watch our savings get swallowed by inflation.
Jul 11, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Strong economic rebound and lingering pandemic disruptions fuel inflation forecasts above 2% through 2023, survey finds. The U.S. inflation rate reached a 13-year high recently, triggering a debate about whether the country is entering an inflationary period similar to the 1970s. WSJ's Jon Hilsenrath looks at what consumers can expect next.
Americans should brace themselves for several years of higher inflation than they've seen in decades, according to economists who expect the robust post-pandemic economic recovery to fuel brisk price increases for a while.
Economists surveyed this month by The Wall Street Journal raised their forecasts of how high inflation would go and for how long, compared with their previous expectations in April.
The respondents on average now expect a widely followed measure of inflation, which excludes volatile food and energy components, to be up 3.2% in the fourth quarter of 2021 from a year before. They forecast the annual rise to recede to slightly less than 2.3% a year in 2022 and 2023.
That would mean an average annual increase of 2.58% from 2021 through 2023, putting inflation at levels last seen in 1993.
"We're in a transitional phase right now," said Joel Naroff, chief economist at Naroff Economics LLC. "We are transitioning to a higher period of inflation and interest rates than we've had over the last 20 years."
Jul 24, 2021 | www.msn.com
The yearly rate of inflation leaped to a 13-year high of 3.6% in April, using the Fed's preferred PCE price gauge. By another measure inflation hit a 28-year peak .
Inflation likely rose sharply again in May. Economists polled by Dow Jones and The Wall Street Journal predict the consumer price index rose 0.5% last month. The report comes out on Thursday. If so, that would push the yearly rate close to 5% from 4.2% in April.
Consumer prices have only risen that fast twice in the past 30 years, most recently in 2008 when the cost of a barrel of oil topped $150.
... ... ...
The central bank has stuck to its prediction that inflation will drop back toward 2% by next year. But many are beginning to wonder.
"The writing is on the wall: The Fed's temporary-inflation mantra is sounding more dated by the week," said senior economist Sal Guatieri of BMO Capital Markets.
Jul 24, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The Fed, in sync with the fiction writers at the Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS), reports consumer inflation as honestly as Al Capone reported taxable income.
Vardaman 3 hours ago
Glock 1 hour ago"A basket of things no one actually buys, with prices we just pull out of our asses..."
Yep, the BLS uses the CPI-W to literally avoid raising SS payments. The real rate of inflation for seniors is close to 10% as the things they spend most of their money on like medical care, medicine, food and utilities have gone through the roof
While the government claims they are entitled to 1.5% or less COLA's out of which comes a bigger deduction every year for Medicare. Scam artists.
Jul 11, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Strong economic rebound and lingering pandemic disruptions fuel inflation forecasts above 2% through 2023, survey finds. The U.S. inflation rate reached a 13-year high recently, triggering a debate about whether the country is entering an inflationary period similar to the 1970s. WSJ's Jon Hilsenrath looks at what consumers can expect next.
Americans should brace themselves for several years of higher inflation than they've seen in decades, according to economists who expect the robust post-pandemic economic recovery to fuel brisk price increases for a while.
Economists surveyed this month by The Wall Street Journal raised their forecasts of how high inflation would go and for how long, compared with their previous expectations in April.
The respondents on average now expect a widely followed measure of inflation, which excludes volatile food and energy components, to be up 3.2% in the fourth quarter of 2021 from a year before. They forecast the annual rise to recede to slightly less than 2.3% a year in 2022 and 2023.
That would mean an average annual increase of 2.58% from 2021 through 2023, putting inflation at levels last seen in 1993.
"We're in a transitional phase right now," said Joel Naroff, chief economist at Naroff Economics LLC. "We are transitioning to a higher period of inflation and interest rates than we've had over the last 20 years."
Jul 15, 2021 | www.bloomberg.com
There's nothing more beautiful to a professional investor than a negative correlation between stocks and bonds. When stocks have a bad month, bonds have a good month, and vice versa. Since their zigs and zags offset each other, the value of the combined portfolio is less volatile. The customers are pleased. And that's how it's been for most of the last two decades.
But for almost a year now, Bloomberg market reporters have been detecting anxiety from the pros that the era of negative correlation may be over or ending, replaced by an era of positive correlation in which stock and bond prices move together, amplifying volatility instead of dampening it. "Bonds Have Never Been So Useless as a Hedge to Stocks Since 1999," read the headline on one article this May.
Yet hope springs eternal. The headline on a July 7 article was, "Bonds Are Hinting They'll Hedge Stocks Again as Growth Bets Ease."
In the big picture and over long periods, it's obvious and necessary that stock and bond returns are positively correlated. After all, they're competing investments. Each generates a stream of income: dividends for (most) stocks, coupon payments for bonds. If stocks get very expensive, investors will shift money into bonds as a cheaper alternative until that rebalancing makes bonds more or less equally expensive. Likewise, when one of the two asset classes gets cheap it will tend to drag down the other.
When the pros talk about negative correlation they're referring to shorter periods""say, a month or two--over which stocks and bonds can indeed move in different directions. Lately two giant money managers have produced explanations for why stocks and bonds move apart or together. They're worth understanding even if your assets under management are in the thousands rather than billions or trillions.
Bridgewater Associates, the world's biggest hedge fund, based in Westport, Conn., says that how stocks and bonds play with each other has to do with economic conditions and policy. "There will naturally be times when they're negatively correlated and naturally be times when they're positively correlated, and those come from the underlying environment itself," senior portfolio strategist, Jeff Gardner says in an edited transcript of a recent in-house interview.
According to Gardner, inflation was the most important factor in the markets for decades""both when it rose in the 1960s and 1970s and when it fell in the 1980s and 1990s. Inflation affects stocks and bonds similarly, although it's worse for bonds with their fixed payments than for stocks. That's why correlation was positive during that long period.
For the past 20 years or so, inflation has been so low and steady that it's been a non-factor in the markets. So investors have paid more attention to economic growth prospects. Strong growth is great for stocks but doesn't do anything for bonds. That, says Gardner, is the main reason that stocks and bonds have moved in different directions.
PGIM Inc., the main asset management business of insurer Prudential Financial Inc., has $1.5 trillion under management. In a report issued in May, it puts numbers on the disappointment the pros feel when stocks and bonds start to move in sync. Let's say a portfolio is 60% stocks and 40% bonds and has a stock-bond correlation of -0.3, which is about average for the last 20 years. Volatility is around 7%. Now let's say the correlation goes to zero" not positive yet, but not negative anymore, either. To keep volatility from rising, the portfolio manager would have to reduce the allocation to stocks to around 52%, which would lower the portfolio's returns. If the stock-bond correlation reached a positive 0.3, then keeping volatility from rising would require reducing the stock allocation to only 40%, hitting returns even harder.
PGIM's list of factors that affect correlations is longer than Bridgewater's but consistent with it. The report by vice president Junying Shen and managing director Noah Weisberger says correlations between stocks and bonds tend to be negative when there's sustainable fiscal policy, independent and rules-based monetary policy, and shifts up or down in the demand side of the economy (consumption). The correlation is likely to be positive, they say, when there's unsustainable fiscal policy, discretionary monetary policy, monetary-fiscal policy coordination, and shifts in the supply side of the economy (output).
One last thought: It's a good idea to spread your money between stocks and bonds even if they don't hedge each other. The capital asset pricing model developed by William Sharpe in the 1960s says everyone should have the same portfolio, consisting of every asset available, and adjust their risk by how much they borrow. True, not everyone agrees. John Rekenthaler, a vice president for research at Morningstar Inc., wrote a fun article in 2017 about the different strategies of Sharpe and fellow Nobel laureate Harry Markowitz.
Jul 15, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
Which U.S. asset class is more likely in a bubble right now" stocks or housing? More than 80% of traders polled in a Charles Schwab survey say both.
To shed light on this question, let's look at where both asset classes stand relative to their long-term trendlines. It's important to take a long-term perspective because commentators seem overly eager to detect bubbles everywhere they look these days. They (and we) need to be reminded that not every bull market is a bubble, and not every bear market represents the bursting of a bubble.
Why are we so eager to detect bubbles? Will Goetzmann, a finance professor at Yale University, told me that he suspects it traces to the moral overtone that investors have when they declare something to be forming a bubble. When they do, he said, they're implying that those who lose big in that bear market will be getting what they deserve.
This column leaves moral judgments out of the equation. I instead am focusing on the most comprehensive data set of U.S. equity and housing returns that I know. This database, which extends back to the late 1800s, was compiled by Ã'scar Jordà of the Federal Reserve Bank of San Francisco, Katharina Knoll of Deutsche Bundesbank in Frankfurt, Dmitry Kuvshinov and Moritz Schularick, both of the University of Bonn, and Alan M. Taylor of the University of California Davis.
This database is unique in several ways. One big advantage is that it includes data for both stocks and housing; other databases extend further back in the case of the stock market but don't include housing. The database also takes rent into account when calculating housing's return. Some prior historical analyses of housing's return have focused only on price appreciation, which significantly underreports housing's performance.
The chart below plots the returns since 1890 of U.S. stocks and housing. Notice that equities and housing have each produced largely similar returns over the past 130 years . As recently as the late 1940s, housing was ahead of equities for cumulative performance since 1890. As recently as the late 1970s the two data series were nearly neck-and-neck. Notice further that housing's performance has been less volatile than the stock market's, especially since World War II.
For each asset class I calculated an exponential trendline that most closely fit the 130 years' worth of data. The bad news is that both stocks and housing currently are above their respective trendlines, so if you insist that both assets are in bubbles now you in fact could find some statistical support.
Of the two, the stock market is further ahead of its long-term trendline than is housing. So if you'd have to pick which of the two is more likely to decline significantly, you should choose stocks.
Bonds are vulnerable
I've not said anything about bonds, but they are even further ahead of their trendline than either stocks or housing. So from this long-term perspective they are even more vulnerable than stocks to a big decline.
Jul 08, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The continued decline in Treasury yields has prompted many short-sighted arm-chair analysts to declare that the Fed was right about inflationary pressures being "transitory". Of course, as Treasury Secretary Janet Yellen herself admitted, a little inflation is necessary for the economy to function long term - because without "controlled inflation," how else will policymakers inflate away the enormous debts of the US and other governments.
As policymakers prepare to explain to the investing public why inflation is a "good thing", a report published this week by left-leaning NPR highlighted a phenomenon that is manifesting in grocery stores and other retailers across the US: economists including Pippa Malmgren call it "shrinkflation". It happens when companies reduce the size or quantity of their products while charging the same price, or even more money.
As NPR points out, the preponderance of "shrinkflation" creates a problem for academics and purveyors of classical economic theory. "If consumers were the rational creatures depicted in classic economic theory, they would notice shrinkflation. They would keep their eyes on the price per Cocoa Puff and not fall for gimmicks in how companies package those Cocoa Puffs."
Play Videohttps://imasdk.googleapis.com/js/core/bridge3.470.1_en.html#goog_911732474
https://imasdk.googleapis.com/js/core/bridge3.470.1_en.html#goog_1480248100 Max Griffin UFC Lock: Andre Fili Via KO - MMA Surge NOW PLAYING Chris Holdsworth UFC Lock: Alexander Volkov Via TKO - MMA Surge Watch: 23andMe Goes Public Via SPAC Blue Jays Blowout Red Sox 18-4 Via 8 Home Runs Nuro to Deliver Medicine Via Robots for CVS Customers Fancy Feast Releases Cookbook Inspired by Cat Food Via CEO Cheers on NYC Congestion Charge as Incentive for More Shared Rides LeBron James and Other Athletes Sign Letter Against Voter Suppression
However, research by behavioral economists has found that consumers are "much more gullible than classic theory predicts. They are more sensitive to changes in price than to changes in quantity." It's one of many well-documented ways that human reasoning differs from strict rationality (for a more comprehensive review of the limitations of human reasoning in the loosely defined world of behavioral economics, read Daniel Kahneman's "Thinking Fast and Slow").
Just a few months ago, we described shrinkflation as "the oldest trick in the retailer's book" with an explanation of how Costco was masking a 14% price hike by instead reducing the sheet count in its rolls of paper towels and toilet paper.
NPR's report started with the story of Edgar Dworsky, who monitors grocery store shelves for signs of "shrinkflation".
A couple of weeks ago, Edgar Dworsky walked into a Stop & Shop grocery store in Somerville, Mass., like a detective entering a murder scene.
He stepped into the cereal aisle, where he hoped to find the smoking gun. He scanned the shelves. Oh no, he thought. He was too late. The store had already replaced old General Mills cereal boxes -- such as Cheerios and Cocoa Puffs -- with newer ones. It was as though the suspect's fingerprints had been wiped clean.
Then Dworsky headed toward the back of the store. Sure enough, old boxes of Cocoa Puffs and Apple Cinnamon Cheerios were stacked at the end of one of the aisles. He grabbed an old box of Cocoa Puffs and put it side by side with the new one. Aha! The tip he had received was right on the money. General Mills had downsized the contents of its "family size" boxes from 19.3 ounces to 18.1 ounces.
Dworsky went to the checkout aisle, and both boxes -- gasp! -- were the same price. It was an open-and-shut case: General Mills is yet another perpetrator of "shrinkflation."
It's also being used for paper products, candy bars and other packaged goods.
Back in the day, Dworsky says, he remembers buying bigger candy bars and bigger rolls of toilet paper. The original Charmin roll of toilet paper, he says, had 650 sheets. Now you have to pay extra for "Mega Rolls" and "Super Mega Rolls" -- and even those have many fewer sheets than the original. To add insult to injury, Charmin recently shrank the size of their toilet sheets. Talk about a crappy deal.
Shrinkflation, or downsizing, is probably as old as mass consumerism. Over the years, Dworsky has documented the downsizing of everything from Doritos to baby shampoo to ranch dressing. "The downsizing tends to happen when manufacturers face some type of pricing pressure," he says. For example, if the price of gasoline or grain goes up.
The whole thing brings to mind a scene from the 2000s comedy classic "Zoolander".
Jul 08, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Let it Go 3 hours agobesnook10 4 hours agoMany people seem to have forgotten after their nearly four-decade run that bonds have a very ugly side that can yield great pain. Today's lower yields may be part of a greater conundrum created by the reality of too much freshly printed money floating around and people needing someplace to stash it. The article below delves into why interest rates may unexpectedly rise.
https://Bonds As An Investment Have A Very Ugly Side.htmlGeorge Bayou 5 hours agothe equity market is reflecting the rush to dollar assets as a function of economic uncertainty especially dedollarization while the low rates also reflect the lower demand for dollars because of dedollarization.
buzzsaw99 4 hours agoTreasury rates are set by the fed and have absolutely nothing to do with reality anymore. The rates are set so that the government can sustain a higher debt ceiling, nothing more. Corporate bonds can be made artificially low because they don't have to compete against treasuries.
bshirley1968 PREMIUM 4 hours agoi would argue that the s&p 500 is set by the fed and has absolutely nothing to do with reality anymore. i would further add that if the fed didn't meddle treasury rates would be even lower and the corporate spread would be huge.
George Bayou 4 hours ago remove linkI would argue you are both right. The meddle when they have to. As long as the sheep run with their narrative, the "markets" usually go the way they want them to. But they will step in when there is a divergence.
I agree that the s&p is inflated due to fed injection and currency devaluation. I disagree about treasury rates, if the fed stopped buying treasuries then the market would not take up the slack unless the rates went higher.
The fed can't do this not only because the government couldn't afford paying higher rates, but the housing industry that they've inflated would get crushed as well.
Jul 08, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Authored by Bill Blain via MorningPorridge.com,
"How many impossible things can you believe before breakfast?"
US 10-year bonds and US equity are in full rally mode. They show contradictory expectations for a stalled recovery and future strong growth! How can that be? Because the market is about what participants collectively think – and how markets think has been utterly changed by 12 years of monetary experimentation, repression, and distortion. We've got to change the way we think about markets.
That the reflation trade is fading fast? Falling bond yields = rising bond prices, and are a sign the market anticipates a slowdown and declining inflationary threat.
Yet, we still expect to see further equity upside? Falling dividend yields = rising equity prices, and are a sign the market anticipates strong growth and rising corporate profits.
In bonds there is truth. Bonds are about credit risk – getting repaid principal and interest. But not the US treasury market – which is why it is called the risk-free rate. The risk of holding a Treasury bond actually boils down to inflation risk. Whatever mad-eyed Libertarian preppers hiding in mountain lairs say, the US Government defaulting on debt is a 50 Sigma possibility – it aint going to happen.
But inflation will eat away the value of the bond today in terms of its purchasing power relative to its future purchasing power at maturity. The greater inflation, the less the bond is worth, and its price today should reflect that. Inflation could occur through rising prices, and declining confidence in currency which creates inflation as its FX value tumbles.
If you assume zero inflation – as the market clearly does when the 10-year risk free rate is 1.34% – then there is no downside risk holding Treasuries. You will happily collect $1.34 for each $100 invested semi-annually and the price of a beer or a McDonalds in 10-years time will be exactly the same as it is today. (Which it won't.)
Bonds have rallied strongly in recent weeks – clearly telling us the expectations of a strong global recovery have stalled. There is little upside to holding bonds. Just certainty. If the global economy does staggering well you won't get $2 back on your $100 investment. The only way you get more at maturity is if we see deflation – when the price of a beer is less in 10 years time than it is today.
Yet, we all know the world is a very uncertain place – its been illustrated by supply chain shifts and breaks, and rising trade hassle and protectionism. Inflation is not only likely – but nailed on. And that means any pension fund buying bonds today to pay your pension tomorrow – is going to fail unless they find other ways to generate returns.
It's the same problem if they buy equity. Long term, bonds outperform, but today we believe stocks are the only place to generate Alpha. If you want upside, then buy stocks. If the global economy rallies and grows, then profits rise and companies become more valuable yada, yada The downside? If the global economy stalls, companies make less money, the price falls or they collapse completely and you get nothing back.
How can the two markets be telling us such a contradictory story?
Distortion is a terrible thing. It affects minds and they way we think about markets.
And this is what I suddenly realised yesterday talking to my chums yesterday. We all noted the same thing – those of us of a certain age are watching younger, more nimble financial minds take over our business. That's normal. They have different perspectives and different reads on what's happening and No One Working In Global Finance Today Under the Age of 32 has ever known markets that were undistorted by QE!
Think about it a second – central bank policies holding interest rates artificially low and them standing ever-ready to support global markets from the consequences of induced bubble conditions – have been the dominant theme of market for 12 years now. A whole generation of very clever bankers and investment managers are maturing into senior positions across the global financial industry having known nothing else.
It amazes me in our own internal discussions how the divide between we few surviving old fogey's who remember free market currency crashes, bond market collapses and equity tumbles, and the younger financiers who can just accept the distortions caused by central banks to avoid these events, as a factor to include in their market expectations..
That's probably why anyone over 40 is such a bear and convinced the market is unsustainable, while the younger generation is far more accepting of distortion as a permanent market reality..
Remember when it comes to generating investment returns, it's not what you think, but what the market thinks that matters. It is just a voting machine
(And, by the way, the only way funds are going to make proper returns in these markets is probably to shift out of distorted financial assets (bonds and equity) and start buying real world assets linked to reality that's a story for tomorrow!)
* * *
Free Bronze subscription allows unlimited blog access, email notification and weekly round up
J J Pettigrew 5 hours ago (Edited)NoDebt 5 hours agoIn the past year the combined QE of the EU plus the Fed went from $8.3 Tr to $17.4 Tr. That is massive economic stimulus and rate suppression. It is estimated by the Fed that for each $ 1Tr of QE in the US, there is a 50 BP reduction from what would have been market interest rates. So, $4 trillion of QE by the Fed equals 200 BP of rate reduction. If inflation is running at 3%, and then there is 2% QE reduction, then real Fed Funds rates are around 500 BP negative. QE is completely distorting the bond market. That is driving a lot of the stock market growth
buzzsaw99 5 hours agoWell, for sure, one thing UST rates are NOT is a proxy for inflation. Haven't been in a long time.
They are a proxy for where the Fed wants the rates to be. Nothing more. And that is mostly driven by the need to finance profligate federal government deficits. What the market won't buy at a given rate, the Fed will buy. But make no mistake, the rate will be what they want it to be. Simple as that.
Herdee 3 hours ago (Edited)That the reflation trade is fading fast? Falling bond yields = rising bond prices, and are a sign the market anticipates a slowdown and declining inflationary threat...
ah, ********. there is no market.
Adino 2 hours agoThe numbers are 3.5% for the U.S. and 2.5% for Japan. Hit those numbers on interest rates and it's game over. Neither one of them at that point according to their tax revenues could even make a payment on the interest, let alone make a principle payment.
bshirley1968 PREMIUM 4 hours agoYeah, I'd love for someone to explain to me how $30 trillion + debt and over $130 trillion in unfunded liabilities gets paid off without hyperinflation.
Especially when the frn itself is the primary source of the debt.
Hal n back 4 hours agoSure, whatever Blain.
It's just time to throw bond traders a bone. Two weeks from now stawks will be once again pushing new records and we'll be talking about "rising interest" rates.
The narrative changes.......consistently.
How long ago were we hearing about the significance of 1.75% on the ten year......as stawks rallied to all time highs day after day? Now we are supposed to be scared because rates are falling......and telling us there is "risk" out there.
The ******** is thick.......and it's all ********.
ChromeRobot 5 hours agomeanwhile, this week a 10.7 ounce bag of M&M's went up 11%.
90% hamburger meat is $4 a pound on sale.
eggs, which do fluctuate, are 1.49 a dozen for large (they were 88 cents not too long ago)
cereals are up in price or down in content.
A bagel is now a buck without the smear.
Too bad there is not an official true inflation rate. even when the govt does it by region, its not correct.
Actually too bad government is not held accountable. On a fair and even basis.
Heroic Couplet 5 hours agoYeah there is no possible way that the "Japanofication" of US bonds and economy can occur. Our CB is much smarter than theirs. Lol, lol, lol.... The 10yr has appreciated 10% in a month! Who cares about the yield. Negative yields on German bunds. This guy kills me!
gcjohns1971 1 hour agoThe libertarian magazine Reason yesterday had an interesting article about the 10 year Treasury and how student loan interest rates are tied to it. Now, if the 10 year goes down, are we going to see the 3% student loan interest rate and the 6% student loan interest rate go down? OF COURSE NOT.
Kreditanstalt 3 hours agoThe US Defaulted in 1790 "Continentals" 1824 "He killed the Bank", the Civil War "Greenbacks", arguably the Panic of 1907, 1933 "Gold Confiscation", 1971 "Temporary suspension of Convertibility...Like the Pound Sterling in 1914!..
"...the price of a beer or a McDonalds in 10-years time will be exactly the same as it is today. (Which it won't.)"
But the type who buy US government bonds don't care about the price of burgers. They only plan to flip the thing back to the next Greater Fool...or THE FED
Jul 03, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
It may not be quite hyperinflation - loosely defined as pricing rising at a double-digit clip or higher - but if former Treasury Secretary and erstwhile democrat Larry Summers is right, it will be halfway there in about six months.
One day after Bank of America warned that the coming "hyperinflation" will last at least 2 and as much as 4 years - whether or not one defines that as transitory depends on whether one has a Federal Reserve charge card to fund all purchases in the next 4 years - Larry Summers, who is this close from being excommunicated from the Democrat party, predicted inflation will be running "pretty close" to 5% at the end of this year and that bond yields will rise as a result over the rest of 2021.
Considering that consumer prices already jumped 5% in May from the previous year, his forecast is not much of a shock.
Speaking on Bloomberg TV, Summers said that "my guess is that at the end of the year inflation will, for this year, come out pretty close to 5%," adding that "it would surprise me if we had 5% inflation with no effect on inflation expectations." If he is right, the recent reversal in one-year inflation expectations which dipped from 4.6% to 4.2% according to the latest UMich consumer sentiment survey, is about to surge to new secular highs.
This is not the first time Summers has predicted that the firehose of fiscal and monetary stimulus will unleash soaring inflation. While career economists at the White House and Fed - who have peasants doing their purchases for them - urge Americans to ignore the current hyperinflation episode, saying that the recent inflation surge will soon pass, Summers has been unique among his fellow Democrats in predicting that massive monetary and fiscal stimulus alongside the reopening of the economy would spark considerable price pressures.
Asked how financial markets may behave in the rest of 2021, Summers said "there will probably be more turbulence" as traders react to faster inflation by pushing up bond yields. "We've got a lot of processing ahead of us in markets," he said.
Ironically, Summers - who now teaches at Harvard University whose president he was not too long ago when he hung out with his buddy Jeffrey Epstein...
Plus Size Model 5 hours ago (Edited)Totally_Disillusioned 1 hour agoExactly!! Not only that, it's not just the FED that is contributing to inflation. We can also blame the SEC and the DOJ. I've never seen a Zero Hedge article blaming stock price appreciation or buybacks for causing inflation or increasing the money supply. The DOJ never enforces antitrust laws. The FBI never investigates money laundering from overseas that creates artificial real estate appreciation that inflates the money supply when people take out HELOC. There are other oversight bodies that, in a sane world, would not allow foreign investment in real estate. Bitcoin and others are a new tool that is being used to manipulate the money supply. It's comical how coins always go down when the little guys are holding the bag and go up when Coinbase executives want to cash out.
Another thing, this artificial chip shortage, punitive tariffs, and new tax laws are also adding to price increases.
Revolution_starts_now 6 hours agoSpeculative investments have NEVER been included in the forumulation of CPI that determines inflation rate.
gregga777 5 hours ago (Edited) remove linkLarry Summers is a tool.
Banksters in 2010's: We've got to revise how we calculate inflation again to conceal it from the Rubes.
Banksters in 2020: Ho Lee Fuk! Gun the QE engine! Pedal to the metal! Monetize all of the Federal government's debt! Keep those stonks zooming upwards!
Banksters in 2021: Ho Lee Fuk! The Rubes have caught onto our game! Gun the QE engine! Keep that pedal to the metal! Maybe the Rubes won't notice housing prices going up 20% per year?
Summer 2021: Ho Lee Fuk! They are noticing Inflation! We'd better revise how we calculate inflation again to conceal it from the Rubes.
Jun 14, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Paul Tudor Jones said economic orthodoxy has been turned upside down with the Federal Reserve focused on unemployment even as inflation and financial stability are growing concerns.
Inflation risk isn't transitory, the hedge fund manager said in an interview on CNBC.
If the Fed says the U.S. economy is on the right path, "then I would go all in on the inflation trade, buy commodities, crypto and gold," he said. "If they course correct, you will get a taper tantrum and a sell off in fixed income and a correction in stocks.
Jun 25, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
BofA expects U.S. inflation to remain elevated for two to four years, against a rising perception of it being transitory, and said that only a financial market crash would prevent central banks from tightening policy in the next six months.
It was "fascinating so many deem inflation as transitory when stimulus, economic growth, asset/commodity/housing inflations (are) deemed permanent", the investment bank's top strategist Michael Hartnett said in a note on Friday.
Thyagaraju Adinarayan
Fri, June 25, 2021, 5:24 AM
By Thyagaraju AdinarayanLONDON (Reuters) - BofA expects U.S. inflation to remain elevated for two to four years, against a rising perception of it being transitory, and said that only a financial market crash would prevent central banks from tightening policy in the next six months.
It was "fascinating so many deem inflation as transitory when stimulus, economic growth, asset/commodity/housing inflations (are) deemed permanent", the investment bank's top strategist Michael Hartnett said in a note on Friday.
Hartnett thinks inflation will remain in the 2%-4% range over the next 2-4 years. U.S. inflation has averaged 3% in the past 100 years, 2% in the 2010s, and 1% in 2020, but it has been annualising at 8% so far in 2021, Bofa said in the note.
Global stocks were holding near record highs hours ahead of the reading of May core personal consumption expenditures index, an inflation gauge tracked closely by the Fed. The gauge is estimated to rise 3.4% year-on-year.
... In the week to Wednesday, investors pumped $7 billion into equities and $9.9 billion into bond funds, while pulling $53.5 billion from cash funds, BofA calculated, using EPFR data.
Jun 25, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
A significant global bond market correction is likely in the next three months as central bankers eye the exit door from pandemic emergency policy, according to a Reuters poll of strategists who also forecast modestly higher yields in a year.
Financial markets were caught off guard by the Federal Reserve's surprisingly hawkish tone at its meeting last week, sparking a sell-off in equities and a safe-haven rush into Treasuries.
While Fed Chair Jerome Powell played down rising price pressures on Tuesday, just a day later two Fed officials said the recent bout of higher inflation could last longer than anticipated.
The MOVE index - a bond market volatility gauge - hit a two-month high on Monday, underscoring those mixed signals and uncertainty about the near-term.
In the June 17-24 poll, over 60% of fixed-income strategists, or 25 of 41, who answered an additional question said a significant sell-off in global bond markets was likely over the next three months.
... The U.S. 10-year Treasury yield was forecast to rise about 50 basis points to 2.0% by June 2022, from around 1.5% on Thursday.
... When asked how high would U.S. 10-year Treasury yields rise to over the next three months, the median of 30 analysts was 1.75%, with forecasts ranging between 1.5% and 2.0%.
... "Inflation is not all transitory. It is going to be a mix of sustainable and transitory," said Guneet Dhingra, head of U.S. interest rates strategy at Morgan Stanley.
Jun 20, 2021 | www.wsj.com
June 18, 2021
... ... ...
In the face of prolonged low interest rates, all investors face three basic choices, says Mr. Skjervem, the consultant who formerly managed roughly $100 billion as chief investment officer of the Oregon State Treasury.
You can raise your existing holdings of traditional risky assets like stocks, even though no one thinks they're cheap.
You can add a bunch of new and exotic bets and hope they don't blow up on you.
Or you can grit your teeth and stay the course, through a period of what may be lackluster returns, until interest rates finally normalize.
"People are looking for the silver bullet, the magic wand, the get-out-of-jail-free card," says Mr. Skjervem. "There isn't one."
Write to Jason Zweig at [email protected]
John Smith
Jason Zweig always offers a breath of fresh air in the world of investment advice.Stuart YoungI like the cautionary tale he offers in re Fund "Trustees". Likely that many serve as decoys on the pond. Ignore that blind, look how comfortable the plastic ducks appear.
There will be no solution to the yield problem until Powell and the Federal Reserve Bank stop having a fire sale on money and return interest rates to their normal levels. It certain that there is much resistance to do this from the administration due to the trillions of dollars they are borrowing and yes, these borrowed dollars are coming from the same Federal Reserve Bank that controls the interest rates for the nation.John ZarwanTwo quick comments. 1, a pension system is different than an individual, as the pension system has a legal obligation to meet the payouts of its members. If my retirement nest egg doesn't provide, too bad for me, but my heirs aren't required to make up the shortfall. 2, it would have been nice if the article focused more on the purported subject rather than the shortcomings of a possibly corrupt pension plan.BRIAN HILLFor those who say just have an S&P 500 index fund, the index had no return from 2000 to 2012 and other long periods like 1966 to 1982. And if you were withdrawing income during this period the sequence of return risk would be a disaster. You need multiple asset classes - not just large cap US stocks.Richard FishmanHow easy it is for these pension trustees to make themselves popular with participants by raising earning assumptions and payouts when they have their big daddy the U.S. Pension Benefit Guarantee Corp. ready to raid the taxpayers pockets again and again. As usual, intelligent, conservative, fiscal management is a joke. What else is new?Khyshang LewI do agree. It is time to lower expected rate of return.Frank WalkerI wouldn't want to pour any water on all the great returns of the past 10 years but they came after a major crash in 2008. A Federal Reserve that dropped the interest rate to 1.5% on a 10 year bond. They have created a Stock, Bond, and Real Estate market bubble. How would your averages work out with a 50% correction?Ralph TibilettiY.C. Sung
"People are looking for the silver bullet, the magic wand, the get-out-of-jail-free card," says Mr. Skjervem. "There isn't one."All of these problems are caused by a dysfunctional federal government controlled by politicians from both parties whose only concern is getting elected and reelected. They accomplish their goal by redistributing wealth in the form of many different entitlement programs and by catering to the legislative needs of special interest groups.
Voting is not the solution because we only replace the existing set with a different set that will perform in the same way. We need a Solomon like individual who can solve the problem.
Private equity is great for money managers; there's no transparency in the value of the investment. Unlike public market managers who have a scorecard on them every day, private equity managers have wide latitude in valuing their investments. They can avoid being fired for a long time.Rachel Glyn
Not sure why it's different than a SPAC.Ralph TibilettiJames Winkle"The challenge we all face as investors is that the collapse in interest rates makes achieving historical rates of return very difficult,"As we all know this problem has been caused by the Fed's zero interest rate and money printing polices in support of the profligate spending and borrowing by both parties in the federal government.Why is the Fed so interested in the interest rate that savers may receive but has no interest in the interest rate that lenders may charge like credit card companies? It does seem a bit unfair when lenders can borrow at near zero percent interest rates and then loan the money out at 16 percent plus. This smacks of inequality with which both the Fed and the federal government seem so terribly concerned.
The only magic bullet for a lot of people is to spend less.
Jun 18, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The reason that rates are discounting the current "economic growth" story is that artificial stimulus does not create sustainable organic economic activity.
"This is because bubble activities cannot stand on their own feet; they require support from increases in money supply that divert to them real savings from wealth generators. Also, note again that a major cause behind the possible decline in the pool of real savings is unprecedented increases in money supply and massive government spending. While the pool of real savings is still growing, the massive money supply increase is likely to be followed by an upward trend in the growth rate of the prices of goods and services. This could start early next year. Once the pool of real savings starts to decline, however -- because of massive monetary pumping and reckless fiscal policies -- various bubble activities are will plunge. This, in turn, is likely to result in a large decline in economic activity and in the money supply." – Mises Institute
As stimulus fades from the system, that decline in money supply is only one of several reasons that "deflation" will resurface.
Monetary & Fiscal Policy Is DeflationaryThe Federal Reserve and the Government have failed to grasp that monetary and fiscal policy is "deflationary" when "debt" is required to fund it.
How do we know this? Monetary velocity tells the story.
What is "monetary velocity?"
"The velocity of money is important for measuring the rate at which money in circulation is used for purchasing goods and services. Velocity is useful in gauging the health and vitality of the economy. High money velocity is usually associated with a healthy, expanding economy. Low money velocity is usually associated with recessions and contractions. " – Investopedia
With each monetary policy intervention, the velocity of money has slowed along with the breadth and strength of economic activity.
While in theory, "printing money" should lead to increased economic activity and inflation, such has not been the case.
A better way to look at this is through the " veil of money" theory.
If money is a commodity, more of it should lead to less purchasing power, resulting in inflation. However, this theory began to fail as Governments attempted to adjust interest rates rather than maintain a gold standard.
Crossing The RubiconAs shown, beginning in 2000, the "money supply" as a percentage of GDP has exploded higher. The "surge" in economic activity is due to "reopening" from an artificial "shutdown." Therefore, the growth is only returning to the long-term downtrend. As shown by the attendant trendlines, increasing the money supply has not led to either more sustainable economic growth rates or inflation. It has been quite the opposite.
However, it isn't just the expansion of the Fed's balance sheet that undermines the strength of the economy. For instance, it is also the ongoing suppression of interest rates to try and stimulate economic activity. In 2000, the Fed "crossed the Rubicon," whereby lowering interest rates did not stimulate economic activity. Therefore, the continued increase in the "debt burden" detracted from it.
Similarly, we can illustrate the last point by comparing monetary velocity to the deficit.
As a result, monetary velocity increases when the deficit reverses to a surplus. Such allows revenues to move into productive investments rather than debt service.
The problem for the Fed is the misunderstanding of the derivation of organic economic inflation
6-More Reasons Deflation Is A Bigger ThreatPreviously, Mish Shedlock discussed Dr. Lacy Hunt's views on inflation, or rather why deflation remains a more significant threat.
Inflation is a lagging indicator. Low inflation occurred after each of the past four recessions. The average lag was almost fifteen quarters from the end of each. (See Table Below)
Productivity rebounds in recoveries and vigorously so in the aftermath of deep recessions . The pattern in productivity is quite apparent after the deep recessions ending in 1949, 1958, and 1982 (Table 2 Below). Productivity rebounded by an average of 4.8% in the year after each of these recessions. Unit labor costs remained unchanged as the rise in productivity held them down.
Restoration of supply chains will be disinflationary . Low-cost producers in Asia and elsewhere could not deliver as much product into the United States and other relatively higher-cost countries. Such allowed U.S. producers to gain market share. As immunizations increase, supply chains will gradually get restored, removing that benefit.
Accelerated technological advancement will lower costs . Another restraint on inflation is that the pandemic significantly accelerated the implementation of technology. The sharp shift will serve as a restraint on inflation. Much of the technology substitutes machines for people.
Eye-popping economic growth numbers vastly overstate the presumed significance of their result . Many businesses failed in the recession of 2020, much more so than usual. Furthermore, survivors and new firms will take over that market share, which gets reflected in GDP. However, the costs of the failures won't be.
The two main structural impediments to traditional U.S. and global economic growth are massive debt overhang and deteriorating demographics, both having worsened as a consequence of 2020.
To summarize, the long-term risk to current outlooks remains the "3-Ds:"
Conclusion
Deflationary Trends
Demographics; and,
Debt
With this in mind, the debt problem remains a massive risk. If rates rise, the negative impact on an indebted economy quickly depresses activity. More importantly, the decline in monetary velocity shows deflation is a persistent threat.
Treasury&Risk clearly explained the reasoning :
"It is hard to overstate the degree to which psychology drives an economy's shift to deflation. When the prevailing economic mood in a nation changes from optimism to pessimism, participants change. Creditors, debtors, investors, producers, and consumers all change their primary orientation from expansion to conservation.
Creditors become more conservative, and slow their lending.
Potential debtors become more conservative, and borrow less or not at all.
Investors become more conservative, they commit less money to debt investments.
Producers become more conservative and reduce expansion plans.
Consumers become more conservative, and save more and spend less.
These behaviors reduce the velocity of money, which puts downward pressure on prices. Money velocity has already been slowing for years, a classic warning sign that deflation is impending. Now, thanks to the virus-related lockdowns, money velocity has begun to collapse. As widespread pessimism takes hold, expect it to fall even further."
There are no real options for the Federal Reserve unless they are willing to allow the system to reset painfully.
Unfortunately, we now have a decade of experience of watching monetary experiments only succeed in creating a massive "wealth gap."
Most telling is the current economists' inability to realize the problem is trying to "cure a debt problem with more debt."
In conclusion, the Keynesian view that "more money in people's pockets" will drive up consumer spending, with a boost to GDP being the result, has been wrong. It hasn't happened in 40 years.
Unfortunately, deflation remains the most significant threat as permanent growth doesn't come from an artificial stimulus.
bikepath999 2 hours agoOldNewB 2 hours agoTitle is 100% wrong! It's artificial growth (money printing) that is the inflation! Organic growth thru increased production can actually lead to deflation!
bikepath999 2 hours agoExactly. Inflation can be the reduction in the rate of deflation due to productivity increases.
dead hobo 2 hours ago (Edited)Transitory is just the new little catch phrase to have you chasing after your own tail rather than skinning alive a central banker or politician
Misesmissesme 2 hours ago (Edited)Transitory was Janet Yellen's favorite word for years. It was her catch phrase like Bernanke's was 'The benefits outweigh the costs'. Total blather in both cases.
In both cases, it was muppet-speak for 'p*ss off'. But it sounded oh so intelligent and the media lapped it up.
About the above article ... Economics, as commonly applied by sales folk, teachers, experts, and pundits is theology, not science. One credibility trick is to quote an expert who quoted another expert. Like above. How can you argue against this depth?
OldNewB 2 hours ago (Edited) remove linkThey are somewhat correct on the technical definition of inflation. However, hyper-inflation does not care about any of that. It only needs a government willing to print and a populace that has lost faith in the currency. We know the gov and the Fed are game. It's just a matter of time until the masses lose faith in the dollar.
-- ALIEN -- 2 hours ago (Edited) remove linkDevaluing the fiat by printing to infinity has nothing to do with growth.
Printing IS inflation. Where it shows up is another matter.
Whether it results in higher prices is a function of behavior between buyers and sellers of assets, products and services.
Quia Possum 2 hours agoInternational Energy Agency said GLOBAL PEAK OIL PRODUCTION for all liquids happened in 2018.
NO economic growth is possible without growing the energy supply, so 2% predicted growth is BS,
unless other countries contract by 2+%.
We're beyond the point of pulling the rip cord.
Some ZH writer had an excellent analogy to a hot air balloon on fire. Up to a height X, you can jump off safely. Up to a height Y you can jump off and survive with some broken bones, but you're going to have to muster some courage to do that. But once you pass that height you're dead whether you jump or stay in the balloon all the way.
Jun 18, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Tesla's Milton 1 hour ago remove linkMarcus (Goldman's bank) pays 0.70% for an 18 month CD. It's not much but it's a lot better than a 2 yr. Treasury.
Jun 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
I commented above on direction. I believe the bond market has the direction in June correct (falling yields).
That said, the "real yield" is nearly -5% (CPI minus the 3-Month Treasury Yield). This fosters speculation in assets.
We are in the midst of the third big bubble in just over 20 years.
Extrapolating ConditionsIt's usually a big mistake to extrapolate current conditions far into the future. And that includes now.
Sure, there are huge wage pressures and the price of some commodities, especially lumber, went through the roof.
But where to from here is what's important.
Despite Wage Increases, Real Hourly Pay Is Losing to InflationOn June 11, I commented Despite Wage Increases, Real Hourly Pay Is Losing to Inflation
I also noted Huge Upward Wage Pressures for Both Skilled and Unskilled Labor
But Lacy Hunt is holding pat as well.
He pinged me in response to Explaining the Shortage of Skilled Workers and Why It Will Get Worse with these thoughts.
The Transitory BoatMish,
Excellent analysis. I would add one point as a result of your conclusion. Older populations with declining birth rates and slower population, depress household, business and public investment. The contracting effect on investment is highly deflationary and overwhelms the impact of inflation due to the smaller labor force. This condition is plainly evident in Japan and Europe. Moreover, this pattern will be increasingly apparent in the US .
The transitory boat is a small one. Powell and Yellen have to say that no matter what they believe.
Rosenberg, Hunt, and I are in the small boat.
And if you want another reason to be in that boat with us, then think about what happens when asset bubbles burst. It won't be inflationary, that's for sure.
Meanwhile, "I just say buy the gold," Rosenberg said. "Gold has 1/5 of the volatility that bitcoin has."
For more on gold and real interest rates, please see my June 11 post Real Interest Rates Suggest It's a Good Time to Buy and Hold Gold
Jun 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Let us preface our inflation note with one of our favorite quotes:
"World War II was transitory"
– GMM
Inflation has eroded my purchasing power in my transitory life. Bring back the $.35 Big Mac, which was only about 20% of the minimum wage. Now? About 40-50%... Enough to spark a revolution?
Jun 13, 2021 | peakoilbarrel.com
EULENSPIEGEL IGNORED 06/11/2021 at 10:07 am
This isn't your history bond market.
Inflation doesn't really matters, what only matters is the one big question: "How much bonds does the one market member with unlimited funds buy?".
And the time the FED was able to rise more than .25% is in the rear mirror – when they hike now, inflation or not, all these zombie companies and zombie banks will fail and no lawyer in the world will be able to clean up the chaos after all these insolvency filings.
They have to talk the way out of this inflation. They have to talk until it stops, or longer. They can't hike. They can perhaps hike again when most of the debt is inflated away – a period with 10+% inflation and 1% bond interrest.
And yes, they can buy litterally any bond dumped onto the market – shown this in March last year when they stopped the corona crash in an action of one week.
I think most non-investment-banks are zombies at the moment, and more than 20% of all companies. They all will fail in less than 1 year when we would have realistic interrest rates. On the dirty end, this would mean 10%+ for all this junk out there – even mighty EXXON will be downgraded to B fast.
In old times the FED rates would be more than 5% now with these inflation numbers. Nobody can pay this these days.
And now in the USA – look for how much social justice and social security laws you'll get. The FED has to provide cover for all of them.
We in Europe will do this, too. New green deal, new CO2 taxes, better social security – the ECB already has said they will swallow everything dumped on the market.
So, oil 100$ the next years – but some kind of strange dollars buying less then they used to.
Just my 2 cents. REPLY HOLE IN HEAD IGNORED 06/12/2021 at 5:39 am
Eulen , your 2cents = 1 Dollar . Everything you say is correct . Weird is the only word for what is happening in the financial world . I was in my first year of college when Paul Volcker hiked interest rates into double digits so I have a benchmark to measure against . This is not going to end well . Take care . REPLY
Jun 12, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Authored by David Stockman via Contra Corner blog,
The Fed's destructive money-pumping has many victims, but chief among these is the Wall Street financial narrative itself.
It emits not a whiff about the patent absurdity of the Fed's monthly purchase of $120 billion of treasury and GSE debt under current circumstances; and treats with complete respect and seriousness the juvenile word game known as "thinking about thinking about tapering" by which the clowns in the Eccles Building fearfully attempt to placate the liquidity-intoxicated speculators on Wall Street.
So it's not surprising that today's 5.0% CPI reading was made inoperative within minutes after the BLS release by a chorus of financial pundits gumming about "base effects" and ridiculing outliers like soaring used car prices (up 29.7% YoY), which, of course, Bloomberg reporters never see the inside of anyway.
Then again, that's why we look at the two-year stacked CAGRs, which smooth the ups and downs of the worst lockdown months last spring; and also why we use the 16% trimmed mean CPI, which eliminates the highest 8% and lowest 8% of items in the overall CPI each month (both sets of deleted outliers are different each month).
In the present instance, therefore, off-setting the used car prices in the highest 8% of items during May is the -5.0% YoY drop in health insurance costs (if you believe that BLS whopper) and the -5.3% drop in sporting event prices, which, of course, have been largely zero since last April.
In any event, the 16% trimmed mean CPI for May was up by 4.7% annualized versus the April number and was higher by 2.62% on YoY basis.
Still, the more salient point is that on a two-year stacked basis the plain old CPI -- used car prices and all -- leaves not a scintilla of doubt: Consumer inflation is accelerating and rapidly.
During the last eight months the growth rate for the two year stack has risen from 1.48% to 2.55% per annum. And we don't recall a word in May 2019 about that year's reading being particularly deflationary. It was actually up 1.83% from May 2018.
Per Annum CPI Increase, Two-Year Stack:
October 2020: 1.48%;
November 2020: 1.59%;
December 2020: 1.78%;
January 2021: 1.92%;
February 2021: 1.99%;
March 2021: 2.07%;
April 2021: 2.23%;
May 2021: 2.55%.
Still, according to the Fed apologists there's nothing troubling about the above because the Fed is now only trying to hit its 2.00% inflation target "averaged over time".
Let's see. Here are the CPI growth rates going back to May 2014. It turns out you have to average back seven years before you have a shortfall from the 2.00% target!
CPI Increase per Annum To May 2021 From:
May 2018, 3-Yr, average: 2.31%;
May 2017, 4-Yr. average: 2.42%;
May 2016, 5-Yr. average: 2.31%;
May 2015, 6-Yr. Average:2.10%;
May 2014, 7-Yr. Average: 1.81%
You get the scam. These mendacious fools will just keep averaging back in time until the get a number that's a tad under 2.00%, smack their lips loudly and then pronounce the current inflation to be "transitory".
And they will also toss out any inflation index that undercuts their MOAAR inflation mantra -- like all of the data reported above!
So we will say it again : The CPI is a highly imperfect general price measure owing to its one-sided treatment of quality (hedonic) improvements, wherein some reported prices are adjusted downward for improved product features like airbags and more powerful PCs, put few prices are adjusted upward for the junkie toys, towels, kitchenware, appliances and furniture that comes out of China.
But with the 8% highest and 8% lowest prices dropped out monthly to filter out the short-run noise, the 16% trimmed mean version of the CPI at least purports to be a fixed basket price index, not a variable weight deflator like the Fed's beloved PCE deflator.
In short, the 16% trimmed mean CPI puts paid to the "transitory" scam. Come hell or high water, this serviceable inflation measure has been rising at 2.00% per annum since the year 2000, and even more than that during the 1990s.
Thus, during the 112 months since the Fed formally adopted inflation targeting in January 2012, it has risen by 2.03% per annum and by 2.15% per annum since January 2000.
Equally significantly, there have been only a handful of times during the 256 monthly readings since January 2000 when the year-over-year measure dropped materially below 2.00%.
YoY Change, 16% Trimmed Mean CPI, 2000-2021
For want of doubt, here is the Fed's preferred short-ruler -- -the core PCE (personal consumption expenditure deflator less food and energy). And the Fed's case for its insane money-pumping essentially boils down to the dueling information covered by the red bars above and the purple bars below.
As it happens, the one-year change in the core PCE deflator is 3.1% and the stacked two-year gain is 1.99% per annum. That latter is apparently not close enough to 2.00% for government work, meaning that the Fed needs to get more years into its average.
Even then, you have to be trained in the medieval theology of counting angels on the head of a pin to ascertain the purported earth-shaking "shortfall" from target. Compared to April 2021, here are the multi-year CAGRs on an April-to-April basis:
2019-2021: 1.99%;
2018-2021: 1.89%;
2017-2021: 1.92%;
2016-2012: 1.86%:
2015-2021:1.82%
That's right. For the five year-pairs shown above, the average CAGR for the core PCE deflator was 1.90%. It seems that "lowflation" amounts to that which you need a magnifying glass to ascertain -- 10 basis points of shortfall.
Of course, our monetary bean counters are not done "averaging", either. If you go back to January 2012 when the Fed officially adopted inflation targeting, the core PCE deflator is up by 1.69% per annum, and since January 2000 it has risen by 1.75% per annum.
So there you have it. For want of 25-31 basis points of annual inflation -- -averaging back to the beginning of the current century -- you have a camarilla of central bankers giving deer in the headlights an altogether new meaning. That is to say, they are apparently not even thinking about thinking about tapering their massive bond-buying fraud owing to the barely detectable differences between purple and red bars of these dueling charts.
As we said a few days back, would that they had applied the 25th Amendment to the Federal Reserve Board.
These sick puppies are in urgent need of palliative care.
YoY Change In Core PCE Deflator, 2000-2021
They are also in need of a dose of realism, and on that score there are three figures in the May CPI report which tell you all you need to know. To wit, compared to May 2020, durable goods prices were up by 10.3%, nondurables were higher by 7.4% and services less energy gained 2.9%.
In fact, in the recent history of these three figures lays a stinging refutation of the entire "lowflation" scam promulgated by the Fed money printers and their acolytes and shills on Wall Street and in Washington, too.
On this matter, the Donald was right, even if by accident or for the wrong reasons. What we are referring to, of course, is the "Shina" factor.
Beijing's form of state-controlled printing press capitalism has systematically drivendown the cost of manufactured goods and especially durables by, in effect, draining the rice paddies of China's great interior and herding its latent industrial work force into spanking new factories which paid wages less than meager. And CapEx costs were rock bottom, too, owing to $50 trillion of central bank-fueled domestic debt and the greatest cheap capital-driven malinvestment spree in human history.
The result was an intense, multi-decade long deflation of manufactured goods as the high labor costs embodied in US and European manufacturers were steadily squeezed out of global prices levels as production shifted to China and its East Asian supply chain.
That impact is patently obvious in the composition of the CPI among the three components which were flashing warning lights in today's inflation report.
Composition of CPI By Major Components, 2000-2021
In the first place, the core of domestic inflation lies in the 58.8% weight of the CPI consisting of mainly domestically supplied services. The 2.9% YoY gain reported for May for CPI services less energy was essentially par for the course.
That is, during the last 21 years (since January 2000) this component (black line) has risen by 2.71% per annum, and since January 2012 it has gained a similar 2.63% per annum.
Needless to say, if there is any part of the inflation rate that the Fed can most powerfully impact, it is domestically supplied services like health care, education, housing, entertainment, travel and foods services. So where's the "lowflation" in that part of the CPI basket?
Alas, we don't have lowflation in services at all, but a stubborn 2.6%-3.0% upward price drift in domestic service components which account for nearly three-fifths of the household budget.
By contrast, the durable goods component (brown line) accounts for 11.1% of the CPI, and it's been an anchor to the windward for more than two decades. As of May 2021, prices were still 8% below their January 2000 level.
The truth is, the alleged lowflation on the top line CPI has been heavily attributable to the deflationary durable goods sector, but, alas, that era is apparently over. The Chinese rice paddies have been drained on a one-time basis and its labor force is now actually shrinking, while the Donald's ill-timed tariff barriers have forced production to move to higher cost venues, albeit not necessary the USA of A.
Either way, the anchor to the windward is largely gone , meaning that rising durable goods prices going forward will no-longer weigh as heavily on the CPI.
It should be further noted that during the past two-decades nondurable prices have also held-down the CPI top line -- again in large part owing to the "Shina" factor and downward pressures from cheap apparel, footwear, home furnishings and the like.
During the past 21 years, the nondurables component (yellow line) of the CPI rose by 1.99% per annum, which is as close as you please to the target, but was also on anchor on the overall CPI top-line ( purple line) which increased by 2.19% per annum.
Alas, during the period since January 2012, nondurables rose by just 0.63% per annum owing to flat-lining energy and commodity prices, thereby pulling the overall CPI down to 1.80% per annum, where it too fell awry of the Fed's sacred 2.00% target.
But here's the thing. A smattering of surging nondurable goods prices in the May 2021 report are a stark reminder that the times they are a changin'.
On a YoY basis, these components suggest that "lowflation" in durables may have passed its sell-by date and that the 7.4% YoY gain in nondurables overall may be lifting, not suppressing, the CPI top-line going forward.
YoY Change In Major Nondurables Components:
Energy commodities: +54.5%;
Apparel: +5.6%;
Home furnishings and supplies: +3.7%;
Footwear: +7.1%;
Food away from home: +4.0%
Household furnishings and operations: +4.6%.
In sum, the chart above captures the one-time history of the Fed's phony "lowflation" narrative -- an aberrant condition that is now fading fast. Sooner or latter they will run out of excuses and back inflation reports to average down. And that, in turn, means tapering of the Fed's great bond-buying fraud -- the lynch pin of the greatest bond and stock bubble in recorded history.
Do we think that will trigger the greatest financial asset value collapse in modern times?
Why, yes, we do! play_arrow
wareco 4 hours ago remove linkSound of the Suburbs 8 hours ago (Edited) remove linkSeriously? David Stockman? This guy has been perpetually wrong for the last 4 years, at least. In June, 2017, he was calling for the S&P to fall to 1600. Never happened. In October 2019, he loudly proclaimed that everyone should get out of the "casino". S&P up 40% since then. He has as much credibility as that self-promoter, Harry Dent, who has been calling for gold to drop to $700 since 2012.
E5 9 hours agoStage one – The markets are rising.
Look at all that wealth we are creating.
Stage two – It's a bubble.
That wealth is going to disappear.
Stage three – Oh cor blimey! I remember now, this is what happened last time
At the end of the 1920s, the US was a ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices.
The use of neoclassical economics, and the belief in free markets, made them think that inflated asset prices represented real wealth.
1929 – Wakey, wakey time
The use of neoclassical economics, and the belief in free markets, made them think that inflated asset prices represented real wealth, but it didn't.
It didn't then, and it doesn't now.
Putting a new wrapper around old economics did fool global elites.
You'd have to get up pretty early in the morning to catch me out.
Not going to happen.
No one is buying.
No one is raising salaries.
Inflation is a stalled plane.
Everyone is waiting.
Self fulfilling prophecy. Mainstreet is waiting on their inheritance from dead Boomers. The only thing that will save America. Money being spent and Cuban Missile Crisis not happening under Boomers.
Jun 10, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The municipal junk-bond boom is roaring back.
With the economy rebounding swiftly from the pandemic, interest rates on high-yield state and local government securities have tumbled to the lowest in over two decades. Cash is pouring into mutual funds focused on the junk-rated debt so quickly that money managers are fighting to get in on new deals. And prices have rallied, driving high-yield bonds to their biggest run of outperformance since 2014.
The demand is so strong that a California agency sold 35-year bonds for the development of a senior-living community at a yield of 4.43%, about two-and-a-half percentage points less than bankers initially anticipated. The price went on to surge 8% in secondary trading.
"We couldn't think of a better time to come to market," said Sarkis Garabedian, an investment banker at Ziegler, the underwriter on the bonds. He said the firm hadn't seen such interest in a transaction for a new senior living campus since they started tracking the metrics in the 1980s. "We really hit the sweet spot here."
Recent bond sales have raised money for an ethanol production facility in North Dakota, a bevy of charter schools, and a youth-sports complex in Arizona. American Samoa, a junk-rated territory, is tapping the market for the first time since 2018. And the owner of a plant that recycles rice waste into fiberboard may sell more debt even though it has already been driven to default.
The dynamics show how much the municipal-bond market has been swept up in the global push into higher yield assets as central banks worldwide hold interest rates low to stoke the economic recovery.
That's fueled a surge in debt sales by corporations and governments battered by virus lockdowns. And for the state and local government debt market, it has revived the years-long rally in junk bonds that was only temporarily derailed by the coronavirus lockdowns.
So far this year, government agencies across the U.S. have sold more than $6.5 billion of bonds that can only be marketed to institutional investors able to bear the risk, driving such issuance toward the biggest year on record, according to data compiled by Bloomberg.
Jun 09, 2021 | www.msn.com
...The consensus forecast for the core consumer price index, which excludes food and energy, is 3.5% on a year-over-year basis, according to Dow Jones. That's the fastest annual pace in 28 years.
Economists expect both core and headline CPI rose by 0.5% in May. Headline CPI is expected to jump 4.7% year-over-year, the highest rate since sky high energy prices spiked inflation readings in the fall of 2008.
... ... ...
"I am worried about rent and owners' equivalent rent because it should go up. It had decelerated," she said. Shelter is more than 30% of CPI , and rent costs have bottomed in some cities, Swonk added. "The issue is it could have longer legs and keep overall inflation measures buoyed more than people expect."
Jun 10, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Analysts said other factors are driving lower yields, including a weaker dollar, which has lifted demand for Treasurys from foreign investors. Foreign investors tend to hold more Treasurys when the dollar declines and reduces the costs of protecting against swings in currencies.
Jun 10, 2021 | financialgazette.co.uk
That is a counterintuitive response , because rising inflation erodes the value of Treasuries' payouts. And the data did indicate stronger inflation: Excluding volatile food and energy costs, prices rose 0.7% in May. That was the second-highest monthly increase in consumer prices since the early 1980s, behind April's 0.8% rise. Compared with last year, when the global economy was mired in a pandemic-driven slowdown, headline consumer prices rose at a 5% pace . (Excluding food and energy, they rose 3.8%.)
The market's moves could be muted because investors are betting that central bankers are going to stick with their view that most of the strength in consumer prices will pass after a potentially bumpy reopening period and keep policy easy.
... ... ...
... Most Fed watchers expect the central bank to start discussing a reduction of its bond purchases this summer or early fall.
That doesn't mean Treasuries have much room to rally more from here.
The Fed's meeting next week may be the first test. If central-bank officials talk about starting to remove accommodation earlier than expected, that could send yields higher. In fact, strategists from TD Securities decided to take a bearish view on the 10-year note on Thursday, after yields fell below 1.5% earlier this week. They argued that continued economic momentum and stronger inflation could lead central-bank officials to take a more upbeat tone on the economy than investors expect at their meeting on June 15 and 16.
Jun 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Wood, who became the face of the outsized rally in technology stocks such as Zoom Video Communications Inc and electric vehicle maker Tesla Inc during the coronavirus pandemic last year, said that falling lumber and copper prices signal that the market is "beginning to see signs that the risks are overblown" from inflation.
...Wood, whose ARK Innovation ETF was the top-performing actively managed U.S. equity fund tracked by Morningstar last year, has seen her performance stagnate along with the slowdown in growth stocks. Her flagship fund is down nearly 28% from its early February high.
Jun 07, 2021 | www.investopedia.com
While seniors can't directly affect the inflation rate, there are ways to minimize the shadow it casts over their retirement.Reducing housing costs, for instance, is a step in the right direction. Trading in a larger home for a smaller one, even if the mortgage is paid off, reduces the monthly outflow for property taxes, utilities, homeowners insurance, and maintenance.
Another smart move is adding investments to your portfolio that are likely to increase in value as inflation rises.
A real estate investment trust (REIT) or energy sector stocks, for example, are better positioned to see their value grow in tandem with the inflation rate.
Jun 07, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Yes, inflation is rising, and retirees must now consider repositioning not just their short-term safe-haven investments (we'll talk more about that in part two) but their entire portfolio as well (which we'll focus on here). Well that, conveniently enough, is the subject (and title) of a paper soon to be published in the Journal of Portfolio Management that was co-authored by Campbell Harvey, a professor at Duke University, and several of his colleagues affiliated with Man Group. What more, Harvey and his co-authors found that no individual equity sector, including the energy sector, offers significant protection against high and rising inflation.
... here's what Harvey and his co-authors discovered after researching eight periods of inflation dating back to 1925: Neither equities nor bonds performed well in real terms during the inflationary periods studied. Real being the nominal rate of return minus the rate of inflation.
... ... ...
TIPS
"Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities (TIPS) are robust when inflation rises, giving them the benefit of generating similar real returns in inflationary and noninflationary regimes, both of which are positive," the authors wrote.
In fact, TIPS had a 2% annualized real return during the most recent five periods of inflation.
But what looks promising in a research paper might not work in reality given the current yield on TIPS (0.872% as of June 2, 2021). The low yield means that TIPS are a "really super expensive" inflation hedge going forward, said Harvey.
"It means that you're going to get a negative return in noninflationary periods," he said. "So yes, they provide the protection, but they're an expensive way to get that protection."
Commodities
"Traded commodities" have historically performed best during high and rising inflation. In fact, traded commodities have a "perfect track record" of generating positive real returns during the eight U.S. periods studied, averaging an annualized 14% real return.
Now investors might not be able to trade commodities in the same manner as institutional investors using futures, but they can invest in ETFs that invest in a broad basket of commodities, said Harvey.
Other assets
Residential real estate on average holds its value during inflationary times, though not nearly as well as commodities. Collectibles such as art (7%), wine (5%) and stamps (9%) have strong real returns during inflationary periods, as well.
And while some suggest adding bitcoin to a diversified portfolio as an inflation protection asset, caution is warranted given that bitcoin is untested with only eight years of quality data -- over a period that lacks a single inflationary period, the authors wrote. "It's not just untested," said Harvey. "It's too volatile."
Gold is also too volatile as a reliable hedge against inflation. Harvey noted, for instance, that the performance of gold since 1975 is largely driven by a single year, 1979, when gold dramatically appreciated in value. "And that makes the average look really good," he said.
Read: Gold- it's not just for crazies
Dynamic strategies
Harvey also said his number one dynamic strategy for inflationary times is changing the sector exposures in your portfolio. With this strategy, you would allocate a greater portion of your assets to sectors that have historically performed well during inflationary periods, such as medical equipment, and less if anything at all to sectors that have performed poorly during inflationary periods, such as consumer durables and retail. "You can naturally rebalance your portfolio to be a little more defensive," he said. "And that can be done by any investor."
Harvey and his co-authors also found active equity factors generally hold their own during inflation surges with "quality stocks" having a small positive real return and "value stocks" having a small negative return.
Dynamic strategies are "active" strategies that involve monthly rebalancing of portfolios, according to Harvey. In contrast, passive strategies require minimal or no rebalancing; for example, holding an S&P 500 index fund.
Active equity factor investing uses frequent rebalancing to take bets that deviate from the investment weights implied by a passive market portfolio. These bets seek to produce returns over and above the passive market portfolio, said Harvey.
In Harvey's study, quality is defined as a combination of profitability, growth and safety and value is defined with traditional metrics such as the book-to-price ratio.
Is now the time to reposition your portfolio?
According to Harvey, inflation surging from 2% to more than 5% is bad for stocks and bonds. We're not there yet; the current rate of inflation is 4.2%. But we are getting close to the "red zone" and now would be a good time to "rethink the posturing of your portfolio," Harvey said. "So even if it doesn't occur, it doesn't matter. If the risk is high enough, you take some actions, you're basically buying some insurance."
And being proactive is the key. "So, at least right now, it's better to have the discussion now than when it's too late; when we're already in the surge and the asset prices have already dropped," said Harvey.
Remember too that what you hedge is "unexpected" inflation, Harvey said. "What you really are concerned with is unexpected inflation or a surprise in inflation. We call it an economic shock."
But not a transitory shock. That won't have any effect on asset prices. "You need to consider long-term inflation," he said.
And that place to look for that is in the break-even inflation (BEI) rate reflected in TIPS and nominal Treasurys. The BEI is the weighted average of inflation expectations over the life of the bond. And changes in the BEI have the advantage of reflecting changes in long-term or permanent inflation expectations. Presently the BEI is 2.44%. "Anything that is a long-term measure of inflation is going to have the maximum reflection in the asset prices," he said.
As for the current inflationary environment, Harvey said it's a mix of transitory and not-so transitory elements. Lumber prices are up but likely not permanently. The rising prices of other goods and services, however, may not be transitory. "It's obviously difficult to dissect this," he said. "But it's really important for people that are running a portfolio draw that distinction."
Jun 05, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
FT reporters
US government bonds rallied on Friday following a weaker-than-expected reading on American job growth for the month of May. But a key report on consumer price inflation will provide a fresh test for investors. Consumer prices rose at its fastest pace in more a decade in the 12 months to April, but analysts project that it has picked up even more since then, raising fears that the economy is overheating. Economists surveyed by Bloomberg expect the year on year inflation rate to have jumped to 4.7 per cent in May in figures to be released by the Department of Labor on Thursday, compared with 4.2 per cent in April.
Jun 07, 2021 | www.wsj.com
It looks like this surge is suitable, especially in energy... That spells troubles for the US economy which is based on cheap energy.Higher prices for commodities are flowing through to more companies and consumers, making it harder for central bankers to ignore them
...The world hasn't seen such across-the-board commodity-price increases since the beginning of the global financial crisis, and before that, the 1970s. Lumber, iron ore and copper have hit records . Corn, soybeans and wheat have jumped to their highest levels in eight years . Oil recently reached a two-year high .
At current metal prices, Rio Tinto PLC, BHP Group Ltd. , Anglo American PLC and Glencore PLC could this year generate a combined $140 billion in earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization, according to Royal Bank of Canada. That compares with $44 billion in 2015, when metals prices were at or near lows.
However, in Russia, a commodity exporter, surging commodity prices also are driving up inflation. While Russia's international reserves hit $600.9 billion in May, the highest ever, its central bank increased its benchmark interest rate by 0.5 percentage point to 5% in April. It said it would consider further increases, citing "pro-inflationary risks generated by price movements in global commodity markets."
"We think that the inflation pressure in Russia is not transitory, not temporary," Russia's central-bank governor Elvira Nabiullina told CNBC in a recent interview.
...Nicolas Peter, chief financial officer of BMW AG , said in May that it expects an impact of 500 million euros, equivalent to about $608 million, from prices for raw materials. Increased steel prices have added about $515 to the cost of an average U.S. light vehicle, according to Calum MacRae, an auto analyst at GlobalData.
Jun 07, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Like most central banks, the US Federal Reserve has been forced to ask why more than a decade of ultra-loose monetary policy has had such lacklustre economic results.
The Fed's data are misleading because they assume the US is the middle-class nation it has ceased to be.
Until it uses data that reflect the nation as it is, the Fed will no more get America back to shared prosperity than someone using a map of New Amsterdam will find the pond in Central Park.
Jun 07, 2021 | www.msn.com
Speaking with Bloomberg News following a G-7 finance ministers' meeting in London, Yellen said it's OK if President Joe Biden's $4 trillion spending plans trigger inflation and higher rates.
"If we ended up with a slightly higher interest-rate environment it would actually be a plus for society's point of view and the Fed's point of view," she told Bloomberg.
"We've been fighting inflation that's too low and interest rates that are too low now for a decade," she said. "We want them to go back to" a normal environment, "and if this helps a little bit to alleviate things then that's not a bad thing -- that's a good thing."
The Fed has said it won't start to scale back its $120 billion-a-month asset purchases until the economy had made "substantial further progress" toward the Fed's goals of full employment and stable long-run 2% inflation.
While indicators of inflation have been rising , bond yields have been subdued, leaving many experts skeptical that a "taper tantrum" in in the cards whenever the Fed starts paring back its purchases.
Jun 02, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The annual rate of inflation in the eurozone rose in May to hit the European Central Bank's target for the first time since late 2018, as energy prices surged in response to a strengthening recovery in the global economy.
May 31, 2021 | www.wsj.com
"The consumer-price index rose at a remarkable 4.2%," says your editorial, "Powell Gets His Inflation Wish" (May 13). Remarkable, yes, but our current inflation problem is far worse than that 4.2%, which is bad enough. The real issue is what is happening in 2021. We need to realize that for the first four months of this year, the seasonally-adjusted consumer-price index is rising at an annual rate of 6.2%. Without the seasonal adjustments, it is rising at 7.8%. Meanwhile, house prices are inflating at 12%.
We are paying the inevitable price for the Federal Reserve's monetization of government debt and mortgages. As for whether this is "transitory," we may paraphrase J.M. Keynes: In the long run, everything is transitory. But now it is high time for the Fed to begin reducing its debt purchases, and to stop buying mortgages.
May 31, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Inflation is here already, and in the long run there is a lot of upward pressure on prices. But between now and then lies a big question for investors and the economy: Is the Federal Reserve right to think that the price rises we're seeing now are temporary and will abate by next year?
Some at the Fed are already having vague doubts, starting to talk about when to discuss removing some of their extraordinary stimulus even as they continue to push the idea that inflation is likely to fall back of its own accord.
... ... ..
Inflation expectations can become self-fulfilling, and are watched closely by the Fed. One-year consumer inflation expectations reached 4.6% in May, according to the University of Michigan survey, the highest since the China commodity boom of 2011.
Jeffrey P
It is important to not underestimate market sentiment and expectations in such matters because sometimes in economics, the expectation can be strong enough to become a self-fulfilling prediction even when other indicators recede or normally wouldn't be a driver.Jeffrey WhyattI wonder how COLAs in wages, pensions, social security, etc. will impact inflation when these kick in. Think most occur automatically on a given contractual date. Might add fuel to the fire.BRANDON JAMESJust look at the prices for all the things they exclude from the CPI and other indices of inflation.stephen rollinsHow do you tell when the Treasury Sec. and Fed Chair are lying about inflation? When you open your eyes in the morning and the Sun rises in the East.RICHARD TANKSLEYIt seems wise not to overlook the upcoming problems that we might have with China which which have the potential to create even more inflation. Lots of tensions are still around and frankly we should seriously dent US imports from there over the Wuhan virus.BRUCE MONTGOMERY
Economists are good at dissecting the past, but terrible at forecasting the future.ROBERT BAILEYThey predicted 12 out of the last 3 recessionsstephen rollinsYes, and non economists do even worse. Look at the Japanese stock market. About 37K in 1990, cratered, and still only at 28 today. Thats over 30 years, folks.RODNEY EVERSONDefinition of a "Positive Carry Trade": Borrowing money at an interest rate and investing it at a higher rate to earn the difference.RODNEY EVERSONBanks do this with deposits, for example, borrowing money from savers and investing it in higher-yielding loans.
Bond traders typically do it by purchasing longer maturities at, say, three percent and financing them in the repo market at a rate now close to zero.
The main risk to such a trade is that the higher-yielding investment loses value while holding it. The bank loan goes bad, or the long bond falls in value while holding it.
Today the Federal Reserve is running the largest positive carry trade in history, borrowing trillions of dollars from the banking system and paying them 1/10 of one percent on the loans while using the money to buy trillions of bonds and mortgages for its portfolio.
If they raise short rates today, the banks will want more than 1/10 of a percent while, simultaneously, bond prices will crater. Anyone see a conflict here?
There seems to be universal agreement that inflation is underway today. The disagreement is three-part: 1) It will be transitory and we will return to low levels; 2) It will not be transitory and we are facing steadily rising prices for the foreseeable future; 3) Not only will it not be transitory, but it will begin to escalate rapidly with the Fed proving unable or even unwilling to control it, resulting in a hyperinflation.C CookThe bond market is clearly betting on scenario #1, as is the Fed.
And yet the government is spending like the proverbial drunken sailor and the Fed has now abandoned the banking system's fractional reserve mechanism that Volcker employed to bring the 1970's inflation back under control. The result, to my mind, is that the U.S. Government's finances now closely approximate those of Venezuela and Zimbabwe in the recent past while the Fed has relinquished the tools that would ordinarily be used to yield a different result than those countries experienced.
Economics and politics.James CornelioThe story describes reality well. Economics is just fuzzy theory now, neither I nor 99% of America can sort it out. MMT... Print money forever and it doesn't matter?
Politics is clear. History has shown that new administrations lose the House at the first mid-term. If that happens next year, the entire woke/green/leftist agenda goes down in flames. Pelosi is back to being a pedestrian member of the House.
To avoid history, DNC will attempt to spend our grandchildren's future to buy every vote available. Free everything, all the time. No need to work, study, or even get out of bed before noon. Infrastructure is code for pay off Unions to get workers to vote, shake down companies who want construction contracts to donate to DNC.
Equity market is watching. Bond market is watching. Likely, they realize that the only reality is the massive damage to the US which will result from the DNC wanting to keep Nancy happy.
Unexplored in this article is the issue of what CAN the Fed do if there is unacceptable inflationary pressures. To think that it could reduce its $100+ billion monthly purchases in debt let alone raise interest rates by any serious amount is to forget that we are a nation awash in debt and that any move by the Fed to do either would result in a 'taper tantrum' the likes of which will cause all previous tantrums to look like nothing more than naughty child's play.William MackeyThe poster child for inflation has to be in the retail housing market. Fixer Uppers that went begging for a buyer two years ago are the subject of bidding wars today. Biden is pouring trillions into an emergency that is not there.DANIEL PETROSINIThe Fed is now just another political entity. They are justifying the ridiculous increase in money supply with the 'temporary' argument. It is critical to note, they have always been late. This will not end well.jennifer raineriSo right. And everyone is just whistling through the graveyard.Ivaylo IvanovCHING CHANG TSAIOne possibility is that households spend some of their savings but continue to save more than before in case of future trouble, while higher prices make people think twice about splashing out.When people see prices rising across the board they spend and hoard, they don't save, especially when savings accounts interest rates are 0%.In my opinion, anyone with common sense knows that inflation is here. Everything is more expensive than before with a significant difference that draws buyer's attention. Even my home value appreciates about 20% more than the value in 2020, estimated by the local government. Thanks to my senior age that helped me to limit the raise to 10%. I protested in vain due to local taxing authority had hard data on hand to dispute my protest.David WeiszI accept the reality except that FED said this inflation is "transitory." I can hardly wait till next year to see my home value will depreciate back to my 2020 property value. I hope FED will not "lie" on this subject.
I accept the reality except that FED said this inflation is "transitory."The Fed description is accurate... it's just whether the transition is to lower inflation or to runaway inflation.
May 31, 2021 | www.wsj.com
RODNEY EVERSON
Mr. Dale, that's not entirely accurate. Obviously, the value of the cash deteriorates as inflation progresses, but once inflation is underway interest rates, particularly short-term rates, typically escalate. Often in the past, the short rate has gone well above the inflation rate and people holding money market funds do quite well, ending up earning more than the inflation rate and able to take advantage of depressed prices in bonds and even stocks later on.C CookBut if we get a hyperinflation, (and to be fair you did specify "runaway inflation") which isn't out of the question given the Fed's actions, short term rates won't likely reach the level required to make cash a good alternative. At that point, real assets, possibly some stocks, or holding cash denominated in another currency become the only reasonable protection from your savings losing significant value. Cryptocurrencies could also pan out, although there's a huge risk that they do not, and that's despite what inflation does.
You cannot eat gold and crypto is a house of cards. Short term, only cash holds up, and even then inflation eats it away slowly.jennifer raineriLonger term, I believe only place to hide is the mega-cap global franchise stocks. They can dodge government policies and can move assets to where they live better.
How can inflation progress if everything crashes? I believe the horrible mess we've gotten into is going to produce horrific results. The financial crisis was the result of deregulation. What's next will be global and will be due to the sheer stupidity of the reaction to Covid. Throw politics in there too.
May 31, 2021 | www.wsj.com
DDavid Weisz
I accept the reality except that FED said this inflation is "transitory."Jim McCrearyThe Fed description is accurate... it's just whether the transition is to lower inflation or to runaway inflation.
The biggest single factor that will drive long-term inflation is the absence of downward price pressure from new Chinese market entrants. Cutthroat pricing from China is the ONLY reason the West has been able to get away with Money-Printing Gone Wild for the past 20 years without triggering runaway inflation.There are no new Chinese entrants because the Chinese are now all in in the world economy. The existing Chinese competitors are seeing their costs go UP, not down, because they have fully employed the Chinese population, and have to pay up in order to get and keep workers.
So, without any more downward price pressure from China, this latest round of Money-Printing Gone Wild is showing up as price inflation, and will continue to do so.
Batten down the hatches! Stagflation and then runaway inflation are coming!
May 30, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Michael Mackenzie Fri, May 28, 2021, 8:00 PM
Calm has descended across one of the most influential markets for all investors: government bonds. Investors fearing a rolling interest rate shock unfolding in 2021 with the potential for puncturing high-flying equities, housing and highly indebted economies have been breathing easier of late.
Courtesy of central banks' sustained presence in bond markets, this year's rise in market borrowing costs has not triggered a bigger shock, At least for now.
May 28, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The latest clue that trouble is brewing has come from the sudden and dramatic arrival of inflation. On May 12, it was revealed that the Consumer Price Index (CPI) had risen 4.2% year-over-year , the fastest pace since 2008.
Some tried to downplay concern by pointing out that the gains resulted from the "base effect" of comparing current prices with the artificially depressed "Covid lockdown" prices of March and April of last year. But that ignores the more alarming trend of near-term price acceleration.
According to the Bureau of Labor Statistics, in every month this year, the month-over-month change in prices has been greater than the change in the previous month.
In April prices jumped .8% from March, versus an expected gain of just .2%. Clearly, if this trend continues, or even fails to dramatically reverse, we could be looking at inflation well north of 5 or 6 percent for the calendar year. That would create a big problem.
Despite Federal Reserve officials' recent assurances that the inflation problem is "transitory," many investors are concluding that the central bank will have to deal with this problem by tightening monetary policy far sooner than had been expected. This would make sense if the Fed cared about restraining inflation or, more importantly, had the power to do anything to stop it. In truth, we are sailing into these waters with little ability to alter speed or course, and we will be wholly at the mercy of the waves we have spent a generation creating.
May 28, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The Commerce Department on Friday reported that consumer spending rose 0.5% in April from a month earlier, which, coming after March's government stimulus-check-fueled surge, was impressive. The gain was driven by a 1.1% increase in spending on services""an indication of how, with Covid-19 cases dropping and vaccination rates rising , consumers are shifting their behavior. Spending on goods actually declined, with the weakness concentrated in spending on nondurable goods such as groceries and cleaning products.
But a closer look at April's overall gain indicates it was mainly driven by price increases. By the Commerce Department's measure, which is the Federal Reserve's preferred gauge of inflation, consumer prices rose 0.6% in April from March, putting them 3.6% above their year-earlier level. As a result, real, or inflation-adjusted spending declined. Core prices, which exclude the often volatile food and energy categories to better capture inflation's underlying trend, were up 0.7% from March, and 3.1% on the year. The Fed's inflation goal is 2%, though it has said it will tolerate higher readings than that for some time.
May 28, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The latest clue that trouble is brewing has come from the sudden and dramatic arrival of inflation. On May 12, it was revealed that the Consumer Price Index (CPI) had risen 4.2% year-over-year , the fastest pace since 2008.
Some tried to downplay concern by pointing out that the gains resulted from the "base effect" of comparing current prices with the artificially depressed "Covid lockdown" prices of March and April of last year. But that ignores the more alarming trend of near-term price acceleration.
According to the Bureau of Labor Statistics, in every month this year, the month-over-month change in prices has been greater than the change in the previous month.
In April prices jumped .8% from March, versus an expected gain of just .2%. Clearly, if this trend continues, or even fails to dramatically reverse, we could be looking at inflation well north of 5 or 6 percent for the calendar year. That would create a big problem.
Despite Federal Reserve officials' recent assurances that the inflation problem is "transitory," many investors are concluding that the central bank will have to deal with this problem by tightening monetary policy far sooner than had been expected. This would make sense if the Fed cared about restraining inflation or, more importantly, had the power to do anything to stop it. In truth, we are sailing into these waters with little ability to alter speed or course, and we will be wholly at the mercy of the waves we have spent a generation creating.
May 28, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
According to BofA's latest Flows Show, this week's EPFR data revealed a broad defensive retrenchment, culminating with the largest inflow to cash since Apr'20 & largest inflow to gold in 16 weeks ($2.6bn); and while broad inflows to equities continue ($512bn YTD) & largest inflow to Europe since Feb'18 ($2.8bn); we just experienced the largest 3-week outflow from tech since Mar'19 ($1.5bn) as well as the largest outflow from banks since Jun'20 ($0.6bn).
Refinitiv confirms this, reporting this morning that "global money market funds saw huge inflows" amounting to no less than $53.2 billion, the highest in four weeks, in the week ended May 26 amid caution that quickening inflation could alter the direction of U.S. monetary policy and shake up asset markets.
Despite the massive flows into the safety of money market, Refinitiv also finds that global equity funds attracted solid inflows of $8.84 billion, a 46% increase over the previous week, as stocks rallied somewhat after U.S. Federal Reserve officials reaffirmed a dovish monetary policy stance: U.S. equity funds received $2.87 billion, while European equity funds and Asian equity funds obtained $2.47 billion and $1 billion, respectively.
Where the EPFR and Refinitiv data diverge is when it comes to tech. Contrary to the EPFR observation, Refinitiv reports that tech funds attracted inflows worth $546 million after three straight weeks of outflows, while financial sector funds faced their first outflow in 16 weeks, hit by a decline in bond yields.
y_arrowPausebreak 6 hours ago"Refinitiv's analysis of 23,865 emerging-market funds showed equity funds had net outflows worth $463 million, while bond funds had inflows worth $420 million after outflows in the previous week."
Not even a material impact to the stock market.
May 18, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Mary Beth 11 months ago Vanguard eliminated the 30% limitation on investments in non-investment grade bonds today . Any indication of how far they will go to increase returns?
May 20, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Prices for the building blocks of the economy have surged over the past year. Oil, copper, corn and gasoline futures all cost about twice what they did a year ago, when much of the world was locked down to fight the spread of the deadly coronavirus. Lumber has more than tripled.
... ... ...
N
Nidge M
Not sure its adding anything which hasn't been said already but to look at the same thing in a different way:Michael Matus
2, or if you look at it 'sideways' 3, main interwoven factors drive inflation:
Access to money to spend - That can be wage/earnings increases or access to cheap debt. That ups demand & prices follow.
Devaluation of the currency - Pushes up raw material imports & prices follow.What curbs inflation?:
High taxation
High interest rates
High unemploymentAnd if anyone can point to any Western Democracy currently willing to implement any one, never mind all three, of those controls a lot of folk will probably be pretty surprised.
Commodities prices are not the problem. They are high now because of a short-term surge in demand and supply chain issues. All should be worked out by this time next year.Michael BrownThe long-term structural problem could be wages. If inflation shows up in wages through wage increases through a multitude of industries then there will be a problem,....... a major one.
Having all these people on the Dole from the government didn't help things Joe!
But like all Presidents that came after HW Bush all you care about is getting re-elected. Doling out is a great way even if its at the cost of the country.
The FED as been intervening in the markets for so long that they have no tools left for the next crisis.
The FED painted themselves into a corner and the Stimulus that was not needed left them no Escape.
"Having all these people on the Dole from the government didn't help things Joe!"Michael MatusWhat about raising the minimum wage, and Joe commanding that all workers for federal contractors be paid $15 per hour or more? You think that could be inflationary?
I would have to agree with yoiu Michael. I should have mentioned that, thank you for reminding me. However, the main problem with all the sources trhat I have out on the street and their are mnay. Is WAGE growth. As far as a national mimum wage there is none. Altough there probably will be now. Most states pay as high or higher than what the Federal Government was proposing.Michael Brown90% of government contractors make at least $15.00 an hour anyway. The VAST majority of the problem is enhanced unemployment insurance. The 3 month averge of wage groth ending in March was 3.4%. If it hits > 4.0% that will be bad.
Excellent points, Michael. The list of government actions instigating inflation would be long indeed.Michael MatusUnfortunately, Michael, I would have to Wholeheartedly agree with you, Have a Good Weekend!JOSEPH MICHAELSerious, severe inflationary problems are here, they are just starting, and they are going to get much worse.Brian Kearnseh.Bill Hestir
best to give corporations a large tax cutso the can buy back stock
I will interested to see if new car prices, lumber prices, new home prices, gasoline prices, and food prices will ever go back down to pre-pandemic levels.Deirdre HoodIf not, with all the new anti-business taxes and reluctance of out-of-work laborers to go back to work, how will businesses not be forced to raise their wages and increase the price of their products even higher than they are today?
At what point, therefore, will the Fed end their "inflation is transitory" farce and raise interest rates?
Food prices, regardless of when inflation ends, will not go down/return to 'normal'.Judy NeuwirthSupply lines are squeezed (NO ONE can hire reliable transport drivers), low supply of workers, plus factor in a bad year for wheat, and it turns into the perfect storm for commercial bakers.
Inflation is just getting started. Cho Bi-Den's hyper-regulated economy is only three months old and already it's 1976 all over again!Jim ChapmanNow Judy, it's just "transitory" inflation as per Yellen, Powell and Buyden. You really must stick with the narrative, and remember, Adam Smith's scurrilous "Invisible Hand" is a ultra-right wing conservative myth. So we are not supposed to believe our lying eyes.
May 24, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The price of the benchmark 10-year Treasury inflation-protected security logged its biggest one-day decline in a month. Shares of real-estate investment trusts slid the most since January. Commodities were generally flat but dropped the following day.
The three asset classes have vacillated since, but their initial moves showed the unexpected ways that markets can behave when inflation is rising, especially when many are already expensive by historical measures.
This week, investors will gain greater insight into the inflation picture when the Commerce Department updates the Federal Reserve's preferred inflation gauge, the personal-consumption-expenditures price index. They will also track earnings from the likes of Dollar General Corp. , Costco Wholesale Corp. and Salesforce.com Inc.
The stakes are high for investors. Inflation dents the value of traditional government and corporate bonds because it reduces the purchasing power of their fixed interest payments. But it can also hurt stocks, analysts say, by pushing up interest rates and increasing input costs for companies.
From early 1973 through last December, stocks have delivered positive inflation-adjusted returns in 90% of rolling 12-month periods that occurred when inflation""as measured by the consumer-price index""was below 3% and rising, according to research by Sean Markowicz, a strategist at Schroders, the U.K. asset-management firm. But that fell to only 48% of the periods when inflation was above 3% and rising.
A recent report from the Labor Department showed that the consumer-price index jumped 4.2% in April from a year earlier, up from 2.6% in March. Even excluding volatile food and energy prices, it was up 3% from a year earlier, blowing past analysts' expectations for a 2.3% gain.
Analysts say that there are plenty of reasons why inflation won't be able to maintain that pace for long. The latest year-over-year numbers were inflated by comparisons to deeply depressed prices from the early days of the pandemic. They were also supported by supply bottlenecks that many view as fixable and robust consumer demand that could dissipate once households have spent government stimulus checks.
... ... ...
By comparison, the S&P GSCI Commodity Total Return Index delivered positive inflation-adjusted returns in 83% of the high and rising inflation periods. "Commodities are a source of input costs for companies and they're also a key component of the inflation index, which by definition you're trying to hedge," said Mr. Markowicz.
At the same time, commodities are among the most volatile of all asset classes and can be influenced by an array of idiosyncratic factors.
T
Tracy Harris
Charles Goodhart, the economist from the Bank of England, has just written an important book arguing that worldwide demographic changes are going to result in a couple of decades of high inflation. See Charles Goodhart, The Great Democratic Reversal: Ageing Societies, Waning Inequality, and an Inflation Revival. Maybe the Journal could find someone to review it. Maybe Ms. Yellen should read it.Bruce Fegley(Douglas Levene)
This article is naive, if not ridiculous, for several reasons. I name a few.Theo Walker1st - the stock market is the best hedge against inflation over a long time period - years, not daily, weekly, or quarterly. Especially with dividend reinvesting and with an automatic buying plan like the DRIP plans offered by many companies at no or very low cost.
2nd - Individuals can buy US government I-series savings bonds at NO COST directly from the US Treasury, and while they do not completely hedge against inflation, they offer good interest rates that beat bank interest and are completely insured.
3rd - Toyota and perhaps other car companies offer notes with higher interest than banks but not FDIC insured. About 1.5% now.
One does not have to blow money away on bitcoin or hold gold, which is taxed as a collectible and has assay fees on the front and back ends of any buy/sell transaction unless one is buying coins which have a markup to begin with.
Started buying I-bonds this month. The rates are great! Easily the best safe investment right now.Bryson Marsh... why would you buy TIPS? The spread is a farce after all.PHILIP NICHOLASInflation is always sticky . In other words all the prices do not go down . Wages that are increased , usually stay . Companies sense a new level they can pass on to consumers . And the Government damage to energy prices will influence prices .Bryson MarshMemory costs, data plans, and televisions are all examples that clearly demonstrate secular price declines despite periodic increases.Charles DA Eichler"Inflation Forces Investors to Scramble for Solutions"Hundreds of millions of Americans are going to suffer as the Federal Government inflates the national debt away over the next 10 to 15 years. Investors will figure it out, but the little guy will get crushed once again. Oh well, we get the government we deserve.CME futures contracts ...Paul SmithOIL - NAT GAS - PROPYLENE - COPPER - LUMBER - STEEL - SOYBEAN - 2 yr. and 5 yr. T-Note
They are all substantially down, one year from now; except Copper and financials which are flat.
What does that say about the economy & inflation in one year?
I am under the impression that the Social Security COLA is based on a September to September comparison of the CPI-U. That is to say, for example, September 2020 CPI-U vs. September 2021 CPI-U. Is this not correct?James WebbWe have had inflation over over the past decade or so. As measured by the CPI-U, it has hovered around 2 percent. Not a big deal to the Fed's economists. Cumulatively, however, it adds up.
I have been retired for 16 years. Inflation has eroded the purchasing power of my fixed pension by 25.5. Mercifully, I have other resources to make up the loss, but for people on a fixed pension, so-called mild inflation can wreck it over time.
Paul, one of the lower estimates for 2022:James Robertson"The Kiplinger Letter is forecasting that the annual cost-of-living adjustment for Social Security benefits for 2022 will be 4.5%, the biggest jump since 2008, when benefits rose 5.8%. That would also be higher than the 3% adjustment The Kiplinger Letter predicted earlier this year."
From SocialSecurity dot gov:
"To determine the COLA, the average CPI-W for the third calendar quarter of the most recent year a COLA was determined is compared to the average CPI-W for the third calendar quarter of the current year. The resulting percentage increase, if any, represents the percentage that will be used to increase Social Security benefits beginning for December of the current year. "
So the predicted 4.5-4.7% increase for 2022 will take effect December 31 this year.
Of course the calculation is not completed yet....
The Fed's inflation calculations have become increasingly "fuzzy" since the Boskin Commission in 1995. The CPI ignores housing, food, and energy. Healthcare gets weighted at 3 percent, though it accounts for 18 percent of expenditures. "Hedonic quality adjustment" is another knob the Fed turns to "control" inflation. Inflation calculated by comparing the price of a basket of goods this year to a basket of goods last year runs quite a bit higher than the CPI; even higher if you include food, shelter, and energy in that basket.James WebbWhat's in the CPI?Tim Adams-Food and Beverages (breakfast cereal, milk, coffee, chicken, wine, full service meals, snacks)
-Housing (rent of primary residence, owners' equivalent rent, fuel oil, bedroom furniture)
-Clothes (men's shirts and sweaters, women's dresses, jewelry)
-Transportation (new vehicles, airline fares, gasoline, motor vehicle insurance)
-Medical Care (prescription drugs and medical supplies, physicians' services, eyeglasses and eye care, hospital services)
-Recreation (televisions, toys, pets and pet products, sports equipment, admissions)
-Education and Communication (college tuition, postage, telephone services, computer software and accessories)
-Other Goods and Services (tobacco and smoking products, haircuts and other personal services, funeral expenses)The core CPI which the Fed uses excludes food and energy. The Consumer price index which is used for things like social security adjustments does not. These very similar but different uses of the same acronym just adds to the confusion.
May 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The prospect of tighter monetary conditions in emerging markets still hasn't changed the overall calculus for many investors, with behemoths including Pacific Investment Management Co. and BlackRock Inc. focusing on the growth story instead. Developing-nation inflation remains near a record low, with the economic rebound making assets look "increasingly interesting," according to Dan Ivascyn, Pimco's group chief investment officer in Newport Beach, California.
Yet there's a growing sense that the forces behind the recovery will eventually feed through to higher prices if left unchecked. One harbinger could be the rally in commodities, with a key index of raw materials this month jumping to a five-year high.
"If the stimulus continues, at some point it will become inflationary," said Sanjiv Bhatia, the chief investment officer at Pembroke Emerging Markets in London. "At some point, we believe it will become a problem."
For now, assurances from the Federal Reserve that inflation in the U.S. is unlikely to get out of control have supported the bulls. The Fed appears in no rush to raise interest rates, a move that would siphon capital out of emerging economies currently enjoying the windfall from U.S. stimulus.
That major central banks currently view inflation as transitory should boost developing-nation currencies as a whole, according to Henrik Gullberg, a London-based macro strategist at Coex Partners Ltd.
MSCI Inc.'s emerging-market currency index has climbed to a record high, while the benchmark equity gauge just posted its biggest two-day rally in almost two weeks amid a rally in energy and technology shares. On Friday, risk assets got further support when U.S. job growth data significantly undershot forecasts.
"On the one hand, the valuations of growth stocks look meaningfully less demanding after recent underperformance coupled with earnings upgrades," said Kate Moore, the head of thematic strategy at BlackRock in New York. "On the other, rising inflationary pressures from the broad economic restart and low inventories should be supportive of cyclicals and commodity producers."
May 21, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Originally from Government Bond Yields Fall as Investors Grapple With Muddied Economic Picture by By Paul J. Davies
In the U.S., inflation readings have been strong and the minutes of the last Fed meeting released Wednesday showed there had been some discussion about slowing bond purchases -- also known as taper talk.
... Mark Carbana, U.S. rates strategist at Bank of America, still expects U.S. rates to rise further especially if there is a strong reading for the Fed's preferred measure of inflation, personal consumption expenditures, due out next Friday. "Uncertainty around inflation is the highest it has been in decades," he said, particularly around whether recent high readings are temporary or due to changes in the underlying economy. He expects Treasury yields to rise in the second half of the year , pushed higher by rises in yields on inflation-protected Treasurys as the Fed starts to talk more seriously about tapering its bond purchases.
Write to Paul J. Davies at [email protected]
May 27, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
As the credit strategist continues, "while it is easy to blame transitory factors, these were surely all known about before the last several data prints and could have been factored into forecasts. That they weren't suggests that the transitory forces are more powerful than economists imagined or that there is more widespread inflation than they previously believed. "
To be sure, all such "˜surprise' indices always mean revert so the inflation one will as well. However as Reid concludes, "the fact that we're seeing an overwhelming positive beat on US inflation surprises in recent times must surely reduce the confidence to some degree of those expecting it to be transitory. "
May 25, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Inflation fears already roiled the market this week with the Nasdaq falling nearly 2%, but one hedge fund founder is sounding the alarm over a potential 20% collapse that could be sparked by the Federal Reserve signaling an end to accommodative pandemic-era monetary policy later this year.
Satori Fund founder Dan Niles recently told Yahoo Finance that this week's hotter-than-anticipated inflation data coupled with other central banks around the world already coming off their easy money policies will likely corner the Fed into tapering its accommodative policies sooner than expected.
"If you've got food prices, energy prices, shelter prices moving up as rapidly as they are, the Fed's not going to have any choice," he said, predicting that the Fed could signal the beginning of a move to wind down its monthly $120 billion a month pace of asset purchases by this summer. "They can say what they want, but this reminds me to some degree of them saying back in 2007 that the subprime crisis was well contained. Obviously it wasn't."
May 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The prospect of a rebound to 2% yields on the world's benchmark bond is alive and well.
Treasury-market bears found a deeper message within Friday's weak employment report that's emboldened a view that inflationary pressures are on the rise, and could boost rates to levels not seen since 2019. For Mark Holman at TwentyFour Asset Management, the sub-par April labor reading indicated companies will need to lift wages to entice people back into the labor force; he's expecting a break of 2% on the 10-year this year.
That level has come to symbolize a return to pre-pandemic normalcy in both markets and the economy. The wild ride in markets on Friday suggests Holman likely has company in his views. Ten-year yields initially plunged to a more than two-month low of 1.46%, then reversed to end the day at 1.58%. Meanwhile, a key market proxy of inflation expectations surged to a level last seen in 2013.
May 24, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
What would happen to the financial system if the Fed stopped printing massive amounts of money for stimulus and debt service? Williams explains,
" You could see financial implosion by preventing liquidity being put into the system. The system needs liquidity (freshly created dollars) to function. Without that liquidity, you would see more of an economic implosion than you have already seen. In fact, I will contend that the headline pandemic numbers have actually been a lot worse than they have been reporting. It also means we are not recovering quite as quickly. The Fed needs to keep the banking system afloat. They want to keep the economy afloat. All that requires a tremendous influx of liquidity in these difficult times."
So, is the choice inflation or implosion? Williams says, "That's the choice, and I think we are going to have a combination of both of them. .."
" I think we are eventually headed into a hyperinflationary economic collapse. It's not that we haven't been in an economic collapse already, we are coming back some now. . . . The Fed has been creating money at a pace that has never been seen before. You are basically up 75% (in money creation) year over year. This is unprecedented. Normally, it might be up 1% or 2% year over year. The exploding money supply will lead to inflation. I am not saying we are going to get to 75% inflation -- yet, but you are getting up to the 4% or 5% range, and you are soon going to be seeing 10% range year over year. . . . The Fed has lost control of inflation. "
And remember, when the Fed has to admit the official inflation rate is 10%, John Williams says, "When they have to admit the inflation rate is 10%, my number is going to be up to around 15% or higher. My number rides on top of their number."
Right now, the Shadowstat.com inflation rate is above 11%. That's if it were calculated the way it was before 1980 when the government started using accounting gimmicks to make inflation look less than it really is. The Shadowstats.com number cuts out all the accounting gimmicks and is the true inflation rate that most Americans are seeing right now, not the "official" 4.25% recently reported.
Williams says the best way to fight the inflation that is already here is to buy tangible assets. Williams says,
"Canned food is a tangible asset, and you can use it for barter if you have to. . . . Physical gold and silver is the best way to protect your buying power over time."
Gold may be a bit expensive for most, but silver is still relatively cheap. Williams says, "Everything is going to go up in price."
When will the worst inflation be hitting America? Williams predicts,
"I am looking down the road, and in early 2022, I am looking for something close to a hyperinflationary circumstance and effectively a collapsed economy."
Join Greg Hunter of USAWatchdog.com as he goes One-on-One with John Williams, founder of ShadowStats.com.
2 play_arrow 1
Nikki Alexis 7 minutes ago
Cautiously Pessimistic 59 minutes agoJohn Williams warning about hyperinflation is like Peter Schitt telling me stocks are going to crash. It's coming, it's coming! Boy crying wolf.
NoDebt 54 minutes ago remove linkAccounting Gimmicks. Election Gimmicks. Gender Gimmicks. Science Gimmicks. Rule of Law Gimmicks.
America has become one big fun house of gimmicks.
Time for a RESET.
Samual Vimes 47 minutes ago (Edited)Yeah, the Reset Gimmick. Where they fundamentally transform themselves into a permanent position of power. Never mind that they'll kill millions to achieve it.
What about gutting primary dealers by buying T bills directly ?
https://www.zerohedge.com/economics/fed-prepares-go-direct-liquidity
May 18, 2021 | wolfstreet.com
Who Bought the $4.7 Trillion of Treasury Securities Added Since March 2020 to the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt? by Wolf Richter • May 17, 2021 • 119 Comments The Fed did. Nearly everyone did. Even China nibbled again. Here's who holds that monstrous $28.1 trillion US National Debt.
By Wolf Richter for WOLF STREET .The US national debt has been decades in the making, was then further fired up when the tax cuts took effect in 2018 during the Good Times. But starting in March 2020, it became the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt. Since that moment 15 months ago, it spiked by $4.7 trillion, to $28.14 trillion, amounting to 128% of GDP in current dollars:
But who bought this $4.7 trillion in new debt?We can piece this together through the first quarter in terms of the categories of holders: Foreign buyers as per the Treasury International Capital data, released this afternoon by the Treasury Department; the purchases by the Fed as per its weekly balance sheet; the purchases by the US banks as per the Federal Reserve Board of Governors bank balance-sheet data; and the purchases by US government entities, such as US government pension funds, as per the Treasury Department's data on Treasury securities.
Foreign creditors of the US.Japan , the largest foreign creditor of the US, dumped $18 billion of US Treasuries in March, reducing its stash to $1.24 trillion. Since March 2020, its holdings dropped by $32 billion.
https://664e3285974f21e0f93cbda833cec3c8.safeframe.googlesyndication.com/safeframe/1-0-38/html/container.html
China had been gradually reducing its holdings over the past few years, but then late last year started adding to them again. In March, its holdings ticked down for the first time in months, by $4 billion, bringing its holdings to $1.1 trillion. Since March 2020, it added $9 billion:
But Japan's and China's importance as creditors to the US has been diminishing because the US debt has ballooned. In March, their combined share (green line) fell to 8.3%, the lowest in many years:
All foreign holders combined dumped $70 billion in Treasury securities in March, bringing their holdings to $7.028 trillion (blue line, left scale). But this was still up by $79 billion from March 2020.
These foreign holders include foreign central banks, foreign government entities, and foreign private-sector entities such as companies, banks, bond funds, and individuals. Despite the increase of their holdings since March 2020, their share of the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt fell to 25.0%, the lowest since 2007 (red line, right scale):
After Japan & China, the 10 biggest foreign holders include tax havens where US corporations have mailbox entities where some of their Treasury holdings are registered. But Germany and Mexico, with which the US has massive trade deficits, are in 17th and 24th place. The percentages indicate the change from March 2020. Note the percentage increase of India's holdings:
US government funds hit record, but share of total debt drops further.US government pension funds for federal civilian employees, pension funds for the US military, the US Social Security Trust Fund , and other federal government funds bought on net $5 billion of Treasury securities in Q1 and $98 billion since March 2020, bringing their holdings to a record of $6.11 trillion (blue line, left scale).
But that increase was outrun by the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt, and their share of total US debt dropped to 21.8%, the lowest since dirt was young, and down from a share of 45% in 2008 (red line, right scale):
Federal Reserve goes hog-wild: monetization of the US debt.The Fed bought on net $243 billion of Treasury securities in Q1 and $2.44 trillion since it began the bailouts of the financial markets in March 2020. Over this period through March 31, it has more than doubled its holdings of Treasuries to $4.94 trillion (blue line, left scale). It now holds a record of 17.6% of the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt (red line, right scale):
US Banks pile them up.US commercial banks bought on net $28 billion in Treasury securities in Q1 and $267 billion since March 2020, bringing the total to a record $1.24 trillion, according to Federal Reserve data on bank balance sheets. They now hold 4.4% of the Incredibly Spiking US National Debt:
Other US entities & individualsSo far, we covered the net purchases by all foreign-registered holders, by the Fed, by US government funds, and by US banks. What's unaccounted for: US individuals and institutions other than the Fed, the banks, and the government. These include bond funds, private-sector, state, and municipal pension funds, insurers, US corporations, hedge funds (they use Treasuries in complex leveraged trades), private equity firms that need to park billions in "dry powder," etc.
These US entities hold the remainder of Incredibly Spiking US National Debt. Their holdings surged by $149 billion in Q4 and by $2.35 trillion since March 2020, to a record $8.76 trillion (blue line, left scale). This raised their share of the total debt to 31.2% (red line, right scale), making these US individuals and institutions combined the largest holder of that monstrous mountain of debt:
The Incredibly Spiking US National Debt and who holds it, all in one monstrous pile:Enjoy reading WOLF STREET and want to support it? Using ad blockers – I totally get why – but want to support the site? You can donate. I appreciate it immensely. Click on the beer and iced-tea mug to find out how:
May 17, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
May 17, 2021Inflation fears already roiled the market this week with the Nasdaq falling nearly 2%, but one hedge fund founder is sounding the alarm over a potential 20% collapse that could be sparked by the Federal Reserve signaling an end to accommodative pandemic-era monetary policy later this year.
Satori Fund founder Dan Niles recently told Yahoo Finance that this week's hotter-than-anticipated inflation data coupled with other central banks around the world already coming off their easy money policies will likely corner the Fed into tapering its accommodative policies sooner than expected.
"If you've got food prices, energy prices, shelter prices moving up as rapidly as they are, the Fed's not going to have any choice," he said, predicting that the Fed could signal the beginning of a move to wind down its monthly $120 billion a month pace of asset purchases by this summer. "They can say what they want, but this reminds me to some degree of them saying back in 2007 that the subprime crisis was well contained. Obviously it wasn't."
For their part, Fed officials have remained adamant that a rise in inflation is to be expected as a transitory reality of the economy reopening from the pandemic lockdown. The latest print from the Bureau of Labor Statistics out this week , however, may have spooked investors when it showed consumer prices for the month of April rose at their fastest annual pace since 2008. That inflation metric, which is different than the Fed's preferred Personal Consumption Expenditures (PCE) index , jumped to a 4.2% rise over the last 12 months. The Fed has already signaled it would be comfortable staying accommodative even if inflation in the recovery shoots past 2% as measured by its preferred metric.
May 16, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
In the US, this translates to a growth environment where GDP will be 3pp above its pre-COVID-19 path by end-2022 and underlying core PCE inflation (adjusted for base effects) rises above 2%Y from March 2022. The Fed, which is now aiming for inflation averaging 2%Y and maximum employment, should remain accommodative. Our chief US economist Ellen Zentner expects the Fed to signal its intention to taper asset purchases at the September FOMC meeting, to announce it in March 2022 and to start tapering from April 2022 . On our forecasts, rate hikes begin in 3Q23, after inflation remains at or above 2%Y for some time and the labour market reaches maximum employment.
What are the risks to this story? Most obvious is the emergence of new COVID-19 variants that resist vaccines. However, I have argued that the biggest threat to this cycle is an overshoot in US core PCE inflation beyond the Fed's implicit 2.5%Y threshold – a serious concern, in my view, which could emerge from mid-2022 onwards .
Portal 4 hours ago
Newpuritan 4 hours agoLMFAO!!!
You sent manufacturing and industry to China.
There is no "red hot recovery.". Just a long descent into fascism and communist poverty.
Iskiab 2 hours ago (Edited)The "red hot recovery." they are hoping for is replacing all efficient energy production with inefficient "green" energy. The costs will be astronomical but are hoped to offset the Boomer generation retirement period.
JH2020 3 hours ago (Edited)Yea, all these forecasting models are garbage. They're all based on a faulty assumption that trends continue so the growth we see now will continue, plus things will revert back to the trend line. Junk in, junk out.
A more realistic assessment would be there was a bump from reopening, but costs have increased. It will be impossible to get back to the old growth trend line, and expect the low growth of the last 20 years to continue from hereon out. The stimulus will help a bit but not much, most of the stimulus was misallocated.
ebworthen 4 hours agoIt's the sycophants of the Wall Street/government confidence game, dropping words that, hopefully, lead to buying securities, not selling, though, perversely, any negative truths result in the assumption there will be a new flood of free money, from the Fed, driving margin debt even more vertical, such that one needs a second page for the chart, or a more drastic log scale. (In this economy so red hot interests rates need to be kept near zero, for the remainder of the century, and near daily reassurance the Fed will accommodate anything and everything, whatsoever, anytime a sector gets some heartburn, or a red candlestick gets too large.)
Red hot = FOMO bait.
The "red not" verbiage is comical, reminds me of Hollywood sycophants, that write reviews of some pretend person, some degenerate nobody, "In an unparalleled display of performing brilliance, in this worthy sequel to A Couple Hours of Brains Splattered All Over the Wall, and which only proves his sheer genius, the way he flared his nostrils, while driving in the chase scene, that went two times around the entire city perimeter, in the ongoing lanes...".
hugin-o-munin 4 hours ago (Edited)"Red hot global recovery"? ROFLMAO!
That isn't recovery, it is money printing, inflation, and rabid speculation.
J J Pettigrew 3 hours agoWho do these people think they can fool?
This was about the dumbest article by a bank in a long while. Pushing a contrarian lie too hard reveals it quicker than keeping quiet. Someone should remind Morgan Stanley of this age old truth. Real inflation is destroying the USD right now. Ignoring it and pretending otherwise will only accelerate the fall into hyper inflation.
Sound of the Suburbs 2 hours agoA little inflation is good for you.
What's a little? 2.5%? For ten years....a flat chart of 2.5% each year... .looks like nothing happened....just 28% off the value of the dollar...thats all.
Sound of the Suburbs 2 hours agoHow does anything really work?
I don't know, I use neoclassical economics.
Everyone tries to kill growth by making the same mistakes as Japan.
Japan led the way and everyone followed.
At 25.30 mins you can see the super imposed private debt-to-GDP ratios.
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=vAStZJCKmbU&list=PLmtuEaMvhDZZQLxg24CAiFgZYldtoCR-R&index=6
What Japan does in the 1980s; the US, the UK and Euro-zone do leading up to 2008 and China has done more recently.
The PBoC saw the financial crisis coming unlike the BoJ, ECB, BoE and the FED.
Oh dear, we did what you did in Japan.
Now we've had a financial crisis and are facing a Great Depression just like you.
Japan could study the Great Depression to avoid this fate.
(The US had done the same thing in the 1920s (see graph above), it always seems to happen with neoclassical economics)
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=8YTyJzmiHGk
How did Japan avoid a Great Depression?
They saved the banks
How did Japan kill growth and inflation for the next thirty years?
They left the debt in place and the repayments on that debt killed growth and inflation (Japanification)
The Chinese did see the financial crisis coming, but they have reached the end of the line on the debt fuelled growth model of globalisation.
They just need to find out how an economy really works.
As if anyone has got the slightest idea what they are doing.
How does anything really work?
I don't know, I use neoclassical economics.
Sound of the Suburbs 2 hours agoEveryone tries to kill growth by making the same mistakes as Japan.
European policymakers were successful.
What does Japanification look like?
https://tradingeconomics.com/japan/gdp
(Set scale to max. to get the full picture)
The EU economy hasn't been going anywhere since 2008.
https://tradingeconomics.com/european-union/gdp
(Set scale to max. to get the full picture)
It's Japanification
The UK economy has hasn't been going anywhere since 2008.
https://tradingeconomics.com/united-kingdom/gdp
(Set scale to max. to get the full picture)
It's Japanification
Well done, you dimwits.
How does anything really work?
I don't know, I use neoclassical economics.
Sound of the Suburbs 2 hours ago (Edited) remove linkWhy did they think private debt wouldn't be a problem after 2008?
Probably the same reason they didn't notice it building up before 2008.
The economics of globalisation has always had an Achilles' heel.
The 1920s roared with debt based consumption and speculation until it all tipped over into the debt deflation of the Great Depression. No one realised the problems that were building up in the economy as they used an economics that doesn't look at debt, neoclassical economics.
Not considering private debt is the Achilles' heel of neoclassical economics.
That explains it.
"We cannot solve our problems with the same thinking we used when we created them." Albert Einstein.
Who do you think you are?
This is what we are going to do, whether you like it or not.
He must be one of those populists.
Einstein was right of course, but you know what neoliberals are like.
Anyone that doesn't go along with their ideas must be a populist.
Not considering private debt is the Achilles' heel of neoclassical economics.
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=vAStZJCKmbU&list=PLmtuEaMvhDZZQLxg24CAiFgZYldtoCR-R&index=6
At 18 mins.
1929 and 2008 stick out like sore thumbs.
No one realised the problems that were building up in the economy as they used an economics that doesn't look at debt, neoclassical economics.
Einstein's definition of madness "Doing the same thing again and again and expecting to get a different result"
Einstein was right again.
He was a clever bloke.
May 13, 2021 | www.ft.com
... prices for used cars and trucks jumped 10 per cent in April alone, accounting for a large slice of the gains in the overall index.
"It looks like Wall Street is climbing the wall of worry," said Gregory Perdon, co-chief investment officer at private bank Arbuthnot Latham. "The bears are constantly looking for signs that the world is going to end. They come up with all the potential excuses. The reality is that the only question that matters is whether the reopening is going OK or not.
... Notably, while 10-year US yields did rise on Wednesday after the inflation data release, they did not hit new highs.
May 13, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Inflation is back. The U.S. consumer-price index surged to a 13-year high of 4.2% in April, official data showed Wednesday. The eurozone's figure is a weaker 1.6%, but still a two-year high. The global bond market isn't panicking yet. The pandemic led many distressed companies to slash prices in 2020. Investors always knew that, as the economy reopened, some year-over-year increases would be huge.
The prices of most products haven't changed much . CPI gyrations are mostly down to a few items particularly affected by lockdowns and travel restrictions, such as airfares and restaurant prices, as well as commodities. Excluding food and energy, U.S. inflation in April was just 3%.
... Over the past few decades, for example, CPI figures have mostly been the results of a concatenation of "temporary" trends in different sectors -- the costs of education and healthcare rose nonstop, while the prices of many goods continuously fell. It was different in the 1970s, when an idiosyncratic squeeze in the supply of oil fueled an inflationary spiral that pushed all costs up.
May 12, 2021 | www.moonofalabama.org
paulmeli , May 12 2021 18:50 utc | 21
"Inflation" in the US is mostly profit-taking and speculation (scalping)
May 11, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
...As Peter Schiff put it, CPI is a lie . Grant used the evolution of the toothbrush into its electric form as an example. How do you measure the clear quality improvements in the toothbrush? The government uses hedonics to measure these changes, but as Grant pointed out, this is "inexact and not really a science."
Grant believes that the economy can only tolerate 2.5% real rates. If that is breached, he thinks the Fed will have to resort to yield-curve control. If it does actually try to shrink its balance sheet and sell bonds, it will drive bond yields even higher. Fed bond-buying is the only thing propping up the bond market right now.
In fact, the Fed is propping up the entire economy. There is a sense that the Fed will always step in and save the markets. As a result, we have bubbles everywhere, from the stock market, to real estate, to cryptocurrency.
"These are strange and oppressive markers of financial markets that have lost moorings of valuation," Grant said.
I think the astounding complacency toward, or indifference of, the evident excesses in our monetary and fiscal affairs I think the lack of concern about those things is perhaps the most striking inflationary augur I know of."
Meanwhile, the Fed continues to create money. M1 annual growth is 350%; M2 is growing at approximately 28%.
"Never before have we had monetary peacetime growth this fast," Grant said.
"Tell me who cares."
Grant said central bankers like Powell are guilty of hubris. They suffer from the delusion that they can actually control everything. Grant called the Fed "un-self-aware."
Despite Jay Powell's credentials, he knows nothing about the past and believes he knows everything about the future."
Grant talked about gold , saying it is an investment in "monetary disorder."
To me, gold isn't a hedge against monetary disorder. It's an investment in monetary disorder, which is what we have. We have floating-rate currencies. We have manipulated exchange rates. We have manipulated interest rates. When the cycle turns, people will want gold and silver, and they will want something tangible ."
May 11, 2021 | wolfstreet.com
Consumers are picking up on the rise of inflation, and the Fed, which has been trying to heat up inflation, is pleased. The Fed watches "inflation expectations" carefully. The minutes from the March FOMC meeting mention "inflation expectations" 12 times.
The New York Fed's Survey of Consumer Expectations for April, released today, showed that median inflation expectations for one year from now rose to 3.4%, matching the prior highs in 2013 (the surveys began in June 2013).
But wait the median earnings growth expectations 12 months from now was only 2.1%, and remains near the low end of the spectrum, a sign that consumers are grappling with consumer price inflation outrunning earnings growth. The whoppers were in the major specific categories.
Dec 17, 2015 | economistsview.typepad.com
Peter K. -> RC AKA Darryl, Ron... December 17, 2015 at 10:12 AM"Corporate bond rates have been rising steadily since May. Yellen is not doing what Greenspan did in 2004."There isn't much of a difference between signaling tighter money to a market that is skeptical of Fed forecasts and actually tightening.
http://cepr.net/press-center/press-releases/statement-on-fed-and-interest-rates
Washington, D.C.- Dean Baker, economist and a co-director of the Center for Economic and Policy Research (CEPR) issued the following statement in response to the Federal Reserve's decision regarding interest rates:
"The Fed's decision to raise interest rates today is an unfortunate move in the wrong direction. In setting interest rate policy the Fed must decide whether the economy is at risk of having too few or too many jobs, with the latter being determined by the extent to which its current rate of job creation may lead to inflation. It is difficult to see how the evidence would lead the Fed to conclude that the greater risk at the moment is too many jobs.
"While at 5.0 percent, the unemployment rate is not extraordinarily high, most other measures of the labor market are near recession levels. The percentage of the workforce that is involuntarily working part-time is near the highs reached following the 2001 recession. The average and median duration of unemployment spells are also near recession highs. And the percentage of workers who feel confident enough to quit their jobs without another job lined up remains near the low points reached in 2002.
"If we look at employment rates rather than unemployment, the percentage of prime-age workers (ages 25-54) with jobs is still down by almost three full percentage points from the pre-recession peak and by more than four full percentage points from the peak hit in 2000. This does not look like a strong labor market.
"On the other side, there is virtually no basis for concerns about the risk of inflation in the current data. The most recent data show that the core personal consumption expenditure deflator targeted by the Fed increased at just a 1.2 percent annual rate over the last three months, down slightly from the 1.3 percent rate over the last year. This means that the Fed should be concerned about being below its inflation target, not above it.
"While wage growth has edged up somewhat in recent months by some measures, it is still well below a rate that is consistent with the Fed's inflation target. Hourly wages have risen at a 2.7 percent rate over the last year. If there is just 1.5 percent productivity growth, this would be consistent with a rate of inflation of 1.2 percent.
"Furthermore, it is important to recognize that workers took a large hit to their wages in the downturn, with a shift of more than four percentage points of national income from wages to profits. In principle, workers can restore their share of national income (the equivalent of an 8 percent wage gain), but the Fed would have to be prepared to allow wage growth to substantially outpace prices for a period of time. If the Fed acts to prevent workers from getting this bargaining power, it will effectively lock in place this upward redistribution. Needless to say, workers at the middle and bottom of the wage distribution can expect to see the biggest hit in this scenario.
"One positive point in today's action is the Fed's commitment in its statement to allow future rate hikes to be guided by the data, rather than locking in a path towards "normalization" as was effectively done in 2004. If it is the case that the economy is not strong enough to justify rate hikes, then the hike today may be the last one for some period of time. It will be important for the Fed to carefully assess the data as it makes its decision on interest rates at future meetings.
"Recent economic data suggest that today's move was a mistake. Hopefully the Fed will not compound this mistake with more unwarranted rate hikes in the future."
RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to Peter K....
I like Dean Baker. Unlike the Fed, Dean Baker is a class warrior on the side of the wage class. He makes the point about the path to normalization being critical that I have been discussing for quite a while. Let's hope this Fed knows better than Greenspan/Bernanke in 2004-2006. THANKS!
likbez said in reply to RC AKA Darryl, Ron...
Very true !
pgl said in reply to RC AKA Darryl, Ron...
"Longer-term bond rates barely moved, showing that there was very little news." This interest rate rose from 4.45% to 5.46% already. So the damage was already done:
RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to pgl...
"... This interest rate rose from 4.45% to 5.46% already..."
Exactly! Corporate bond rates have been rising steadily since May. Yellen is not doing what Greenspan did in 2004. Yellen's Fed waited until the bond rate lifted off on its own (and maybe with some help from policy communications) before they raised the FFR.
So far, there is no sign of their making a fatal error. They are not fighting class warfare for wage class either, but they seem intent on not screwing the pooch in the way that Greenspan and Bernanke did. No double dip thank you and hold the nuts.
Apr 26, 2021 | wolfstreet.com
YuShan Apr 18, 2021 at 3:13 am
historicus Apr 18, 2021 at 5:06 amExactly. It is way more scary than even Wolf's charts suggest because there are so many layers of leverage stacked on top of each other.
People taking out margin debt on stock portfolios that they bought by re-mortgaging their bubbled houses to buy stocks with record corporate debt, collaterised (if at all) with bubble assets, at record valuations driven itself by leverage etc etc
It's just unbelievable that central banks are actively encouraging this.
Moosy Apr 17, 2021 at 6:13 pm"It's just unbelievable that central banks are actively encouraging this."
Indeed. It's QUITE believable that the politicians love the free money and would never be bold enough to say .
"Hey Fed. Your mandates say you are to FIGHT inflation (stable prices) NOT PROMOTE inflation."
ru82 Apr 17, 2021 at 11:45 pmThe amount of margin debt is not a WTF amount if you use the prices-double each 11 year rule of thumb.
This 11 year period is strikingly accurate if you take the price of the New York Times since 1900 (I have a booklet with frontpages of each year and discovered this when looking at the selling prices). Having said that, the current 800B is the same as the previous inflation corrected peaks of 2009 and around 1999.
So yes, Wolf is 100% correct with the prediction on what is coming. It is just not a WTF amount but a history-repeats-itself moment
cas127 Apr 18, 2021 at 5:06 amGood point. Many times we look at charts and say WTF but once you normalize to inflation, maybe this is not as bad as originally it appeared
Old School Apr 19, 2021 at 6:08 am"normalize to inflationary, maybe not as bad as originally it appeared"
I know what you mean, but then the (major) problem is that the inflation itself shouldn't be viewed as "normal". Kinda reminds me of a gvt program defending doubled budget over 8 yrs because of "inflation" when in point of fact it is likely that G printing/policy has *created* the inflation in the first place (to help fund the program now pointing at inflation).
Also, reminds me of an abusive husband telling his beaten wife, "See what you made me do!"
K Apr 17, 2021 at 9:10 pmHussman says the right way to do that is to look at margin debt to GDP ration, which is a record. GDP is doubling rate is about every 20 years now at nominal 3.5%
That description applies to most Wall Streeters and banksters, whose titanic egos are amazing given the fact that most are parasites that contribute less than a woodlouse to society. Still, I dread the coming US debt collapse discussed in this website, which I would term a debt explosion as all of the bubbles start to pop and so many debtors and former creditors (like lessors, banks, etc.) become publicly known to be legally insolvent.
It is unfortunate that it may happen at the worst possible time, when we face an adversary worse and more powerful than the Soviet Union or Nazi Germany ever was. I have invested carefully but we will all lose much or most of our savings.
It is very irritating to think of the trillions that the banksters' deceptively named, "Federal" Reserve has been transferring to its ultra-rich owners for decades. They will probably even avoid most taxation again.
I do not like to even think how many Americans will wind up. Remember the saying "There but for the grace of god, go I." Many of us will be saying that a lot in the coming years if we are very fortunate.
May 04, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
We've been talking a lot about the specter of inflation. Despite the Fed's assurances not to worry because any price increases we're seeing are transitory, some people are indeed worried. A former JP Morgan managing director warned about inflation and echoed Peter Schiff's view that the central bank is powerless to fight it.
And we're seeing rising prices all over the place, from the grocery store to the gas station. Even the government numbers flash warning signs . But as Peter Schiff explains in this clip from an interview with Jay Martin, it's probably even worse than we realize because the government cooks the numbers when it calculates CPI.
The monthly rises in CPI through the first quarter show an upward trend. The CPI in January was up 0.3%. It was up 0.4% in February. And now it's up 0.6% in March. That totals a 1.013% increase in Q1 alone. The question is does this really reflect the truth about inflation? Peter doesn't think it does.
The government always makes changes to their methods of measuring things, whether it's GDP, or inflation, or unemployment. And they always tweak the numbers to produce a better result as a report card. "
https://www.youtube.com/embed/lnPrsBzIZsw
Imagine if students in a school had the ability to change the metrics by which they were graded or the methodology the teacher used to calculate their grades.
Would it surprise anybody that all of a sudden they started getting more As and Bs and fewer Cs and Ds? The government always wants to make the good stuff better, like economic growth, and the bad stuff better, like unemployment or inflation. So, they want to find ways to make those numbers little and the good numbers big."
The CPI is calculated by analyzing the price of a "basket of goods." The makeup of that basket has a big impact on the final CPI number. According to WolfStreet , 10.9% of the CPI is based on durable goods (computers, automobiles, appliances, etc.). Nondurable goods (primarily food and energy) make up 26.6% of CPI. Services account for the remaining 62.5% of the basket. This includes rent, healthcare, cellphone service etc.)
The things the government includes and excludes from the basket can make a profound difference in that final CPI number. Back in 1998, the government significantly revised the CPI metrics. Even the Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS) admitted the changes were "sweeping."
According to the BLS, periodic changes to the CPI calculation are necessary because "consumers change their preferences or new products and services emerge. During these occasions, the Bureau reexamines the CPI item structure, which is the classification scheme of the CPI market basket. The item structure is a central feature of the CPI program and many CPI processes depend on it."
In 1998, the BLS followed the recommendations of the Boskin Commission. It was appointed by the Senate in 1995. Initially called the "Advisory Commission to Study the Consumer Price Index," its job was to study possible bias in the computation of the CPI. Unsurprisingly, it determined that the index overstated inflation " by about 1.1% per year in 1996 and about 1.3% prior to 1996. The 1998 changes to CPI were meant to address this "issue."
As Peter pointed out, there is a lot of geometric weighting, substitution and hedonics built into the calculation. The government can basically create an index that outputs whatever it wants.
I think this period of "˜Oh wow! We have low inflation!' It's not a coincidence that it followed this major revision into how we calculate it."
Peter said there is a bit of irony in government officials and central bankers constantly complaining about "not enough inflation."
They're the ones that are cooking the books to pretend that inflation is lower than it really is. Because what they're really trying to do is get the go-ahead to produce more inflation, which is printing money."
Peter said the CPI will never reveal the true extent of rising prices.
And there are other things that hide inflation. For instance, shrinking packaging so there is less product sold at the same price, or substituting lower quality ingredients, or requiring consumers to assemble items themselves.
They find different ways to lower the quality and not increase the price, and I'm sure that the government is not picking up on any of that. If the quality improves, yeah, yeah, they calculate that. But they probably ignore all the circumstances where the quality is diminished."
The bottom line is we can't trust CPI to tell us the truth about inflation.
May 05, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
If you are seeking stocks that could perform well during the inflationary environment the U.S. looks to be headed into as it recovers from the depths of the COVID-19 pandemic , Goldman Sachs suggests parking some money in auto parts retailers.
Yes, auto parts retailers.
The investment thesis is pretty straightforward. With mobility across the country picking up (see chart below) as people get vaccinated, cars will likely need more maintenance. That leaves auto parts retailers such as O'Reilly ( ORLY ), Genuine Parts Company ( GPC ), AutoZone ( AZO ) and Advance Auto Parts ( AAP ) in the enviable position of being able to pass inflation in everything from tires to car wax on to consumers and then post strong profits.
"In a highly inflationary environment, we like the auto parts space with its unique ability to pass-through higher costs to customers given the non-discretionary nature of the category," says Goldman Sachs analyst Kate McShane. "For instance, in 2019, telegraphed prices increases to offset cost pressures arising from tariffs provided an incremental benefit to same-store sales growth and most auto parts retailers cited between 150-300 basis points of tariff-related inflation."
McShane rounds out her bullish thesis on auto parts retailers by noting the main sector plays sport price-to-earnings multiples below historical averages. Of the four aforementioned auto parts retailers, AutoZone has the lowest forward price-to-earnings multiple of 18.7 times, according to Yahoo Finance Plus data .
As for which name McShane is most bullish on, that award goes to Advance Auto Parts in the wake of a recent analyst day. McShane made the rare Wall Street move of upgrading her rating on Advance Auto Parts to Buy from Sell.
"Our double tier upgrade " from Sell to Buy " is predicated upon
- (1) Advance Auto Parts improving profit and loss dynamics with 2-4% same-store sales per annum and 230-450 basis points of margin expansion by 2023;
- (2) cyclical recovery in do-it-for-me, where Advance Auto Parts has greater exposure vs peers;
- (3) a finally improving do-it-yourself story as its new private label and loyalty program appears to be resonating with customers;
- (4) improved capital allocation to shareholders;
- (5) the ability of the auto parts space to pass-through inflation; and
- (6) valuation that looks appealing vs history, especially in light of improving macro and company specific dynamics,"
McShane says.
May 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Signs of inflation are picking up, with a mounting number of consumer-facing companies warning in recent days that supply shortages and logistical logjams may force them to raise prices.
Tight inventories of materials as varied as semiconductors, steel, lumber and cotton are showing up in survey data, with manufacturers in Europe and the U.S. this week flagging record backlogs and higher input prices as they scramble to replenish stockpiles and keep up with accelerating consumer demand.
As commodities become increasingly expensive, whether faster inflation proves transitory -- or not -- is the biggest question for policy makers and markets. Rising prices and the potential for a response from central banks topped the list of concerns for money managers surveyed by Bank of America Corp.
Many economists and central bankers, from the Federal Reserve on down, maintain that price gains are temporary and will be curbed by forces such as virus worries and unemployment. Investors remain skeptical, with businesses including Nestle SA and Colgate-Palmolive Co. already announcing they’ll need to raise prices.
U.S. Treasury Secretary Janet Yellen, a former Fed chair, entered the debate on Tuesday when she ruffled markets with the observation that rates will likely rise as government spending ramps up. She later clarified she was neither predicting nor recommending an increase.
The Bloomberg Commodity Spot Index, which tracks 23 raw materials, has risen to its highest level in almost a decade. That has pushed a gauge of global manufacturing output prices to its highest point since 2009, and U.S. producer prices to levels not seen since 2008, according to data from JPMorgan Chase & Co. and IHS Markit. JPMorgan analysts also estimate non-food and energy import prices in the biggest economies rose almost 4% in the first quarter, the most in three years.
“Risk clearly leans to the upside in the current environment,†said John Mothersole, pricing and purchasing research director at IHS Markit. “The surge in commodity prices over the past year now guarantees higher goods-price inflation this summer.â€
May 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Money managers who’ve spent the bulk of their careers profiting from deflationary trends need to quickly switch gears or risk an “inflation shock†to their portfolios, warns JPMorgan Chase & Co. chief global markets strategist Marko Kolanovic.
“Many of today’s investment managers have never experienced a rise in yields, commodities, value stocks, or inflation in any meaningful way,†Kolanovic wrote in a report Wednesday. “A significant shift of allocations towards growth, ESG and low volatility styles over the past decade, all of which have negative correlation to inflation, left most portfolios vulnerable.â€
After staging a powerful rally since November amid vaccine rollouts and government stimulus, bets tied to inflation -- rising Treasury yields, cyclical stocks and small-caps, to name a few -- have taken pause in recent weeks. While that has sparked debate over how long the trend will persist, Kolanovic urged clients to adjust to the new regime amid the reopening of the global economy.
“Given the still high unemployment, and a decade of inflation undershoot, central banks will likely tolerate higher inflation and see it as temporary,†he wrote. “The question that matters the most is if asset managers will make a significant change in allocations to express an increased probability of a more persistent inflation.â€
The way Kolanovic sees it, as data continue to point to higher prices of goods and services, investors will be forced to shift from low-volatility plays to value stocks, while increasing allocations to direct inflation hedges such as commodities. That trend is likely to persist in the second half of the year, he wrote.
Based on JPMorgan’s data, professional investors have yet to fully embrace the reflation trade. Take equities, for instance. Both computer-driven traders and hedge funds now hold stocks at levels below historical averages.
“Portfolio managers likely will not take chances and will reposition portfolios,†Kolanovic wrote. “The interplay of low market liquidity, systematic and macro/fundamental flows, the sheer size of financial assets that need to be rotated or hedges for inflation put on, may cause outsized impact on inflationary and reflationary themes over the next year.â€
Story
May 08, 2021 | wolfstreet.com
And if it doesn't last after the stimmies are gone, dealers will sit on massively overpriced collateral, which could get messy.
By Wolf Richter for WOLF STREET .This has been going on for months: Used-vehicle prices spiking from jaw-dropper to jaw-dropper, and just when I thought prices couldn't possibly spike further, they do.
Prices of used vehicles that were sold at auctions around the US in April spiked by 8.3% from March, by 20% year-to-date, by 54% from April 2020, and by 40% from April 2019, according to the Used Vehicle Value Index released today by Manheim, the largest auto auction operator in the US and a unit of Cox Automotive. All heck has broken loose in the used vehicle market:
The price spike has now completely blown by the prior record spike over the 13-month period through September 2009, which included the cash-for-clunkers program that removed a whole generation of serviceable older vehicles from the market.
makruger May 8, 2021 at 1:31 am
Wolf Richter May 8, 2021 at 8:55 amCuriously, the St. Louis Fed says used car prices have been pretty much flat for the last 25 years. While the last year of data shows a notable jump in prices, it's apparently been bludgeoned a little with some old fashioned hedonic quality adjustments.
Scott May 8, 2021 at 1:34 ammakruger,
I'll help you out since I've been covering this for years. So here is the correct link that explains it all, new vehicle CPI and used vehicle CPI (which is what you cited), plus "hedonic quality adjustments."
And some relevant charts from that article:
ReplyI can see how the supply for these auctions will be tight for some time given that business travel and the resulting car rental usage is way down. In addition, I would expect a lot of corporate car purchasing is down considerably as many sales reps have worked remotely which stalled corporate car purchasing schedules.
May 08, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Naples, Fla.
Messrs. Levy and Bordo allude to the sharp drop in the velocity of M2 after the 2007-09 crisis. The actual decline is startling. In the first quarter of 2007 M2 velocity was 1.99, by the first quarter of 2020 it had fallen almost continually to 1.38. In other words, the money stock went from turning over twice a year to under 1.4 times a year. This is the primary reason for the very low inflation over the period.
Because of the Covid lockdowns, M2 fell even further to 1.13 by the fourth quarter of 2020. As the authors point out, conditions are much different today than in 2007-20 because of boosted bank reserves, households with substantial savings ready to spend and commercial banks in good shape and eager to lend. Unless an economy-wide lockdown occurs, these are very good reasons to believe the velocity of money will increase significantly, just as the 27% surge in M2 since the outbreak of the pandemic works its way through the economy.
This is a prescription for major inflation, perhaps 4%-5% in the next two years. When people say "no way," I remind them that in the early 1980s hardly anyone believed that interest rates would ever return to 1950s levels. While many individuals prefer to trend forecast, never underestimate how inflation (and interest rates) can swing back and forth in ways that amaze.
Em. Prof. Stephen Happel
Arizona State University
Tempe, Ariz.
Messrs. Levy and Bordo might have made an equally compelling case about the Fed being in total denial about the more troubling risk: that its policies have been contributing to a global asset-price and credit-market bubble.
By maintaining ultralow interest rates and by continuing to expand its balance by $120 billion a month, even when the economy could soon be overheating and U.S. equity valuations are close to their all-time highs, the Fed risks further inflating the asset-price bubble. By so doing, it is heightening the chances of a hard economic landing when the Fed is eventually forced to slam on the monetary-policy brakes to meet its inflation objective.
Desmond Lachman
American Enterprise Institute
Washington
Why did the money supply hardly budge in 2008, whereas now it's steadily increasing? The answer is that during the financial crisis the Fed conducted a radical experiment: It paid banks not to lend. By design, quantitative easing shored up banks' balance sheets while interest on excess reserves prevented the newly created money from circulating.
In March 2020, the Fed slashed interest on excess reserves from 1.60% to 0.10%. The benefits of sitting on funds is much smaller, which is why lending has increased.
Messrs. Levy and Bordo emphasize structural factors in the U.S. economy, such as housing and trade. These matter, but not nearly so much as policy. Inflationary pressures will continue if the Fed's asset purchases increase the broader money supply. But this depends on whether the Fed raises interest on excess reserves to prepandemic levels.
For better or worse, interest on excess reserves is now a crucial policy tool. We can't understand inflation without it.
Assoc. Prof. Alexander William Salter
Texas Tech University
Lubbock, Texas
Copyright ©2020 Dow Jones & Company, Inc. All Rights Reserved. 87990cbe856818d5eddac44c7b1cdeb8
Appeared in the May 5, 2021, print edition as 'Inflation Is More of a Threat Than Fed Says.'
May 08, 2021 | www.wsj.com
SUBSCRIBER 3 hours ago Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII.
The Fed is riding a tiger by the tail and will likely have great difficulty extricating itself from a torrid monetary experiment that is reaching its limits. The U.S. M4 money supply rose an alarming 24% in March alone from a year earlier whereas M1 rose 37%. Notwithstanding these shocking numbers the Fed continues to buy $120bn of bonds each month and the total amount of money in circulation is exploding at an unprecedented 40% rate.
Professor William Barnett of the Center for Financial Stability in New York explained that today's financial collusion between the Fed and the Treasury is much like the 1940s when the Fed served as a fiscal agent for Democratic administrations. The chaotic aftermath? By mid-1947 the rate of inflation exceeded 17% per year - destroying low income households.
(Cont.)
Like thumb_up 5 Reply reply Share link Report flag D
SUBSCRIBER 3 hours agoYellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII.Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII SUBSCRIBER 3 hours agoThe Fed is riding a tiger by the tail and will likely have great difficulty extricating itself from a torrid monetary experiment that is reaching its limits. The U.S. M4 money supply rose an alarming 24% in March alone from a year earlier whereas M1 rose 37%. Notwithstanding these shocking numbers the Fed continues to buy $120bn of bonds each month and the total amount of money in circulation is exploding at an unprecedented 40% rate.
Professor William Barnett of the Center for Financial Stability in New York explained that today's financial collusion between the Fed and the Treasury is much like the 1940s when the Fed served as a fiscal agent for Democratic administrations. The chaotic aftermath? By mid-1947 the rate of inflation exceeded 17% per year - destroying low income households.
(Cont.)
Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII.Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWIIThe Fed is riding a tiger by the tail and will likely have great difficulty extricating itself from a torrid monetary experiment that is reaching its limits. The U.S. M4 money supply rose an alarming 24% in March alone from a year earlier whereas M1 rose 37%. Notwithstanding these shocking numbers the Fed continues to buy $120bn of bonds each month and the total amount of money in circulation is exploding at an unprecedented 40% rate.
Professor William Barnett of the Center for Financial Stability in New York explained that today's financial collusion between the Fed and the Treasury is much like the 1940s when the Fed served as a fiscal agent for Democratic administrations. The chaotic aftermath? By mid-1947 the rate of inflation exceeded 17% per year - destroying low income households.
(Cont.)
Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII.Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWIIThe Fed is riding a tiger by the tail and will likely have great difficulty extricating itself from a torrid monetary experiment that is reaching its limits. The U.S. M4 money supply rose an alarming 24% in March alone from a year earlier whereas M1 rose 37%. Notwithstanding these shocking numbers the Fed continues to buy $120bn of bonds each month and the total amount of money in circulation is exploding at an unprecedented 40% rate.
Professor William Barnett of the Center for Financial Stability in New York explained that today's financial collusion between the Fed and the Treasury is much like the 1940s when the Fed served as a fiscal agent for Democratic administrations. The chaotic aftermath? By mid-1947 the rate of inflation exceeded 17% per year - destroying low income households.
(Cont.)
Yellen and the Fed are currently repeating one of the most disturbing episodes of U.S. economic history. It happened during the 1940s following the conclusion of WWII.The Fed is riding a tiger by the tail and will likely have great difficulty extricating itself from a torrid monetary experiment that is reaching its limits. The U.S. M4 money supply rose an alarming 24% in March alone from a year earlier whereas M1 rose 37%. Notwithstanding these shocking numbers the Fed continues to buy $120bn of bonds each month and the total amount of money in circulation is exploding at an unprecedented 40% rate.
Professor William Barnett of the Center for Financial Stability in New York explained that today's financial collusion between the Fed and the Treasury is much like the 1940s when the Fed served as a fiscal agent for Democratic administrations. The chaotic aftermath? By mid-1947 the rate of inflation exceeded 17% per year - destroying low income households.
(Cont.)
May 08, 2021 | www.wsj.com
President Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation
Carlos LumpuyPresident Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation.President Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation Carlos Lumpuy
On May 7 of last year, the metric standard of lumber, 1,000 board feet was $360 . Today it's $1,702 a record high. It broke $1,000 first time ever a month ago on April 7.
That's a 70% increase in lumber in just the last 30 days.
Copper was $2.33 on May 7 of last year. Today, $4.76 a record high.
Steel Rebar was $3,768 on May 7 of last year. Today: $5,483 , record high.
President Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation .
Tell that to a builder, his subcontractors, and the buyer of a newly built home this summer.
Food prices for Corn, Wheat, Soybeans, Rice, Milk, Coffee, Cocoa are up double digits in just the last two months.
Vice President Harris ignored a question about inflation with her regular everyday cackle laughing as she walked away.
We are in month four of this administration that prioritizes its war on the wind and the weather.
Figures are from Yahoo FinancePresident Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation.
On May 7 of last year, the metric standard of lumber, 1,000 board feet was $360 . Today it's $1,702 a record high. It broke $1,000 first time ever a month ago on April 7.
That's a 70% increase in lumber in just the last 30 days.
Copper was $2.33 on May 7 of last year. Today, $4.76 a record high.
Steel Rebar was $3,768 on May 7 of last year. Today: $5,483 , record high.
President Biden and Secretary Yellen said this week there is no significant inflation .
Tell that to a builder, his subcontractors, and the buyer of a newly built home this summer.
Food prices for Corn, Wheat, Soybeans, Rice, Milk, Coffee, Cocoa are up double digits in just the last two months.
Vice President Harris ignored a question about inflation with her regular everyday cackle laughing as she walked away.
We are in month four of this administration that prioritizes its war on the wind and the weather.
Figures are from Yahoo Finance
May 08, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
The 10-year US Treasury yield fell to only 0.48% in March 2020, when deflationary fears were mounting. The S&P 500 index had fallen by 32% in just five weeks as China's covid crisis was followed by the prospect of other jurisdictions going into pandemic lockdowns. Commodity prices were collapsing. The Fed then did what it always does in these conditions. It cut interest rates to the minimum possible (zero this time) and it flooded markets with money ($120bn in QE every month) along with some other market fixes to cap corporate bond yields from rising to reflect lending risks.
Fuelling it all is the expansion of base money by central banks. The St Louis Fed's FRED chart below showing the Fed's monetary base illustrates the point and is a proxy for the global picture, because the dollar is the reserve currency and the pricing medium for all commodities.
From the beginning of March 2020, which was the month the Fed announced virtually unlimited monetary expansion, base money has grown by 69%. It is this rapid growth in central bank money which is undoubtedly behind rising commodity prices, or put more accurately, is why the purchasing power of the dollar in international markets is falling.
When the outlook for the purchasing power of a fiat currency falls, all holders expect compensation in the form of higher interest rates. Partly, it is due to time preference -- the fact that an owner of the currency has parted with the use of it for a period of time. And partly it is due to the expectation that when returned, the currency will buy less than it does today. Official forecasts of the CPI state that the dollar's purchasing power will probably sink to 97.5 cents on the dollar, then the yield on the ten-year UST should be at least 2.56% (2.5%/0.97), otherwise new buyers face immediate losses. The official expectation that the rise in the rate of price inflation will be temporary is immaterial to an investment decision today, because the yield can be expected to evolve over time in the light of events.
This is before adding something to the yield for time preference (admittedly minimal in a freely traded bond), plus something for currency risk relative to an investor's base currency and plus something for creditor risk. Stripped of these other considerations, on the basis of expected inflation alone a current yield of 1.61 appears to be far too low, and a yield target of at minimum of 2.5% appears more appropriate.
ay_arrow
FinsterF 14 hours ago
HorseBuggy 19 hours agoWill increase??? Inflation is already much higher than 2% or whatever the latest government figures imply. Price inflation first shows up in real time data like stock and commodity prices. It only later shows up in broad consumer prices. Not to mention that year over year data already average six months late.
And this on top of tricks like homeowners equivalent rent and hedonic adjustments. So official inflation stats both systematically understate and lag actual inflation.
philipat 14 hours agoAs long as you print money you could keep this market going higher and higher regardless of any reality.
Sound of the Suburbs 13 hours agoAs much as I enjoy reading Alasdair's work, he's wrong about Bond Yields because there IS NO RECOVERY. The latest BLS jobs report started to indicate that despite all the "stimulus" the underlying economy is very weak, and that isn't due to the excuse of Covid. From the data, the global economy started turning down in 4Q2108. This became more obvious in 3Q2019 with the REPO crisis. All before Covid.
The Bond markets almost always get it right and, as of now, Bond yields are falling as also are Eurodollar Futures, suggesting that for once Powell is right, any inflation is indeed transitory.
The good news for Alasdair is that for the last 3 years, Gold has been a precise mirror image of Bond REAL yields so as Real Yields now fall further negative again, Gold should respond to the upside - as already being seen.
Sound of the Suburbs 13 hours ago (Edited)Why is neoclassical economics so dangerous to the financial system?
We never did learn as much as we should have done from 1929.
Neoclassical economics produces ponzi schemes of inflated prices.
When they collapse it feeds back into the financial system.
Neoclassical economics still has its 1920's problems.
What's wrong with neoclassical economics?
- It makes you think you are creating wealth by inflating asset prices
- Bank credit flows into inflating asset prices, debt rises faster than GDP and you eventually get a financial crisis.
- No one notices the private debt building up in the economy as neoclassical economics doesn't consider debt.
What is the fundamental flaw in the free market theory of neoclassical economics?
The University of Chicago worked that out in the 1930s after last time.
Banks can inflate asset prices with the money they create from bank loans.
Henry Simons and Irving Fisher supported the Chicago Plan to take away the bankers ability to create money.
"Simons envisioned banks that would have a choice of two types of holdings: long-term bonds and cash. Simultaneously, they would hold increased reserves, up to 100%. Simons saw this as beneficial in that its ultimate consequences would be the prevention of "bank-financed inflation of securities and real estate" through the leveraged creation of secondary forms of money."
https://www.newworldencyclopedia.org/entry/Henry_Calvert_Simons
Margin lending had inflated the US stock market to ridiculous levels.
Richard Vague had noticed real estate lending balloon from 5 trillion to 10 trillion from 2001 – 2007 and went back to look at the data before 1929.
Real estate lending was actually the biggest problem lending category leading to 1929.
The IMF re-visited the Chicago plan after 2008.
https://www.imf.org/external/pubs/ft/wp/2012/wp12202.pdf
Existing financial assets, e.g. real estate, stocks and other financial assets, are traded and bank credit is used to fund the transfers. This inflates the price.
You end up with a ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices that will collapse and feed back into the financial system.
At the end of the 1920s, the US was a ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices.
The use of neoclassical economics and the belief in free markets, made them think that inflated asset prices represented real wealth.
1929 – Wakey, wakey time
Why did it cause the US financial system to collapse in 1929?
Bankers get to create money out of nothing, through bank loans, and get to charge interest on it.
What could possibly go wrong?
Bankers do need to ensure the vast majority of that money gets paid back, and this is where they get into serious trouble.
Banking requires prudent lending.
If someone can't repay a loan, they need to repossess that asset and sell it to recoup that money. If they use bank loans to inflate asset prices they get into a world of trouble when those asset prices collapse.
As the real estate and stock market collapsed the banks became insolvent as their assets didn't cover their liabilities.
They could no longer repossess and sell those assets to cover the outstanding loans and they do need to get most of the money they lend out back again to balance their books.
The banks become insolvent and collapsed, along with the US economy.
When banks have been lending to inflate asset prices the financial system is in a precarious state and can easily collapse.
What was the ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices that collapsed in Japan in 1991?
Japanese real estate.
They avoided a Great Depression by saving the banks.
They killed growth for the next 30 years by leaving the debt in place.
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=8YTyJzmiHGk
What was the ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices that collapsed in 2008?
"It's nearly $14 trillion pyramid of super leveraged toxic assets was built on the back of $1.4 trillion of US sub-prime loans, and dispersed throughout the world" All the Presidents Bankers, Nomi Prins.
They avoided a Great Depression by saving the banks.
They left Western economies struggling by leaving the debt in place, just like Japan.
It's not as bad as Japan as we didn't let asset prices crash in the West, but it is this problem has made our economies so sluggish since 2008.
The last lamb to the slaughter, India
They had created a ponzi scheme of inflated asset prices in real estate, but it collapsed.
Now they need to recapitalize their banks.
Their financial system is in a bad way, recovery isn't going to be easy.
They did work out what went wrong the last time they used neoclassical economics.
They put regulations in place to ensure financial stability.
Financial stability arrived in the Keynesian era and was locked into the regulations of the time.
https://www.brettonwoodsproject.org/wp-content/uploads/2009/10/banking-crises.png
"This Time is Different" by Reinhart and Rogoff has a graph showing the same thing (Figure 13.1 - The proportion of countries with banking crises, 1900-2008).
Neoclassical economics came back and so did the financial crises.
The neoliberals removed the regulations that created financial stability in the Keynesian era and put independent central banks in charge of financial stability.
Why does it go so wrong?
Richard Vague had noticed real estate lending balloon from 5 trillion to 10 trillion from 2001 – 2007 and knew there was going to be a financial crisis.
Richard Vague has looked at the data for financial crises going back 200 years and found the cause was nearly always runaway bank lending.
We put central bankers in charge of financial stability, but they use an economics that ignores the main cause of financial crises, private debt.
Most of the problems are coming from private debt.
The technocrats use an economics that ignores private debt.
The poor old technocrats don't really stand a chance.
In 2008 the Queen visited the revered economists of the LSE and said "If these things were so large, how come everyone missed it?"
It's that neoclassical economics they use Ma'am, it doesn't consider private debt.
Here it is Ma'am, look it's obvious.
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=vAStZJCKmbU&list=PLmtuEaMvhDZZQLxg24CAiFgZYldtoCR-R&index=6
At 18 mins.
Let's get our experts in neoclassical economics to have a look.
"It was a black swan"
Not considering private debt is the Achilles' heel of neoclassical economics.
It is a black swan to them.
That's the problem.
May 07, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Goldman Sachs Group Inc. and bond titan Pacific Investment Management Co. have a simple message for Treasuries traders fretting over inflation: Relax.
The firms estimate that bond traders who are pricing in annual inflation approaching 3% over the next handful of years are overstating the pressures bubbling up as the U.S. economy rebounds from the pandemic.
...the overshoot could be as large as 0.2-to-0.3 percentage point. That gap makes a difference with key market proxies of inflation expectations for the coming few years surging this week to the highest in more than a decade. The 10-year measure, perhaps the most closely followed, eclipsed 2.5% Friday for the first time since 2013, even after unexpectedly weak U.S. jobs data.
There's at least one market metric that backs up the view that the pressures, which have been building for months, aren't about to get out of hand and may even prove temporary. A swaps instrument that reflects the annual inflation rate for the second half of the next decade has been relatively stable in recent months.
...The Federal Reserve has been hammering home that it sees any spike in price pressures as likely short-lived, and that it's willing to let inflation run above target for a period as the economy revives.
... ... ...
... Inflation worries have been mounting against a backdrop of soaring commodities prices -- copper, for example, set a record high Friday. It's all happening as lawmakers in Washington debate another massive fiscal-stimulus package.
...
Korapaty calls the outlook for inflation "benign." His view is that the market is overly optimistic with its inflation assumptions, with the greatest mismatch to be found on the three- and five-year horizon. At roughly 2.75% and 2.7%, respectively, those rates are around 20 to 30 basis points higher than they should be, in his estimate.
... ... ...
...Treasury Secretary Janet Yellen stirred markets by saying interest rates will likely rise as government spending swells and the economy achieves faster growth. She walked back the remarks hours later.
... "Because we think front-end rates are pricing in a more aggressive Fed path than we believe, we do like shorter-dated nominal bonds, and think there's value there," she said.
May 01, 2021 | www.nakedcapitalism.com
Yves here. Mark Blyth is such a treat. How can you not be a fan of the man who coined "The Hamptons are not a defensible position"? Even though he's not always right, he's so incisive and has such a strong point of view that his occasional questionable notions serve as fodder for thought. And I suspect he'll be proven correct on his topic today, the inflation bugaboo. Yves here. Mark Blyth is such a treat. How can you not be a fan of the man who coined "The Hamptons are not a defensible position"? Even though he's not always right, he's so incisive and has such a strong point of view that his occasional questionable notions serve as fodder for thought. And I suspect he'll be proven correct on his topic today, the inflation bugaboo. Even though he's not always right, he's so incisive and has such a strong point of view that his occasional questionable notions serve as fodder for thought. And I suspect he'll be proven correct on his topic today, the inflation bugaboo. Even though he's not always right, he's so incisive and has such a strong point of view that his occasional questionable notions serve as fodder for thought. And I suspect he'll be proven correct on his topic today, the inflation bugaboo. By Paul Jay.
... ... ...
Paul Jay
And is the idea that inflation is about to come roaring back one of the stupid ideas that you're talking about? And is the idea that inflation is about to come roaring back one of the stupid ideas that you're talking about?Mark Blyth
I hope that it is, but I'm going to go with Larry on this one. He says it's about one third chance that it's going to do this. I'd probably give it about one in ten, so it's not impossible.So, let's unpack why we're going to see this. Can you generate inflation? Yeah. I mean, dead easy. Imagine your Turkey. Why not be a kind of Turkish pseudo dictator?
Why not fire the head of your central bank in an economy that's basically dependent on other people valuing your assets and giving you money through capital flows? And then why don't you fire the central bank head and put in charge your brother-in-law? I think it was his brother-in-law. And then insist that low interest rates cure inflation. And then watch as the value of your currency, the lira collapses, which means all the stuff you import is massively expensive, which means that people will pay more, and the general level of all prices will go up, which is an inflation. So, can you generate an inflation in the modern world? Sure, yeah. Easy. Just be an idiot, right? Now, does this apply to the United States? No. That's where it gets entirely different. So, a couple of things to think about (first). So, you mentioned that huge number of 20 trillion dollars. Well, that's more or less about two thirds of what we threw into the global economy after the global financial crisis, and inflation singularly failed to show up. All those people in 2010 screaming about inflation and China dumping bonds and all that. Totally wrong. Completely wrong. No central bank that's got a brass nameplate worth a damn has managed to hit its inflation target of two percent in over a decade. All that would imply that there is a huge amount of what we call "˜slack' in the economy. (Also) think about the fact that we've had, since the 1990s, across the OECD, by any measure, full employment. That is to say, most people who want a job can actually find one, and at the same time, despite that, there has been almost no price pressure coming from wages, pushing on into prices, to push up inflation. So rather than the so-called vertical Phillips curve, which most of modern macro is based upon, whereby there's a kind of speed bump for the economy, and if the government spends money, it can't push this curve out, all it can do is push it up in terms of prices. What we seem to actually have is one whereby you can have a constant level of inflation, which is very low, and any amount of unemployment you want from 2 percent to 12 percent, depending on where you look and in which time-period.
All of which suggests that at least for big developed, open, globalized economies, where you've destroyed trade unions, busted up national product cartels, globally integrated your markets, and added 600 million people to the global labor supply, you just can't generate inflation very easily. Now, we're running, depending on how much actually passes, a two to five trillion-dollar experiment on which theory of inflation is right. This one, or is it this one? That's basically what we're doing just now. Larry's given it one in three that it's his one. I'd give it one in ten his one's right. Now, if I may just go on just for a seconds longer. This is where the politics of this gets interesting. Most people don't understand what inflation is. You get all this stuff talked by economists and central bankers about inflation and expectations and all that, but you go out and survey people and they have no idea what the damn thing is. Think about the fact that most people talk about house price inflation.
There is no such thing as house price inflation. Inflation is a general rise in the level of all prices. A sustained rise in the level of prices. The fact that house prices in Toronto have gone up is because Canada stopped building public housing in the 1980s and turned it into an asset class and let the 10 percent top earners buy it all and swap it with each other. That is singularly not an inflation. So, what's going to happen coming out of Covid is there will be a big pickup in spending, a pickup in employment. I think it's (going to be) less than people expect because the people with the money are not going to go out and spend it because they have all they want already. There are only so many Sub-Zero fridges you can buy. Meanwhile, the bottom 60 percent of the income distribution are too busy paying back debt from the past year to go on a spending spree, but there definitely will be a pickup. Now, does that mean that there's going to be what we used to call bottlenecks? Yeah, because basically firms run down inventory because they're in the middle of a bloody recession. Does it mean that there are going to be supply chain problems? Yes, we see this with computer chips. So, what's going to happen is that computer chips are going to go up in price.
So, lots of individual things are going to go up in price, and what's going to happen is people are going to go "there's the inflation, there's that terrible inflation," and it's not. It's just basically short-term factors that will dissipate after 18 months. That is my bet. For Larry to be right what would have to be true?
That we would have to have the institutions, agreements, labor markets and product markets of the 1970s. We don't.
... ... ...
So, I just don't actually see what the generator of inflation would be. We are not Turkey dependent on capital imports for our survival with a currency that's falling off a cliff. That is entirely different. That import mechanism, which is the way that most countries these days get a bit of inflation. That simply doesn't apply in the U.S. So, with my money on it, if I had to bet, it's one in 10 Larry's right, rather one in 3.
Paul Jay
The other point he raises, and we talked a little bit about this in a previous interview, but let's revisit it, is that the size of the American debt, even if it isn't inflationary at some point, creates some kind of crisis of confidence in the dollar being the reserve currency of the world, and so this big infrastructure spending is a problem because of that. That's part of, I believe, one of his arguments. The other point he raises, and we talked a little bit about this in a previous interview, but let's revisit it, is that the size of the American debt, even if it isn't inflationary at some point, creates some kind of crisis of confidence in the dollar being the reserve currency of the world, and so this big infrastructure spending is a problem because of that. That's part of, I believe, one of his arguments.Mark Blyth
The way political economists look at the financial plumbing, I think, is different to the way that macro economists do. We see it rather differently. The first thing is, what's your alternative to the dollar unless you're basically going to go all-in on gold or bitcoin? And good luck with those. If we go into a crushing recession and our bond market collapses, don't think that Europe's going to be a safe haven given that they've got half the US growth rate. And we could talk about what Europe's got going on post-pandemic because it's not that good. So what's your alternative (to the Dollar)? Buy yen? No, not really. You're going to buy Chinese assets? Well, good luck, and given the way that their country is being run at the moment, if you ever want to take your capital out. I'm not sure that's going to work for you, even if you could. So you're kind of stuck with it. Mechanically there's another problem. All of the countries that make surpluses in the world make surpluses because we run deficits. One has to balance the other. So, when you're a Chinese firm selling to the United States, which is probably an American firm in China with Chinese subcontractors selling to the United States, what happens is they get paid in dollars. When they receive those dollars in China, they don't let them into the domestic banking system. They sterilize them and they turn them into the local currency, which is why China has all these (dollar) reserves. That's their national savings. Would you like to burn your reserves in a giant pile? Well, one way to do that would be to dump American debt, which would be equivalent to burning your national savings. If you're a firm, what do you do? Well, you basically have to use dollars for your invoicing. You have to use dollars for your purchasing, and you keep accumulating dollars, which you hand back to your central bank, which then hands you the domestic currency. The central bank then has a problem because it's got a liability " (foreign) cash rather than an asset. So, what's the easiest asset to buy? Buy another 10-year Treasury bill, rinse and repeat, rinse and repeat. So, if we were to actually have that type of crisis of confidence, the people who would actually suffer would be the Germans and the Chinese, because their export-driven models only makes sense in terms of the deficits that we run. Think of it as kind of monetarily assured destruction because the plumbing works this way. I just don't see how you can have that crisis of confidence because you've got nowhere else to take your confidence.Paul Jay
If I understand it correctly, the majority of American government debt is held by Americans, so it's actually really the wealth is still inside the United States. I saw a number, this was done three or four years ago, maybe, but I think it was Brookings Institute, that assets after liabilities in private hands in the United States is something like 98 trillion dollars. So I don't get where this crisis of confidence is going to come any time soon. If I understand it correctly, the majority of American government debt is held by Americans, so it's actually really the wealth is still inside the United States. I saw a number, this was done three or four years ago, maybe, but I think it was Brookings Institute, that assets after liabilities in private hands in the United States is something like 98 trillion dollars. So I don't get where this crisis of confidence is going to come any time soon.Mark Blyth
Basically, if your economy grows faster (than the rest of the world because you are) the technological leader, your stock markets grows faster than the others. If you're an international investor, you want access to that. (That ends) only if there were actual real deep economic problems (for the US), like, for example, China invents fusion energy and gives it free to the world. That would definitely screw up Texas. But short of that, it's hard to see exactly what would be these game-changers that would result in this. And of course, this is where the Bitcoin people come in. It's all about crypto, and nobody has any faith in the dollar, and all this sort of stuff. Well, I don't see why we have faith in something (like that instead . I think it was just last week. There wasn't much reporting on this, I don't know if you caught this, but there were some twenty-nine-year-old dude ran a crypto exchange. I can't remember where it was. Maybe somewhere like Turkey. But basically he had two billion in crypto and he just walked off with the cash. You don't walk off with the Fed, but you could walk off with a crypto exchange. So until those problems are basically sorted out, the notion that we can all jump into a digital currency, which at the end of the day, to buy anything, you need to turn back into a physical currency because you don't buy your coffee with crypto, we're back to that (old) problem. How do you get out of the dollar? That structural feature is incredibly important.Paul Jay
So there's some critique of the Biden infrastructure plan and some of the other stimulus, coming from the left, because, one, the left more or less agrees with what you said about inflation, and the critique is that it's actually not big enough, and let me add to that. I'm kind of a little bit surprised, maybe not anymore, but Wall Street on the whole, not Larry Summers and a few others, but most of them actually seem quite in support of the Biden plan. You don't hear a lot of screaming about inflation from Wall Street. Maybe from the Republicans, but not from listening to Bloomberg Radio. So there's some critique of the Biden infrastructure plan and some of the other stimulus, coming from the left, because, one, the left more or less agrees with what you said about inflation, and the critique is that it's actually not big enough, and let me add to that. I'm kind of a little bit surprised, maybe not anymore, but Wall Street on the whole, not Larry Summers and a few others, but most of them actually seem quite in support of the Biden plan. You don't hear a lot of screaming about inflation from Wall Street. Maybe from the Republicans, but not from listening to Bloomberg Radio.Mark Blyth
You don't even hear a lot of screaming about corporate taxes, which is fascinating, right? You'd think they'd be up in arms about this? I actually spoke to a business audience recently about this, and I kind of did an informal survey and I said, "why are you guys not up in arms about this?" And someone that was on the call said, "well, you know, the Warren Buffet line about you find out who's swimming naked when the tide goes out? What if a lot of firms that we think are great firms are just really good at tax optimization? What if those profits are really just contingent on that? That would be really nice to know this because then we could stop investing in them and invest in better stuff that actually does things." You don't even hear a lot of screaming about corporate taxes, which is fascinating, right? You'd think they'd be up in arms about this? I actually spoke to a business audience recently about this, and I kind of did an informal survey and I said, "why are you guys not up in arms about this?" And someone that was on the call said, "well, you know, the Warren Buffet line about you find out who's swimming naked when the tide goes out? What if a lot of firms that we think are great firms are just really good at tax optimization? What if those profits are really just contingent on that? That would be really nice to know this because then we could stop investing in them and invest in better stuff that actually does things."Paul Jay
And pick up the pieces of what's left of them for a penny if they have to go down. And pick up the pieces of what's left of them for a penny if they have to go down.Mark Blyth
Absolutely. Just one thought that we'll circle back, to the left does not think it's big enough, etc. Well, yes, of course they wouldn't, and this is one of those things whereby you kind of have to check yourself. I give the inflation problem a one in ten. But what I'm really dispassionately trying to do is to look at this as just a problem. My political preferences lie on the side of "˜the state should do more.' They lie on the side of "˜I think we should have higher real wages.' They lay on the side that says that "˜populism is something that can be fixed if the bottom 60 percent actually had some kind of growth.' So, therefore, I like programs that do that. Psychologically, I am predisposed therefore to discount inflation. I'm totally discounting that because that's my priors and I'm really deeply trying to check this. In this debate, it's always worth bearing in mind, no one's doing that. The Republicans and the right are absolutely going to be hell bent on inflation, not because they necessarily really believe in (inevitable) inflation, (but) because it's a useful way to stop things happening. And then for the left to turn around and say, well, it isn't big enough, (is because you might as well play double or quits because, you know, you've got Biden and that's the best that's going to get. So there's a way in which when we really are trying to figure out these things, we kind of have to check our partisan preferences because they basically multiply the errors in our thinking, I think.Paul Jay
Now, earlier you said that one of the main factors why inflation is structurally low now, I don't know if you said exactly those words. Now, earlier you said that one of the main factors why inflation is structurally low now, I don't know if you said exactly those words.Mark Blyth
I would say that yes. I would say that yes.Paul Jay
Is the weakness of the unions, the weakness of workers in virtually all countries, but particularly in the U.S., because it matters so much. That organizing of workers is just, they're so unable to raise their wages over decades of essentially wages that barely keep up with inflation and don't grow in any way, certainly not in any relationship to the way productivity has grown. So we as progressives, well, we want workers to get better organized. We want stronger unions. We want higher wages, but we want it without inflation. Is the weakness of the unions, the weakness of workers in virtually all countries, but particularly in the U.S., because it matters so much. That organizing of workers is just, they're so unable to raise their wages over decades of essentially wages that barely keep up with inflation and don't grow in any way, certainly not in any relationship to the way productivity has grown. So we as progressives, well, we want workers to get better organized. We want stronger unions. We want higher wages, but we want it without inflation.Mark Blyth
And it's a question of how much room you have to do that. I mean, essentially, if you quintuple the money supply, eventually prices will have to rise"¦but that depends upon the velocity of money which has actually been collapsing. So maybe you'd have to do it 10 times. There's interesting research out of London, which I saw a couple of weeks ago, that basically says you really can't correlate inflation with increases in the money supply. It's just not true. It's not the money that's doing it. It's the expectations. That then begs the question, well, who's actually paying attention if we all don't really understand what inflation is? So I tend to think of this as basically a kind of a physical process. It's very easy to understand if your currency goes down by 50 percent and you're heavily dependent on imports. You're import (prices) go up. All the prices in the shops are going to go up. That's a mechanism that I can clearly identify that will generate rising prices. If you have big unions, if you have kind of cartel-like vertically integrated firms that control the national market, if you have COLA contracts. If you have labor able to do what we used to call leapfrogging wage claims against other unions, if this is all institutionally and legally protected, I can see how that generates inflation, that is a mechanism I can point to. That doesn't exist just now. Let's unpack this for a minute. The sort of fundamental theoretical assumption on this is based is some kind of "˜marginal productivity theory of wages.' In a perfectly free market with free exchange, in which we don't live, what would happen is you would hire me up to the point that my marginal product is basically paying off for you, and once it produces zero profits, that's kind of where my wages end. I'm paid up to the point that my marginal product is useful to the firm. This is not really a useful way of thinking about it because if you're the employer and I'm the worker, and I walk up to you and say, hey, my marginal productivity is seven, so how about you pay me seven bucks? You just say, shut up or I'll fire you and get someone else. Now, the way that we used to deal with this was a kind of "˜higher than your outside option,' on wages. The way we used to think about this was "why would you pay somebody ten bucks at McDonald's?" Because then you might actually get them to and flip the burgers because they're outside option is probably seven bucks, and if you pay them seven bucks, they just won't show up. So we used to have to pay workers a bit more. So that was, in a sense, (workers) claiming (a bit of the surplus) from productivity. But now what we've done, Suresh Naidu the economist was talking about this the other day, is we have all these technologies for surveilling workers (instead of paying them more). So now what we can do is take that difference between seven and ten and just pocket it because we can actually pay workers at your outside option, because I monitor everything you do, and if you don't do exactly what I say I'll fire you, and get somebody else for seven bucks. So all the mechanisms for the sharing of sharing productivity, unions, technology, now lies in the hands of employers. It's all going against labor. So (as a result) we have this fiction that somehow when the economy grows, our productivity goes up, and workers share in that. Again, what's the mechanism? Once you take out unions and once you weaponize the ability of employers to extract surplus through mechanisms like technology, franchising, all the rest of it, then it just tilts the playing field so much that we just don't see any increase in wages. (Now) let's bring this back to inflation. Unless you see systematic (and sustained) increases in the real wage that increases costs for firms to the point that they need to push on prices, I just don't see the mechanism for generating inflation. It just isn't there. And we've underpaid the bottom 60 percent of the U.S. labor market so long it would take a hell of a lot of wage inflation to get there, with or without unions.Paul Jay
Yeah, what's that number, that if the minimum wage was adjusted for inflation and it was what the minimum wage was, what, 30 years ago, the minimum wage would be somewhere between 25 and 30 bucks, and that wasn't causing raging inflation. Yeah, what's that number, that if the minimum wage was adjusted for inflation and it was what the minimum wage was, what, 30 years ago, the minimum wage would be somewhere between 25 and 30 bucks, and that wasn't causing raging inflation.Mark Blyth
And there is that RAND study from November 2020 that was adeninely entitled, "˜Trends in Income 1979 to 2020,' and they calculated, and I think this is the number, but even if I'm off, the order of magnitude is there, that transfers, because of tax and regulatory changes, from the 90th percentile of the distribution to the 10 percentile, totalled something in the order of $34 trillion. That's how much was vacuumed up and practically nothing trickled down. So when you consider that as a mechanism of extraction, why are worrying about inflation (from wages)? The best story on inflation is actually Charles Goodhart's book that came out last year. We got a long period of low inflation because of global supply chains, and because of demographic trends. It's a combination of global supply chains, Chinese labor, and demographics all coming together to basically push down labor costs, and that's why you get this long period of deflation, which leads to rising profits and zero inflation. A perfectly reasonable way of explaining it. And his point is that, well, that's coming to an end. The demographics are shifting, or shrinking. We're going back to more closed economies. You're going to create this inflation problem again. OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? And there is that RAND study from November 2020 that was adeninely entitled, "˜Trends in Income 1979 to 2020,' and they calculated, and I think this is the number, but even if I'm off, the order of magnitude is there, that transfers, because of tax and regulatory changes, from the 90th percentile of the distribution to the 10 percentile, totalled something in the order of $34 trillion. That's how much was vacuumed up and practically nothing trickled down. So when you consider that as a mechanism of extraction, why are worrying about inflation (from wages)? The best story on inflation is actually Charles Goodhart's book that came out last year. We got a long period of low inflation because of global supply chains, and because of demographic trends. It's a combination of global supply chains, Chinese labor, and demographics all coming together to basically push down labor costs, and that's why you get this long period of deflation, which leads to rising profits and zero inflation. A perfectly reasonable way of explaining it. And his point is that, well, that's coming to an end. The demographics are shifting, or shrinking. We're going back to more closed economies. You're going to create this inflation problem again. OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? The best story on inflation is actually Charles Goodhart's book that came out last year. We got a long period of low inflation because of global supply chains, and because of demographic trends. It's a combination of global supply chains, Chinese labor, and demographics all coming together to basically push down labor costs, and that's why you get this long period of deflation, which leads to rising profits and zero inflation. A perfectly reasonable way of explaining it. And his point is that, well, that's coming to an end. The demographics are shifting, or shrinking. We're going back to more closed economies. You're going to create this inflation problem again. OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? The best story on inflation is actually Charles Goodhart's book that came out last year. We got a long period of low inflation because of global supply chains, and because of demographic trends. It's a combination of global supply chains, Chinese labor, and demographics all coming together to basically push down labor costs, and that's why you get this long period of deflation, which leads to rising profits and zero inflation. A perfectly reasonable way of explaining it. And his point is that, well, that's coming to an end. The demographics are shifting, or shrinking. We're going back to more closed economies. You're going to create this inflation problem again. OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? OK, what's the timeline on that? About 20 years? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here? A few years ago, we were told we had 12 years to fix the climate problem or we're in deep shit. If we have to face the climate problem versus single to double-digit inflation, I'm left wondering what is the real problem here?
cocomaan , , May 1, 2021 at 7:24 am
Great piece. He put to words something I've thought about but couldn't articulate: if wages are stagnant, how could you possibly get broad based inflation?
There is no upward pressure on labor costs anywhere in the economy. The pressures are all downward.
You would need government spending in the order of magnitudes to drive up wages. Or release from a lot of debt, like student loan forgiveness or what have you.
Left in Wisconsin , , May 1, 2021 at 2:06 pm
I'm not sure you need wage growth to get inflation. As Blyth notes, most of the time inflation is a currency or a monetary issue. In the 70s, it was initially an oil thing " and oil flows through a lot of products " and then really went crazy only when Volker started raising interest rates. I don't think there is an episode of "wage-push" inflation in history. (The union cost-of-living clauses don't "cause" inflation, they only adjust for past inflation. If unions can cause wage-push inflation, someone needs to explain how they did this in the late 70s, when they were much less powerful and unemployment was substantially higher, than in the 1950s.) One could argue that expansive fiscal policy might drive inflation but, even then, the mechanism is through price increases, not wage increases. You do need consumption but that can always come from the wealthy and further debt immiseration of the rest of us.
Adam Eran , , May 1, 2021 at 2:51 pm
Blythe is one of those guys who is *almost* correct. For example he declares that expectations drive inflation. What about genuine shortages? The most recent U.S. big inflation stemmed from OPEC withholding oil"a shortage we answered by increasing the price ($1.75/bbl in 1971 -> $42/bbl in 1982). In Germany, the hyperinflation was driven by the French invading the Ruhr, something roughly like shutting down Ohio in the U.S. A shortage of goods resulted. Inflation! In Zimbabwe, the Rhodesian (white) farmers left, and the natives who took over their farms were not producing enough food. A shortage of food, requiring imports, resulted. Inflation!
I guess you could say people in Zimbabwe "expected" food"¦but that's not standard English.
JFYI, Blythe is not a fan of MMT. He calls it "annoying." Yep, that's his well-reasoned argument about how to think about it.
As a *political* economist, he may have a point in saying MMT is a difficult political sell, but otherwise, I'd say the guy is clueless about it.
CH , , May 1, 2021 at 9:13 am
Inflation isn't caused by the amount of money in the economy but by the amount of *spending*.
Like the other commenter, I've wondered this too"if wages have been stagnant for a generation, then how are we going to get inflation? By what mechanism? It seems like almost all of the new money just adds a few zeros to the end of the bank account balances of the already rich (or else disappears offshore).
Still, you just cannot people to understand this because of houses, health care and education. One might even argue that inflated house and education prices are helping keep inflation down. If more and more of our meager income is going to pay for these fixed expenditures, then there's no money left over to pay increased prices for goods and services. So there's no room to increase the prices of those things. As Michael Hudson would point out, it's all sucked away for debt service, meaning a lot of the "money printing" is just subsidizing Wall Street.
But if you pay attention to the internet, for years there have been conspiracy theories all across the political spectrum that we were really in hyperinflation and the government just secretly "cooked the books" and manipulated the statistics to convince us all it wasn't happening. Of course, these conspiracy theories all pointed to the cost of housing, medicine and education as "proof" of this theory (three things which, ironically, didn't go up spectacularly during the Great Inflation of the 1970's). Or else they'd point to gas prices, but that strategy lost it's potency after 2012. Or else they'd complain that their peanut butter was secretly getting smaller, hiding the inflation (shrinkflation is real, or course, but it's not a vast conspiracy to hide price increases from the public).
I'm convinced that this was the ground zero for the kind of anti-government conspiratorial thinking that's taken over our politics today. These ideas was heavy promoted by libertarians like Ron Paul starting in the nineties, helped by tracts like "The Creature from Jekyll Island," which argued that the Fed itself was one big conspiracy. I've seen plenty of people across the political spectrum"including on the far Left"take all of this stuff as gospel.
So if the government is secretly hiding inflation and the Fed itself is a grand conspiracy to convince us that paper is money (rather than "real" money, aka gold), then is it that hard to believe they're manipulating Covid statistics and plotting to control us all by forcing us all to wear masks and get vaccinated? In my view, it all started with inflation paranoia.
Blyth explains why housing inflation isn't really a sign of hyperinflation. But the average "man on the street" just doesn't get it. To Joe Sixpack, not counting some of the things he has to pay for is cheating. So are "substitutions" like ground beef when steak gets too pricey, or a Honda Civic for a Toyota Camry, for example. The complexity of counting inflation is totally lost on them, making them vulnerable to conspiratorial thinking. Since Biden was elected, the ZOMG HyPeRiNfLaTiOn!!&%! articles are ubiquitous.
Does anyone have a good way of explaining this to ordinary (i.e. non-economically literate) people? I'd love to hear it! Thanks.
TomDority , , May 1, 2021 at 9:41 am
"There is no such thing as house price inflation. Inflation is a general rise in the level of all prices. A sustained rise in the level of prices. The fact that house prices in Toronto have gone up is because Canada stopped building public housing in the 1980s and turned it into an asset class and let the 10 percent top earners buy it all and swap it with each other. That is singularly not an inflation."
Maybe I am totally off but, I would say"¦. By your definition, inflation does not exist in the economic terminology as inflation only exists if generally all prices go up and a singularity of soaring house prices and education and healthcare do not constitute an inflation because the number of things inflating do not meet some unknown number of items needed for a general rise in all prices to create an inflation.
What I read you to say is that if Labor prices go up " that could lead to inflation " but if house prices go up (as they have) that is not inflation.
Hypothetically " if labor prices do not go up and the "˜nessesities of living' prices go up (Housing and Med) " would you not have an inflation in the cost of living? " I am convinced that economists and market experts try to claim that the economy and markets are seperate and distinct from humans as a science " and that Political science has nothing to do with what they present. Yet, humans are the only species to have formed the markets and money we all participate and, the only species, therefore, to have an exclusive asset ownership, indifferent to any other species " IE " if you can't pay you can't play and have no say.
I submit that one or a few asset price increases that are combined with labor price stasis(the actual money outlayed for those asset price increased products not moving up) " especially one that is a basic to living (shelter) and not mobile (like money) is inflation " Land prices going up will generally increase the prices of all products created thereon.
Chris , , May 1, 2021 at 9:55 am
Exactly my interpretation.
The "transitory" "food inflation" (but it's not inflation since TVs went down!) is no issue. Just eat 2 years from now or a TV instead.
Objective Ace , , May 1, 2021 at 10:23 am
I think there's two things going on here. There's different inflation indicators, and asset prices are by definition never a part of inflation
The main indicator of CPI has so many different things in it that the inflation of any one item is going to have little effect on it. But you can look up BEA's detailed GDP deflator to see inflation for more specific things like housing expenses (rent) or transportation.
So back to real estate/land: real estate and land are like the stock market. They aren't subject to inflation. They are subject to appreciation. There is somewhat of a feedback effect for sure though: Increased real estate prices can drive up inflation. Rent for sure gets driven up, but also any other good that's built domestically if the owners of capital need to pay more to rent their factories/farms etc.
As noted in the article though, capitalists can simply move their production overseas so there's a limit to how much US land appreciation can filter into inflation. Its definitely happening with rent as housing can't be outsourced. But rent is only one part of overall inflation
jsn , , May 1, 2021 at 10:23 am
The point he was making is that the price change in housing is the result of a policy restructuring of the market: no new public housing and financial deregulation.
The price of food is similarly a response to policy changes: industry consolidation and resulting price setting to juice financial profits.
The point is distinguishing between political forces and market forces. The former is socially/politically determined while the latter has to do with material realities within a more or less static market structure.
This is a distinction essential to making good policy but useless from a cost of living perspective.
Starry Gordon , , May 1, 2021 at 11:26 am
One could prevent crossover for awhile, but eventually certain policies are going to affect certain markets. The policy of giving the rich money drives up asset prices, real estate is a kind of asset, eventually rising real estate costs affect the market the proles enter when they have to buy or rent real estate.
If state institutions tell them there is no inflation, the proles learn that the state institutions lie because they know better from direct experience. Once that gap develops, it's as with personal relationships: when trust is broken, it is very hard to replace. Once belief in state institutions is lost, significant political effects ensue. Often they are rather unpleasant.
jsn , , May 1, 2021 at 1:06 pm
Yes. Discussing complexity in a low trust society makes definitions of terms within a discussion necessary.
The same words are used in different contexts to mean different things making a true statement in one place a lie in another.
Skip Intro , , May 1, 2021 at 2:22 pm
Blyth pointed to the lack of systemic drivers of price increases, and how the traditional ones have disappeared. I think one that he missed, that results in a disconnect with the evidence of price increases across multiple sectors, is the neoliberal infestation. Rent-sucking intermediaries have imposed themselves into growing swaths of the mechanisms of survival, hollowed out productive capacity, and crapified artifacts to the extent that their value is irredeemably reduced. This is a systemic cause for reduced buying power, i.e. inflation, but it is not a result of monetary or fiscal policy, but political and ideological power.
cnchal , , May 1, 2021 at 3:23 pm
> . . . The fact that house prices in Toronto have gone up is because Canada stopped building public housing in the 1980s and turned it into an asset class and let the 10 percent top earners buy it all and swap it with each other.
That is a total load of baloney. The eighties were a time when the Conservative government came up with the foreign investor program and it was people from Hong Kong getting out before the British hand over to China in 1997.
I was there, trying to save for a house and for every buck saved the houses went up twenty. I finally pulled the plug in 89 when someone subdivided a one car garage from their house and sold it for a small fortune. The stories of Hong Kongers coming up to people raking their yard and offering cash well above supposed market rates and the homeowner dropping their rakes and handing over the keys were legendary.
It's still that way except now they come from mainland China, CCP members laundering their loot.
Any government that makes domestic labor compete with foreign richies for housing is mendacious.
When a Canadian drug dealer "saves up" a million to buy a house and the RCMP get wind of it, they lose the house. When a foreigner show up at the border with a million, it's all clean.
Robert Hahl , , May 1, 2021 at 9:49 am
Many people who talk about avoiding inflation are speaking euphemistically about preventing wage growth, and only that; dog whistles, clearly heard by the intended audience. Yet they are rarely confronted directly on this point. Instead we hear that they don't understand what the word inflation means, and Mark seems to be saying these euphamists (eupahmites?) needn't be so concerned because wages will not go up anyway. If so, what we are talking about here is merely helping workers stay afloat without making any fundamental changes. Well, both sides can agree to that as usual. Guess I'm just worn out by this kind of thing.
Basil Pesto , , May 1, 2021 at 10:02 am
this is only related insofar as Mark Blyth is a treat, and I shared it last week, but icymi, an excellent interview with him on the European Super League debacle last week , which really was a huge story.
The Rev Kev , , May 1, 2021 at 10:28 am
The thing that I like about Mark Blyth is how he cuts to the chase and does not waffle. Must be his upbringing in Scotland I would say. The revelation that the US minimum wage should be about $25-30 is just mind-boggling in itself. But in that talk he unintentionally put a value on how much is at stake in making a fairer economic system and it works out to be about $34 trillion. That is how much has been stolen by the upper percentile and why workers have gone from having a job, car, family & annual vacation to crushing student debt, a job at an Amazon fulfillment center and a second job being an Uber driver while living out of car.
Skip Intro , , May 1, 2021 at 1:24 pm
That $25-30 wage was keeping up with inflation , if it were keeping up with productivity it would be, IIRC, nearly twice that. It is interesting to see a dollar figure put on the amount you can reap after a generation or two of growing a middle class, by impoverishing it.
cnchal , , May 1, 2021 at 3:41 pm
This is key.
But now what we've done, Suresh Naidu the economist was talking about this the other day, is we have all these technologies for surveilling workers (instead of paying them more) . So now what we can do is take that difference between seven and ten and just pocket it because we can actually pay workers at your outside option, because I monitor everything you do, and if you don't do exactly what I say I'll fire you, and get somebody else for seven bucks.
Praise be the STEM workers. Without them where would the criminal corporate class be?
Every time I listen to the news (without barfing) the story is, we need moar STEM workers, and I ask myself, what do they do for a living?
howard in nyc , , May 1, 2021 at 10:37 am
Blyth is a bass guitar player! The things you learn about people.
eg , , May 1, 2021 at 11:32 am
I think he also plays guitar and drums, in addition to the bass guitar.
Mikel , , May 1, 2021 at 2:02 pm
If that kind of tidbit excites you:
Before going into economics, Alan Greenspan was a sax and clarinet player who played with the likes of Stan Getz and Quincy Jones.Go figure"¦.
The Rev Kev , , May 1, 2021 at 7:42 pm
Mark Blyth has a remarkable history as well as, well, I will let you read this article about him-
https://www.jhunewsletter.com/article/2006/10/things-ive-learned-prof-mark-blyth-26651
As a tidbit, he has released five or six albums when younger and is into gourmet Indian cuisine.
HotFlash , , May 1, 2021 at 9:04 pm
And Michael Hudson studied piano and conducting . Do failed musicians gravitate to economics? Perhaps for the same reason as my bank manager, a failed bass player (honors graduate from Classy Cdn U in double bass), they see the handwriting on the wall. He told me his epiphany came when he and his band-mates were trying to make cup-o-noodles with tap water in a room over the pub in Thunder Bay where they were playing.
Tex , , May 1, 2021 at 10:39 am
The mental gymnastics to get to "everything needed to survive costs more but wages have not gone up in decades so therefore its all transitory and inflation does not exist" must be painful. How high does the price for cat food have to get before we stop eating?
freebird , , May 1, 2021 at 10:11 pm
Thank you. Most things I buy or am forced to pay for are rising in price. The economists may enjoy the article, but here in Topeka, it's not flying.
KLG , , May 1, 2021 at 10:49 am
Yes! "The Hamptons are not a defensible position" ranks right up there with "It is easier to imagine the end of the world than the end of (neoliberal) capitalism" by Mark Fisher (and F. Jameson?).
Jeff W , , May 1, 2021 at 5:03 pm
"The Hamptons are not a defensible position"
From Mark Blyth's 2016 interview with AthensLive here .
Return of the Bride of Joe Biden , , May 1, 2021 at 12:12 pm
Does anybody here have knowledge of how much hedonic adjustments influence our official measures of inflation?
chuck roast , , May 1, 2021 at 12:30 pm
Very good, Mark. This leads to the next Q. How do we maintain aggregate demand? The rich guys increasingly Hoover everything up and pay no taxes. So, there is no T. Is the only way to get cash and avoid deflation deficit spending by the G? There is no I worth a damn. (X-M) is a total drain on everything since it's all M in the US and no X. The deficits will have to go out of sight in the future.
You say that there is no velocity of money. Is this because the more money pored into the economy by the G, the more money the rich guys steal? So, there is a general collapse in C. Maybe the work around for the rich guy theft is a $2,000 (sorry, $1,400) check every now and then to the great unwashed. The poors can circulate it a couple of times before the rich guys steal it. Seems like the macro-economists have a lot of "˜splainin' to do. Oh, right, they are busy right now measuring the output gap.
eg , , May 1, 2021 at 2:17 pm
Can someone please define the variables in this comment?
T
G
X
M
CAlso, is there an equation that goes with them?
chuck roast , , May 1, 2021 at 3:29 pm
GNP = Consumption + Investment + Government + (Exports " Imports)
I'd like to see Mark go into a discussion on the velocity of money. I remember the old timey Keynesians lecturing about it, and that's all I remember. I'm guessing that it's related to the marginal propensity to consume.
Ed S. , , May 1, 2021 at 4:35 pm
Chuck,
I may be getting a bit out over my skis, but the St. Louis Fed calculates the velocity of money ( https://fred.stlouisfed.org/series/M2V ). It is defined as
The velocity of money is the frequency at which one unit of currency is used to purchase domestically- produced goods and services within a given time period. In other words, it is the number of times one dollar is spent to buy goods and services per unit of time. If the velocity of money is increasing, then more transactions are occurring between individuals in an economy.
So as velocity slows, fewer transactions happen. Based on the linked chart, the peak velocity was 2.2 in mid-1997. In Q1 2021, it was 1.12. By my understanding, although the money supply continues to increase, the money isn't flowing through the economy in the way it was over the last 30 years (or even 10 years ago).
It's beyond my level of understanding to say with any certainty as to why the slowdown in velocity has occurred, but I speculate it's directly related to the ever-growing inequality in the US economy and the ongoing rentier-ism that Dr. Hudson discusses. [simplistically, if Jeff Bezos has $1.3 billion more on Monday than on Friday, that money will flow virtually nowhere. If each of Amazon's employees equally shared that $1.3 billion (about $1,000 each), the preponderance of the money would flow into the economy in short order].
I've always speculated that money velocity is one of the key indicators of the stagnant economy since 2008. It certainly has coincided with the dramatic increase in wealth in the top fraction (not the 1% but the 0.001%) of the US population.
flora , , May 1, 2021 at 1:03 pm
Thanks for this post. Blyth is always good at explaining in a way I can understand.
Mikel , , May 1, 2021 at 1:04 pm
What Blythe has laid out is not a tale about inflation or money, but a tale about power.
If money goes to the non-elite, you get inflation. If it goes to the elite, you don't get inflation.
If you are a country with little control of your resources (not lack of resources, but control) and/or loans (think IMF)/debt (think war reparations) that give people with little interest in whether you live or die control over your countries' finances, you can be prone to inflation or even hyperinflation.Yeah, I figured out a long time ago that none of this is any "natural economic law" because there is no such thing as "nature" in economics. Inflation is all about political decisions and perceptions.
And I saw this on YouTube a couple of days ago"¦and I still can't think of anything around me that hasn't gone up on price.
politicaleconomist , , May 1, 2021 at 2:37 pm
This is a good response to Summers. But I have a quibble and a concern.
My quibble is that he offers no theory of inflation except implicitly aggregate supply exceeding aggregate demand and there is nothing but hand-waving regarding what he is referring to that he feels has a one chance in ten of happening versus Summers one in three. A second part of this quibble is: what does it mean for inflation to "come roaring back." I assume it means more than just a short-term adjustment to a shot of government spending and gifting. I believe if he thought this through he would have to conclude that without changes in the current structure of the global economy there is no way for this to happen. That really is the case he has made. With labor beaten down not only in the US but worldwide inflation will not come roaring back, period. That is unless there is a chance either that a labor renewal is a near-term possibility. I doubt he believes this. Or does he believe there is another way for inflation to roar back? If so, what is that way, what is the theory behind it?A more fundamental concern is the part where he relies on marginal productivity theory when discussing employment and exploitation. Conceptually that far from Marx's fundamental distinction between labor and labor power.
Wukchumni , , May 1, 2021 at 2:45 pm
Hyperinflation doesn't seem to be possible in this age of digital money no matter how much you conjure up because nobody notices the extreme amount of monies around all of the sudden as the average joe isn't in the know.
Used houses are always appreciating in value, but none dare call it inflationary, more of a desired outcome in income advancement if you own a domicile.
There were no shortages of anything in the aftermath of the GFC, and now for want of a semiconductor, a car sale was lost. Everything got way too complex, and we'll be paying the price for that.
I think the inflation to come won't be caused by a lack of faith in a given country's money, but the products and services it enabled us to purchase.
Mikel , , May 1, 2021 at 3:47 pm
""¦and now for want of a semiconductor, a car sale was lost"¦."
Sometimes car sales are lost because the price of cars has gone up (new and used)"¦just don't call it inflation"¦I'm going to let some more time pass, but stimulus or not, we went from all economic problems being laid at the feet of Covid to now moving on to "shortages" everywhere"¦
Just enought to make you go"¦hmmmm"¦.unti more time passes.
Ed S. , , May 1, 2021 at 8:34 pm
Used houses always appreciate " or is it that they appreciate due to a combination of inflation in income over time and the dramatic decrease in interest rates over the last 20 years?
A very quick back of the envelope calc (literally " and all number are approximate):
In June 2000, median US income was $40,500; 30 yr mortgage rate was 8.25%. 28% of monthly income = $945. That supports a mortgage (30 yr fixed, P&I only " no tax, insurance, etc) of roughly $125,000.
In June 2005, median US income was $44,000; 30 yr mortgage rate was 5.5%. 28% of monthly income = $1026. That supports a mortgage (30 yr fixed, P&I only " no tax, insurance, etc) of roughly $180,000.
In June 2010, median US income was $49,500; 30 yr mortgage rate was 4.69%. 28% of monthly income = $1155. That supports a mortgage (30 yr fixed, P&I only " no tax, insurance, etc) of roughly $225,000.
In June 2015, median US income was $53,600; 30 yr mortgage rate was 4.00%. 28% of monthly income = $1250. That supports a mortgage (30 yr fixed, P&I only " no tax, insurance, etc) of roughly $260,000.
Finally, In June 2020, median US income was $63,000; 30 yr mortgage rate was 3.25%. 28% of monthly income = $1470. That supports a mortgage (30 yr fixed, P&I only " no tax, insurance, etc) of roughly $340,000.
And for fun, if you went to 40% of income in 2020 (payment only), a $2100 monthly payment will cover nearly a $500,000 mortgage in 2020.
For the vast majority of home buyers, the price isn't the main consideration " it's how much will it cost per month. So a small increase in median income (roughly 2% per year) combined with dramatically lower interest rates can drive a HUGE increase in a mortgage " and ultimately the price that can be paid for a house.
Michael Ismoe , , May 1, 2021 at 3:24 pm
I find it amazing that when you give poor people money, it creates inflation. If you give rich people money, it creates jobs (LOL. Sure it does.).
As long as billionaires pay as little as possible, the world is fine.
Tom Bradford , , May 1, 2021 at 3:49 pm
Can't say I really understand this sort of thing but saying rocketing house-prices is "˜a singularity' rather than "˜house-price inflation' has to me echoes of the Bourbon's "Bread too expensive? Let them eat cake." And Versailles wasn't a defensive position either.
In my version of economics-for-the-under-tens you get inflation in two situations. First is where enough folk have enough cash in their pockets for producers/manufacturers/retailers to hike their prices without hitting their sales too much and secondly where there's a shortage of stuff people want and/or need which leads to a bidding war. However I'd agree with Blyth that neither condition exists now or seems likely to arise for a while, making a "˜spike' in inflation unlikely.
ArvidMartensen , , May 1, 2021 at 4:17 pm
I am a non-economist, and so my thoughts below may be wrong. However, here goes.
I would say we have had inflation. Roaring inflation. For the past 20 years of so.Inflation in wages and ordinary costs of living? No, wages have been stagnant. Health care has led the charge in cost of living increases, but most other living expense increases have been low.
Inflation in asset prices? We have had massive inflation in the costs of residential housing where I live.
20 years ago I could buy a 5 br, 3 bath home on a decent block in a good area close to everything for $270,000 dollars. Sure it needed some renovation, but still"¦. Now to buy that home it would cost me around $1,250,000. So that home has gone up in value by 500%. Man, that is inflation.As I understand it, asset inflation is not counted by governments in the GDP or CPI. It appears that those who have most of the assets don't want this to be counted, by the very fact that they control the politicians who control what is counted, and asset inflation isn't counted in the economic data that the politicians rely upon to prove how prudent they are.
So if you want a day to day example of where all this free money is going, look at housing. And also have a quick look at the insane increases in the worth of billionaires. They love all this government spending which magically? seems to end up, via asset purchase and asset price inflation, in their pockets.
cnchal , , May 1, 2021 at 7:02 pm
That home has gone up in price by 500%
Price is what one pays, value is what one gets. That house is roughly the same, so the value has not changed, but the price has gone up by a factor of 5
Same with stawks. One share of Amazon stawk is $3,467.42 as of yesterday.
What is its value? If Bezos can work his tools ever harder, monitor them down to the nanosecond and wring ever moar productivity out of them before throwing them in the tool dumpster behind every Amazon warehouse, the value proposition is that someone else will believe the stawk price should be even higher, at which point one can sell it at greater price for a profit.
Susan the other , , May 1, 2021 at 5:07 pm
What is inflation? Good question. I'd say inflation is fear of monetary devaluation. Not devaluation, just the fear of it. We'll never overcome this unease if we always deal in numbers. Dollars, digits, whatever. We need to deal in commodities " let's call just about everything we live with and use a "commodity". Including unpaid family help/care; and the more obvious things like transportation. If we simply took a summary of all the necessary things we need to live decent lives " but not translated into dollars because dollars have no sense " and then provided these necessities via some government agency so that they were not "inflated" in the process and thereby provided a stable society, then government could MMT this very easily. Our current approach is so audaciously stupid it will never make sense let alone balance any balance sheets. That's a feature, not a bug because it's the best way to steal a profit. The best way to stop demand inflation or some fake scarcity or whatever is to provide the necessary availability. That's where uncle Joe is gonna run headlong into a brick wall. He has spent his entire life doing the exact opposite.
William Neil , , May 1, 2021 at 6:59 pm
The figure for the upward transfer of wealth from the Rand Study was $50 trillion between 1975-2018. It was adjusted up by the authors from $47 trillion to bring it up to 2020 trends.
Here are the authors explaining what they found and their methodology: https://time.com/5888024/50-trillion-income-inequality-america/
Now the interesting thing to me is this " look at the date of the publication in Time magazine: Sept. 14, 2020, so right in the heart of campaign fever, and it never came up in the debates, in the press"¦I didn't hear about it until Blyth made one of his appearances on Jay's show with Rana Foroohar. Long after the election.
VietnamVet , , May 1, 2021 at 9:47 pm
As long as 80% of Americans are head over heels in debt and 52% of 18-to-29-year-olds are currently living with their parents, there never will be the wage inflation of the 1970s. A majority of the people arrested for the Capitol riot had a history of financial trouble. The elite blue zones in Washington State and Oregon that prospered from globalism are seeing a spike in coronavirus cases. North American neoliberal governments have failed dismally. It is intentional in order to exploit more wealth for the rich from the natural resources and workers. If the mRNA vaccines do not control coronavirus variants, and a workable national public health system is not implemented; succession and chaos will bring on Zimbabwe type inflation.
There is a reason why Portland Oregon has been a center of unrest for the past year. The Elite just do not want to see it. How can Janet Yellen deal with this? She can't. She is an Insider. She was paid 7.2 million dollars in speaker and seminar fees in the last two years not to.
May 05, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Treasury Secretary walks backs comments she made earlier suggesting that rates might riseTreasury Secretary Janet Yellen said Tuesday she is neither predicting nor recommending that the Federal Reserve raise interest rates as a result of President Biden's spending plans, walking back her comments earlier in the day that rates might need to rise to keep the economy from overheating.
"I don't think there's going to be an inflationary problem, but if there is, the Fed can be counted on to address it," Ms. Yellen, a former Fed chairwoman, said Tuesday at The Wall Street Journal's CEO Council Summit.
Ms. Yellen suggested earlier Tuesday that the central bank might have to raise rates to keep the economy from overheating, if the Biden administration's roughly $4 trillion spending plans are enacted.
May 03, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The prices of raw materials used to make almost everything are skyrocketing, and the upward trajectory looks set to continue as the world economy roars back to life.
From steel and copper to corn and lumber, commodities started 2021 with a bang, surging to levels not seen for years. The rally threatens to raise the cost of goods from the lunchtime sandwich to gleaming skyscrapers. It’s also lit the fuse on the massive reflation trade that’s gripped markets this year and pushed up inflation expectations. With the U.S. economy pumped up on fiscal stimulus, and Europe’s economy starting to reopen as its vaccination rollout gets into gear, there’s little reason to expect a change in direction.
JPMorgan Chase & Co. said this week it sees a continued rally in commodities and that the “reflation and reopening trade will continue.†On top of that, the Federal Reserve and other central banks seem calm about inflation, meaning economies could be left to run hot, which will rev up demand even more.
“The most important drivers supporting commodity prices are the global economic recovery and acceleration in the reopening phase,†said Giovanni Staunovo, commodity analyst at UBS Group AG. The bank expects commodities as a whole to rise about 10% in the next year.
May 03, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The Treasury market's inflation bulls seem to have gotten a green light from Federal Reserve Chair Jerome Powell to double down on wagers that price pressures will only intensify in the months ahead.
The renewed mojo for the reflation trade follows Powell's reaffirmation this week of the central bank's intention to let the world's biggest economy run hot for some time as it recovers from the pandemic. The Fed's unwavering commitment to ultra-loose policy in the face of robust economic data is what caught traders' attention. It took on added significance as it coincided with signs infections are ebbing again in the U.S., and as President Joe Biden unveiled plans for trillions more in fiscal spending.
Investors eying all this aren't ready to give the Fed the benefit of the doubt in its assessment that inflationary pressures will prove temporary. A key bond-market proxy of inflation expectations for the next decade just hit the highest since 2013, and cash has been pouring into the largest exchange-traded fund for Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities. Globally, there's been a net inflow into mutual and exchange-traded inflation-linked debt funds for 23 straight weeks, EPFR Global data show.
The Fed is stressing that inflation's upswing "is transitory, but we likely won't have better clarity on this assertion until this initial economic wave from reopening has subsided," said Jake Remley, a senior portfolio manager at Income Research + Management, which oversees $89.5 billion. "Inflation is a very difficult macro-economic phenomenon to predict in normal times. The uncertainty of a global pandemic and a dramatic economic rebound" has made it even harder.
Ten-year TIPS provide a reasonably priced insurance policy against inflation risk over the coming decade, Remley said. The securities show traders are wagering annual consumer price inflation will average about 2.4% through April 2031. The measure has roared back from the depths of last year, when it dipped below 0.5% at one point in March.
May 03, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Brian Sozzi · Editor-at-Large Sat, May 1, 2021, 6:05 PM
Billionaire Warren Buffett is joining the long list of executives saying serious levels of inflation are starting to take hold as the U.S. economy roars back from the COVID-19 downturn.
"We are seeing substantial inflation," Buffett said at the Berkshire Hathaway annual shareholder meeting broadcast exclusively by Yahoo Finance . "We are raising prices. People are raising prices to us, and it's being accepted."
Buffett called out much higher steel costs impacting Berkshire's housing and furniture businesses.
"People have money in their pocket, and they pay higher prices... it's almost a buying frenzy," Buffett said, noting that the economy is "red hot."
The Oracle of Omaha isn't alone in battling inflation at the moment from everything to higher steel prices to runaway copper prices.
The number of mentions of "inflation" during first quarter earnings calls this month have tripled year-over-year, the biggest jump dating back to 2004, according to fresh research from Bank of America strategist Savita Subramanian . Raw materials, transportation, and labor were cited as the main drivers of inflation .
Subramanian's research found that the number of inflation mentions has historically led the consumer price index by a quarter, with 52% correlation. In other words, Subramanian thinks investors could see a "robust" rebound in inflation in coming months in the wake of the latest round of C-suite commentary.
"Inflation is arguably the biggest topic during this earnings season, with a broad array of sectors (Consumer/Industrials/Materials, etc.) citing inflation pressures," Subramanian notes.
The world's biggest companies are taking action, just like Buffett at Berkshire.
Proctor & Gamble said recently it would begin to hike prices on baby care , feminine care and adult incontinence products in the United States. Price increases will range from mid- to high-single digit percentages. The hikes will go into effect in mid-September.
Whirlpool CFO Jim Peters recently told Yahoo Finance Live the appliance maker just jacked up prices by 5% to 12% to counteract rising steel costs.
Kleenex maker Kimberly-Clark said it will increase prices in the U.S. and Canada on the majority of its consumer products due to "significant" commodity cost inflation. The percentage increases will range from mid- to high-single digits and go into effect in June.
May 03, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
The threat of higher inflation: For the past three decades, U.S. inflation has been low, leading some investors to discount it as a threat. Yet veteran investors will remember that in the late 1970s inflation reached double-digit levels. For the 1973â€"1982 period, the annual inflation rate averaged 8.7%. At that rate, a car that cost $20,000 would be priced at $21,740 one year later. Five years later, the price of the same car would be $30,351. Of course, it’s not just big-ticket items that are affected by inflation. Virtually everything you buy costs more â€" from a gallon of milk to a pair of running shoes.
It’s safe to assume that inflation will be a factor to one degree or another during your investing lifetime. For this reason, it’s vital to consider inflation when you calculate how your investments will grow with time.
Inflation is also an important consideration in portfolio construction. The real returns (i.e., adjusted for inflation) of cash investments have not kept pace with inflation. Bonds are particularly vulnerable, too, because a considerable portion of their return consists of interest payments, which are worth a little less each year in an inflationary period. (At one point in the 1970s, bonds were facetiously known as “certificates of confiscation.â€) As such, most long-term investors need to hold a significant stake in stocks, which provide more stable dividends and the potential to increase substantially in value
... ... ...
Jack Brennan is the former chairman and CEO of Vanguard. He is the author of More Straight Talk on Investing: Lessons for a Lifetime (Wiley, 2021) .
Pius Twelvetrees 5 hours ago Excellent advice from someone who's seen a lot of ups and downs. Many of today's investors/traders have never experienced a truly bear market. There will be some hard lessons learned over the next few months/years. I predict inflation will come roaring back.
May 03, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
...“The economy went off a cliff in March [2020],†Buffett said. “It was resurrected in an extraordinarily effective way by Federal Reserve actions and, later, on the fiscal front, by Congress.â€
Buffett added that the Fed’s actions helped companies brace for impact, as the initial spread of COVID sent companies scrambling to raise funds. Berkshire Hathaway was among the many companies that turned to debt issuance as the stock market tanked in late February and early March last year, issuing a $500 million 10-year bond on March 4, 2020.
The appetite for corporate debt dried up shortly after that, prompting the Fed weeks later to create several liquidity facilities that would take on commercial paper and medium-term investment grade debt.
[Read: A glossary of the Federal Reserve's full arsenal of 'bazookas' ]
By entering the debt market as its own counterparty (through separate vehicles with equity investment from the U.S. Treasury), the central bank hoped to not only backstop markets but give private players the confidence to provide their own liquidity.
“[The Fed] took a market where Berkshire couldn't sell bonds on the day before and turned it into one where Carnival Cruise Lines, a day or two later, had record issuance of corporate debt,†Buffett said. “Companies losing money, companies were closed. It was the most dramatic move that you could imagine.â€
The Fed had been buying individual corporate bonds and corporate bond ETFs until December 31, 2020, accumulating billions in debt as part of its effort to inspire confidence in corporate funding markets.
Those purchases included over $40 million in debt issued by Berkshire Hathaway, covering its insurance, finance, and energy businesses.
Buffett applauded Powell for his “speed and decisiveness†in backstopping the corporate debt market, adding that his persistence on getting more fiscal support was also helpful to the federal government’s relief efforts.
Buffett similarly said at Berkshire Hathaway’s meeting last year that “every one of those people that issued bonds in late March and April [2020] ought to send a thank you letter to the Fed.â€
The Oracle of Omaha added that the Fed and the government have helped the economic rebound, estimating that 85% of the U.S. economy now appears to be “running a super high gear.â€
May 03, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
By Joseph Carson , former chief economist of Alliance Bernstein
Federal Reserve Chairman Jerome Powell has played down the current runup in inflation, arguing it is associated with the reopening of the economy. And as the low inflation readings of one year ago drop out, the twelve-month calculation (i.e., the so-called base effect) of reported inflation is likely to move up in the coming months.
Yet, Mr. Powell's "base effect" inflation argument is nonsense. For the "base effect" argument to be correct, the twelve-month reading of reported inflation should be markedly lower when the economy was closed than what occurred before the pandemic. But that's not the case.
Last week, the Bureau of Economic Analysis reported that the twelve-month change ending in March 2021 in the core personal consumption index (the Fed's preferred price index) was 1.83%. That compares to the 1.87% reading for the year ending in February 2020 and 1.7% for the year before that.
The 1.83% reading for twelve months ending March 2021 essentially matches the average inflation rate of the two prior years. And that 12 month period includes the three months (April to June) when the economy was closed, and GDP plunged a record 31% annualized. How could there be a "base effect" on reported inflation when the base year has the same inflation rate as it did before the pandemic?
Mr. Powell's "base effect" inflation argument has not been questioned or challenged by analysts or reporters. Regardless of that, investors need to ignore the Fed's rhetoric and treat upcoming price increases as "new" inflation.
As nonsensical as the explanation for the uptick in inflation, so too is the remedy. Demand has always been the primary force behind broad inflation cycles. Yet, Mr. Powell argues that product price inflation will ease once manufacturers increase output and eliminate "supply bottlenecks," and home inflation will slow once builders build more homes.
It's hard to see how more supply (or growth) will slow inflation anytime soon. Federal Home Loan Mortgage Company (Freddie Mac) estimates that the US needs almost 4 million new homes to meet demand. That could take two to three years. Also, it's hard to see how increasing product output will solve the inflation problem. The supply-side argument solution; fight inflation with more demand and more commodity inflation.
The Fed's mantra has always been "inflation is everywhere and always a monetary phenomenon." But nowhere in Mr. Powell's statements or comments do you find any monetary policy role for increased inflation or any responsibility for containment. Investors forewarned.
Apr 27, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The recent calm in the Treasury market contrasts with early-year selling that pushed yields to their highest levels since the pandemic started.
... Foreign investors purchased around $135 billion worth of long-term Treasuries on a net basis in January and February, according to data recently compiled by Citiâ€"the best two-month start to a year since 2012.
...But buying from foreign investors and even pension funds may not be enough to quell a rise in yields, said Mr. Goldberg. His firm is forecasting the 10-year yield to rise to 2% by the end of the year, supported by improving economic data and passage of a fiscal package later this year.
Apr 29, 2021 | www.moonofalabama.org
vk , Apr 29 2021 15:19 utc | 7
Food for thought:
Federal Reserve isn't fooling anybody on inflation
I don't share David P. Goldman's ideology and convictions. They are almost the polar opposite of mine's.
But he has something I don't have, something that only a bourgeois specialist can give: insider information.
I once hypothesized here that, if the USA were to collapse suddenly (which I don't think it ever will, but if it do happen), then it would surely involve an uncontrolled growing spiral of inflation/hyperinflation. That's the logical conclusion of an hypothetical collapse of the USD standard.
So far, I can only see a mild rise in inflation. I don't think the USA will ever experience hyperinflation (four-digit) or even true high inflation (two-digit). Goldman is a rabid neoliberal, and anything above 2% is hyperinflation for him, so we should take these kind of analyses with a grain of salt.
--//--
Sugar rush:
US real GDP rose 6.4 per cent on an annualised basis in the first quarter
Fed Chair Jay Powell said that the Fed was not going to tighten monetary policy any time soon. So the US stock market hit yet another all-time high.
Apr 29, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Mary 5 days ago As an alternative to PTTRX, which is waning in the current interest rate environment...
A special deal is available and it's one of the few times you can lock in a great return with no risk. On May 1, the inflation component on US Treasury I-Bonds will adjust to an annualized rate of 3.54%. This is a tremendous jump due to inflation ramping up. I-Bonds, similar to TIPS combine the inflation rate with an interest rate component (currently 0% for I-Bonds) to get the overall yield. There is a $10k/person/year cap on the amount of I-Bonds that can be purchased through Treasury Direct. Between the folks living under your roof, that could amount to a good chunk.
In any case, you can easily set up an account on Treasury Direct and any money going in on/after May 1 will get the new 3.54% rate. You can't withdraw the funds for 5 years to avoid penalty. However, with a 3.54% yield, if you do need to withdraw early, the 6 months penalty still leaves you significantly better off than CDs or other alternatives.
The inflation component adjusts every 6 months, so the yield you get will vary. However, it's pretty well known that Powell/Treasury are looking to let the economy run hot for a while, basically committing not to raise interest rates until 2023.
Anyhow, have a look. There's a couple of good articles out there about this situation. I personally like the one on tipswatch. Mary 2 days ago @DOOGIE1 My pleasure. It's a tough environment for fixed income investors these days...I take what I can get. I think the I-Bonds are one of the best inflation hedges out there. TIPS should be good, but again, as a result of the crazy interest rate environment, the interest rate component on short-term TIPS is negative! I-Bonds never have negative interest component.
Lastly, re-reviewing terms, if you withdraw earlier than 5 years, penalty is last 3 months of interest, not 6 - so even better.
Feb 23, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"
How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"To what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals.How long does THIS go on....?
Extracted from Key Short-Term Bond Spread Hits Lowest Level in Nearly a Year - WSJ By Julia-Ambra Verlaine
Yield curve is available from Statista See also Daily Treasury Yield Curve Rates and Understanding The Treasury Yield Curve Rates
Feb. 23, 2021The spread between the two-year Treasury yield and a key interest rate set by the Federal Reserve is the narrowest since the depths of the coronavirus market selloff, a potential sign of financial-system stress.
The two-year Treasury yield, which closed Tuesday at 0.115%, is 0.015 percentage point above the interest rate on excess reserves, or IOER. It traded as low as 0.105% earlier in February. The Fed pays banks on the reserves held above and beyond those required by central-bank regulatory policy as part of its effort to maintain liquidity in the financial system.
When the coronavirus sent markets and the economy into a tailspin in March, the Fed cut IOER by 1 percentage point to 0.10% -- alongside other interventions -- to shore up short-term lending markets and support economic activity. The spread between IOER and the two-year yield has typically been above 0.05 percentage point since the Fed cut the rate to its lowest level ever in March.
Yield on U.S. 10-year Treasury note Source: Tullett Prebon % March 2020 '21 0.4 0.6 0.8 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6 Traders said the shrinking of this spread reflects appetite for short-term debt as investors gobble up safe assets and park their cash. It also highlights a key tension point in financial markets: to what extent is Fed support for markets taking asset prices to unsustainable levels, and how vulnerable does that leave bond markets and other areas exposed to sudden reversals
...bond traders are concerned that inflation could rise in coming months and years as the government prints money to support the economy and cover future borrowing costs.
Traders contend that short-term yields would be higher if the central bank wasn't anchoring rates. The Fed has been buying $80 billion in Treasurys each month since June and slashed rates to near zero in March to stabilize financial markets.
The idea is that low interest rates and bond buying boost spending by providing cheap credit to businesses and households. Some bond investors fear too much cheap credit will mean inflation.
... Another corner of U.S. markets is sending warning signals: the 10-year break-even rate, which tracks annual inflation expectations over the next decade, traded as high as 2.24% last week.
....The difference between the break-even rate and the Treasury yield recently widened to more than 1 percentage point. For some this is a sign that inflation isn't far off, and in the meantime that financial markets remain vulnerable to bubbles.
"I would characterize the phase we are in now as an era of hyperstimulation between fiscal and monetary policy," said Thomas Pluta, global head of linear rates trading at JPMorgan Chase & Co. "The byproduct is all this cash sloshing around the system chasing assets like crypto, commodities and meme stocks." (Traders on Reddit's WallStreetBets forum use memes such as a rocket emoji to accompany favorite stock picks like GameStop Corp.) SUBSCRIBER 1 month ago
So every time the stock market wobbles the Fed is going to step up and say "don't worry, hang onto your stocks and bonds, we'll keep printing more money?"How long does THIS go on....?
Apr 27, 2021 | www.wsj.com
... Conditions are significantly different now than in 1999, when speculative telecommunications companies raised capital by issuing stock and high-yield bonds, Mr. Daigle said. That bubble enabled companies like Global Crossing Ltd., Iridium LLC and WorldCom Inc., to raise billions of dollars before they went bankrupt .
"The biggest lesson for the leveraged finance market from the late 1990s is that no amount of equity can salvage a bad business model," Mr. Daigle said.
In contrast, the average credit quality of high-yield bond issuers today is relatively strong. More than half of high-yield bonds are rated double-B, the highest below-investment-grade rating, compared with a historical average of 35%, Citigroup's Mr. Anderson said.
Still, credit risk has been rising in the $1.2 trillion market of below-investment-grade loans, like those Cyxtera took on for its 2017 acquisition by private-equity firms. Issuers of such "leveraged loans" are also being acquired by SPACs. That will likely lead to higher levels of distress among such companies in the next economic downturn, according to Mr. Daigle.
"It's the opposite of what we saw in the 1990s when the speculative lending was happening in the high-yield bond market," he said.
... .... ...
Write to Matt Wirz at [email protected]
Apr 23, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Money from stock offerings is flowing into below-investment-grade companies at a pace not seen since the dot.com boom of the 1990sThe wave of cash raised by special-purpose acquisition companies is rolling into the junk debt market, aiding distressed companies and rewarding investors who own their bonds and loans.
SPACs, also known as blank-check companies, have issued roughly $100 billion of stock this year, a record, to buy private companies and take them public. Some SPACs are targeting companies with below-investment-grade credit ratings, hoping to use their cash piles to pay down debt and grow the businesses.
Not since the dot.com-boom two decades ago has stock-market enthusiasm been hot enough to fuel such activity in debt markets , bond investors and analysts say.
Mutual funds managers that owned WeWork bonds booked paper gains of 25% after the ailing shared-office provider started merger talks in January with a SPAC, according to MarketAxess. Companies with junk credit ratings are typically required to buy back their debt, often at a premium, when a change of control occurs via a merger. Loans of Cyxtera Technologies Inc.â€"which credit-rating companies recently warned was in danger of defaultâ€"jumped 16% in February when the data-center operator agreed to merge with one of the blank-check companies , according to AdvantageData Inc.
“There’s a lot of deja-vu of the late 1990s happening in the high-yield market right now,†said Michael Anderson, a managing director for credit research at Citigroup Inc.
Apr 27, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
We've been outlining how the Fed and other central banks have unleashed an inflationary bubble in all assets truly an Everything Bubble.
We've already assessed the impact this is having on commodities, bonds and other asset classes. Today I want to assess the impact this will have on stocks.
To do that, we need to look at emerging markets.
Inflation is a common occurrence for emerging markets, primarily because more often than not they devalue their currencies, whether by choice or because the markets lose faith in their ability to pay off their debts.
Because of this, emerging markets can provide a glimpse into how inflation affects stocks. So, let's dig in.
Here is a chart of South Africa's stock market since 2003. As you can see, the stock market rallied significantly until 2010, but has effectively gone nowhere ever since then.
The reason this chart looks so lackluster is because it is priced in U.S. dollars. The $USD has been strengthening against the South African currency (the Rand) since 2010.
Watch what happens we price the South Africa stock market in its domestic currency (blue line). Suddenly, this stock market has been ROARING, rising some 750% since 2003. That means average annual gains of 41%!!!
Let's use another example.
Below is a chart of the Mexican stock market priced in $USD. Once again, we see a stock market that has done nothing of note for years.
Now let's price it in pesos (actually the exchange rate of pesos to $USD, but close enough).
You get the general idea. So if hot inflation is in the U.S. financial system, it would make perfect sense for stocks (denominated in the $USD which is losing value due to inflation) to ERUPT higher.
Something like I don't know what's happened since mid-2020?
Look, we all know what's going on here. The stock market is erupting higher as inflation rips into the financial system based on Fed NUCLEAR money printing. And we all know what comes when this bubble bursts.
On that note, we just published a Special Investment Report concerning FIVE secret investments you can use to make inflation pay you as it rips through the financial system in the months ahead.
The report is titled Survive the Inflationary Storm. And it explains in very simply terms how to make inflation PAY YOU.
We are making just 100 copies available to the public.
To pick up yours, swing by:
https://phoenixcapitalmarketing.com/inflationstorm.html
Best Regards
Graham Summers
Chief Market Strategist
Phoenix Capital Research
Apr 27, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Don't believe your lying eyes, will be the message tomorrow from The Fed's Jay Powell as he hypnotizes investors to believe that "inflation is transitory" and they have "the tools" to manage it.
'Bond King' Jeff Gundlach is not buying that line and told BNN Bloomberg in an interview this morning.
"...more importantly, I'm not sure why they think they know it's transitory... how do they know that?"
"...there's plenty of money-printing that's been going on, and we've seen commodity prices going up massively... home prices in the US are inflating very substantially... so there's a lot of inflation that's already baked in to input prices ."
Gundlach does admit that Powell has a point in the very near term as the prints were about to see "which could be as high as 4% [for CPI]" are off of year-ago, very depressed levels. "...what he means by transitory is that the base effect will lead to problems in the next few months but then the base effect will become less problematic."
But, Gundlach adds, "it's not clear to me that inflation is going to go back down to around 2 to 2.5%... we don't know, nobody knows... but we're most concerned with the fact that The Fed thinks they know."
This is worrisome because The Fed's track record is anything but inspiring...
"when I go back to the global financial crisis, when we almost had a complete meltdown of the financial system, Ben Bernanke completely missed all of the problems that led to the crisis."
Bernanke's infamous "contained to subprime... and subprime is only a sliver of the market" comments could be about to be trumped by Powell's "inflation is transitory" comments as Gundlach warns "there's plenty of indicators that suggest inflation is going to go higher and not just on a transitory basis."
The Fed is "trying to paint the picture" of control, but Gundlach tries to make clear: "they're guessing."
So, what does that mean for markets?
While some fear "we ain't seen nothing yet" in terms of yields rising (and multiple contraction), Gundlach notes that "it really depends on just how much manipulation the authorities are willing to do."
The billionaire fund manager notes that yields are "still very low... well below the current inflation rate... so we have negative yields everywhere on the yield curve."
It's also "hard to figure out who's going to buy the bonds," he notes, "as we are about to see issuance like we have never seen before." Foreigners have been selling bonds for years and domestically there is little demand, so Gundlach notes the only one left to soak up all this extra supply is The Federal Reserve, which has already expanded its balance sheet massively in the last 12 months.
"Who's going to buy all these many trillions of dollars of bonds? Foreigners have been selling for years and they've accelerated their selling in the last several quarters, domestic buyers are not exactly selling, but they're not adding to their holdings. So what's left to absorb all of the spawn supply is the Federal Reserve ."
"Left to true, free markets, bond yields at the long-end would obviously be higher than they are now."
And so who will buy all these bonds with negative real yields - The Fed... "and they have been transparent about their willingness and ability to buy bonds and expand their balance sheet with no ceiling."
Gundlach is talking about Yield Curve Control, reminding viewers that "The Fed can set the long-end wherever they want it... there's a precedent for this from back in the 1940s into the 50s," in order to ease the pain of the debt from World War II.
Of course, Gundlach warns ominously, "once they stopped the yield curve control, we went into a 27 year massive bear market in bonds, because of 'guns-n'butter' policies... which look like our policies today."
Simply put, he sees "an echo [in current markets and policies] of what happened in the late 1970s into the early 1980s."
His forecast is that "The Fed will allow the market forces to take yields to higher levels [10Y 2.25%] before stepping in."
The Bond King also note that the US stock market is very overvalued by virtually every important metric , and especially so versus foreign markets such as Asia and even Europe.
"I bought European equities a couple of weeks ago, literally for the first time in many years. I can't remember the last time I did it. And that's largely because I think the U.S. dollar is almost certain to decline over the intermediate to long term."
There's a lot more in the interview on the impact of Biden's stimmies and potential tax hikes...
https://webapps.9c9media.com/vidi-player/1.9.19/share/iframe.html?currentId=2189621&config=bnn/share.json&kruxId=&rsid=bellmediabnnbprod,bellmediaglobalprod&siteName=bnnb&cid=%5B%7B%22contentId%22%3A2189621%2C%22ad%22%3A%7B%22adsite%22%3A%22ctv.bnn%22%2C%22adzone%22%3A%22ctv.bnn%22%7D%7D%5D 10,571 48 NEVER
Sound of the Suburbs 26 minutes ago
WITCH PELOSI 39 minutes agoWe are going to train you in this Mickey Mouse economics that doesn't consider private debt and put you in charge of financial stability at the FED.
They don't stand a chance.
Financial stability arrived in the Keynesian era and was locked into the regulations of the time.
https://www.brettonwoodsproject.org/wp-content/uploads/2009/10/banking-crises.png
"This Time is Different" by Reinhart and Rogoff has a graph showing the same thing (Figure 13.1 - The proportion of countries with banking crises, 1900-2008).
Neoclassical economics came back and so did the financial crises.
The neoliberals removed the regulations that created financial stability in the Keynesian era and put independent central banks in charge of financial stability.
Why does it go so wrong?
Richard Vague had noticed real estate lending balloon from 5 trillion to 10 trillion from 2001 – 2007 and knew there was going to be a financial crisis.
Richard Vague has looked at the data for financial crises going back 200 years and found the cause was nearly always runaway bank lending.
We put central bankers in charge of financial stability, but they use an economics that ignores the main cause of financial crises, private debt.
Most of the problems are coming from private debt.
The technocrats use an economics that ignores private debt.
The poor old technocrats don't stand a chance.
atomp 34 minutes ago42" entry level lawnmower @ Home Depot, spring 2014, $999. Spring 2021 $1549. That's what I call inflation! And maybe a little greed to boot!
Sound of the Suburbs 25 minutes ago remove link$30 is the new $10.
In 2008 the Queen visited the revered economists of the LSE and said "If these things were so large, how come everyone missed it?"
It's that neoclassical economics they use Ma'am, it doesn't consider private debt.
Here it is Ma'am, look it's obvious.
https://www.youtube.com/watch?v=vAStZJCKmbU&list=PLmtuEaMvhDZZQLxg24CAiFgZYldtoCR-R&index=6
At 18 mins.
Let's get our experts in neoclassical economics to have a look.
"It was a black swan"
Not considering private debt is the Achilles' heel of neoclassical economics.
It is a black swan to them.
That's the problem.
Apr 22, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Brian Sozzi · Editor-at-Large Thu, April 22, 2021, 4:32 PM
If you believe the market is a forward looking mechanism -- and most investors would agree that it is -- then you may want to prepare your portfolios for a sharp slowdown in economic growth later this year and into 2022 as fiscal stimulus wanes.
U.S. economic growth for this year is "peaking," Goldman Sachs strategists led by Ben Snider warned in a new note on Thursday. Snider said Goldman's economists predict 10.5% GDP growth for the second quarter, the strongest quarterly growth rate since 1978. The projection is also near the high-end of most economists on Wall Street.
From there, well, it's all downhill for GDP growth.
Goldman estimates growth in the third and fourth quarters of this year will clock in at 7.5% and 6.5%, respectively. Growth is then seen slowing in each quarter of 2022 -- by the fourth quarter Goldman is modeling a mere 1.5% GDP increase.
"Although our economists expect U.S. GDP growth will remain both above trend and above consensus forecasts through the next few quarters, they believe the pace of growth will peak within the next 1-2 months as the tailwinds from fiscal stimulus and economic reopening reach their maximum impact and then begin to fade," Snider said.
The economic growth peak could have major implications for investor returns, Snider thinks.
Goldman's research shows decelerating economic growth usually leads to weaker -- though still positive -- equity returns and greater volatility. Since 1980, the S&P 500 has averaged a monthly return of 0.6% when economic growth was positive but decelerating. That is half the 1.2% average gain when economic growth was positive and accelerating, points out Snider.
"Decelerating economic growth is also typically accompanied by sector rotations within the equity market,' Snider added. "Cyclical industries tend to lead the market in environments of positive and accelerating economic growth, but as growth peaks and decelerates more defensive industries typically outperform."
Apr 20, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Bond investors are bewildered after last week's stellar US economic data sparked a rally in haven US Treasuries -- a market reaction that breaks the typical dynamic for fund managers. The price of highly rated government bonds tends to jump in response to bad news, pushing down yields. Mike Riddell, a portfolio manager at Allianz Global Investors, described the market move as "bonkers".
Apr 19, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Katie Martin Sun, April 18, 2021, 8:00 PM
The recent run-up in government bond yields is a gift to any fund manager fretting over market risks ranging from geopolitics to leverage. It is true that the first quarter of this year was no fun for holders of government bonds, which dropped in price on the largest scale in four decades. The pullback means that, just as Russia and the US once again lock horns, and as the Archegos implosion stirs concerns over potentially systemic risks stemming from plentiful global leverage, government bonds again offer something of a safety net.
Apr 19, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The Fed has been buying at least $120 billion a month of Treasury debt and mortgage-backed securities since last June to hold down long-term borrowing costs. Since December, the central bank has said the economy must make "substantial further progress" toward its goals of maximum employment and 2% inflation before it scales back those purchases.
"We will taper asset purchases when we've made substantial further progress toward our goals, from last December when we announced that guidance," Mr. Powell said in a virtual event held by the Economic Club of Washington, D.C. "That would in all likelihood be before -- well before -- the time we consider raising interest rates."
The Fed has said it will hold rates near zero until it sees the labor market return to full employment and inflation rise to 2% and is forecast to moderately exceed that level for some time. Mr. Powell reiterated that he thinks it is highly unlikely that the Fed would raise interest rates this year and noted that most central-bank officials see rates remaining near zero through 2023.
Tuesday's report fueled concerns that inflation, dormant through the record-long economic expansion from 2009 to 2020, could soon become a challenge for policy makers. Mr. Powell acknowledged those worries while reiterating that the Fed seeks inflation "that is moderately above 2% for some time" to make up for the past decade's shortfalls.
Both the Biden administration and the Fed acknowledge the possibility of prices rising faster than usual in coming months as the economic recovery strengthens and demand for goods and services temporarily outruns supply. But both expect the acceleration in inflation to prove temporary.
Apr 15, 2021 | www.wsj.com
Treasury yields still remain much higher than where they started the year.
The 10-year finished last year at 0.913%. The yield on the 30-year bond settled Thursday at 2.210%, down from 2.325% Wednesday but up from 1.642% at the end of last year.
Apr 17, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
Instead, the muni market "yawned" when the bill was passed, said Eric Kazatsky, Bloomberg Intelligence head municipal strategist, a signal that the aid money had already been priced in. But muni ETFs are still worth a look, he thinks.
Kazatsky is a fan of the "gorillas" in the marketplace for all the usual reasons -- what he calls "solid" management, low fees, liquidity and robust inflows. He mentions the $21 billion iShares National Muni Bond ETF MUB,
-0.06% , which tracks investment-grade bonds. For investors willing to take on a little more risk, there's the VanEck Vectors High Yield Muni ETF HYD,-0.02% , which has $3.3 billion under management. For taxable munis, the Invesco Taxable Municipal Bond ETF BAB,-0.21% is one of the bigger funds.For investors unfamiliar with the municipal space, "high-yield" is a different animal than in the corporate sector: much safer, with very infrequent defaults. The space "could actually offer a much bigger reward because there are a lot of bargains to be had from the market dislocation last year, if you don't think they've run their course," Kazatsky told MarketWatch.
With slightly less risk comes a bit less reward: HYD has a 30-day SEC yield of 2.82% as of March 5 while the largest corporate junk-bond ETF, the iShares iBoxx $ High Yield Corporate Bond ETF HYG,
-0.21% , has yielded 3.42%.
Apr 14, 2021 | seekingalpha.com
Summary
- For a third consecutive month, everyday prices moved sharply higher with gains led by motor fuels prices.
- On the core services side, significant increases came from motor vehicle insurance (up 3.3 percent for the month), transportation services (+1.8 percent), and motor vehicle maintenance services (+1.0 percent).
- Energy prices continue to drive the Everyday Price Index higher in the early part of 2021.
Apr 14, 2021 | angrybearblog.com
For a given time-horizon, it has been conventional for those estimating such a "rational" market forecast of expected inflation to take the appropriate Treasury security nominal yield of that time horizon (say 5 years) and simply subtract from it the yield on the same time horizon TIPS, which covers security holders for inflation. So it has long looked like this difference is a pretty good estimate of this market expectation of inflation, given that TIPS covers for it while the same time horizon Treasury security does not.
Well, it turns out that there are some other things involved here that need to be taken account, one for each of these securities. On the Treasury side, it turns out that the proper measure of the expected real yield must take into account the expected time path of shorter term yields up to that time horizon. This time path has associated with it a risk regarding the path of interest rates throughout the time period. This is called the Treasury risk premium, or trp. It can be either positive or negative, with it apparently having been quite high during the inflationary 1979s.
The element that needs to be taken into account with respect to the TIPS is that these securities are apparently not as liquid in general as regular Treasury securities, and the measure of this gap is the Liquidity premium, or lp. This was apparently quite high when these were first issues and also saw a surge during the 2008-09 financial crisis. In principle this can also be of either sign, although has apparently been positive.
Anyway, the difference between the nominal T security yield and the appropriate TIPS yield is called the "inflation breakeven," the number that used to be focused on as the measure of market inflation expectations. But the new view is that this must be adjusted by adding (tpr – lp).
In a post just put up on Econbrowser by Menzie the current inflation breakeven for five years out is 2.52%. But according to Menzie the current (tpr – lp) adjustment factor is -0.64%. So adding these two together gives as the market expected inflation rate five years from now of 1.88%, although Menzie rounded it out to 1.9%.
If indeed this is what we should be looking at it says the market is not expecting all that much of an increase in the rate of inflation from its current 1.7% five years from now. The Fed and others are looking at a short term spike in prices this year, but the market seems to agree with their apparent nonchalance (shared by Janet Yellen) that this will wain later on, with that expected 5 year rate of inflation still below the Fed's target of 2%.
Certainly this contrasts with the scary talk coming from Larry Summers and Olivier Blanchard, not to mention most GOP commentators, regarding what the impact of current fiscal policies passed and proposed by Biden will do to the future rate of inflation. Not a whole lot, although, of course, rational expectations is not something that always forecasts all that well, so the pessimists might still prove to be right.
Barkley Rosser
Likbez , April 14, 2021 6:27 pm
Larry Summers is a puppet of financial oligarchy. Everything that he writes should be viewed via this prism. He also is highly overrated.
IMHO rates are no longer are determined by only domestic factors.I think that the size of foreign holdings of the USA debt and their dynamics is another important factor. FED will do everything to keep inflation less then 2% but this is possible only as long as they can export inflation.
BTW realistically inflation in the USA is probably 30%-60% higher than the official figure. Look at http://www.shadowstats.com/ :
March 2021 annual Consumer Price Index inflation hit an unadjusted three-year high of 2.62%, as gasoline prices soared to multi-year highs, not seen since well before the 2020 Oil Price War. -- March Producer Price Index exploded, with respective record annualized First-Quarter PPI inflation levels of 9.0% in Aggregate, 16.0% in Goods and 5.6% in Services.
• L A T E S T .. N U M B E R S .. March 2021 unadjusted year-to-year March 2021 CPI-U Inflation jumped 2.62% -- a one-year high -- as gasoline prices soared, not only fully recovering pre-Oil Price War levels of a year ago, but also hitting the highest unadjusted levels since May of 2019 (April 13th, Bureau of Labor Statistics – BLS). Headline March 2021 CPI-U gained 0.62% in the month, 2.62% year-to-year, against monthly and annual gains of 0.35% and 1.68% in February.
That inflation pickup reflected more than a full recovery in gasoline prices, which had been severely depressed by the Oil Price War of one year ago. Such had had the effect of depressing headline U.S. inflation up through February 2021, including suppressing the 2021 Cost of Living Adjustment (COLA) for Social Security by about one-percentage point to the headline 1.3%. By major sector, March Food prices gained 0.11% in the month, 3.47% year-to-year (vs. 0.17% and 3.62% in February); "Core" (ex-Food and Energy) prices gained 0.34% in March, 1.65% year-to-year (vs. 0.35% and 1.28% in February); Energy prices gained 5.00% in March, 13.17% year-to-year (vs. 3.85% and 2.36% in February), with underlying Gasoline prices gaining 9.10% in the month, 22.48% year-to-year (vs. 6.41% and 1.52% in February).
The March 2021 ShadowStats Alternate CPI (1980 Base) rose to 10.4% year-to-year, up from 9.4% in February 2021 and against 9.1% in January 2021. The ShadowStats Alternate CPI-U estimate restates current headline inflation so as to reverse the government's inflation-reducing gimmicks of the last four decades, which were designed specifically to reduce/ understate COLAs.
Related graphs and methodology are available to all on the updated ALTERNATE DATA tab above. Subscriber-only data downloads and an Inflation Calculator are available there, with extended details in pending No. 1460 .
In this sense China and Japanese policies will influence the USA rates. If they cut buying the US debt the writing for higher rates is on the wall. In a way, recent events might signal that FED can lose the control over rate if and when foreign actors cut holding of the USA debt.
Behavior of foreign actors is probably the key factor that will determine the rates in the future.
economistsview.typepad.com
The 10-year Treasury note yield TMUBMUSD10Y,
1.653% fell to 1.659%, down from 1.675% at the end of Monday, while the 2-year note TMUBMUSD02Y,0.168% was steady at 0.169%. The 30-year bond yield TMUBMUSD30Y,2.339% slid 0.9 basis point to 2.336%.What's driving Treasurys?
The U.S. consumer price index rose 0.6% in March, while the core gauge that strips out for energy and food prices came in at an 0.3% increase.
The annual rate of inflation climbed to 2.6% from 1.7% in the prior month, marking the highest level since the fall of 2018.
Apr 12, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
More content below More content below More content below More content below More content below More content below Jared Blikre Sat, April 10, 2021, 8:22 AMWarren Buffett's Berkshire Hathaway should scale back its passive investment in the S&P 500 ( ^GSPC ) and plow it right back into Berkshire stock ( BRK-A , BRK-B) . That's because the environment for stock picking is ripe for a shift away from passive investing, which could suffer a decade of low or nonexistent returns.
"This is the single worst time to be a passive investor in since they started passive investments... The [S&P 500] index is highly likely to not make money over the next 10 years," said Bill Smead, chief investment officer of Smead Capital Management, during the most recent Yahoo Finance Plus webinar on Wednesday. "Whether you look at historical price earnings ratios, whether you look at the normalization of interest rates, whether you look at ridiculously high levels of participation by individual investors -- compared to household network going back for decades, it all points to the same thing. The markets are not designed to make the majority succeed."
'You have to be a deviant to outperform'In investing parlance, alpha is the return above and beyond a benchmark, such as the S&P 500 -- in other words, a trader's edge. By definition, an investor in an ETF that tracks the index, such as the SPDR S&P 500 ETF ( SPY ), will see no alpha. But an active trader needs to find alpha by thinking differently.
"Alpha comes from deviation. You have to be a deviant to outperform -- not a non-deviant," said Smead.
Not all stock pickers are alike. Cathie Wood 's ARK Innovation ETF quickly became the world's largest actively managed ETF, with $28 billion in assets under management at its February peak. Over the last year, the fund loaded up on high growth names like Tesla ( TSLA ), Square ( SQ ) and the Grayscale Bitcoin Trust ( GBTC ).
Smead prefers a more value-focused approach that also incorporates growth strategies. He uses a few recent examples to warn how quickly momentum trades can reverse. "[W]hen money comes out of popular growth stocks, it's like a fire hose. And the companies that it's going into are a teacup. You're pouring water from a fire hose into a teacup. And that's also part of what happened with Reddit and Archegos," he said.
Apr 09, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
For low-income Americans, it has been a double-whammy of job losses (the total number of Americans receiving jobless benefits from the government has basically stagnated for the last four months)...
Source: Bloomberg
...and significant increases in the costs of living.
As Bloomberg reports , while the headline consumer inflation rate in the U.S. remains subdued, at 1.7% - but it masks large differences in what people actually buy .
If you like to eat, food-price inflation is running at more than double the headline rate , and staples like household cleaning products have also climbed.
Source: Bloomberg
if you drive a car, gas prices have soared in recent months...
Source: Bloomberg
All of which might explain why confidence among the lowest income Americans is lagging significantly (because groceries or gas take up a bigger share of their monthly shopping basket than is the case for wealthier households, and they're items that can't easily be deferred or substituted )...
Source: Bloomberg
An analysis by Bloomberg Economics , which reweighted consumer-price baskets based on the spending habits of different income groups, found that the richest Americans are experiencing the lowest level of inflation .
As Bloomberg 's Andrew Husby points out:
"On average, higher-income households spend a smaller fraction of their budgets on food, medical care, and rent, all categories that have seen faster inflation than the headline in recent years, and 2020 in particular."
The question of who exactly gets hurt most by higher prices could become more urgently concerning as most economists - and even The Fed itself - expect inflation to accelerate in the next 12 months.
"The food price story and inflation story are important to the issue of equality," says Carmen Reinhart, the World Bank's chief economist.
"It's a shock that has very uneven effects."
So, in summary, The Fed is telling Americans - ignore "transitory" spikes in non-core inflation (such as food and energy), it's just temporary and base-effect-driven (oh and we have the "tools" to manage it). However, despite all The Fed's pandering and virtue-signaling about "equity" and "fairness", it is precisely this segment of the costs of living that is crushing most of the long-suffering low-income population ($1400 checks or not) .
And now all eyes will be on this morning's PPI print which is expected to surge to +3.8% YoY.
Apr 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Pascal Blanqué Wed, April 7, 2021, 8:00 PMBond markets are firmly in the driving seat. For too long, inflation has disappeared from investors' radar. The key ones include a hostile environment for trade and globalisation, business and labour support public programmes and the extraordinary debt burden fuelled by the pandemic. These are set to create a turning point in the current market regime before long.
Apr 09, 2021 | www.bloomberg.com
American savers could once count on bonds to provide meaningful returns with modest risk. Not anymore.More than a decade of easy money has kept the U.S. economy afloat in times of crisis and fueled an unprecedented boom in financial markets.
But it's also created a whole new series of risks, especially for savers.
Where there was once a vast pool of safe debt in which they could park their cash and count on annual payouts of 5% or more -- comfortably above inflation -- today there's little more than a puddle, and a shrinking one at that. In fact, never has the amount of new government and corporate debt paying even modest yields been so minuscule.
Institutional investors and savers looking for a 5% annual interest rate had plenty of new bond and loan offerings rated BB and above to choose from prior to the 2008 financial crisis. These included debt from government-sponsored mortgage-loan companies like Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac. By 2019, after a decade in which the Federal Reserve kept benchmark rates near zero, the pool had shrunk dramatically, despite the fact that issuance of new debt was near record levels. Debt rated A or above paying 5% virtually disappeared, leaving the vast majority of such offerings rated in the lowest tier of investment-grade, or worse. Now, after the Fed's unprecedented intervention in bond markets drove rates down even further in the pandemic, finding anything paying more than 5% has become difficult, except for investors willing to dip into the riskiest parts of the junk-bond market. While cheap borrowing costs have been a boon for corporate America, the same can't be said for money managers that need to generate returns that match their long-term obligations.The repercussions -- for pension managers, endowments, insurance companies and 70 million baby boomers starting their retirements -- are vast. Sure, yields aren't negative like in much of Europe, but many are nonetheless being forced to, as legendary investor Warren Buffett recently put it , "juice the pathetic returns now available by shifting their purchases to obligations backed by shaky borrowers."
Others may choose to heed the advice of Ray Dalio, the founder of hedge fund giant Bridgewater Associates, who now recommends avoiding the U.S. bond market entirely and focusing on higher-returning, non-debt investments.
While the potential payout is greater, such moves also carry significant risk, especially for groups previously accustomed to holding only the safest assets.
It's possible that as savers push deeper into lower-rated debt, equities and more esoteric markets, the reckoning never comes.
But most know that's ultimately unlikely.
"It's a struggle that all of the public pension plans have been facing for a number of years -- there are some solutions, and there are some hope and pray trades," said Steve Willer, who helps manage $21 billion as deputy chief investment officer at the Kentucky Public Pensions Authority, which has lowered certain return targets amid the changing investment environment. "People are having to be more creative in looking at different segments of the debt market. That comes with different risks."
Source: Bloomberg compilation of government and corporate dollar-denominated bond and loan offerings with a yield of 5% or more at issue and at least one BB- or higher rating from S&P Global Ratings, Moody's Investors Service or Fitch Ratings. Issuance is for the six months ended March 31. Debt amounts are aggregated by issuer and ratings tier. Data includes debt issued in exchange for older bonds and notes linked to currencies that may yield more than traditional securities.
Editors: Boris Korby, Natalie Harrison and Alex Tribou
Apr 01, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
...Economists do expect inflation to rise to above 2% as more states reopen and then stay there. And the St. Louis Fed is forecasting a 2.35% rate for the next 10 years.
...China's economy has dynamics that could raise the U.S. inflation rate over time. Key to the argument are China's aging population and the value of the country's currency, the Yuan. First, age. Today, the average age in China is 38, the same as in the U.S. By 2040, though, the number skyrockets to 47 in China and dips to 37 here.
The shift means fewer Chinese workers and upward pressure on pay. Higher wages probably would cause Chinese manufacturers to raise prices of exports, which could be passed onto American consumers.
Now, the Yuan. The currency bottomed at 7.12 per dollar in late 2019 after a more than five-year down-trend. China wants a weaker currency so its exports are more competitive -- cheaper -- for global buyers. Since the end of 2019, the Yuan has risen to 6.50 per dollar. If the trend continues, U.S. importers might raise prices because the cost of their imports are higher.
"Over the next decade, Asia's growth will slow dramatically, its wages will rise, its factories will close, its surpluses will melt and its currencies will rise sharply," wrote Vincent Deluard, global macro strategist at StoneX in a note. "For the rest of the world, this will be a massive and unexpected inflationary shock."
Apr 02, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
OVERVIEW CHARTS HISTORICAL QUOTES KEY DATA
- OPEN 1.720%
- DAY RANGE 1.720 - 1.720
- 52 WEEK RANGE 0.502 - 1.778
- PRICE 94 6/32
- CHANGE 0/32
- CHANGE PERCENT 0.00%
- COUPON RATE 1.125%
- MATURITY Feb 15, 2031
Apr 01, 2021 | www.bloomberg.com
...High-yield bonds rated in the CCC tier, usually the lowest-graded bonds that trade, gained 3.58% year-to-date, according to Bloomberg Barclays index total return data. They performed better than leveraged loans, which saw returns of 1.78%, and high-grade bonds, which posted a 4.65% loss. They outperformed mortgage bonds and Treasuries too.
The higher coupons that the securities pay can offer insulation against the sting of rising yields. CCC notes average coupons of 7.7%, compared with 5.9% for high yield debt overall and 3.7% for investment-grade corporate notes, according to Bloomberg Barclays index data.
"The lower quality trade still has some legs," said Scott Kimball, co-head of U.S. fixed income at BMO Global Asset Management. "Investors typically look to high-yield securities, particularly CCCs, when yields are on the rise. Now, we see record positive revisions for U.S. growth by economists being further boosted by record fiscal stimulus expectations."
Mar 31, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
S&P gained over 6% as Treasury's total return fell over 4%...
Energy stocks soared 30% in Q1 (after rising 26% in Q4) and Tech underwhelmed (but was still higher in Q1...
brian91145 4 hours ago
TOTAL FRAUD FUELED BY DEBT!
Mar 28, 2021 | angrybearblog.com
Paul Krugman
I agree. I want to elaborate on one point he hasn't emphasized; namely, you can't have a wage-price inflationary spiral if wages don't participate!
To make my point, let me show you three graphs below, covering wages and prices in three
different periods: (l) the inflationary 1960s and '70's, (2) the disinflationary
Reagan-era 1980s and early '90's, and (3) the low inflation period of the late 1990s to the
present.
In addition to the YoY% change in CPI, I also show CPI less energy (gold), better to show oil shocks, and also that it takes about a year for inflation in energy prices to filter through to inflation in other items.
Also, hourly wages were greatly affected (depressed) by the entry of 10,000,000's of women into the workforce between the 1960s and mid-1990s. This increased median household income, which would be the better metric, but since that statistic is only released once a year, I've approximated its impact by adding 1% to the YoY% change in average hourly wages (light blue).
Here are the three graphs:
... ... ...
Mar 19, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
"It took really more than a decade of screwing things up -- year after year -- to get to that pass, and I don't think we're going to do that again," Krugman said of the inflation scourge of the 1970s to early 1980s. He spoke in an interview with David Westin for Bloomberg Television's "Wall Street Week" to be broadcast Friday.
...The worst-case scenario out of the fiscal stimulus package would be a transitory spike in consumer prices as was seen early in the Korean War, Krugman said. The relief bill is "definitely significant stimulus but not wildly inflationary stimulus," he said.
...Economists predict that the core inflation measure tied to consumer spending that the Fed uses in its forecasts will remain under 2% this year and next, a Bloomberg survey shows. A different gauge, the consumer price index is seen at 2.4% in 2021 and 2.2% next year. The CPI peaked at over 13% in 1980.
The risk is that policy makers are "fighting the last war" -- countering the undershooting of the 2% inflation target and limited fiscal measures taken after the 2007-09 financial crisis, the economists said.
Even so, he argued that "redistributionist" aspects of the pandemic-relief package will reduce the need for the Fed to keep monetary stimulus too strong for too long in order to address pockets of high unemployment. Fed Chair Jerome Powell has repeatedly said the central bank wants to see very broad strengthening in the labor market, not just a drop in the national jobless rate.
"It's not silly to think that there might be some inflationary pressure" from the fiscal package, Krugman said. But it was designed less as stimulus than as a relief plan, he said.
Mar 27, 2021 | asiatimes.com
The 30-year Treasury yield has climbed all the way back to its 2019 level, mainly because inflation expectations built into the yield have risen to the highest level since 2014. A US government deficit equal to 20% of GDP, a falling dollar and rising commodity prices mean more inflation in the future.
The Federal Reserve bought most of the Treasury debt issued in the past year, and will have to buy most of the Treasury debt issued during the coming year, as Bridgewater's Ray Dalio told the China Economic Forum on Sunday.
Unlike the period after the 2009 crash, when foreigners financed roughly half of the US government deficit, foreigners haven't increased their holdings of US debt during the past twelve months.
Dalio, one of the world's most successful investors, warns that they might start to sell the debt they already own. "The situation is bearish for the dollar," Dalio concluded.
As the late Herbert Stein said, anything that can't go on forever won't.
Budan University Professor Bai Gang told China's Observer website last week: "For the past year, the US has continued to issue more currency to ease its internal situation. The pressure will eventually seriously damage the status of the US dollar as the core currency in the international payment system."
Mar 26, 2021 | www.investors.com
Biden hailed the new law's focus on growing the economy "from the bottom up and the middle out," after decades of supply-side, or "trickle down" tax policies. It "changes the paradigm" for the first time since President Johnson's Great Society programs, he said.
But the last time free-spending, inflation-permissive "regime shifts for fiscal and monetary policymakers" coincided, wrote Deutsche Bank economists David Folkerts-Landau and Peter Hooper, "such shifts touched off a sustained surge in inflation in the U.S.," beginning in 1966.
Growth in core prices, which exclude food and energy, jumped from well under 2% in 1965 to nearly 3.5% in 1966 and approached 5% by late 1968, Deutsche Bank noted. Inflation remained elevated into the early 1970s, even before an oil shock hit in 1973. The pickup was broad-based, but health care inflation played a key role, going from less than 3% to nearly 7% by early 1967.
The S&P 500 suffered through a bear market in 1966. Another 19-month bear market began in late 1968. The Dow Jones made a major top in January 1966. It would take the Dow Jones until 1982 to finally break through that ceiling for good.
What Is Inflation And Why Does It Matter To The Fed -- And You?
Outlook For Inflation, Federal Reserve PolicyAlmost everyone expects a notable pickup in inflation this year -- including the Fed. Monetary policymakers expect the personal consumption expenditures (PCE) price index to rise 2.4% this year. That's vs. 1.5% in the 12 months through January.
Fed Chair Jerome Powell said March 17 that the Fed will discount this year's jump in prices as a transitory bounce from pandemic-induced weakness. What happens in 2022 will be key. Fed projections show inflation easing back to 2%. But if pressures don't ease, the Fed will have to reassess its 2024 timetable for the cycle's first rate hike.
It's easy to see how Fed projections might understate next year's inflation. Policymakers likely are not factoring in any impact from the Democrats' next massive spending package.
Subdued health care prices might help keep inflation in check, depending on what Congress does. A 2% hike in Medicare reimbursements is scheduled to lapse in April, but lawmakers appear set to extend it. A 3.75% increase in Medicare fees for physicians could end in January, Deutsche Bank said.
Democrats also are eyeing spending curbs to help pay for their infrastructure package. Letting Medicare negotiate prescription drug prices is high on the list of options.
Longer term, the inflation outlook may depend on whether a post-pandemic productivity boom offsets upward price pressure as globalization backslides.
10-Year Treasury Yield Surges On U.S. Economy Growth OutlookThis week, the 10-year Treasury yield has eased to 1.66%, after hitting 1.75% last week, the highest of the Covid era. Still, the 10-year yield is up 66 basis points since Jan. 5.
Financial market pricing now indicates an expectation that inflation will average 2.35% over the coming decade. That's the difference between the 10-year Treasury yield and the -0.69% yield on 10-year Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities, or TIPS.
"Negative real yields seem highly incongruous with the robust economic growth in train," Moody's Analytics chief economist Mark Zandi wrote. As real yields rebound, Zandi sees the 10-year Treasury yield reaching 2% by year end, 2.5% in 2022 and 3% by late 2023.
What Do Taxes, Interest Rates Mean For S&P 500?As the new fiscal and monetary policy regime takes hold, investors will have a lot to process. If the era of too-little inflation and ultralow interest rates is drawing to an end, but earnings growth surges as the economy catches fire, what will that mean for the S&P 500? And how might tax hikes affect stock prices?
... ... ...
The UBS economics team holds the out-of-consensus view that annual core PCE inflation won't exceed the Fed's 2% target until 2024. Chief U.S. economist Seth Carpenter expects the new stimulus checks to be largely saved. The next fiscal package might likewise have a "muted" bang for the buck, while adding just $600 billion to the federal deficit.
... ... ...
Interest Rates: Parker finds that a 50-basis-point rise in the 10-year Treasury yield compresses price-earnings multiples by six-tenths of a point. Based on the S&P 500's current forward earnings multiple of about 21.5, that would equate to about a 3% decline in the S&P 500.
Capital Gains Taxes: Biden has proposed hiking the capital gains tax rate from 20% to 39.6% for high earners. Parker figures that could slice 1.5 points off the S&P 500 P/E multiple, potentially a 7% hit. However, UBS expects that not quite half the tax plan will become law.
Parker arrives at a 19.5 forward earnings multiple for the S&P 500. That also factors in some compression because the fiscal boost to earnings is bound to slacken...
Feb 23, 2021 | maalamalama.com
... On December 7, 2009, I sent out a warning from our Managing Director, J. Kim, to thousands of people via email about the deterioration of the global economy...
...J. Kim: "Despite the weapons of mass financial destruction that bankers have created and governments worldwide have coddled and shielded from proper regulation, the majority of people still incredibly do not understand the crime syndicate-like relationships among governments, corporations and banks. The public sees that the US markets are up a little over 10% this year and many are duped into believing that that the stock market performance means that the economy is recovering. And this belief is reinforced by idiot talking heads on TV like Jim Cramer that do nothing but misinform people. Sure, US markets have now risen by more than 36.79% since they crashed in 2008, a figure that sounds impressive on the surface level. Then combine this impressive sounding figure with US Fed Reserve Chairman Ben Bernanke's national appearance on 60 Minutes, when he lies to the nation about inflation rates and about continuing to create more money out of thin air, and you have millions more that are converted into sheeple. How do I know? Because I talk almost every month to people in the US that tell me they believe the economy is recovering. So when people believe that inflation is still less than 2% because the Fed tells them to believe this, they look at a near 37% gain in the US markets in the last two years and believe that they have made substantial recovery in their pensions and IRAs and consequently believe the economy must be recovering as well! (by comparison, J. Kim's Crisis Investment Opportunities newsletter(that he published back then) has returned more than 105.25% over the same time period, clobbering the S&P 500's 36.79% return, and yielding very substantial REAL gains, even after the inflationary monetary effects of the US Federal Reserve's schemes)."
James C : "So besides the government and bankers deliberately keeping people in the dark, why else do you think some, or even many, people believe the economy is recovering?"
J. Kim: "First of all, the Federal Reserve's insane POMO (Permanent Open Market Operation) schemes this year (2010) are largely responsible for propping up the US market this year. In 2009, when I stated that the US would experience significant economic shocks in 2010 and 2011, I did not yet know the duration of the Fed's POMO operations and how insane they were going to be. Although daily POMOs had already reached upwards of $6 billion and $7 billion per day as of mid-2009 (just for US Treasuries, but up to multiples of these figures when including US Treasuries and other debt-related financial products), many had speculated that the POMOs would soon end. Obviously, with projected cumulative POMOs of nearly $1,000,000,000,000 just between November 2010 and June 2011 (again just for US Treasuries), the Fed Reserve POMO scheme not only did not end, but it received an injection of steroids in 2010. So POMOs that were used to buy future contracts of US market indexes is a major factor that has kept the US market afloat at this juncture and may continue to keep it afloat for several more months. Rising stock markets have no correlation to a strong economy anymore due to scams run by Central Banks and due to gains that largely occur due to the devaluing currencies that these markets are denominated in . The best performing stock market of the past decade has been the Zimbabwe stock market. Still, it's irrelevant if you made a quadrillion Zimbabwe dollar profit investing in the Zimbabwe stock market, as by 2008, a loaf of bread would have cost you 1.6 trillion Zimbabwe dollars."
James C: "If the economy is really not recovering, then can you explain what is really going on?"
J. Kim: "Let me explain what is really going on with the economy with the following disaster analogy. In June of 1995, the Sampoong department store, a five-story building with four basement levels, suddenly collapsed in Seoul, South Korea, tragically killing 501 people and injuring 937 others. When the Sampoong department store was constructed, the owners, due to a desire to cut costs, made several fatal decisions. First, they decided to cut away a number of support columns in the original blueprint in order to install escalators. Secondly, in order to cut costs, the owners shrunk the original width of the support columns from the required 80cms to only 60 cms, an inadequate width to support the load of the building. In addition, the original blueprint called for only a four-story building but the owners built an additional fifth story that housed a restaurant with a very heavy heated concrete base that quadrupled the load of the original building design.
Two months before the building collapsed, worrisome cracks appeared in the ceiling of the south wing's floor. On the day of the collapse, cracks as wide as 10 centimeters appeared in the top floors of the building five hours before the building collapsed, but the owners hid this information from its patrons and refused to shut down and/or evacuate the building as they did not want to lose its daily revenue. When it became clear that the building was going to collapse, senior executives of the department store fled without warning any of the patrons still inside the building. An alarm to evacuate the building was only sounded when the building started to make loud cracking sounds, just 7 minutes before its collapse at 5:57 PM despite signs of an imminent collapse being clearly visible more than five hours prior. City officials Lee Chung-Woo and Hwang Chol-Min, in charge of overseeing the construction of the building, were responsible with concealing the illegal changes to the original blueprint designs and were later charged with and convicted of bribery."
"Amazingly, the above story serves as nearly a perfect analogy for the US economy. The government and bankers laud a rising stock market as proof that the economy is recovering. They go on record stating that inflation is less than 2% when in reality it is more than four times higher. They state unemployment is less than 10% when it is nearly 23% [Editor's Note: These statistics all apply to the year in which this original interview was conducted, 2010]. Thus, to many people, the economy appears as the Sampoong department store's exterior appeared to the public right before its collapse, structurally sound and with a solid exterior. This is the reason why 40,000 people a day visited the department store despite its fatal structural integrity problems. The government and bankers are just like the Sampoong department store owners, actively concealing all warning signs from the public and selling them an illusion that all is okay when instead, the economy is heading for collapse. Just as the Sampoong department store owners constructed a crappy building destined to collapse due to excessive greed, bankers with the help of government officials, constructed dozens of financial derivative products destined to collapse due to their excessive greed as well."
"The US regulators that also see the impending cracks in the economy, are just like Lee Chung-Woo and Hwang Chol-Min. They receive inordinate pressure and bribes from the bankers to look the other way and keep the public in the dark about the impending doom that is coming. In the case of the Sampoong disaster, when the contractors refused to continue work on the building when the owners changed structural regulations that endangered the integrity of the building, the owners fired the contractors and hired ones that would cut corners. US regulators that are honest and that try to protect the American public, like Brooksley Born, received the same fate as the original Sampoong contractors and are also fired or forced to resign. When the entire system is corrupt, even the rare good person can't save disasters from happening. Thus, the public is none-the-better-off despite the presence of regulators that are supposed to protect the public's interests and safety, but in reality, protect the greed and profits of companies that exploit the public's interests."
"And finally, the economy itself is like Sampoong's interior. It is replete with cracks and fractures that warn us of the disaster ahead. But even so, a large percentage of the masses still remains ignorant because the banker/corporate/government three-headed monster keeps the people's vision in a tunnel by pummeling the public with a constant stream of propaganda on MSNBC, newspapers, and financial talk shows. In Seoul, Sampoong's owners distracted the public's attention away from the developing disaster with stores fully of luxury goods. So when the US economy finally experiences shocks in the future more disastrous than those in 2008, as was the case with the Sampoong department store collapse, many will believe that now warning signs had existed despite the evidence that exists to the contrary today. And I'm quite certain the media, just as they did in 2008, will stupidly ask the same questions they did back then, such as "How did this happen?" when in fact, all the answers stare them in the face right now. With the Fed's POMO schemes, regulators that aid and abet fraud, and governments and bankers that conceal truth from the public, the combined effect of these actions is just to delay disaster for another year or two. So that is why I say now that disaster will visit the US sometime between 2011-2013."
Mar 26, 2021 | maalamalama.com
... As I already stated above, anyone that has a rudimentary understanding of real finance (meaning finance as it operates in the real world, not finance as taught in MBA programs) already understood that Central Bankers' massive provisions of liquidity in the overnight repo market pointed to US banks being undercapitalized in cash
... in my referenced April 2020 article above, I only explained why it was necessary for Central Bankers to keep interest rates extremely low, and I had not yet realized, as we were only a few weeks into a global economic lockdown that was promised to last only a few weeks, that the global economic destruction caused by lockdowns would be the mechanism used to achieve this goal of keeping interest rates extremely low. In other words, only in hindsight, a few months into the lockdown, did I connect the dots myself and understand why it was necessary to keep the economic lockdowns going forever, which is also why I stated at the end of 2020 that only the extremely naïve and foolish believe that the bankers and politicians would end the lockdowns in the New Year, as the problem I explained in April 2020 that needs to be managed to avoid meltdown of the global financial system still very much exists in March of 2021.
Mar 22, 2021 | maalamalama.com
- READ TIME: 1 MINUTE
- BY J. KIM
- LEAVE A COMMENT
I often look at rising US corporate junk bond yields after long periods of decline as the proverbial "canary in the coal mine" to predict major trouble ahead in global stock markets.
As you can see, US corporate junk bond yields have just started to rise after nearly a full year of plunging yields. Is the rise enough to spark concern? In my opinion, the rise in yields is not significant enough to yet spark major concern, but if they break 5.0% then at this point, I will dive deeper into the muck to see what I can find.
So stay tuned, and if you have not yet subscribed to my free newsletter, please do so at the link at the top of this page.
Mar 25, 2021 | www.wsj.com
...The Fed reiterated last week that its rate-setting committee doesn't expect to increase interest rates until after 2023. However, investors predict that it will, according to Sebastien Galy, senior macro strategist at Nordea Asset Management.
... the difference between longer-term and shorter-term yields remains far greater in real yields than in nominal yields. This difference over time, known as the yield curve, illustrates how much investors expect interest rates to rise in the future: A steep curve equals more rate rises.
... For normal Treasury yields, that five-year to 10-year gap was 0.798 percentage points, up from 0.550 percentage points at the end of 2020 .
... ... ...
Some investors also fear that a sharper rise in interest rates later will be more destabilizing for other assets such as stocks or riskier corporate debt...
... ... ...
Harold Begzos SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago The value of fiat currency is only as good as the government that prints the paper. We are managing the dollar like a Caudillo running a banana republic. The U.S. is experiencing a sugar high. When the sugar runs out the crash will cause harm for the next decade. A Andy Kives SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago One of my many price increases this year was this morning from my metal and plastic container wholesaler, who I buy a few hundred thousand pieces from annually. Prices are only going up 10-26% in April.What inflation? Like thumb_up 3 Share link Report flag S Susan Croxton SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago (Edited) The dollar tanked under Trump, like he wanted Like thumb_up Share link Report flag G Gerald Garibaldi SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago (Edited) My grandmother was a deft investor, and her credo when investing was always "Don't ignore what's around you." I'm not her equal, but what's around me doesn't seem to be middle/working class families and people gearing up to shoot their stimulus wad on new TV sets and sunglasses. I think growth will after a short spirt, disappoint. And inflation will hit like a tsunami. EU is not following our example, by the way. Most inflation will be imported. 1 Share link Report flag J John Harris SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago (Edited) An included modest understatement of the year:
"The flip side of this exceptionalism is a growing fear of higher inflation that could eventually reverse the dollar's fortunes, according to some investors."
J John Harris SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago (Edited) Duh --
Did anybody look at M2 ?? Austin Lowrie SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago The currency debasement will continue, until morale improves.... Like thumb_up 5 Share link Report flag I Ivaylo Ivanov SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago The article misses an important component of the equation. Various estimates suggest about half of all US cash in circulation, about $700-800 billion, circulates outside US borders. The trigger of a run on the dollar (a collapse, really) might be these holders, not foreign governments. The moment they realize they are holding increasingly worthless money they will try to dump it. Often ordinary people figure out the worthlessness of a currency much faster than governments.M1 (hot money) has increased by 70% in 12 months. The question is how fast people realize what that means.
Like thumb_up Share link Report flag Frank Mostek SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago If you drive car, own a home, require healthcare, have kids and eat - you have noticed plenty of inflation... L Lester Brown SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Makes you realize how slanted the CPI measurement is. 1.4% in 2020 - my a $$!! B Brett M SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago go through the exercise of reconstructing the CPI with research online. I did. It won't take you long to see that there is no component less than 2%. you will find edu costs +5% annully for years, medical costs +4% annually for years. 2 Share link Report flag B bruce strong SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago So the Federal debt as a percentage of GDP was about 30% in 2001 and it's now around 100%. Seems we are living way beyond our means and this can only lead to trouble in the coming years. The only question is will Congress do anything to stop the spending? Forget about worrying about inflation as it;s the least of our concerns. p 5 Share link Report flag Frank Mostek SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago I think it around 130% now...
T Ted Terry SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Apparently the Business Kids are surprised at the strength of the dollar but knowledgeable readers are not that surprised. The Dollar competes against the Euro and look at where the EU is. They are squabbling at each other over their ineffective response to the virus and their economies are struggling to break back to normal. I'm not sure where the Dollar is with respect to the Pound but the Brits too are still more virus bound than we are.
B bruce strong SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Japan's been running with a debt load of over 200% and the Yen has held up quite well. 2 Share link Report flag S Stephen S S Hyde SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago "The U.S. has a big advantage because the dollar is the world's most commonly used currency."This both understates and buries the lede on this seemingly granitic foundation of a fiscal/monetary system that has allowed us to get away with simultaneously lowering taxes, explosively expanding borrowings, creating the money to cover it, and then lending it to ourselves. (Eat your heart out, Argentina.)
Unfortunately, having the world's reserve currency is not a skyhook, as our British cousins learned with their once indomitable Sterling. Like thumb_up 23 Share link Report flag I Ivaylo Ivanov SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago If you do everything in your power to debase your currency foreigners eventually notice. It will take one big player noticing to bring down the house (of cards). In the 60-s and the gold backed dollar it was de Gaulle. It will be interesting to see who will jump the gun this time around. 3 Share link Report flag S Stephen S S Hyde SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago You obviously have an informed sense of history. The dollar's gold backing had been increasingly precarious but relatively stable until de Gaulle pulled the fatal trigger. David Van Wie SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago
Fears of rampant inflation have gone unfulfilled for years. The U.S. has had low and stable inflation for nearly three decades.Indeed. That point can't be emphasized enough. Said differently: for all of our research, economic theories and modeling, we still don't understand what causes inflation in our economy.
Is it caused by massive amounts of deficit spending? Nope. We've had lots of that and no serious inflation. Higher taxes? Lower taxes? No and no. What about high or low trade deficits? Sorry, try again. No correlations here.
I could go on, but you get my point. All of the things forecasters such as myself rely on to model inflation all sound like they should be predictive, but they aren't. Intuition creates cognitive bias, which in turn leads to bad trades that don't work.
We won't figure out what's going on until about 6-12 months after inflation restarts, unfortunately. Then, everyone will have known it all along! Just don't ask to see their old forecasts. Like thumb_up 15 Share link Report flag S Stephen S S Hyde SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Great comment, Mr. Van Wie. On top of your point (or underneath it) is the tendency for complex systems to fail not gradually, but suddenly and catastrophically. Think the Great Depression, the Soviet Union, the Great Credit Crunch, and Long Term Capital Management (talk about a moniker to challenge the gods!). I don't know when, how, or why, but I think our lifetimes will witness the opportunity to dig through the ruins of a once magnificent edifice built on sand. Like thumb_up 10 Share link Report flag B Brett M SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Yes but your whole basis is on the government orgs giving your inflation information [% year over year ] are telling the truth. They are not. Like thumb_up Share link Report flag J Domingo SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Everyone is worried about inflation except the Fed.
Which is why everyone is worried about inflation except the Fed. Like thumb_up 21 Share link Report flag I Ivaylo Ivanov SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago
Everyone is worried about inflation except the Fed.Which is why everyone should be very worried about inflation. The seeming carelessness of the Fed is the best indication inflation will get out of hand. Like thumb_up 3 Share link Report flag Stuart Young SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago With the government pumping trillions of dollars into the economy, anyone who chooses to ignore serious inflation problems is just fooling themselves. Like thumb_up 11 Share link Report flag A Anne T SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Not an investment expert here at all.But anyone with a mind knows where the Biden-Harris Administration is going and it's worse than route Obama-Biden took us on.
Seems Democrats still refuse to stop themselves from getting in the way of a budding recovery.
And learned nothing between 2009-2020. Like thumb_up 6 Share link Report flag P Paul Kaufmann SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Did you happen to notice the debt/gdp graph in the article? The slope in the past 4 years is so great that it is almost uncalculable...infinite. Like thumb_up Share link Report flag A Anne T SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Yes I did.
From 2008-1016 it soared from 40% to 76% where it pretty much stayed until the Covid stimulus of 2020. Like thumb_up Share link Report flag H H S Howell SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago We are already in an inflationary spiral. Don't rely on gov figures, just take a trip to the local hardware or grocery store. In the past the danger of big socialist government was Tax and Spend, today it is Print and Spend resulting in an enormous escalation of Debt (the largest in the world).China officially holds $1.1 trillion of our debt, but actually much more when counting Hong Kong, other regions of China. Should China sell (debt dump) their US bonds, it would have the destabilizing effect of lower bond prices and higher yields, devaluation of the dollar, higher cost of servicing our debt and a stock market crash. J Jeffrey Cunningham SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Seems like a very effective way to "tax" 401k money indirectly. thumb_up Share link Report flag P Peter Sherman SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago Bond investors are selling.
The Unholy Marriage of the Federal Reserve and Treasury allowing for the implementation of MMT ( Magic Money Tree ) probably create high inflation .Given the rotten value in bonds now ( negative real yield) and rising odds of higher inflation, expect to see more selling.
B Brett M SUBSCRIBER 1 week ago (Edited) I read a quote in an article one time"until the bond market rebels"
It means people become like me - refusing to own US treasuries nor USA bonds. The only exception is a 529 account I have which limits choices.
If people became like me relatively fast, investors sell bonds off, interest rates shoot through the roof as the USA gov loses control of their puppet show. Then the government defaults - and rather quickly, say within a year after.
I personally believe that USA government debt is worthless. I am a big fan of gold right now.
If China ever moved toward being a reformed country that didn't have George Orwell cameras in every alley, field and wooded grove, then the dollar would plummet. If there was another country that was not pathetic financially I would move my money there.
Mar 24, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The investment seeks to track the performance of the Bloomberg Barclays U.S. Treasury Inflation-Protected Securities (TIPS) 0-5 Year Index. The index is a market-capitalization-weighted index that includes all inflation-protected public obligations issued by the U.S. Treasury with remaining maturities of less than 5 years. The manager attempts to replicate the target index by investing all, or substantially all, of its assets in the securities that make up the index, holding each security in approximately the same proportion as its weighting in the index.
Vanguard Short-Term Inflation-Protected Securities Index Fund ETF Shares (VTIP) NasdaqGS - NasdaqGS Real Time Price. Currency in USD Add to watchlist
Mar 24, 2021 | www.reuters.com
WASHINGTON (Reuters) - Inflation will hit 2.5% this year and not fall much in 2022, which the Federal Reserve should welcome as a way to reaffirm the central bank's inflation target, St. Louis Federal Reserve Bank President James Bullard said on Tuesday.
" I am not seeing the inflation rate come down very much in 2022 ... maybe just slightly, " Bullard said in comments that placed him among the more aggressive Fed officials in terms of willingness to see inflation move higher this year and remain there without raising interest rates.
"Part of the goal is to take the increase in inflation that we have this year penciled in and allow some of that to move through to inflation expectations," and keep them cemented at the Fed's 2% inflation target.
Mar 24, 2021 | www.thebalance.com
Year Inflation Rate YOY Fed Funds Rate* Business Cycle (GDP Growth) Events Affecting Inflation ... ... ... ... ... 2000 3.4% 6.50% Expansion (4.1%) Tech bubble burst 2001 1.6% 1.75% March peak, Nov. trough (1.0%) Bush tax cut, 9/11 attacks 2002 2.4% 1.25% Expansion (1.7%) War on Terror 2003 1.9% 1.00% Expansion (2.9%) JGTRRA 2004 3.3% 2.25% Expansion (3.8%) 2005 3.4% 4.25% Expansion (3.5%) Katrina, Bankruptcy Act 2006 2.5% 5.25% Expansion (2.9%) Bernanke became Fed Chair 2007 4.1% 4.25% Dec peak (1.9%) Bank crisis 2008 0.1% 0.25% Contraction (-0.1%) Financial crisis 2009 2.7% 0.25% June trough (-2.5%) ARRA 2010 1.5% 0.25% Expansion (2.6%) ACA, Dodd-Frank Act 2011 3.0% 0.25% Expansion (1.6%) Debt ceiling crisis 2012 1.7% 0.25% Expansion (2.2%) 2013 1.5% 0.25% Expansion (1.8%) Government shutdown. Sequestration 2014 0.8% 0.25% Expansion (2.5%) QE ends 2015 0.7% 0.50% Expansion (3.1%) Deflation in oil and gas prices 2016 2.1% 0.75% Expansion (1.7%) 2017 2.1% 1.50% Expansion (2.3%) Core inflation rate 1.7% 2018 1.9% 2.50% Expansion (3.0%) Core rate 2.2% 2019 2.3% 1.75% Expansion (2.2%) Core rate 2.3% 2020 1.2% 0.25% Contraction (-2.4%) Forecast: Core rate 1.4%
Impact of COVID2021 1.8% 0.25% Expansion (4.2%) Forecast: Core rate is 1.8% 2022 1.9% 0.25% Expansion
(3.2%)Forecast: Core rate is 1.9% 2023 2.0% 0.25% Expansion (2.4%) Forecast: Core rate is 2.0%
Mar 24, 2021 | www.wsj.com
"The Fed has signaled that its dovish monetary policy is here indefinitely," Mr. Toomey said, noting a recent uptick in commodity prices and a brightening outlook for economic growth. "I worry that the Fed will be behind the curve when inflation picks up."
Mr. Powell, however, reiterated that he doesn't expect supply-chain bottlenecks or an expected surge in consumer demand later this year as the economy reopens to change in long-term price trends. The Fed generally doesn't alter its policies in response to temporary price pressures.
"In the near term, we do expect, as many forecasters do, that there will be some upward pressure on prices," Mr. Powell said. "Long term we think that the inflation dynamics that we've seen around the world for a quarter of a century are essentially intact. We've got a world that's short of demand with very low inflation and we think that those dynamics haven't gone away overnight and won't."
Sen. Richard Shelby (R., Ala.) pressed Ms. Yellen on her changing views on the risks of high and rising federal debt. Government red ink has swelled over the past year as economic activity stalled and Congress ramped up spending to combat the pandemic.
Mar 24, 2021 | www.wsj.com
John Gimmy Chesapeake City, Md
. Alan S. Blinder is correct that with the slack in the economy and high unemployment there is no risk of wage inflation (" There's No Need to Panic About a Little Inflation ," op-ed, March 16).
... ... ...
Lloyd B. Thomas, Ph.D. University of Missouri Columbia, Mo.
The Federal Reserve is capable of nipping any surge of inflation, but it has made clear it will be behind the curve as inflation rises. It has announced that it will not boost interest rates until it is confident we have reached full employment and until inflation substantially exceeds 2% annually for a considerable period.
Ed Kah, l Woodside , Calif,
The Fed's "foresight" in the 1970s sleepwalked us over 10 years into 14.5% inflation, 18.5% mortgage rates, 7.5% unemployment and a severe recession in 1980. The Fed's repression of interest rates has already inflated asset prices. It is now favoring spending that will move the national debt held by the public toward 150% of GDP if the Democrats keep passing multitrillion-dollar stimulus spending bills in a fast recovering economy.
The big risk comes when interest rates regress to higher historic averages that increase the cost of government debt. Even a very small rise in short-term rates shook the markets recently. The Fed should at the very least hedge this risk by lengthening the maturity of most government debt. They should also caution Congress about the sorry history of countries whose debt exceeds GDP.
Jacob R. Borden , P.E. Trine University, Angola, Ind.
Prof. Blinder uses macroeconomic anecdotes to argue that upward of 4% inflation is no big deal. But it is a big deal when you recognize that inflation is a tax on the accumulation of wealth. Sen. Elizabeth Warren must be smiling.
Even worse, inflation is a regressive tax on wealth. The professional class is already shifting assets to protect against inflationary headwinds. Mary B. Flyover, on the other hand, has few such assets and instead spends relatively more of her money on fuel and groceries, the very elements missing from Mr. Blinder's preferred measure of inflation.
Every year, inflation saps the spending power of a dollar earned, putting future savings further out of reach for people already being left behind. What little savings is available is largely in checking and savings accounts that don't even keep up with current inflation, let alone just a little more. Then add the compounding impact of inflated incomes on inflated tax bills. Once 4% inflation is baked in, Ms. Flyover's tax bill will be forever higher, while her purchasing power will trend ever lower.
Thomas Porth, Hockessin, Del.
The facts that Prof. Blinder doesn't cite are what worry me. When I studied economics at Princeton in 1981 (using Prof. Blinder's textbook), the yield on the 10-year Treasury stood at 14% as of the end of December, while the CPI-U inflation rate stood at 8.9%. The real risk-free rate of return was therefore a positive 5.1% or so. In contrast, today the CPI-U stands at 1.7% (March 10), while the yield on the 10-year Treasury stands at 1.71% (March 18), for a real risk-free rate of return of what is effectively zero.
Even relying on current measures of inflation, the real rate of return has dropped from positive 5.1% in 1981 to zero or, let's be serious, less than zero today (when I am retired). Sorry, Prof. Blinder, but I'm starting to panic.
Copyright ©2020 Dow Jones & Company, Inc. All Rights Reserved. 87990cbe856818d5eddac44c7b1cdeb8
Appeared in the March 23, 2021, print edition.
Mar 24, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
Mar 13, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
Last Updated: March 20,2021 at 12:33 p.m. ET
First Published: March 13,2021 at 7:08 a.m. ETYou'd have to hold U.S. Treasury bonds for 57 years to not lose to inflation
Mar 20, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
...The economics of trading from stocks and real estate to interest rates would be turned upside down if projections of runaway prices are to be believed.
Yet there are clear divisions. Goldman Sachs Group Inc. says commodities have proven their mettle over a century while JPMorgan Asset Management is skeptical -- preferring to hide in alternative assets like infrastructure.
Pimco, meanwhile, warns the market's inflation obsession is misplaced with central banks potentially still set to undershoot targets over the next 18 months.
... There will be rotation into real-economy assets such as small caps, financials and energy stocks instead of rates and credit, and that will generate a lot of volatility.
... TIPS (only if bought directly from the treasury) offer reasonable insurance for an inflation overshoot. Commodities and assets linked to real estate should also benefit in an environment of rising inflation.
Mar 20, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
The bond vigilantes appear to have returned, punishing not only the Treasury market but also exacting a toll on the Nasdaq Composite's highfliers. What's different this time is that the bond vigilantes are fighting the Fed, to mix two market aphorisms. The Federal Reserve just reiterated its intention to maintain its ultra-accommodative policy until it sees what it deems as maximum employment and inflation steadily above 2%.
Mar 18, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
As 10-year TSY yields briefly touched 1.75% this morning in the wake of Wednesday's FOMC, an overnight note from Zoltan Pozsar predicting the end of SLR relief , and a report by the Nikkei noting that the BOJ would allow long-term interest rates to move in a slightly larger range of about 0.25%, versus 0.2% now...
Bank of America warned that ... 10-year yields above that level could become a headwind for the equity complex. As BofA strategist Savita Subramanian wrote "history suggests that 1.75% on the 10-yr (the house forecast and ~25bp above current levels) is the tipping point at which asset allocators begin to shift back to bonds" and thus sell stocks in the next wave of aggressive liquidations.
Why 1.75%? Because that yield on the 10Y is decisively above the S&P's dividend yield, and where according to BofA "there is an alternative to stocks", or TIAA.
Separately, in its fund manager survey, Bank of America found that while few believed that rates at 1.5% would cause an equity correction (which they did as Nomura originally predicted one month ago ), the move from 1.5% to 2% is critical as 43% of investors now think 2% is the level of reckoning in the 10-year Treasury that will cause a 10% correction in stocks .
Ajax_USB_Port_Repair_Service_ 7 hours ago
paid_attention 4 hours ago (Edited)2.0 is the new 1.75
Globalistsaretrash 7 hours ago remove linkI've noticed that there hasn't been any down days over 2% in months...
Boxed Merlot 7 hours agoJust last week an article said 1.54% would trigger Armageddon.
Seasmoke 7 hours ago...last week...1.54% would trigger Armageddon...
I know this is getting old, but being cursed with a "boomer memory", I still remember when interest only real estate purchases at 1% of purchase price per month to service one's "note" was considered a steal. Home loans at 16-18% were common and t-bills were paying a mere 10-12% a year.
What's more, me and mine are still here after all those years, albeit a bit longer in the tooth, but that's life.
I know, I know, this time is different.
Globalistsaretrash 7 hours agoSo no Ponzi Collapse at 1.65 ?? Because I read that somewhere last week.
radical-extremist 7 hours ago (Edited) remove linkMe too.
nope-1004 7 hours ago remove linkOMG! I can't decide whether I want a 1.75% yield in treasuries or SPY dividends....just so I can keep pace with 2.2% inflation of the DXY...of my $1400 stimmie.
mtl4 7 hours ago (Edited) remove link1.75.... lmao. The rigged casino is THAT weak?
drjd 6 hours agoEveryone was a genius back in the Dot Com era too.......works until it doesn't.
I woke up 7 hours agoBecause life is all about the pursuit of profits?
gcjohns1971 6 hours agoHow much more fake money needs to be printed to cover the debt when yields go to 1.75
itstippy 7 hours agoWhen everyone is a finacialized zombie, a rotation from stocks bankrupts everyone. If corporates are deprived of their financial casino takes, then you have until quarterlies to see that as a GDP bloodbath.
Then the only place to go will be commodities. The inflation the Fed has been searching for lives there. PPI will go wild, up double and some times triple digits in a matter of days, spooking everyone.
JZimmerman901 7 hours agoDoes the Fed have some sort of tool in their toolbox they could use to suppress market yields on the 10 year if needed?
Chutney ferret Harris 7 hours agoThey only have one "tool" and that's to print money. And sure, if they print money to buy 10 years, that would suppress yields.
ReadyForHillary 6 hours agoCorrection to the article - "Then again, Goldman has been wrong about virtually everything it has said publicly in recent years so take the bank's optimism with a metric ton of salt."
We know privately Goldman knows what is going on and happily collecting its vig from the taxpayers.
silverredux 7 hours agoWhy would anyone assume that what GS states publicly is their true opinion?
MrNoItAll 7 hours agoGoldman has been correct because they've invested in the other side of the argument every time
Goldman up 152% in 12 months.
Rising rates keep metals in check too. Just a bonus
QE4MeASAP 7 hours agoGoldman Sach bank's optimism is fabricated hope-filled messaging to the "investors" their mega-bonuses are dependent on.
Everybody All American 7 hours ago remove linkMaybe we'll get to see if "Not in my Lifetime" Bernanke was correct.
incalescent 7 hours agoWe are now over the 100% debt to GDP ratio barrier and if rates rise from here to any even small degree it is game, set, match. Since the market top of the 10yr in price there has been a 7% loss for those who bought as it stands right now. We are talking some big losses. Remember, no one is buying this stuff for the yield.
Calvinharrison 1 hour agoWhile I like to disagree with Goldman on principle. I think there is a better argument than the dividend yield of S&P500 stocks to account for the upcoming shift. The 2% and 3% inflections points have more weight with the general trends. This 1.5% number feels like an exercise in finding a reason to pick the number, not a sharp pin to prick the bubble.
Bubble though, it is, and we live in cactus times.
AUD 3 hours agoI put all my pension into government bond funds.. it will drop the least compared to stocks. And I could enter stocks again later. 30% up on the year is ridiculous and there are some funds that went up close to 50%.
Ozarkian 7 hours agoI think it's the volatility of the move which concerns the Fed. If interest rate spreads stay tight as rates move higher, the casino can stay afloat. If rates move to fast, things get out of control.
Does this mean you can't have your cake and eat it too?
Mar 15, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
A worry for retirees: Inflation forecasts hit 8-year high Brett Arends Mon, March 15, 2021, 10:01 AM
Nobody suffers more from high inflation than retirees. Back in the 1970s, it was those in retirement living on fixed income that got hit the hardest as prices rose year after year. The investment returns from their bonds and cash fell way behind.
Mar 14, 2021 | www.barrons.com
Inflation may be on many investors' minds, but it has yet to show up in the numbers. Moreover, a close reading of the data suggests that inflation won't be a problem for some time, if ever.
The latest reading of the consumer price index shows that Americans' cost of living was only 1.7% higher in February 2021 than a year earlier. That's the fastest inflation reading since the pandemic began, but still substantially slower than the pre-pandemic average. Exclude volatile food and energy prices, and inflation is running at 1.3%...
Mar 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Submitted by Joseph Carson, former chief economist of AllianceBernstein
The understatement of housing inflation in the consumer price index has reached a new milestone. As reported, the gap between the actual change in house prices and owners' rent, published by the Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS), exceeds the "bubble" levels.
In February, BLS reported owner's rent increased 2% over the last 12 months. House price inflation, as reported by the Federal Housing Finance Agency (FHFA), increased 11.4%. That gap over 900 basis points exceeds the 800 basis point gap recorded during the housing bubble peak.
The consumer price index was created and designed to measure prices paid for purchases of specific goods and services by consumers. The CPI was often referred to as a buyers' index since it only measured prices "paid" by consumers.
The CPI has lost that designation. It is no longer measures actual prices. For the past two decades, BLS imputes the owners' rent series, using data from the rental market, no longer using price data from the larger single-family market.
Imputing prices for the cost of housing services make the CPI a hybrid index or a cross between a price index and a cost of living index. A hybrid index is not appropriate as a gauge to ascertain price stability, especially when the hypothetical measure of owner's rent accounts for 30% of the core CPI.
The CPI missed the price "bubble" of the mid-2000s, and the economic and financial fallout was historic. History sometimes repeats itself in economics and finance. Policymakers forewarned.
Mar 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
USAllDay 3 hours ago
Greed is King 1 hour ago remove linkThe FED has been inflating a cheap money bubble for 40 years. The response to every recession is to cut rates. But the Fed never returns rates to pre-recession levels so the economy ultimately enters one recession after the next at lower and lower rates. Now at near zero, the gig is up. Dropping rates by nearly 50 basis points per year for four decades has created the mother of all bubbles.
Utopia Planitia 2 hours agoUSA, the new Roman Empire and just like the old Roman Empire was, the scourge of the planet.
A Sovereign debt ridden nation, that only survives due to its enormous military that enables the USA to pillage the resources of other countries via a foreign policy of threat, intimidation, invasion and occupation; exactly the same tactics used by the original Roman Empire.
Unfortunately for the USA, the MIC and American armed forces, are the biggest consumer of all of the income and resources obtained from pillaging and debt, they are a greedy insatiable monster that continues to grow and demands more and more to be fed.
We`re now in the ludicrous, unsustainable and unacceptable situation of, all of the countries who are having their resources stolen by the USA, and all of the American tax payers who are underwriting the debt incurred by the USA are in fact paying for the MIC and armed forces to repress them.
Here`s a radical idea; why not stop borrowing to feed the MIC monster, and try treating the rest of planet Earth with respect and cooperation.
Make peace, not war.
It's a positive feedback loop...
Mar 14, 2021 | angrybearblog.com
CPI Rose 0.4% in February on Higher Prices for Energy and Medical Services
run75441 | March 10, 2021 9:59 pm
US ECONOMICSCommenter R.J.S. Discuses CPI Rising led by Food, Energy, and Medical
The consumer price index rose 0.4% in February , as higher prices for fuel, groceries, utilities, and medical services were only partly offset by lower prices for clothing, used vehicles, and airline fares the Consumer Price Index Summary from the Bureau of Labor Statistics indicated that seasonally adjusted prices averaged 0.4% higher in February, after rising by 0.3% in January, 0.2% in December, 0.2% in November, 0.1% in October, 0.2% in September, 0.4% in August, by 0.5% in July and by 0.5% in June, after falling by 0.1% in May, falling by 0.7% in April and by 0.3% in March, but after rising by 0.1% in February of last year .the unadjusted CPI-U index, which was set with prices of the 1982 to 1984 period equal to 100, rose from 261.582 in January to 263.014 in February , which left it statistically 1.6762% higher than the 258.678 reading of February of last year, which is reported as a 1.7% year over year increase, up from the 1.4% year over year increase reported a month ago .with higher prices for energy and foods both factors in the overall index increase, seasonally adjusted core prices, which exclude food and energy, were up just 0.1% for the month, as the unadjusted core price index rose from 269.755 to 270.696, which left the core index 1.2826% ahead of its year ago reading of 267.268, which is reported as a 1.3% year over year increase, down from the 1.4% year over year core price increase that was reported for January and the 1.6% the year over year core price increase that was reported for December
The volatile seasonally adjusted energy price index rose 3.9% in February , after rising by 3.5% in January, 2.6% in December, 0.7% in November, 0.6% in October, 1.4% in September, 0.9% in August, 2.1% in July, and by 4.4% in June, but after falling by 2.3% in May, by 9.5% in April, 5.8% in March, and by 2.5% last February, and hence is only 2.4% higher than in February a year ago the price index for energy commodities was 6.6% higher in February, while the index for energy services was 0.9% higher, after falling 0.3% in January .the energy commodity index was up 6.6% on a 6.4% increase in the price of gasoline and a 9.9% increase in the index for fuel oil, while prices for other energy commodities, including propane, kerosene, and firewood, were on average 7.3% higher within energy services, the price index for utility gas service rose 1.6% after falling 0.4% in January and is now 6.7% higher than it was a year ago, while the electricity price index rose 0.7% after falling 0.2% in January .energy commodities are now averaging 1.6% higher than their year ago levels, with gasoline price averaging 1.5% higher than they were a year ago, while the energy services price index is now up 3.2% from last February, as electricity prices are also 2.3% higher than a year ago
The seasonally adjusted food price index rose 0.2% in February, after rising by 0.1% in January and 0.3% in December, after being unchanged in November, rising 0.2% in October, rising 0.1% in August and in September, after falling 0.3% in July, rising 0.5% in June, 0.7% in May, 1.4% in April, 0.3% in March, and by 0.3% last February, as the price index for food purchased for use at home was 0.3% higher in January, after falling 0.1% in January, while the index for food bought to eat away from home was 0.1% higher, as average prices at fast food outlets rose 0.4% and prices at full service restaurants rose 0.3%, while food prices at employee sites and schools averaged 12.2% lower notably, the price index for food at elementary and secondary schools was down 13.7% and is now down 32.5% from a year ago
Mar 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Goldman's Clients Are Asking Is There Are Any Cheap Stocks Left - ZeroHedge
Yet anyone hoping for a quick and painless reprieve from surging rates will be disappointed. In his latest Weekly Kickstart, Goldman's David Kostin writes that the bank's economists expect that rates will continue to rise in coming months and forecast 11% real US GDP growth in 2Q with core PCE inflation rising to 2.3% "suggesting that investors will have to continually grapple with the anxiety about economic overheating and Fed tightening that has gripped markets in recent weeks." Goldman also expects the 10-year yield will rise to 1.8% by mid-year and 1.9% by year-end. At the rate it is going, it may get there next week.
Mar 14, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
HARLEY BASSMAN: Well, that's a good question. I would say that this notion that rates are exploding higher and bad things are happening, it's not quite the case. I would say that when 10-years were at 0.75, that was the wrong price. All we're doing now is going to the right price as opposed to where we were before , which is the wrong price. I would push back at you. We've seen a significant curve steepening. I'm quite certain we're going to talk about that today quite a bit.
... ... ...
The banking system, maybe there's bad guys in there and certainly there were villains 10 years ago who should have gone to jail, and didn't, but the banking system is the plumbing of our financial economy, and we need to maintain it. Therefore steeper curve helps that plumbing system, so the government can do it. The Fed and fiscal policy can be more efficient.
... ... ...
HARLEY BASSMAN: Circling back to our first two sentences here, it's never different this time. That's my mantra. It's never different this time. I can't explain why or how but I just do not think that we've reinvented human tragedy. Hubris, greed, ego. We wrote about it, the Greeks wrote about it, Shakespeare wrote about it. It just hasn't changed, and it's this idea that we've invented a new paradigm I just don't believe it. It's a different song, but it's still music and I think that we'll find some way to go and cause trouble, which is why I believe in inflation ultimately.
Is it next year? No. Is it in 20 years? I don't know. What I do think, it's going to happen in two to four years when the demographic bubble rolls over. We could do that later on. I think we're going to get it because I don't think you could print the coin of the realm at a faster pace than the overall growth of the economy without inflation at some point. Now, could it take 20 years? Why not? It took 400 years for the Roman Empire collapsed, so in the grand scheme of things, maybe not.
This policy of money printing is not going to end well. That doesn't mean it was a bad public policy, by the way, because having the economy totally collapse either in 2009 or last year is certainly a bad idea, so maybe deferring the pain or spreading the pain out. I think that inflation is the ultimate solution. Because inflation is a beautiful tax. It taxes, everybody. It taxes them silently, and the politicians dumped a vote on it. As a tax, everyone -- well, I wasn't happy, but it's the easiest one to live with in a democracy.
ebworthen 1 hour ago remove link
YuriTheClown 1 hour ago" They purchase a Rembrandt for a sandwich and our souls for a glass of whisky. Krupp and Stinnes get rid of their debts, we of our savings. The profiteers dance in the palace hotels." -- Klaus Mann, 1923; Weimar, Germany.
The more things change, the more they stay the same.
Creamaster 1 hour agoAnd the Weimar Republic was run by who? Very similar make up to that of the Bolsheviks.
85% non members of the Royal Church of Scotland.
Son of Loki 1 hour ago (Edited)Covid timing was sure convenient for a lot of things to occur
You decide, was it naturally occurring, or released intentionally?
Son of Loki 1 hour ago (Edited)The 10-years will hit 2% soon, and 3% by end of year.
Given the sad state of the economy and leadership (Yellen, Bribem, etc), no way of stopping it.
Jalmar Shockt 14 minutes agoThe 10-years will hit 2% soon, and 3% by end of year.
Given the sad state of the economy and leadership (Yellen, Bribem, etc), no way of stopping it.
aeslong 48 minutes ago (Edited) remove linkIt doesn't work that way and it's not about inflation the way one usually thinks of it.
Hyperinflation is not the same as the ultimate inflation of the money supply. It is the ultimate depreciation of the currency unit. The two concepts are far from being the same. When the populace eventually figures out what's going on the bonds, notes, bills, and other obligations of the United States government that are all irredeemable will be repudiated.
Ted Baker 1 hour ago"I would say that when 10-years were at 0.75, that was the wrong priceI would say that when 10-years were at 0.75, that was the wrong price. All we're doing now is going to the right price as opposed to where we were before , ....."
yea, only bond was mispriced, right? other assets, including public debts don't have to be priced to where they were before.
Bank_sters 1 hour ago (Edited)more market manipulation...
overbet 1 hour agoCentral banksters print money and give most to the wealthy and connected, foreign govts, the war machine and then send a few crumbs to the serfs. Meanwhile destroy their currency, savings and future.
Yields? what a joke. CPI- pure fiction.
Finance so easy a psychopathic child can do it.
YuriTheClown 1 hour ago (Edited)Wall Street adage:
The most dangerous words on Wall Street are, this time its different.
Ron_Paul_Was_Right 46 minutes ago remove linkBassman's outlook for rates and markets. Unsurprisingly, he sees more volatility, and higher convexity, ahead.
I've tried searching for the definition of "convexity" in this context and had no luck. Anyone care to enlighten?
Oops. I guess the internet had some additions since then. Convexity
vote_libertarian_party 1 hour ago remove link"A steeper curve helps the baking system."
Did you mean like, a more steeply curved cookie sheet? To help the baking of brownies? I don't follow.
Something will trigger the stock and bond bubble to pop...
Mar 12, 2021 | www.wsj.com
The consumer-price index rose 0.4% in February from the prior month, as the pace of the economic recovery increased following a winter lull, buoyed by higher gasoline and energy costs.
Mar 12, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
A bond market selloff is calling the tune across financial markets. Equilibrium is unlikely to return until the yield on the benchmark 10-year U.S. Treasury note hits 2%, a well-known macro strategist argued Friday.
"There will be no peace until U.S. 10s reach 2%," said Kit Juckes, global macro strategist at Société Générale, in a note.
... ... ...
"The pattern seems clear enough: The equity market is seeing a sector rotation but not a correction; the bond market is seeking a new equilibrium in the light of a vastly improved economic outlook in both the U.S. and elsewhere; some policy makers are pushing back against the bond moves, with little success," Juckes wrote.
As yields rise, the dollar rallies, but when yields settle at a new level, the dollar drops back. The pattern probably goes on until bonds find an equilibrium, unlikely before 10-year note yields have a 2-handle, judging by taper tantrums and past cycles," he said.
Mar 11, 2021 | www.marketwatch.com
... ... ...
"2020 marked the secular low point for inflation and interest rates," warned Michael Hartnett, chief investment strategist for Bofa Global Research, in a Thursday note. "The 40-year bull market in bonds is over."
His cautionary words come as investors contend with the sudden surge in long-term Treasury yields this year which has surprised even the bond bears.
The 10-year note yield TMUBMUSD10Y,
1.540% was at 1.532% on Thursday, over 60 basis points from where it traded at the beginning of the year.That rise has, in turn, heightened concerns around stretched valuations in equities, briefly sending the Nasdaq Composite COMP,
+2.52% into correction territory this week, defined as a 10% fall from its intraday peak. Stocks have recently found their footing again, with the S&P 500 SPX,+1.04% up nearly 3% this week.Investors throughout the multidecade long bull market in bonds have sometimes bet against a continued slide in long-term Treasury yields, but as inflation has struggled to break above the Federal Reserve's 2% target for any sustained stretch, forecasts for higher yields have often proved a losing proposition.
Still, Hartnett suggested any complacency is dangerous as undercurrents in the economy and policymaking pointed towards a tidal wave of inflationary pressures that could overwhelm buyers of Treasurys.
Mar 10, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Dishonest Inflation Reporting
The blunt answer is that the Fed, in sync with the fiction writers at the Bureau of Labor Statistics (BLS), reports consumer inflation as honestly as Al Capone reported taxable income.
In short: The Fed has been lying about (i.e. downplaying) inflation for years.
As we've shown in many prior reports, the Consumer Price Index (CPI) scale used by the BLS to measure U.S. consumer price inflation is an open charade, allowing the BLS, and hence the Fed, to basically "report" inflation however they see fit -- at least for now.
If, for example, the weighting methodologies hitherto used by the Fed to measure CPI inflation in the 1980's were used today, then US, CPI-measured inflation would be closer to 10% not the reported 2%.
Concerned about by rising consumer costs, the Fed simply tweaked its CPI scale for measuring the same, effectively downplaying rising costs like a fat-camp scale which downplayed the significance of say beer, chocolate or pizza.
In short, the Fed didn't like the old CPI scale for measuring inflation, and so they simply replaced it with one in which 2+2 =2.
But why all the mathematical gymnastics and creative writing at the current BLS and Fed?
What explains the ongoing double-speak wherein the Fed wishes to target higher inflation yet simultaneously and deliberately mis-reports it at far lower levels?
Necessity: The Mother of Invention .The Fed, in deep need of keeping its IOU-driven (i.e debt-driven) façade of "recovery" in motion, has no choice but to invent a respectably controlled (i.e. LOW) CPI inflation rate in order to make US Treasury bonds look even moderately attractive to others.
After all, the US lives on those IOU's. They need to look pretty.
If, however, the more honest and much higher 10% inflation rate were honestly reported on an honest CPI scale, the inflation-adjusted yield on the US 10-Year Treasury would be negative 8%–which hardly makes it a pretty bond for the world to either admire or buy.
That's a problem for Uncle Sam.
And so the Fed invents a CPI inflation number that is less embarrassing than reality. It's just that simple.
By the way, if real yields on the US 10-Year were honestly reported at -8%, gold would be ripping to the moon right now (it skyrocketed in the 1970's when real yields were -4%).
This is because gold rises fastest the faster real yields go negative .
We all know, however, that the Fed (and the bullion banks it serves) are terrified of rising gold prices, as a rising gold price confirms the absolute failure of their monetary policies and the open, and ongoing, debasement of the US Dollar.
This further explains why the world's central and bullion banks openly manipulate the paper gold price in the COMEX markets on a daily basis.
Furthermore, given that the only thing that seems to be "healthy" in the US today is the biggest stock and bond market bubble in its history, the Fed wants to keep that bubble growing rather than naturally popping.
And toward this end, the Fed may be desperate, dishonest and delusional, but they aren't completely stupid.
They know, for example, that for the last 140 years, ALL (and I mean ALL) of the stock market's gains came during disinflationary periods, not inflationary periods -- which is all the more reason for the Fed to lie about inflation and keep the bubble rising.
So, please don't fall for Powell's double-speak that he's more concerned about focusing on employment than inflation.
The unspoken truth is that Powell (as well as Yellen, Bernanke et al) have been absolutely obsessed with inflation for years. They simply mis-report it (i.e. lie), as the dollar's purchasing power continues its slow fall toward the floor of history.
Having Your Cake and Eating it Too.What the Fed has been doing ever since Greenspan (the veritable "Patient Zero" of the current global $280T debt disaster) is very clever yet extremely toxic, as well as openly duplicitous.
Specifically, the Fed now prints over $120B per month (to buy $80B in unwanted Treasury bonds and another $40B in unwanted, toxic MBS paper) with no apparent inflationary effect (despite the fact that inflation is defined by money supply) beyond its 2% "allowance."
Such extreme money creation openly dilutes the USD to inflate away US debt with increasingly diluted dollars, now a desperate as well as deliberate Fed policy.
But by simultaneously and dishonestly mis-reporting CPI inflation as they dilute the dollar, the Fed can inflate away US debt without having to make the inflation-adjusted yields on Treasury bonds appear too embarrassingly ugly (i.e. grotesquely negative ) for circulation and consumption.
Such open fraud, of course, allows the Fed to have its cake (debased currencies to inflate away debt) and eat it too (by under-reporting the otherwise disastrous CPI inflationary consequences of such a desperate policy.)
In short, by putting lipstick on the pig of what would otherwise by highly negative real yields on an openly bogus Treasury bonds if the CPI inflation rate were accurately reported, the Fed can continue to live on more debt, more IOU's and more dishonesty.
Such veiled inflationary dishonesty allows the U.S. to effectively extend and pretend as the US credit market marches forward like a veritable Frankenstein -- that is dead, yet still marching, arms outstretched and moaning like a beast.
QuiteShocking 4 hours ago
PodissNM PREMIUM 3 hours ago
Gas was around $2 a gallon on Election Day (Nov 3rd 2020)... and now over $2.70 a gallon for a 35% increase and we're just getting started... So much for the 2% fantasy...
philipat 3 hours ago (Edited)
The price of practically everything has doubled in the past 20 years. Other than a few outliers like TVs, which have seemingly never been cheaper.
Now they're reducing package quantities in consumer staples to obfuscate further price increases.
buzzsaw99 4 hours ago (Edited) remove link
It's all a confidence game. The Fed CANNOT let rates rise (USG can't afford to pay higher rates on interest on the ever increasing debt, let alone paying down principal - that can never happen) but on the other hand it needs inflation to inflate away some of the debt. And it cannot allow Equity markets to crash (they have become the surrogate US economy) so as the debt grows the equity markets must continue to grow. Just a smallish sustained drop would cripple GDP.
Which means the USD should collapse.
BUT it's like keeping all the plates spinning together. All three are manipulated. EVERYTHING is manipulated, there are NO free markets. The ESF and Central Banks (Why does the Fed need trading floors?) intervene daily in everything. And so far they are getting away with it.
Which brings us back to confidence......
thezone 3 hours ago
The principal value of TIPS rises as inflation rises. Inflation is the pace at which prices increase throughout the U.S. economy, as measured by the Consumer Price Index (CPI)...
real yields all negative baybee, except the 30y is a whopping +0.010%
Let it Go 3 hours ago
NBL = Nothing But Lies.
Give Me Some Truth 43 minutes ago
The purpose of the consumer price index (CPI) is to reflect just how much inflation is eating into both our incomes and our savings. Currently, the government understates inflation by using a formula based on the concept of a "constant level of satisfaction" that evolved during the first half of the 20th century in academia. More on this subject in the article below.
https://The CPI Understates Inflation Skewing Our Expectations.html
MrBoompi 1 hour ago remove link
There are many reasons the stock market HAS to keep rising. One of the main ones is that all of the city and state pension funds are heavily invested in the stock market. If the stock market wasn't rising, tax-payers would have to pick up a greater share of pensions. Simply put, this can't happen.
Give Me Some Truth 1 hour ago remove link
Come on. The only jobs Fed employees care about are their own jobs. They supervised the dismantling of our manufacturing jobs, without lifting a finger, since 1971. They are not screaming to end the lockdowns either.
Just like minimum wage, Seniors have been denied the true COL increases, which are the law, for Social Security. These payments should at least be double what they are today.
They are globalists and as such could care less about common folk. A must-have skill if you want to be Fed Chair is the ability to lie. This skill will be needed much more than your business, law, and accounting degrees.
Thanks to the author for pointing out the elephant in the room that "officials" and the mainstream media are not allowed to discuss. Namely (from this article):
"We all know, however, t hat the Fed (and the bullion banks it serves) are terrified of rising gold prices, as a rising gold price confirms the absolute failure of their monetary policies and the open, and ongoing, debasement of the US Dollar.
This further explains why the world's central and bullion banks openly manipulate the paper gold price in the COMEX markets on a daily basis."
In short, EVERYTHING the "Powers that Be" do is designed to keep gold and silver prices contained, which thus protects the all-important fiat printing press.
Inflation numbers are rigged to help achieve this result and so too are precious metal markets rigged.
I'd also add that the "unemployment" numbers are equally bogus. So too are many of the COVID numbers and metrics.
If numbers can be rigged - if definitions can be changed - to support a specious narrative, they will be ... All for the same purpose.
Mar 07, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
PIMIX 11.98 -0.02 -0.17% - PIMCO Income Fund Institutional Class - Yahoo Finance
Top 10 Holdings AS OF 12/31/2020; 47.15% of Total Portfolio
10 Year Treasury Note Future Mar 211 2.37% Federal National Mortgage Association 2.5% 03/11/2051 6.76% Federal National Mortgage Association 2.5% 02/11/2051 5.93% Federal National Mortgage Association 2% 03/11/2051 5.41% Pimco Fds 5.38% Federal National Mortgage Association 3% 2.97% FTSE Bursa Malaysia KLCI Future Mar 21 2.60% Federal National Mortgage Association 2% 02/11/2051 2.18% CSMC TRUST 3.32183% 1.86% Fin Fut Us Ultra 30yr Cbt 03/22/21 1.69% 7706 holdings as of 12/31/2020
Mar 07, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
In one of his latest Flows and Liquidity reports, JPM quant Nick Panigirtzoglou writes that as we approach quarter-end, the equity rebalancing flow question is resurfacing in client conversations. As we notes, "the equity rally and the bond sell-off during the current quarter is naturally creating a pending rebalancing flow for multi-asset investors away from equities into bonds for pension funds and balanced mutual funds. How much of equity/bond rebalancing flow should we expect into current quarter-end?"
To answer this question, the Greek strategist applies a familiar framework and looks at the four key multi-asset investors that have either fixed allocation targets or tend to exhibit strong mean reversion in their asset allocation. These are balanced mutual funds, such as 60:40 funds, US defined benefit pension plans, Norges Bank, i.e. the Norwegian oil fund, and the Japanese government pension plan, GPIF.
For those curious about the details, below is a more detailed summary of the considerations behind the four key investor classes ahead of month and quarter-end.
1. Balanced mutual funds including 60:40 funds , a close to $7.5tr AUM universe globally, tend to rebalance over 1-2 months or so. The lesson from last Nov/Dec is that balanced mutual funds exhibit flexibility and they do not necessarily rebalance every single month. During the previous quarter, they appear to have postponed rebalancing for Nov-end or Dec-end and to have waited until January to de-risk/rebalance. JPM believes that funds de-risked in January, as a result of the tumble in balanced MFs equity beta...
.. and since it would have been too soon to rebalance again in February, the quant believes that they have likely postponed any pending rebalancing to March. Assuming they were fully rebalanced at the end of January, which is a reasonable hypothesis given the reduction in their betas in January and by taking into account the performance of global equities and bonds since then, JPMorgan estimates around $107bn of equity selling by balanced mutual funds globally into the end of March in order to revert to their 60:40 target allocation.
lay_arrow
HankMFRearden PREMIUM 18 hours ago
BandGap 1 hour ago
Reconcile this with previous post about off the hook equity inflows. Would not passive mostly be rebalancing by targeted direction of new flows vs. selling of existing positions, particulalry in tech which has declined?
It's all good.
Janet weighs in.
https://finance.yahoo.com/news/yellen-says-higher-treasury-yields-015420252.html
The lies get bigger and bigger. We, the peons, are expected to believe the unbelieveable.
Mar 07, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
Americans aren't spending but saving, by paying down debt at an enormous rate, the nightmare of Keynesians the world over.
They are unleashing trillions in new spending but cutting back, in the stimulus bill, support for actual Americans whose lives they've ruined with lockdowns and public health terrorism.
They have held interest rates at or below zero for so long that when the market makes the slightest move to go somewhere else, it precipitates massive market dislocation in fundamental markets.
We're no longer talking about the sub-prime mortgage market or Turkish corporate debt loads . We're talking about massive short bets against the U.S. 10 year Treasury Note.
Eventually reality always reasserts itself. The central banks are running out of maneuvering space before he entire system collapses. Maybe that's what they want.
Maybe they think they can maintain their narrative of competence long enough to shift the blame to incompetent governments who have incurred the wrath of their people through inhuman COVID-19 lockdowns and endless psychological torture.
I don't know at this point. But I can tell you that debt first extends and then destroys all illusions about who is and who isn't truly solvent.
And over the past few weeks it's clear there are an increasing number of people who command real amounts of money who don't buy the narratives the central banks are selling.
* * *
play_arrow
Hickory Dickory Dock 21 hours ago
conraddobler 21 hours ago (Edited)Inflation expectations are rising because of fiscal and monetary stimulus and the "re-opening" of the economy.
Those rising inflation expectations cause nominal interest rates to rise.
If nominal interest rates rise more than inflation rises, real interest rates rise.
Rising real interest rates cause stocks, bonds and gold/silver to fall.
Falling 'markets' cause the Fed to step in and save the day by capping nominal interest rates.
Capped nominal interest rates cause real rates of interest to fall (assuming no change in inflation rates).
Falling real rates of interest mean higher gold and silver prices.
Hickory Dickory Dock 21 hours agoInterest rates were near 15% in 1979, what did gold and silver do back then?
BarneyFife714 20 hours agoIncorrect. Real interest rates were below zero in 1979-1980.
Hickory Dickory Dock 17 hours agoReal rates not interest rates.
hisnamewas 7 hours agoReal rates are interest rates (just not nominal interest rates).
Hickory Dickory Dock 17 hours agoI assume by "real" you mean an imaginary number called the "inflation" which they can set arbitrarily low by choosing what is included in the calculation.
George Bayou 21 hours ago remove linkSince real interest rates are calculated as being equal to nominal interest rates minus the rate of inflation, understating inflation (whether intentionally or simply through mis-measurement) will have the effect of overstating real interest rates, not understating them. E.g., if the nominal interest rate is 10% and the inflation rate is 7%, the real interest rate is 3%. However, if the inflation rate is understated in this example as being 4% instead of 7%, the real interest rate (10% nominal interest rate minus 4% inflation rate) will appear as 6% rather than 3% (thus overstating the real inflation rate).
I do believe that the inflation data on Shadowstats is more accurate than the CPI or other government-supplied figures, which are heavily gamed.
I believe it's only a matter of time before yield curve control will be implemented. Keep in mind it may not be called that, but the net effect will be to suppress longer term interest rates. Assuming the policy is effective at doing that, you can expect gold and silver to resume their bull runs, virtually overnight.
itstippy 22 hours ago remove linkIt is obvious what the Fed is doing, they want to devalue the dollar so the gov't can continue to service the debt. YCC will keep the debt serviceable and devalues the dollar at the same time. The Fed is on board with any spending the democrats can dream up now because they know the dollar will be devalued in the future. That is the only way they can get out of this mess.
The problem with devauling the dollar is it will transfer real wealth to the wealthy elites in the process. That is something that the democrats fail to tell their base.
dead hobo 22 hours agoToday's Central Bankers never stop jawboning. They think it's their job to somehow "justify" the way they support banks and the financial sector at the expense of the working and middle classes. They're no longer economists, but just more politicians.
Central Banker: "Please stop yawning when I'm talking."
Real Economist: "I'm not yawning, I'm trying to say something."
zorrosgato 19 hours agoLong yields have about 3/4% to rise to reach recent historical levels. The world didn't end a couple of years ago at these rates. It won't end now. No YCC for you.
Since September 21,1981 the yield on the US 10yr treasury has been falling. A 40 year descent to where we are at today, at times easing off from the fall but seemingly never to take back over 3%. If the powerful bond market and/or the Fed decided that inflation, yields or interest rates were either too high or too low they most likely wouldn't have waited until today to fix the problem. A day when insurmountable debt has pretty much taken that option out of the equation. Lets not forget, as always, no market goes straight down or straight up.
https://www.macrotrends.net/2016/10-year-treasury-bond-rate-yield-chart
Mar 07, 2021 | www.macrotrends.net
Interactive chart showing the daily 10 year treasury yield back to 1962. The 10 year treasury is the benchmark used to decide mortgage rates across the U.S. and is the most liquid and widely traded bond in the world. The current 10 year treasury yield as of March 04, 2021 is 1.54% .
Mar 06, 2021 | www.moonofalabama.org
Canadian Cents , Mar 5 2021 6:08 utc | 81
Passer by @21 and @26, had a thought related to your mention that "the US dollar still remains 62% of world currency reserves" , or "nearly two thirds of world currency reserves" . That seems to correspond to the IMF figure of 61.5% from December 2019. The IMF figure from December 2020, however, is now down to 60.4% .
A few months ago I read that Goldman Sachs had suggested the USD could drop 6% in 2021, while Citigroup suggested that it could drop as much as 20%.
Assuming no other changes to reserves, a 6% drop in the USD seems to imply the 60.4% percentage would become less than 58%. And a 20% drop in the USD seems to imply that US dollar holdings could fall to around 50% of world currency reserves.
And if it gets to around 50%, does a tipping point, as William Gruff @28 mentioned, kick in?
On the other hand, other Wall Street strategists think the USD will strengthen in 2021, so who knows ...
Sep 14, 2020 | www.bloomberg.com
High-yield bond default rates may double as companies struggle with a protracted economic downturn even as the Federal Reserve props up valuations, said Jeffrey Gundlach.
The investment grade corporate debt market has skewed toward lower quality BBB- rated debt, but if just 50% of that were to be downgraded it could fuel a near doubling of the high-yield market, Gundlach said Tuesday on a webcast for his firm's flagship DoubleLine Total Return Bond Fund .
Gundlach's views reflect broad skepticism about the market's connection to economic realities. He criticized the Fed's emergency actions as buoying asset prices and spurring unsustainable corporate borrowing binges.
Risk assets such as equities and high yield credit markets are responding to this support, and government stimulus, disproportionately as the Covid-19 pandemic remains a threat to the recovery, he said.
"It's foolhardy to believe that one can have this kind of a shock to an economy and it just gets healed through a one-shot deal" from the Treasury, he said.
Gundlach pointed out that the global GDP forecast is -3.9%, whereas the U.S. lags at -5% despite the country's response to the Covid-19 crisis being "one of the highest in the world."
Highlighting the effect of the weekly $600 stimulus checks, he called it a distortion of the personal-income spending picture akin to the Fed's effect on the markets.
"This is a large incentive to stay on public assistance," Gundlach said, noting that benefit payments have exceeded many workers' regular income.
Gundlach also snubbed one of the market's favorite trades on a U.S. recovery, saying he's "betting against" the inflation-linked bond market. TIPS products have seen some of the strongest monthly inflows in four years, and market-implied expectations for inflation have touched a 2020 high. Gundlach repeated that the impact of the pandemic is deflationary.
Sep 10, 2020 | www.zerohedge.com
As investors, we have several tools and indicators at our disposal.
Whether it is technical indicators such as Fibonacci levels, moving averages, or price supports, or fundamental indicators such as corporate earnings or economic data, we have a lot of information to use when making decisions.
Today's chart incorporates both. Junk Bonds play a critical role in highlighted investor sentiment. When junk bonds (lower-rated debt) is performing well, then that means investors are taking more risks. When junk bonds struggle, that means investors are taking on less risk.
So today, we highlight the Junk Bonds ETF (JNK). Using technical analysis, we can see that JNK is trading near line (A), a price level that has served as support and resistance over the past several years. It is currently serving as price resistance.
At the same time, there is a divergence between the stock market (the S&P 500 made new all-time highs) and Junk Bonds (well below all-time highs and 5 percent off 2019 highs).
So this is an important resistance test for junk bonds. Will Junk Bonds (JNK) break down from here (bearish) or break out (bullish).
What happens here will send an important message to stocks (and investors)!
Jan 08, 2020 | www.kiplinger.com
High-yield bonds (avoid the oil patch), emerging-markets bonds and dividend-paying stocks such as real estate investment trusts and utilities are good places to hunt for yield. Funds to consider include Vanguard High Yield Corporate ( VWEHX ), yielding 4.5%, and TCW Emerging Markets Bond ( TGEIX ), yielding 5.1%. Schwab US Dividend Equity ( SCHD , $56), a member of the Kiplinger ETF 20 list of our favorite ETFs, invests in high-quality dividend payers and yields just over 3%. Spath, at Sierra Funds, is bullish on preferred stocks. IShares Preferred and Income Securities ETF ( PFF , $37) yields 5.5%. (For more ideas, see Income Investing .)
Jan 08, 2020 | www.kiplinger.com
Market value: $71.3 billion
SEC yield: 1.6%
Expense ratio: 0.17%
Suppose my outlook for the bond market is either wrong, or at best, premature. Bond yields could fall next year, or just stay relatively flat. That's why it usually makes sense to own more than one bond fund.
Vanguard Intermediate-Term Tax-Exempt Investor ( VWITX , $14.41) should hold up pretty well if rates rise only a small amount in 2020, and it could trounce the other funds in this article if rates fall.
VWITX's duration is 4.9 years. That means if bond yields rise by one percentage point, the fund's price should decline by 4.9%. That wouldn't be fun for investors, but it would hardly be catastrophic, especially when you factor in the yield.
Like most Vanguard bond offerings, Vanguard Intermediate-Term Tax-Exempt Investor is plain vanilla, and that's OK. It sticks almost entirely to high-quality municipal bonds. Its weighted average credit quality is a sterling AA.
VWITX also has been a decent performer, at an annualized 3.1% total return over the past five years.
Dec 21, 2019 | peakoilbarrel.com
HHH x Ignored says: 12/12/2019 at 11:27 pm
Price of oil does have problem that will play out over next 6-8 months. Without a trade war and Brexit hanging over markets. There isn't a whole lot of reason to be holding government bonds which yield next to nothing or less than nothing in some cases. Fed is buying bills so Repo market won't implode into another 2008. Only problem is they need to be buying coupons or treasuries also. They are buying some treasuries but it's not near enough to hold interest rates down. Yields on debt are going to rise without something like a trade war holding them down. That is a problem if your long oil.Keep an eye on 10 year US treasuries. If they become just a little less liquid and yields rise as i believe they will. These OPEC cuts aren't going to mean as much as some might think.
Dec 07, 2019 | economistsview.typepad.com
Joe -> Joe... , November 30, 2019 at 09:53 PM
https://www.bloomberg.com/news/articles/2019-11-30/record-2-4-trillion-bond-binge-is-threatening-investor-returnsJoe -> Joe... , November 30, 2019 at 10:03 PMAn unprecedented frenzy of debt sales around the world is threatening to cool this year's hot returns on corporate bonds.
Companies have sold a record $2.43 trillion so far this year across currencies, surpassing previous full-year records. Investors rushed to snap up all this debt because they were desperate for yield as central banks cut rates. That has pushed up valuations.
Now, some troubling signs for the direction of those valuations are converging. Recent data suggest that the worst may be over for the global economy, which means many central banks could have less reason next year to guide down borrowing costs. That will all make it harder to top the double-digit returns that some investors scored on corporate bonds this year.
---
Wealthy made some real money betting on our government bailouts, in Europe an the US. Now the yields are gone, where to? China, the only rational central banker left means, park your money in China.https://finance.yahoo.com/news/while-the-us-chilled-this-thanksgiving-week-china-moved-forward-125657666.htmlPaine -> Joe... , December 01, 2019 at 06:22 AMWhat this means now is that things will only get more complicated for Beijing from here on out. Chinese President Xi Jinping bet on letting the people of Hong Kong decide, and they did. Only it was against him.
We'll return to the political situation in Hong Kong momentarily, but before we do, another major development, this time on the business front.
On Tuesday, Alibaba executed a slam-dunk secondary offering in Hong Kong, raising $12.9 billion. That easily surpassed Uber's $8.1 billion IPO in May, making it the biggest public offering of 2019. For those who were predicting the death of Hong Kong -- and they've been doing that for decades, (and Kyle Bass and others are still at it) -- that again appears to be premature.
---
Clueless reporting. Xi came out of this looking great. He has one country three systems, he now has a sound central banking, investment is flowing in, not out. They are immune from sanctions, and even the trade tariffs are expanding Chinese influence in Asia, Iran, Russia and China can look forward to a new global banking system, absent the dollar. Belt and suspenders is moving forward.I like it, I have no priors, I can point this fact without contradiction. Go Xi.
This in fact is poisonous
Bourgeois think heresyThe struggle inside the party continues
Policy
Zero real sovereign note
Intetest ratesup and down the term structure
A Lerner mark up cap and trade net
For the big corporate players
A huge expansion
of the social payments system
transition to a 100 percent George tax on land lotsImmediately begin a three staged
Liberation
Of Tibet Hong Kong
and
SinkiangCut North Korea loose
to unite with the south
Allow open elections at the neighborhood level
Oct 26, 2019 | www.zerohedge.com
Authored by Mike Shedlock via MishTalk,
What's behind the ever-increasing need for emergency repos? A couple of correspondents have an eye on shadow banking.
Shadow Banking
- The shadow banking system consists of lenders, brokers, and other credit intermediaries who fall outside the realm of traditional regulated banking.
- It is generally unregulated and not subject to the same kinds of risk, liquidity, and capital restrictions as traditional banks are.
- The shadow banking system played a major role in the expansion of housing credit in the run up to the 2008 financial crisis, but has grown in size and largely escaped government oversight since then.
The above from Investopedia .
Image courtesy of my friend Chris Temple.
Hey It's Not QE, Not Even MonetaryYesterday, I commented Fed to Increase Emergency Repos to $120 Billion, But Hey, It's Not Monetary .
Let's recap before reviewing excellent comments from a couple of valued sources.
The Fed keeps increasing the size and duration of "overnight" funding. It's now up $120 billion a day, every day, extended for weeks. That is on top of new additions.
Three Fed StatementsThree Mish Comments
- Emergency repos were needed for " end-of-quarter funding ".
- Balance sheet expansion is " not QE ". Rather, it's " organic growth ".
- This is "not monetary policy ".
- Hmm. A quick check of my calendar says the quarter ended on September 30 and today is October 23.
- Hmm. Historically "organic" growth was about $2 to $3 billion.
- Hmm. Somehow it takes an emergency (but let's no longer call it that), $120 billion " at least " in repetitive " overnight " repos to control interest rates, but that does not constitute "monetary policy"
I made this statement: I claim these "non-emergency", "non-QE", "non-monetary policy" operations suggest we may already be at the effective lower bound for the Fed's current balance sheet holding .
Shadow Banking Suggestion by David CollumPater Tenebrarum at the Acting Man blog pinged me with these comments on my article, emphasis mine.
Reader CommentsWhile there is too much collateral and not enough reserves to fund it, we don't know anything about the distribution [or quality] of this collateral . It could well be that some market participants do not have sufficient high quality collateral and were told to bugger off when they tried to repo it in the private markets.
Such market participants would become unable to fund their leveraged positions in CLOs or whatever else they hold.
Mind, I'm not saying that's the case, but the entire shadow banking system is opaque and we usually only find out what's what when someone keels over or is forced to report a huge loss.
- Axiom7: Euro banks are starving for dollar funding and if there is a hard Brexit both UK and German banks are in big trouble. I wonder if this implies that the EU will crack in negotiations knowing that a DB fail is too-big-to-bail?
- Cheesie: How do you do repos with a negative interest rate?
- Harry-Ireland: [sarcastically], Of course, it's not QE. How can it be, it's the greatest economy ever and there's absolutely nobody over-leveraged and the system is as healthy as can be!
- Ian: Taking bad collateral to keep banks solvent is not QE.
In regards to point number four, I commented:
This is not TARP 2009. [The Fed is not swapping money for dodgy collateral] Someone or someones is caught in some sort of borrow-short lend-long scheme and the Fed is giving them reserves for nothing in return. Where's the collateral?
Pater Tenebrarum partially agrees.
Guessing GameYes, this is not "TARP" - the Fed is not taking shoddy collateral, only treasury and agency bonds are accepted. The primary dealers hold a huge inventory of treasuries that needs to be funded every day in order to provide them with the cash needed for day-to-day operations - they are one of the main sources of the "collateral surplus".
We are all guessing here, so I am submitting possible ideas for discussion.
RehypothecationI am not convinced the Fed isn't bailing out a US major bank, foreign bank, or some other financial institution by taking rehypothecated , essentially non-existent, as collateral.
Current Primary DealersRehypothecation is the practice by banks and brokers of using, for their own purposes, assets that have been posted as collateral by their clients.
In a typical example of rehypothecation, securities that have been posted with a prime brokerage as collateral by a hedge fund are used by the brokerage to back its own transactions and trades.
- Amherst Pierpont Securities LLC
- Bank of Nova Scotia, New York Agency
- BMO Capital Markets Corp.
- BNP Paribas Securities Corp.
- Barclays Capital Inc.
- Cantor Fitzgerald & Co.
- Citigroup Global Markets Inc.
- Credit Suisse AG, New York Branch
- Daiwa Capital Markets America Inc.
- Deutsche Bank Securities Inc.
- Goldman Sachs & Co. LLC
- HSBC Securities (USA) Inc.
- Jefferies LLC
- J.P. Morgan Securities LLC
- Merrill Lynch, Pierce, Fenner & Smith Incorporated
- Mizuho Securities USA LLC
- Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC
- NatWest Markets Securities Inc.
- Nomura Securities International, Inc.
- RBC Capital Markets, LLC
- Societe Generale, New York Branch
- TD Securities (USA) LLC
- UBS Securities LLC.
- Wells Fargo Securities LLC.
The above Primary Dealer List from Wikipedia as of May 6, 2019.
Anyone spot any candidates?
My gosh, how many are foreign entities?
It's important to note those are not "shadow banking" institutions, while also noting that derivative messes within those banks would be considered "shadow banking".
Tenebrarum ReplyPreparation for End of LIBORIn this case the problem is specifically that the primary dealers are holding huge inventories of treasuries and bank reserves are apparently not sufficient to both pre-fund the daily liquidity requirements of banks and leave them with enough leeway to lend reserves to repo market participants.
The Fed itself does not accept anything except treasuries and agency MBS in its repo operations, and only organizations authorized to access the federal funds market can participate by offering collateral in exchange for Fed liquidity (mainly the primary dealers, banks, money market funds,...).
Since most of the repo lending is overnight - i.e., is reversed within a 24 hour period (except for term repos) - I don't think re-hypothecated securities play a big role in this.
But private repo markets are broader and have far more participants, so possibly there is a problem elsewhere that is propagating into the slice of the market the Fed is connected with. Note though, since the Treasury is borrowing like crazy and is at the same time rebuilding its deposits with the Fed (which lowers bank reserves, ceteris paribus), there is a several-pronged push underway that is making short term funding of treasury collateral more difficult at the moment.
So I'm not sure a case can really be made that there is anything going on beyond what meets the eye - which is already bad enough if you ask me.
What about all the LIBOR-based derivatives with the end of LIBOR coming up?
The Wall Street Journal reports U.S. Companies Advised to Prepare for Multiple Benchmark Rates in Transition from Libor
Repro QuakeLibor is a scandal-plagued benchmark that is used to set the price of trillions of dollars of loans and derivatives globally. A group of banks and regulators in 2017 settled on a replacement created by the Federal Reserve known as the secured overnight financing rate, or SOFR. Companies must move away from Libor by the end of 2021, when banks will no longer be required to publish rates used to calculate it.
"We don't expect that 100% of the Libor-based positions today will migrate 100% to SOFR," Jeff Vitali, a partner at Ernst & Young, said this week during a panel at an Association for Financial Professionals conference in Boston. "It is going to be a scenario where entities are going to have to prepare and be flexible and build flexibility into their systems and models and processes that can handle multiple pricing environments in the same jurisdiction."
I invite readers to consider Tenebrarum's " Repro Quake - A Primer " but caution that it is complicated.
He informs me "a credit analyst at the largest bank in my neck of the woods sent me a mail to tell me this was by far the best article on the topic he has come across".
Note: That was supposed to be a private comment to me. I placed it in as an endorsement.
Tenebrarum live in Europe. Here are his conclusions.
What Else is the Fed Missing?Effective Lower Bound
- Contrary to similar spikes in repo rates in 2008, it was probably not fear of counterparty risk that led to the recent repo quake. What's more, the Federal Reserve without a doubt knew that something like this was coming. We say this because even we knew it – it was not a secret. A number of analysts have warned of just such a situation for months.
- It is astonishing that the Fed somehow seemed unprepared and quite surprised by the extent of the liquidity shortage. We would submit that this fact alone is a good reason for markets to be concerned. If the Fed is not even able to properly gauge such a "technical problem" in advance, what else is there it does not know?
Finally, Tenebrarum commented: " I agree on your effective lower bound comment, since obviously, the 'dearth' of excess reserves was pushing up all overnight rates, including the FF rate ."
For discussion of why the effective lower bound of interest rates may be much higher than zero, please see In Search of the Effective Lower Bound .
argento3 , 4 hours ago link
Doge , 4 hours ago linkmy gut tells me (I have no tangible evidence)
that some of this money is leaking out to continue to prop up the stock market. I've been trading for 46 years and current valuations are beyond ridiculous. for example, Tesla made a buck a share in the last quarter. woop di do. and the stock zooms to $300++ a share with a market cap of $58 bil. 60% more than Ford???!!! We know that Porsche and BMW and Mercedes and Audi are going to build a much better EV. another one, Cintas. They rent uniforms. what a sexy business! valued at a p/e of 32 with a $28 bil. market cap. Book value of $29 a share. the stock is at $270 !!! the list goes on and on and on Carvana, etc.
personally, I have 5% bitcoin 5% gold and have a nice chunk in a very high quality diversified commodity mutual fund. Commodities (relative to stocks) are at multi decade lows. a deep value trade. very best wishes to you. Argento
argento3 , 4 hours ago linkCan you name the commodity fund you own?
Let it Go , 6 hours ago linki like both DCMSX and PCRAX (DFA and Pimco)
this sector has under performed stocks as written above. so the returns have been negative (for now)
namrider , 6 hours ago linkOn occasion, it is important to revisit issues that have been swept under the rug or simply overlooked. For most people, the derivatives market falls into this category, partly because they don't understand exactly what derivatives are or why this market is so important.
Anyone paying attention knows that the size of the derivatives market dwarfs the global economy. Paul Wilmott who holds a doctorate in applied mathematics from Oxford University has written several books on derivatives. Wilmott estimates the derivatives market at $1.2 quadrillion, to put that in perspective it is about 20 times the size of the world economy.
That is an OLD guess... today it is estimated that derivatives exceeds $2 quadrillion, and that just commodity derivatives approaches the old figure. Interest rate based derivatives still dominate, my guess is much higher.
Sep 17, 2019 | economistsview.typepad.com
Joe , September 16, 2019 at 12:11 PM
Paine -> Joe... , September 16, 2019 at 02:01 PM
https://www.bloomberg.com/markets/rates-bonds/government-bonds/usOne of the key U.S. borrowing markets saw a massive surge Monday, a sign the Federal Reserve is having trouble controlling short-term interest rates.
Amid the settlement of Treasury coupon auctions and the influx of quarterly corporate tax payments, the rate on overnight repurchase agreements soared by 153 basis points to 3.80%, the largest daily increase since December, based on ICAP pricing.
---------
The would be Treasury trying to tilt the curve, deposit short borrow long. Finance, in general, is rescaling to accommodate the next 2 trillion in debt while rolling over trillions of 'Uncle can do it later' debt. A quick downturn, readjustment, and the 'Uncle do it later' payments to the wealthy will continue.This is common, our progressive tribe has moles who suddenly rush off and do a deal with the wealthy leaving the rest of us in the dark.
The end time nearsJoe , September 17, 2019 at 06:08 AMhttps://thehill.com/blogs/blog-briefing-room/news/461692-cost-for-recent-government-shutdowns-estimated-at-4bRepo Squeeze Threatens to Spill Over Into Funding Markets
By Stephen Spratt
September 17, 2019, 3:19 AM PDT Updated on September 17, 2019, 5:24 AM PDT
Cross-currency basis, FX forwards, eurodollar futures shift
Sale of $78 billion in Treasuries led to sudden cash squeeze
----------------Treasury is ahead of finance in paying for the 'Uncle do it later' trick. The short rate has jumped 10 basis points, not much but there was a reading on the overnight market of 7%. This may mean nothing, but more likely means higher consumer credit charges. W have to pay for 'Uncles later'.
Sep 04, 2019 | finance.yahoo.com
Sep.04 -- Sean Carney, head of municipal strategy at BlackRock, discusses the municipal bond market posting its best returns since 2014. He speaks with Bloomberg's Taylor Riggs in this week's "Muni Moment" on "Bloomberg Markets."
Aug 17, 2019 | economistsview.typepad.com
anne , August 07, 2019 at 09:17 AM
https://www.nytimes.com/2019/08/07/opinion/tariff-tantrums-and-recession-risks.htmlAugust 7, 2019
Tariff Tantrums and Recession Risks
Why trade war scares the market so much
By Paul KrugmanIf the bond market is any indication, Donald Trump's escalating belligerence on trade is creating seriously increased risks of recession. But I haven't seen many clear explanations of why that might be so. The problem isn't just, or even mainly, that he really does seem to be a Tariff Man. What's more important is that he's a capricious, unpredictable Tariff Man. And that capriciousness is really bad for business investment.
First things first: why do I emphasize the bond market, not the stock market? Not because bond investors are cooler and more rational than stock investors, although that may be true. No, the point is that expected economic growth has a much clearer effect on bonds than on stocks.
Suppose the market becomes pessimistic about growth over the next year, or even beyond. In that case, it will expect the Fed to respond by cutting short-term interest rates, and these expectations will be reflected in falling long-term rates. That's why the inversion of the yield curve -- the spread between long-term and short-term rates -- is so troubling. In the past, this has always signaled an imminent recession:
[That scary yield curve]
And the market seems in effect to be predicting that it will happen again.
But what about stocks? Lower growth means lower profits, which is bad for stocks. But it also, as we've just seen, means lower interest rates, which are good for stocks. In fact, sometimes bad news is good news: a bad economic number causes stocks to rise, because investors think it will induce the Fed to cut. So stock prices aren't a good indicator of growth expectations.
O.K., preliminaries out of the way. Now let's talk about tariffs and recession.
You often see assertions that protectionism causes recessions -- Smoot-Hawley caused the Great Depression, and all that. But this is far from clear, and often represents a category error.
Yes, Econ 101 says that protectionism hurts the economy. But it does its damage via the supply side, making the world economy less efficient. Recessions, however, are usually caused by inadequate demand, and it's not at all clear that protectionism necessarily has a negative effect on demand.
Put it this way: a global trade war would induce everyone to switch spending away from imports toward domestically produced goods and services. This will reduce everyone's exports, causing job losses in export sectors; but it will simultaneously increase spending on and employment in import-competing industries. It's not at all obvious which way the net effect would go.
To give a concrete example, think about the world economy in the 1950s, before the creation of the Common Market and long before the creation of the World Trade Organization. There was a lot more protectionism and vastly less international trade then than there would be later (the containerization revolution was still decades in the future.) But Western Europe and North America generally had more or less full employment.
So why do Trump's tariff tantrums seem to be having a pronounced negative effect on near-term economic prospects? The answer, I'd submit, is that he isn't just raising tariffs, he's doing so in an unpredictable fashion.
People are often sloppy when they talk about the adverse effects of economic uncertainty, frequently using "uncertainty" to mean "an increased probability of something bad happening." That's not really about uncertainty: it means that average expectations of what's going to happen are worse, so it's a fall in the mean, not a rise in the variance.
But uncertainty properly understood can have serious adverse effects, especially on investment.
Let me offer a hypothetical example. Suppose there are two companies, Cronycorp and Globalshmobal, that would be affected in opposite ways if Trump imposes a new set of tariffs. Cronycorp would like to sell stuff we're currently importing, and would build a new factory to make that stuff if assured that it would be protected by high tariffs. Globalshmobal has already been considering whether to build a new factory, but it relies heavily on imported inputs, and wouldn't build that factory if those imports will face high tariffs.
Suppose Trump went ahead and did the deed, imposing high tariffs and making them permanent. In that case Cronycorp would go ahead, while Globalshmobal would call off its investment. The overall effect on spending would be more or less a wash.
On the other hand, suppose that Trump were to announce that we've reached a trade deal: all tariffs on China are called off, permanently, in return for Beijing's purchase of 100 million memberships at Mar-a-Lago. In that case Cronycorp will cancel its investment plans, but Globalshmobal will go ahead. Again, the overall effect on spending is a wash.
But now introduce a third possibility, in which nobody knows what Trump will do -- probably not even Trump himself, since it will depend on what he sees on Fox News on any given night. In that case both Cronycorp and Globalshmobal will put their investments on hold: Cronycorp because it's not sure that Trump will make good on his tariff threats, Globalshmobal because it's not sure that he won't.
Technically speaking, both companies will see an option value to delaying their investments until the situation is clearer. That option value is basically a cost to investment, and the more unpredictable Trump's policy, the higher that cost. And that's why trade tantrums are exerting a depressing effect on demand.
Furthermore, it's hard to see what can reduce this uncertainty. U.S. trade law gives the president huge discretionary authority to impose tariffs; the law was never designed to deal with a chief executive who has poor impulse control. A couple of years ago many analysts expected Trump to be restrained by his advisers, but he's driven many of the cooler heads out, many of those who remain are idiots, and in any case he's reportedly paying ever less attention to other people's advice.
None of this guarantees a recession. The U.S. economy is huge, there are a lot of other things going on besides trade policy, and other policy areas don't offer as much scope for presidential capriciousness. But now you understand why Trump's tariff tantrums are having such a negative effect.
Jun 05, 2019 | www.nakedcapitalism.com
djrichard , June 5, 2019 at 6:32 pm
I just assume the 10Y yield is reverting to trend – the trend downward it has had since 1982. The counter trend move upward in 2018 assumed the fiscal spigots were going to be turned on, that the deficit was no longer a dirty word and therefore inflation was no longer a dirty word. It's just taken til now to capitulate that none of that's going to happen.
Seems the Federal Reserve was caught by surprise by this too. Otherwise I don't think they would have raised their Fed Funds rate to where it is. Because now that the 10Y yield has capitulated, it's actually lower than the Fed Funds rate, creating an inverted yield curve. Which is unusual because normally an inverted yield curve is created on purpose by the Federal Reserve – they raise their rate above the 10Y yield rather than wait for the 10Y yield to drop below their rate. Still, every good trader knows an inverted yield curve is bad juju. So what's the Fed Reserve to do? Sit on its hands and let the inverted yield curve work its magic and create a recession?
Seems to me that the Federal Reserve doesn't want the market to crash on Trump's watch. At least not until after the 2020 election. So the Fed Reserve is signaling to the traders, "we feel your pain", they'll lower their rate to bring it back below the 10Y yield. They just need a pretext on why they're doing so, something that doesn't simply smack of the Fed Reserve propping up the stock market. "It's the PMI, it's the employment report, it's trade, it's one of those, yeah that's the ticket."
Anyways, even if the fiscal spigots get turned on, I don't see the 10Y yield reversing trend until spiraling wage inflation is a thing again. I.e. when people aren't worried about their exposure to inflating prices as long as their wages are increasing / tracking with inflation. Making it safe for them to take on debt at increasing interest rates – i.e. generating inflation. And I don't see that happening anytime soon unless there's some kind of JG program.
Until then, the trend line of the 10Y yield is downwards. Giving the Federal Reserve less and less room for their Fed Funds rate to operate in without inverting the yield curve. Seems like that won't be able to continue at some point. Interesting years ahead.
May 16, 2019 | www.bloomberg.com
The fourth-quarter stock market rout that wiped out $12 trillion in shareholder value and sparked a bout of Christmas Eve panic may have quickly been forgotten by most Americans, but not by the salespeople and financial engineers of Wall Street.
No, the selloff, it would appear, wound up triggering fears that time was running out on the longest bull market in history. And so, when early 2019 delivered a miraculous rebound, they wasted no time in peddling all sorts of deals and arrangements that test the limits of risk tolerance: from health-food makers fast-tracked into public hands to stretched retailers wrung for billions by private equity owners in the debt market.
Junk bonds are flying out the door once again. Deeply indebted companies are borrowing even more to pay equity holders . And while you can't say the megadeal IPOs got rushed to market, two that were held up as heralding a return to IPO glory days have been flops. It's quickly turning Uber and Lyft into poster children for Wall Street eagerness amid an equity-market bounce that has all but banished memories of the worst fourth quarter in a decade.
"At some point, people are going to get burned," said Marshall Front, the chief investment officer at Front Barnett Associates and 56-year Wall Street veteran. "People want to take their companies public because they don't know what the next years hold, and there are people who think we're close to the end of the cycle. If you're an investment banker, what do you do? You keep dancing until the music stops."
May 03, 2019 | www.kiplinger.com
For more than a decade, income investors have been plagued by paucity wrapped in misery. The bellwether 10-year Treasury note has doled out an average 2.6% interest since 2008. Although the Federal Reserve has nudged its target interest rate range to 2.25% to 2.50%, it has signaled that it's done raising rates for now. Even worse, the yield on the 10-year T-note briefly sank below the yield on the three-month T-bill -- an unusual inversion that can sometimes herald a recession and lower yields ahead. The takeaway: Locking your money up for longer periods is rarely worth the negligible increase in yield. What could increase your yield these days? Being a little more adventurous when it comes to credit quality. When you're a bond investor, you're also a lender, and borrowers with questionable credit must pay higher yields. Similarly, stocks with above-average yields probably have some skeletons in their balance sheets.
You can ameliorate credit risk -- but not eliminate it -- through diversification. Invest in a mutual fund, say, rather than a single issue. And invest in several different types of high-yielding investments -- for example, investment-grade bonds, preferred stocks and real estate investment trusts -- rather than just one category. Despite such caveats, income investing is not as bad as it was in 2015, when it was hard to milk even a penny's interest out of a money market. Now you can get 3.3% or more from no-risk certificates of deposit at a bank. We'll show you 33 ways to find the best yields for the risk you're willing to take, ranging from 2% all the way up to 12%. Just remember that the higher the payout, the greater the potential for some rough waters.
SEE ALSO: 20 of Wall Street's Newest Dividend Stocks Prices, yields and other data are as of April 19.
Check OutKiplinger's Latest Online Broker RankingsShort-term interest rates largely follow the Fed's interest rate policy. Most observers in 2018 thought that would mean higher rates in 2019. But slowing economic growth in the fourth quarter of 2018 and the near-death experience of the bull market in stocks changed that. The Fed's rate-hiking campaign is likely on hold for 2019. Still, money markets are good bets for money you can't stand to lose. Money market funds are mutual funds that invest in very-short-term, interest-bearing securities. They pay out what they earn, less expenses. A bank money market account's yield depends on the Fed's benchmark rate and the bank's need for deposits.
The risks: Money market mutual funds aren't insured, but they have a solid track record. The funds are designed to maintain a $1 share value; only two have allowed their shares to slip below $1 since 1994. The biggest risk with a bank money market deposit account is that your bank won't raise rates quickly when market interest rates rise but will be quick on the draw when rates fall. MMDAs are insured up to $250,000 by the federal government. How to invest: The best MMDA yields are from online banks, which don't have to pay to maintain brick-and-mortar branches. Currently, a top-yielding MMDA is from Investors eAccess , which is run by Investors Bank in New Jersey. The account has no minimum, has an annual percentage yield of 2.5% and allows six withdrawals per month. You'll get a bump from a short-term CD, provided you can keep your money locked up for a year. Merrick Bank , in Springfield, Mo., offers a one-year CD yielding 2.9%, with a $25,000 minimum. The early-withdrawal penalty is 2% of the account balance or seven days' interest, whichever is larger. The top five-year CD yield was recently 3.4%, from First National Bank of America in East Lansing, Mich.
SEE ALSO: 7 Best Ways to Earn More on Your Savings
Your primary concern in a money fund should be how much it charges in expenses. Vanguard Prime Money Market Fund (symbol VMMXX , yield 2.5%) charges an ultralow 0.16% a year and consistently sports above-average yields. Investors in high tax brackets might consider a tax-free money fund, whose interest is free from federal (and some state) income taxes, such as Vanguard Municipal Money Market Fund ( VMSXX 1.6%). To someone paying the maximum 40.8% federal tax rate, which includes the 3.8% net investment income tax, the fund has the equivalent of a 2.7% taxable yield. (To compute a muni's taxable-equivalent yield, subtract your tax bracket from 1, and divide the muni's yield by that. In this case, divide 1.6% by 1 minus 40.8%, or 59.2%). The fund's expense ratio is 0.15%.
SEE ALSO: 12 Bank Stocks That Wall Street Loves the Most //www.dianomi.com/smartads.epl?id=4908
Muni bonds are IOUs issued by states, municipalities and counties. At first glance, muni yields look as exciting as a month in traction. A 10-year, AAA-rated national muni yields 2.0%, on average, compared with 2.6% for a 10-year Treasury note. But the charm of a muni bond isn't its yield; it's that the interest is free from federal taxes -- and, if the bond is issued by the state where you live, from state and local taxes as well. As with tax-free money funds, investors should consider a muni fund's taxable equivalent yield; in the case above, it would be 3.4% for someone paying the top 40.8% federal rate.
Yields get better as you go down in credit quality. An A-rated 10-year muni -- two notches down from AAA but still good -- yields 2.3%, on average, or 3.9% for someone paying the top rate. The risks: Munis are remarkably safe from a credit perspective, even considering that defaults have inched up in recent years. But like all bonds, munis are subject to interest rate risk. If rates rise, your bond's value will drop (and vice versa), because interest rates and bond prices typically move in opposite directions. If you own an individual bond and hold it until it matures, you'll most likely get your full principal and interest. The value of muni funds, however, will vary every day.SEE ALSO: 9 Municipal Bond Funds for Tax-Free Income
How to invest: Most investors should use a mutual fund or ETF, rather than pick their own individual bonds. Look for funds with rock-bottom expenses, such as Vanguard Limited-Term Tax-Exempt ( VMLTX , 1.8%). The fund charges just 0.17%, and yields the equivalent of 3% for someone paying the highest federal tax rate. It's a short-term fund, which means it's less sensitive to interest rate swings. That means its share price would fall less than longer-term funds' prices if rates were to rise. The average credit quality of the fund's holdings is a solid AA–. Fidelity Intermediate Municipal Income ( FLTMX , 2.0%), a member of the Kiplinger 25 , the list of our favorite no-load funds, gains a bit of yield (a taxable equivalent of 3.4% for those at the top rate) by investing in slightly longer-term bonds. The fund's expense ratio is 0.37%; the largest percentage of assets, 39%, is in AA bonds. Vanguard High-Yield Tax-Exempt Fund Investor Shares ( VWAHX , 2.9%) also charges just 0.17% in fees and yields 4.9% on a taxable-equivalent basis for someone at the highest rate. The extra yield comes from investing in a sampling of riskier bonds. But the fund's average BBB+ credit rating is still pretty good, and its return has beaten 96% of high-yield muni funds over the past 15 years.
SEE ALSO: How Smart a Bond Investor Are You? //www.dianomi.com/smartads.epl?id=4908
You get higher yields from corporate bonds than you do from government bonds because corporations are more likely to default. But that risk is slim. The one-year average default rate for investment-grade bonds (those rated BBB– or higher), is just 0.09%, going back to 1981, says Standard & Poor's. And corporate bonds rated AAA and maturing in 20 or more years recently yielded 3.7%, on average, while 20-year Treasury bonds yielded 2.8% and 30-year T-bonds, 3.0%. You can earn even more with bonds from firms with lightly dinged credit ratings. Bonds rated BBB yield an average 4.0%. The risks: The longer-term bond market moves independently of the Fed and could nudge yields higher (and prices lower) if inflation worries pick up. Though corporate defaults are rare, they can be devastating. Lehman Brothers, the brokerage firm whose bankruptcy helped fuel the Great Recession, once boasted an investment-grade credit rating.How to invest: Active managers select the bonds at Dodge & Cox Income ( DODIX , 3.5%). This fund has beaten 84% of its peers over the past 15 years, using a value-oriented approach. It holds relatively short-term bonds, giving its portfolio a duration of 4.4 years, which means its share price would fall roughly 4.4% if interest rates rose by one percentage point over 12 months. The fund's average credit quality is A, and it charges 0.42% in expenses. If you prefer to own a sampling of the corporate bond market for a super-low fee, Vanguard Intermediate-Term Corporate Bond Index Fund Admiral Shares ( VICSX , 3.6%) is a good choice. Vanguard recently lowered the minimum investment to $3,000, and the fund charges just 0.07%. Interest-rate risk is high with Vanguard Long-Term Bond ETF ( BLV , $91, 3.8%). The exchange-traded fund has a duration of 15, which means fund shares would fall 15% if interest rates moved up by one percentage point in a year's time. Still, the yield on this long-term bond offering is enticing, and the fund's expense ratio is just 0.07%. SEE ALSO: The 7 Best Bond Funds for Retirement Savers in 2019 //www.dianomi.com/smartads.epl?id=4908
Dividend stocks have one advantage that bonds don't: They can, and often do, raise their payout. For example, Procter & Gamble ( PG , $106, 2.7%), a member of the Kiplinger Dividend 15 , the list of our favorite dividend-paying stocks, raised its dividend from $2.53 a share in 2014 to $2.84 in 2018, a 2.3% annualized increase. Preferred stocks, like bonds, pay a fixed dividend and typically offer higher yields than common stocks. Banks and other financial services firms are the typical issuers, and, like most high-dividend investments, they are sensitive to changes in interest rates. Yields for preferreds are in the 6% range, and a generous crop of new issues offers plenty of choices.The risks: Dividend stocks are still stocks, and they will fall when the stock market does. Furthermore, Wall Street clobbers companies that cut their dividend. General Electric slashed its dividend to a penny per share on December 7, 2018, and the stock fell 4.7% that day. How to invest: Some slower-growing industries, such as utilities or telecommunications firms, tend to pay above-average dividends. Verizon Communications ( VZ , $58, 4.2%), a Kip 15 dividend stock, is the largest wireless carrier in the U.S. Its investment in Fios fiber-optic cable should pay off in coming years. SPDR Portfolio S&P 500 High Dividend ETF ( SPYD , $39, 4.3%) tracks the highest-yielding stocks in the S&P 500 index. The fund has 80 holdings and is sufficiently diversified to handle a clunker or two. Utility PPL Corp. ( PPL , $31, 5.3%) derives more than 50% of its earnings from the United Kingdom. Worries that the U.K.'s departure from the European Union will pressure PPL's earnings have weighed on the stock's price, boosting its yield. Nevertheless, PPL's U.S. operations provide strong support for the company's generous payout. Ma Bell is a Dividend Aristocrat , meaning that AT&T ( T , $32, 6.4%) has raised its dividend for at least 25 consecutive years (35 straight years, in AT&T's case). The company has plenty of free cash flow to keep raising its payout. SEE ALSO: 9 High-Yield Dividend Stocks That Deserve Your Attention //www.dianomi.com/smartads.epl?id=4908
You can invest in two types of REITs: those that invest in property and those that invest in mortgages. Both types must pass on at least 90% of their revenue to investors, which is partly why they have such excellent yields. Typically, REITs that invest in income-producing real estate have lower yields than those that invest in mortgages. The average property REIT yields 4.1%, compared with the average mortgage REIT yield of 10.6%, according to the National Association of Real Estate Investment Trusts. Why the big difference? Property REITs rack up expenses when they buy and sell income properties or lease them out as landlords. Mortgage REITs either buy mortgages or originate them, using borrowed money or money raised through selling shares as their capital.The risks: When the economy slows down, so does the real estate market, and most REITs will take a hit in a recession. Mortgage REITs are exceptionally sensitive to interest rate increases, which squeeze their profit margins, and to recessions, which increase the likelihood of loan defaults. REIT dividends are not qualified dividends for tax purposes and are taxed at your ordinary income tax rate. How to invest: Realty Income Corp. ( O , $69, 4.0%) invests in property and rents it to large, dependable corporations, such as Walgreens, 7-Eleven and Fed-Ex. It's a Kiplinger 15 dividend stalwart and pays dividends monthly. Fidelity Real Estate Income ( FRIFX , 4.0%) isn't a REIT, although it invests in them (among other things). The fund puts income first. It has 43% of its assets in bonds, most of them issued by REITs. The fund lost 0.6% in 2018, compared with a 6% loss for other real estate funds. Investors will forgive a lot in exchange for a high yield. In the case of iShares Mortgage Real Estate Capped ETF ( REM , $44, 8.2%), they're choosing to accept a high degree of concentration: The top four holdings account for 44% of the ETF's portfolio. Although concentration can increase risk, in this instance the fund's huge position in mortgage REITs has helped returns. Falling interest rates late in 2018 pushed up mortgage REITs, limiting the fund's losses to just 3% in 2018. Annaly Capital Management ( NLY , $10, 12%) is a REIT that borrows cheaply to buy government-guaranteed mortgage securities. Most of those holdings are rated AA+ or better. Annaly boosts its yield by investing in and originating commercial real estate loans and by making loans to private equity firms. Its 2018 purchase of MTGE Investment, a mortgage REIT that specializes in skilled nursing and senior living facilities, will help diversify the firm's portfolio. Annaly is the largest holding of iShares Mortgage Real Estate Capped ETF.
SEE ALSO: A Dozen Great REITs for Income AND Diversification
If you think interest rates are low in the U.S., note that most developed foreign countries have even lower rates because their economies are growing slowly and inflation is low. The U.K.'s 10-year bond pays just 1.2%; Germany's 10-year bond yields 0.1%; Japan's yields –0.03%. There's no reason to accept those yields for a day, much less a decade. You can, by contrast, find decent yields in some emerging countries. Emerging-markets bonds typically yield roughly four to five percentage points more than comparable U.S. Treasury bonds, which would put yields on some 10-year EM debt at about 7%, says Pramol Dhawan, emerging-markets portfolio manager at bond fund giant Pimco.The risks: You need a healthy tolerance for risk to invest in emerging-markets bonds. U.S. investors tend to be leery of them because they remember massive defaults and currency devaluations, such as those that occurred in Asia in the late 1990s. But in the wake of such debacles, many emerging countries have learned to manage their debt and their currencies better than in the past. But currency is still a key consideration. When the U.S. dollar rises in value, overseas gains translate into fewer greenbacks. When the dollar falls, however, you'll get a boost in your return. A higher dollar can also put pressure on foreign debt denominated in dollars -- because as the dollar rises, so do interest payments. How to invest: Dodge & Cox Global Bond ( DODLX , 4.5%) can invest anywhere, but lately it has favored U.S. bonds, which were recently 48% of the portfolio. The fund's major international holdings show that it isn't afraid to invest in dicey areas -- it has 11% of its assets in Mexican bonds and 7% in United Kingdom bonds. Fidelity New Markets Income ( FNMIX , 5.6%), a Kip 25 fund, has been run by John Carlson since 1995. That makes him one of the few emerging-markets debt managers who ran a portfolio during the currency-triggered meltdown in 1997-98. He prefers debt denominated in dollars, which accounts for 94% of the portfolio. But he can be adventurous: About 6.5% of the fund's assets are in Turkey, which is currently struggling with a 19% inflation rate and a 14.7% unemployment rate. IShares Emerging Markets High Yield Bond ETF ( EMHY , $46, 6.2%) tracks emerging-markets corporate and government bonds with above-average yields. The holdings are denominated in dollars, so there's less currency risk. But this is not a low-risk holding. It's more than twice as volatile as the U.S. bond market, although still only half as volatile as emerging-markets stocks. SEE ALSO: 39 European Dividend Aristocrats for International Income Growth
Junk bonds -- or high-yield bonds, in Wall Street parlance -- aren't trash to income investors. Such bonds, which are rated BB+ or below, yield, on average, about 4.7 percentage points more than the 10-year T-note, says John Lonski, managing director for Moody's Capital Markets Research Group. What makes a junk bond junky? Typical high-yield bond issuers are companies that have fallen on hard times, or newer companies with problematic balance sheets. In good times, these companies can often make their payments in full and on time and can even see their credit ratings improve. The risks: You're taking an above-average risk that your bond's issuer will default. The median annual default rate for junk bonds since 1984 is 3.8%, according to Lonksi. In a recession, you could take a big hit. In 2008, the average junk bond fund fell 26%, even with reinvested interest.How to invest: RiverPark Strategic Income ( RSIVX , 4.8%) is a mix of cash and short-term high-yield and investment-grade bonds. Managers choose bonds with a very low duration, to cut interest rate risk, and a relatively low chance of default. Vanguard High-Yield Corporate ( VWEHX , 5.5%), a Kip 25 fund, charges just 0.23% in expenses and invests mainly in the just-below-investment-grade arena, in issues from companies such as Sprint and Univision Communications. SPDR Bloomberg Barclays High Yield Bond ETF ( JNK , $36, 5.8%) charges 0.40% in expenses and tracks the Barclays High Yield Very Liquid index -- meaning that it invests only in easily traded bonds. That's a comfort in a down market because when the junk market turns down, buyers tend to dry up. The fund may lag its peers in a hot market, however, as some of the highest-yielding issues can also be the least liquid. Investors who are bullish on the economy might consider Northern High Yield Fixed Income Fund ( NHFIX , 7.0%). The fund owns a significant slice of the junkier corner of the bond market, with about 23% of its holdings rated below B by Standard & Poor's. These bonds are especially vulnerable to economic downturns but compensate investors willing to take that risk with a generous yield.
SEE ALSO: 12 Dividend Stocks That May Be Income Traps //www.dianomi.com/smartads.epl?id=4908
You might be surprised to learn how much income you can generate from moving hydrocarbons from one place to another. Most MLPs are spin-offs from energy firms and typically operate gas or oil pipelines. MLPs pay out most of their income to investors and don't pay corporate income taxes on that income. Those who buy individual MLPs will receive a K-1 tax form, which spells out the income, losses, deductions and credits that the business earned and your share of each. Most MLP ETFs and mutual funds don't have to issue a K-1; you'll get a 1099 form reporting the income you received from the fund.The risks: In theory, energy MLPs should be somewhat immune to changes in oil prices; they collect fees on the amount they move, no matter what the price. In practice, when oil gets clobbered, so do MLPs -- as investors learned in 2015, when the price of West Texas intermediate crude fell from $53 a barrel to a low of $35 and MLPs slid an average 35%. Oil prices should be relatively stable this year, and high production levels should mean a good year for pipeline firms. How to invest: Magellan Midstream Partners ( MMP , $62, 6.5%) has a 9,700-mile pipeline system for refined products, such as gasoline, and 2,200 miles of oil pipelines. The MLP has a solid history of raising its payout (called a distribution) and expects a 5% annual increase in 2019. The giant of MLP ETFs, Alerian MLP ETF ( AMLP , $10, 7.2%), boasts $9 billion in assets and delivers a high yield with reasonable expenses of 0.85% a year. Structured as a C corporation, the fund must pay taxes on its income and gains. That can be a drag on yields compared with MLPs that operate under the traditional partnership structure. EQM Midstream Partners ( EQM , $46, 10.1%) is active in the Appalachian Basin and has about 950 miles of interstate pipelines. The firm paid $4.40 in distributions per unit last year and expects to boost that to $4.58 in 2019.
SEE ALSO: 7 High-Yield MLPs to Buy as Oil Prices Climb
Closed-end funds (CEFs) are the forebears of mutual funds and ETFs. A closed-end fund raises money through an initial stock offering and invests that money in stocks, bonds and other types of securities, says John Cole Scott, chief investment officer, Closed-End Fund Advisors. The fund's share price depends on investors' opinion of how its picks will fare. Typically, the fund's share price is less than the current, per-share value of its holdings -- meaning that the fund trades at a discount. In the best outcome, investors will drive the price up to or beyond the market value of the fund's holdings. In the worst case, the fund's discount will steepen.The risks: Many closed-end income funds borrow to invest, which can amplify their yields but increase their price sensitivity to changes in interest rates. Most CEFs have higher expense ratios than mutual funds or ETFs, too.
How to invest: Ares Dynamic Credit Allocation Fund ( ARDC , $15, 8.5%) invests in a mix of senior bank loans and corporate bonds, almost all of which are rated below investment grade. Borrowed money as a percentage of assets -- an important indicator for closed-end funds known as the leverage ratio -- is 29.6%, which is a tad lower than the average of 33% for closed-end funds overall. The fund's discount to the value of its holdings has been narrowing of late but still stands at 12.1%, compared with 11.2%, on average, for the past three years.
Advent Claymore Convertible Securities and Income Fund ( AVK , $15, 9.4%), run by Guggenheim Investments, specializes in convertible bonds, which can be exchanged for common stock under some conditions. The fund also holds some high-yield bonds. Currently, it's goosing returns with 40% leverage, which means there's above-average risk if rates rise. For intrepid investors, the fund is a bargain, selling at a discount of 10.6%, about average for the past three years.
Clearbridge Energy Midstream Opportunity ( EMO , $9, 9.7%) invests in energy master limited partnerships. It sells at a 12.1% discount, compared with a 6.6% average discount for the past three years. Its leverage ratio is 33% -- about average for similar closed-end funds.
SEE ALSO: The 10 Best Closed-End Funds (CEFs) for 2019
Mar 31, 2019 | medium.com
Mar 31, 2019 | www.bloomberg.com
The global bond market's soaring performance has left investors queasy about the ride ahead.
The Bloomberg Barclays Global Aggregate index has earned 2.3 percent through March 28, its best quarter since mid-2017. But with yields sinking across major sovereign markets, investors now face a dilemma. Buying government bonds at these levels is perilous because economic data may improve, while taking more risk could leave investors nastily exposed to a global downturn.
Mar 26, 2019 | peakoilbarrel.com
Watcher 03/24/2019 at 10:25 am
Re shale financing . . . Folks should go and read financial articles from Wednesday afternoon of this week.The Fed basically took a sledgehammer to their dot charts. In the ongoing desire on their part to be transparent they have, until Wed., projected their expectations for increases to short-term rates over the next two years to be 4 increases this year and 4 next year.
As of Wednesday, that's all gone. The new dot chart says zero increases this year and at most 1 next year. The 10-year treasury immediately cratered its yield to 2.5something percent. Still falling. Overseas we see Germany tracking, and Japan, and more and more maturities on their yield curves return to negative. Not just real negative. Outright nominal negative.
This is something that Financial media does not talk about. Negative nominal interest rates from major country government bonds. How could they talk about it? It is utterly obvious that this specific reality demonstrates that the entirety of all analyses has no meaning. Their only defense is silence. Shale would prefer that it stay that way.
The Fed also announced an end to balance sheet normalization, which is euphemism for trying to get rid of all of those bonds and MBS that were purchased as part of QE. They are ending their purchases late this year. They dare not continue the move towards normal. I believe that leaves their balance sheet still holding in excess of 3 trillion. That's not normalization, sports fans. And it has been TEN YEARS.They havent been able to get to "normal" in ten years, and as of Wed, they will stop trying.
The Treasury notes are the underlying basis for what shale companies have to pay to borrow money. Thoughts by folks here that the monetary gravy train will shut off shale drilling need rethinking. Bernanke changed everything. Forever.
These Fed actions are indistinguishable from whimsy. Imagining that Powell is Peak Oil cognizant and is focused on shale is a tad extreme, but only a tad.
I recall a Bernanke quote during the crisis that made clear he knew what Peak would mean -- at any price.
Mar 25, 2019 | www.bloomberg.com
"Bond markets globally, along with dovish central banks, have been telling us a slowdown is on the way," said Jeffrey Halley, senior market analyst at Oanda Corp. in Singapore. "Some parts of the world will be better equipped than others to handle this. The U.S. can at least cut rates and apply monetary tools, while things could be worse for Europe and Japan, where they cannot."
Mar 22, 2019 | www.zerohedge.com
He said the stock market, for now, "likes the fact that they (the Fed) aren't going to give them any problems."
But things could change quickly and dramatically, he said, with his final comment, the most ominous:
"It feels eerily like '07," he said.
" The stock market is near its high and the economy is noticeably weaker - and yet everyone is saying 'Everything is Great! '"
And just in case you wondered how bad the underlying is - despite equity market's enthusiasm - Citi's Economic Data Change index as its worst level since 2009...
Mar 12, 2019 | www.zerohedge.com
Today at 4:15pm EDT, DoubleLine founder Jeff Gundlach is holding his latest live webcast open to investors and casual listeners, titled enticingly 'Highway to Hell', and which we assume will discuss either Brexit, the US-China trade deal, the long-term US debt picture or how this, latest asset bubble finally ends.
Readers can register and follow it live at this address , or clicking on the image below
As usual, we will grab and highlight the most interesting charts from Gundlach's presentation as they come in.
* * *
Gundlach, as usual, starts with one of his favorite charts, the one showing the global central bank balance sheet level juxtaposed to the global market, as the background for the Fed's "180 degree turn" in the stock market's recent rebound, which is understandable since the "S&P was and is in a bear market."
... ... ...
If that wasn't bad enough, Gundlach also said that stocks will take out the December low during the course of 2019 and markets will roll over earlier than they did last year.Shifting from the market to the economy, Gundlach shows that global economic momentum is getting worse across the globe... Gundlach then highlights the sudden collapse in global trade, which would suggest the world is in a global recession.
And yet at the same time, US economic data, at least in the labor market, has never been stronger as Gundlach shows:
Of course, another big red flag is the collapse in December retail sales, and despite the sharp rebound in the January print as we saw yesterday, Gundlach highlights the sharp drop in the 6 month average and highlights it as another potential recessionary risk factor.
Going back to one of his favorite topics, the relentless growth of US debt, Gundlach shows the following chart of debt by sector. Needless to say, it is troubling, and as Gundlach said.
And tied to that, the following new warning on the US interest expense: "The US interest expense is projected by the CBO to explode higher starting yesterday"
Gundlach then went on a rant against MMT, calling it a "crackpot" theory, which is based on a "completely fallacious argument", and adds that "People who have PhDs in economics actually are buying the complete nonsense of MMT which is used to justify a massive socialist program."
Gundlach also discusses the US trade deficit, which recently soared, saying that "the trade deficit is not shrinking but expanding," and the goods deficit is at "an all-time record", which according to Gundlach may hurt Trump's re-election chances.
Having predicted president Trump early, when everyone else was still mocking him, Gundlach admits that he is "not really sure what's going to happen,'' when it comes to the next election. "If you ran on promising a lesser trade deficit'' and elimination of national debt, and both have "exploded" higher, Gundlach thinks it's hard to say that you're winning.
And speaking of the next president, Gundlach suggests that if the economy falls into recession and Trump gets thrown out, we might get the chance to see how MMT, i.e. helicopter money, really works with the next, socialist, president.
Perhaps this is also why to Gundlach "the next big move for the dollar is lower."
Looking ahead, Gundlach also touches on the future of monetary policy, and once again highlights the discrepancy between the bond market, which expects half a rate cut, and the Fed's dot plot which expects three hikes in 2019-2020.
What happens? To Gundlach, "Fed expectations are likely to show capitulation to the Fed this time...the bond market is having none of the Fed's two dots that they revealed in December." He then adds that the Fed "will absolutely drop the 2019 dot," suggesting it may be dropped to 1/2 a hike.
Let it Go , 41 minutes ago link
themarketear , 1 hour ago linkOptimism that a new trade deal will occur between America and China has driven stock markets higher even as data continues to emerge confirming economies across the world continue to slow. It seems much of the current market fervor is based on optimism and hope falls into the category of "irrational exuberance" a term that Allen Greenspan has in the past used to describe unbridled enthusiasm. More on the realities being ignored in the following article.
https://Unbridled Market Euphoria Rooted In Optimism And Hope
GUS100CORRINA , 2 hours ago linkSPX versus US 10 year continues widening. https://themarketear.com/posts/cFmMM1H8UE
cowdiddly , 2 hours ago linkI think with the increasing number of DOOM scenarios issued lately, I may need to go see a therapist.
THE SKY TRULY MAY INDEED BE FALLING!! PROBABLY NOT!!! FEAR promotion is truly running wild!
ElTerco , 2 hours ago linkHmm....Kinda strange call there Jeffy Jeff on those higher interest rates.
Especially considering just today where the 1yr yield is higher than...get this, the 2yr, the 3yr, the 5yr aaaaand the 7year bond. Kinda strange setup for rates exploding higher isn't it? Or if you like to think of it as a belly that sumbuck is getting one BIG pot gut.
NOT BUYING IT BUDDY.
Bam_Man , 3 hours ago linkWhen the BBBs start toppling like dominoes, you'll understand better.
Keter , 2 hours ago linkThis guy just REFUSES to give up with his "higher interest rates" schtick.
He was DEAD WRONG with his call for 4.00%-4.50% on the 10-year UST last year.
He simply refuses to acknowledge that short-tern interest rates will be NEGATIVE in the US within the next 18 months.
Politicians are imbeciles and have no remedies. The US is the least ugly pig of the bunch. The EU needs major structural tax and regulatory reform; open borders with a pervasive social welfare state has proven a recipe for disaster. The US is in similar circumstances, but its tax and regulatory environment are at least rational. It requires massive entitlement and spending reforms with some minor tax hikes on the top end marginal income and capital gains brackets.
Mar 12, 2019 | www.zerohedge.com
Today at 4:15pm EDT, DoubleLine founder Jeff Gundlach is holding his latest live webcast open to investors and casual listeners, titled enticingly 'Highway to Hell', and which we assume will discuss either Brexit, the US-China trade deal, the long-term US debt picture or how this, latest asset bubble finally ends.
Readers can register and follow it live at this address , or clicking on the image below
As usual, we will grab and highlight the most interesting charts from Gundlach's presentation as they come in.
* * *
Gundlach, as usual, starts with one of his favorite charts, the one showing the global central bank balance sheet level juxtaposed to the global market, as the background for the Fed's "180 degree turn" in the stock market's recent rebound, which is understandable since the "S&P was and is in a bear market."
Mar 10, 2019 | finance.yahoo.com
"At this point in the cycle, a pickup in inflation will generally lead to corporate margin compression, which is potentially more supportive of maintaining a long duration stance," Bartolini, lead portfolio manager for U.S. core bond strategies, said after the jobs figures. He sees annual CPI remaining around this report's consensus of 1.6 percent -- the slowest since 2016 -- for a while.
Benchmark 10-year yields enter the week at 2.63 percent, close to the lowest level in two months. In the interest-rate options market, traders have been ramping up positions that target lower yields in five- and 10-year notes.
DougDoug,
The Fed is pretty much DONE with rate hikes, as paying the INTEREST on, 22 Trillion in Debt will get,.. UGLIER and UGLIER ! Especially with, all the new,.. Tax and SPEND Demo'Rat Liberals, coming into, Congress ! "We the People", will be,.. TOAST !!
I'm HOLDING, my "Floating Rate" senior secured, Bond CEF's and my Utility and Tech, CEF's, too ! Drawing NICE Dividends,.. Monthly !
The World is NOT ending for, the USA,.. THANKS,.. to Trump !
Jan 17, 2019 | www.nasdaq.com
NEW YORK, Jan 17 (Reuters) - U.S. fund investors charged into high-yield "junk" bonds during the latest week, pouring in $3.3 billion, the most cash flowing into that market since late 2016, Lipper said on Thursday, boosted by soothing words by Federal Reserve Chairman Jerome Powell.Underscoring investors' appetite for some risk-taking, investors pulled $15 billion net cash from U.S.-based money market funds, according to the Refinitiv research service. For their part, U.S.-based equity mutual funds - which exclude exchange-traded funds - posted inflows of $4.8 billion, Lipper data showed.
Jan 20, 2019 | economistsview.typepad.com
anne , January 17, 2019 at 09:35 AM
http://cepr.net/blogs/beat-the-press/does-william-cohan-s-nyt-tirade-against-low-interest-rates-make-any-senseJanuary 17, 2019
Does William Cohan's New York Times Tirade Against Low Interest Rates Make Any Sense?
By Dean BakerIt doesn't as far as I can tell. Cohan has been on a rant * for years about how high risk corporate bonds are going to default in large numbers and then ... something. It's not clear why most of us should care if some greedy investors get burned as a result of not properly evaluating the risk of corporate bonds. No, there is not a plausible story of a chain of defaults leading to a collapse of the financial system.
But even the basic proposition is largely incoherent. Cohan is upset that the Federal Reserve has maintained relatively low, by historical standards,interest rates through the recovery. He seems to want the Fed to raise interest rates. But then he tells readers:
"After the fifth straight quarterly rate increase, Mr. Trump, worried that the hikes might slow growth or even tip the economy into recession, complained that Mr. Powell would 'turn me into Hoover.' On January 3, the president of the Federal Reserve Bank of Dallas said the Fed should assess the economic outlook before raising short-term interest rates again, a signal that the Fed has hit pause on the rate hikes. Even Mr. Powell has signaled he may be turning more cautious."
It's not clear whether Cohan is disagreeing with the assessment of the impact of higher interest rates, not only by Donald Trump, but also the president of the Dallas Fed, Jerome Powell, and dozens of other economists.
Higher interest rates will slow growth and keep people from getting jobs. The people who would be excluded from jobs are disproportionately African American, Hispanic, and other disadvantaged groups in the labor market. Higher unemployment will also reduce the bargaining power of tens of millions of workers who are currently in a situation to secure real wage increases for the first time since the recession in 2001.
If Cohan had some story of how bad things would happen to the economy if the Fed doesn't raise rates then perhaps it would be worth the harm done by raising rates, but investors losing money on corporate bonds doesn't fit the bill.
* https://www.nytimes.com/2019/01/17/opinion/shutdown-recession.html
Jan 13, 2019 | economistsview.typepad.com
im1dc , January 08, 2019 at 08:44 AM
Goldman's Bond Desk just called for a slower and lower US GDP in 2019"Goldman cuts 10-year Treasury yield target for 2019 to 3%"
By Sunny Oh...Jan 8, 2019...10:45 a.m. ET
"Goldman Sachs has rolled back its call for much higher rates in U.S. government bonds in the U.S., though it still expects a gradual climb from the current muted levels in the Treasury market.
In a Tuesday note, Goldman Sachs said they expect the 10-year yield TMUBMUSD10Y, +0.06% to hit 3% by year-end, a 50 basis point cut from their forecast of 3.5%. Since last week, the benchmark bond yield has steadily risen to 2.710% Tuesday, after hitting an 11-month low of 2.553% last Thursday, according to Tradeweb data.
Bond prices fall as yields climb."...
Jan 13, 2019 | finance.yahoo.com
Confidence in continued economic growth has been waning. A huge majority of chief financial officers around the world say a recession will happen by the end of 2020. Most voters think one will hit by the end of this year.
Now the Goldman Sachs economic research team says that the market shows a roughly 50% chance of a recession over the next year, according to Axios.
Goldman Sachs looked at two different measures: the yield curve slope and credit spreads. The former refers to a graph of government bond interest rates versus the years attaining maturity requires. In a growing economy, interest rates are higher the longer the investment because investors have confidence in the future. A frequent sign of a recession is the inversion of the slope, when investors are uncertain about the future, so are less willing to bet on it.
Credit spreads compare the interest paid by government bonds, which are considered the safest. Corporate bonds, which are riskier, of the same maturity have to offer higher interest rates. As a recession approaches, credit spreads tend to expand, as investors are more worried about companies defaulting on their debt.
However, despite the signs, Goldman Sachs assumes the indicators are wrong and that "recession risk remains fairly low, in the neighborhood of 15% over the next year." The bank has predicted that the S&P 500 will finish 2019 at 3,000, up from the current value just below 2,600.
Jan 12, 2019 | finance.yahoo.com
(Bloomberg) -- Jeffrey Gundlach said yet again that the U.S. economy is gorging on debt.
Echoing many of the themes from his annual "Just Markets" webcast on Tuesday, Gundlach took part in a round-table of 10 of Wall Street's smartest investors for Barron's. He highlighted the dangers especially posed by the U.S. corporate bond market.
Prolific sales of junk bonds and significant growth in investment grade corporate debt, coupled with the Federal Reserve weaning the market off quantitative easing, have resulted in what the DoubleLine Capital LP boss called "an ocean of debt."
The investment manager countered President Donald Trump's claim that he's presiding over the strongest economy ever. The growth is debt-based, he said.
Gundlach's forecast for real GDP expansion this year is just 0.5 percent. Citing numbers spinning out of the USDebtClock.org website, he pointed out that the U.S.'s unfunded liabilities are $122 trillion -- or six times GDP.
"I'm not looking for a terrible economy, but an artificially strong one, due to stimulus spending," Gundlach told the panel. "We have floated incremental debt when we should be doing the opposite if the economy is so strong."
Stock Bear
Gundlach is coming off another year in which his Total Return Bond Fund outperformed its fixed-income peers. It returned 1.8 percent in 2018, the best performance among the 10 largest actively managed U.S. bond funds, according to data compiled by Bloomberg.
Gundlach expects further declines in the U.S. stock market, which recently have steadied after reeling for most of December since the Great Depression. Equities will be weak early in the year and strengthen later in 2019, effectively a reversal of what happened last year, he said.
"So now we are in a bear market, which isn't defined by me as stocks being down 20 percent. A bear market is determined by the way stocks are acting," he said.
Rupal Bhansali, chief investment officer of International & Global Equities at Ariel Investments, picked up on Gundlach's debt theme in the Barron's cover story. Citing General Electric's woes, she urged investors to focus more on balance-sheet risk rather than whether a company could beat or miss earnings. Companies with net cash are worth looking at, she said.
To contact the reporters on this story: James Ludden in New York at [email protected];Hailey Waller in New York at [email protected]
To contact the editors responsible for this story: Matthew G. Miller at [email protected], Ros Krasny
For more articles like this, please visit us at bloomberg.com
Dec 20, 2018 | www.project-syndicate.org
A decade after the subprime bubble burst, a new one seems to be taking its place in the market for corporate collateralized loan obligations. A world economy geared toward increasing the supply of financial assets has hooked market participants and policymakers alike into a global game of Whac-A-Mole.
A recurrent topic in the financial press for much of 2018 has been the rising risks in the emerging market (EM) asset class. Emerging economies are, of course, a very diverse group. But the yields on their sovereign bonds have climbed markedly, as capital inflows to these markets have dwindled amid a general perception of deteriorating conditions . 1
Historically, there has been a tight positive relationship between high-yield US corporate debt instruments and high-yield EM sovereigns. In effect, high-yield US corporate debt is the emerging market that exists within the US economy (let's call it USEM debt). In the course of this year, however, their paths have diverged (see Figure 1). Notably, US corporate yields have failed to rise in tandem with their EM counterparts.
What's driving this divergence? Are financial markets overestimating the risks in EM fixed income (EM yields are "too high")? Or are they underestimating risks in lower-grade US corporates (USEM yields are too low)?
Taking together the current trends and cycles in global factors (US interest rates, the US dollar's strength, and world commodity prices) plus a variety of adverse country-specific economic and political developments that have recently plagued some of the larger EMs, I am inclined to the second interpretation.
In what is still a low-interest-rate environment globally, the perpetual search for yield has found a comparatively new and attractive source in the guise of collateralized loan obligations (CLOs) within the USEM world. According to the Securities Industry and Financial Markets Association, new issues of "conventional" high-yield corporate bonds peaked in 2017 and are off significantly this year (about 35% through November). New issuance activity has shifted to the CLO market, where the amounts outstanding have soared, hitting new peaks almost daily. The S&P/LSTA US Leveraged Loan 100 Index shows an increase of about 70% in early December from its 2012 lows (see Figure 2), with issuance hitting record highs in 2018. In the language of emerging markets, the USEM is attracting large capital inflows.
These CLOs share many similarities with the mortgage-backed securities that set the stage for the subprime crisis a decade ago. During that boom, banks bundled together loans and shed risk from their balance sheets. Over time, this fueled a surge in low-quality lending, as banks did not have to live with the consequences.
Likewise, for those procuring corporate borrowers and bundling corporate CLOs, volume is its own reward, even if this means lowering standards for borrowers' creditworthiness. The share of "Weakest Links" – corporates rated B- or lower (with a negative outlook) – in overall activity has risen markedly since 2013-2015. Furthermore, not only are the newer issues coming from a lower-quality borrower, the covenants on these instruments – provisions designed to ensure compliance with their terms and thus minimize default risk – have also become lax. Covenant-lite issues are on the rise and now account for about 80% of the outstanding volume.
As was the case during the heyday of mortgage-backed securities, there is great investor demand for this debt, reminiscent of the "capital inflow problem" or the " bonanza " phase of the capital flow cycle. A recurring pattern across time and place is that the seeds of financial crises are sown during good times (when bad loans are made). These are good times, as the US economy is at or near full employment.
The record shows that capital-inflow surges often end badly. Any number of factors can shift the cycle from boom to bust. In the case of corporates, the odds of default rise with mounting debt levels, erosion in the value of collateral (for example, oil prices in the case of the US shale industry), and falling equity prices. All three sources of default risk are now salient, and, lacking credible guarantees, the CLO market (like many others) is vulnerable to runs, because the main players are lightly regulated shadow banking institutions.
And then there are the old and well-known concerns about shadow banking in general, which stress both its growing importance and the opaqueness of its links with other parts of the financial sector. Of course, we also hear that a virtue of financing debt through capital markets rather than banks is that the shock of an abrupt re-pricing or write-off will not impair the credit channel to the real economy to the degree that it did in 2008-2009. Moreover, compared to mortgage-backed securities (and the housing market in general), the scale of household balance sheets' exposure to the corporate-debt market is a different order of magnitude.
A decade after the subprime bubble burst, a new one seems to be taking its place – a phenomenon aptly characterized by Ricardo Caballero, Emmanuel Farhi, and Pierre-Olivier Gourinchas as " Financial 'Whac-a-Mole .'" A world economy geared toward increasing the supply of financial assets has hooked us into a global game of waiting for the next bubble to emerge somewhere.
Like the synchronous boom in residential housing prior to 2007 across several advanced markets, CLOs have also gained in popularity in Europe. Higher investor appetite for European CLOs has predictably led to a surge in issuance (up almost 40% in 2018). Japanese banks, desperately seeking higher yields, have swelled the ranks of buyers. The networks for financial contagion, should things turn ugly, are already in place. 1 Carmen M. Reinhart is Professor of the International Financial System at Harvard University's Kennedy School of Government. Douglas Leyendecker Dec 23, 2018 The most important questions isn't when or why this bubble will burst but how we got here in the first place. It all starts with BAD economic and social policies. Now we require more and more "money" to keep the wheels on. Bubble to bubble...this is where we are in the developed world today. When the reboot finally hits there won't be any cryptocurrency because there won't be any internet. This is what happens in a fiat currency system. Read More
- MARCO TEAMNEURS Dec 23, 2018 Certain deterministic outcome such as the one presented by Professor Carmen M. Reinhart fits with the Idols refereed by Francis Bacon in Novum Organum. We will be using financialization until it will be not relevant because something else had emerged or most of us de-merged. This time might be that we are on those moments where something relevant is moving under our feet.
What seems to be making the difference is strength of soft/hard power the CCP (Communist Chinese Party) has to leverage decisions over the world. What happened when in the Subprime Crises Russia called China to together attack capital markets of USA and China refused (according to Mr. Henry Paulson) might have not the same reply this time. Read less
Paul Daley Dec 23, 2018 Good article. But -- do I dare say it -- this time may be different. As Reinhart points out, CLOs do not have heavily engaged public institutions, as was the case with mortgage backed securities and sovereign debt. A collapse in CLO prices would fall largely on private shoulders. And, after their first experiments with QE, central banks should have a better grip on the risks and consequences of asset price support programs in encouraging and sustaining asset price bubbles, and be prepared this time to employ income support measures to sustain real economic activity, if necessary. nigel southway Dec 22, 2018 The best course of action is stop the easy movement of capital across borders that way it stops the phoney wealth transactions caused by a foolish focus on the global economy start more national centered wealth funds Jacob Alhadeff Dec 20, 2018 I had no idea any of this was going on. This was very informative, but I don't know yet exactly what to do with this information. I'm cynical about our ability to avoid such bubbles, but we can prepare for them. In terms of how low/middle income Americans can prepare what would anyone suggest? Also, I'm not looking for advice on investing decisions Read less
- nigel southway Dec 24, 2018 We need to come to terms with who owns capital. It's mostly the nation that created it. The capitalists should only rent it and the traders and globalists have zero rights to it hence the justification for stricter controls
Jan 03, 2019 | finance.yahoo.com
Berkshire, with the third-highest credit rating from both Moody's Investors Service and S&P Global Ratings, is expected to price the debt on Thursday with a spread of 150 to 155 basis points above benchmark Treasuries. The 30-year U.S. yield fell to 2.91 percent on Thursday, the lowest since January 2018.
The other interpretation is that the company chose to refinance with long-term fixed-rate debt because it sees the big drop in 30-year yields as unsustainable. After all, if a borrower expects interest rates to rise in the future, it would prefer to lock in a fixed rate now rather than face higher payments down the road.
Dec 05, 2018 | www.bradford-delong.com
Contra Tim Duy, The Lack of Federal Reserve Maneuvering Room Is Very Worrisome...
This , by the every sharp Tim Duy, strikes me as simply wrong: Contrary to what he says, the Fed has room to combat the next crisis only if the next crisis is not really a crisis, but only a small liquidity hiccup in the financial markets. Anything bigger, and the Federal Reserve will be helpless, and hapless.
Look at the track of the interest rate the Federal Reserve controls -- the short safe nominal interest rate:
In the past third of a century, by my count the Federal Reserve has decided six times that it needs to reduce interest rates in order to raise asset prices and try to lift contractionary pressure off of the economy -- that is, once every five and a half years. Call these: 1985, 1987, 1991, 1998, 2000, and 2007.
Nov 19, 2018 | safehaven.com
Three things are certain: death, taxes, and that the already thin gap between human trader and algo is narrowing ever further.
AllianceBernstein's new virtual assistant can now suggest to fixed income portfolio managers what the best bonds may be to purchase using parameters such as pricing, liquidity and risk, according to Bloomberg . The machine has numerous advantages to humans: "she" can scan millions of data points and identify potential trades in seconds. Plus she never needs to take a cigarette or a bathroom break.
The new virtual assistant, dubbed Skynet 2.0 "Abbie 2.0", specializes in identifying bonds that human portfolio managers have missed. She can also help spot human errors and communicate with similar bots like herself at other firms to arrange trades, making humans redundant. This is the second iteration of AllianceBernstein's electronic assistant which debuted in January of this year, but could only build orders for bonds following precise input from humans.
Sourcing bonds that are easy to trade is done by Abbie 2.0 reaching out to another AB system called ALFA, which stands for Automated Liquidity Filtering and Analytics. The AFLA system gathers bids and asks from dealers and electronic trading venues to work out the best possible trades.
For now, humans are still required: Jeff Skoglund, chief operating officer of fixed income at AB told Bloomberg that "humans and machines will need to work closer than ever to find liquidity, trade faster and handle risks. Our hope is that we grow and use people in ways that are more efficient and better leverage their skills."
What he really means is that his hope is to fire as many expensive traders and PMs as possible to fatten the company's profit margins. Which is why the virtual assistant already helps support a majority, or more than 60 percent of AllianceBernstein's fixed income trades. The "upgrades" that are coming for the new assistant will help it include high-yielding investment grade bonds, before expanding to other more complex markets in the coming months. AB says that they will still rely on humans to make the final decisions on trades. For now. Related: IBM Launchs Global Payments System With New Stablecoin
While the original version of the assistant had to be told how much a portfolio manager wanted of a specific bond, the new version now mines data pools to be proactive, making sizing suggestions to portfolio managers. Among other things, the assistant looks at ratings of companies, capital structure and macro data such as social and geopolitical risks.
This is just another step in the industry becoming machine oriented in order to help cut costs, save time and avoid errors, especially in relatively illiquid bond markets. Liquidity could become even more of a factor if the economy slips into recession over the next couple of years.
Electronic trading in general is becoming more pronounced in fixed income as banks act more like exchanges instead of holding bonds on their balance sheet. All the while, regulations have encouraged the shifting of bond trading to exchanges. More than 80 percent of investors in high-grade bonds use electronic platforms, accounting for 20 percent of volume, according to Bloomberg.
Skoglund concluded, "We expect to be faster to market and capture opportunities we otherwise would not have caught by using this system. There's a liquidity problem right now that could become significantly more challenging in a risk-off environment."
By Zerohedge
Nov 15, 2018 | investornews.vanguard
Fund news We're introducing a new active bond fund that allows you to take advantage of Vanguard's extensive global investment management capabilities and expertise. Vanguard Global Credit Bond Fund ( Admiral™ Shares: VGCAX ; Investor Shares: VGCIX ) gives you unique access to the global credit market, which includes both U.S. and international investments. The fund will be managed by the Vanguard Fixed Income Group, which has more than 35 years of experience managing active bond portfolios.Key potential benefits of the fund include:
Which bond fund is right for you?
- Lower volatility. The fund's global diversification reduces the impact of country-specific risks. This can help lower volatility relative to a U.S.-only credit fund.
- Higher returns. Rather than government-guaranteed bonds, the fund will hold mostly investment-grade credit bonds. These corporate and noncorporate obligations typically offer higher yields than their government-guaranteed counterparts. In addition, the fund has a global -- rather than a U.S.-only -- scope. This creates greater opportunity for value-added investments.
- Competitive value through active management. The fund will seek to deliver consistent outperformance with a goal of beating its benchmark, the Bloomberg Barclays Global Aggregate Credit Index (USD Hedged). It will do this at a lower cost than most competing funds, with expense ratios of 0.25% for Admiral Shares and 0.35% for Investor Shares. For comparison, the asset-weighted average expense ratio of its active peer funds in the world bond category is 0.65%.*
We've recently expanded our bond offerings to provide more options for diversification and income. While more choices can help you build a better portfolio, they can also make it tricky to decide which funds are right for you.
Here's a chart that shows, at a glance, the main differences between 3 similar bond funds:
Making the most of Vanguard's management resources
Global or U.S.-only Investment type Bond issuer types It might be right for you if you want: Vanguard Global Credit Bond Fund Global Actively managed mutual fund Investment-grade corporate and government-related entities An actively managed bond fund that provides global exposure to nongovernment bonds. Vanguard Total World Bond ETF Global Index ETF (exchange-traded fund) Broad investment-grade market coverage of Treasuries and government-related, securitized, and corporate debt An all-in-one, low-cost global bond ETF. Vanguard Intermediate-Term Investment-Grade Fund U.S. Actively managed mutual fund Investment-grade corporate and government-related entities An actively managed bond fund that focuses on U.S., nongovernment exposure. Vanguard Global Credit Bond Fund will complement Vanguard's existing suite of 25 actively managed fixed income funds, not including Vanguard's actively managed money market funds.
Vanguard launched its first internally managed active fixed income fund in 1982 and the world's first bond index fund in 1986. Vanguard is one of the world's largest fixed income fund managers with approximately $1.3 trillion in assets under management.** Over $600 billion of those assets are in actively managed fixed income funds (including money markets).
The Vanguard Fixed Income Group has more than 175 global fixed income professionals, 90 of whom are part of the active taxable fixed income team, including over 30 global credit research analysts around the world.
Vanguard Global Credit Bond Fund is the first Vanguard fund of its kind. This globally diversified, actively managed bond product capitalizes on Vanguard's extensive global investment capabilities and global credit expertise.
*Source: Morningstar, Inc., as of September 30, 2018.
**Data as of September 30, 2018.
Oct 12, 2018 | www.zerohedge.com
Yields to maturity on 10-year U.S. Treasury notes are now at their highest level since April 2011. The current yield to maturity is 3.21%, a significant rise from 1.387% which the market touched on July 7, 2016 in the immediate aftermath of Brexit and a flight to quality in U.S. dollars and U.S. Treasury notes.
The Treasury market is volatile with lots of rallies and reversals, but the overall trend since 2016 has been higher yields and lower prices.
The consensus of opinion is that the bull market that began in 1981 is finally over and a new bear market with higher yields and losses for bondholders has begun. Everyone from bond guru Bill Gross to bond king Jeff Gundlach is warning that the bear has finally arrived.
I disagree.
It's true that bond yields have backed up sharply and prices have come down in recent months. Yet, we've seen this movie before. Yields went from 2.4% to 3.6% between October 2010 and February 2011 before falling to 1.5% in June 2012.
Yields also rose from 1.67% in April 2013 to 3.0% in December 2013 before falling again to 1.67% by January 2015. In short, numerous bond market routs have been followed by major bond market rallies in the past ten years.
To paraphrase Mark Twain, reports of the death of the bond market rally have been "greatly exaggerated." The bull market still has legs. The key is to spot the inflection points in each bear move and buy the bonds in time to reap huge gains in the next rally.
That's where the market is now, at an inflection point. Investors who ignore the bear market mantra and buy bonds at these levels stand to make enormous gains in the coming rally.
The opportunity is illustrated in the chart below. This chart shows relative long and short positions in ten major trading instruments based on futures trading data. The 10-year U.S. Treasury note is listed as "10Y US."
As is shown, this is the most extreme short position in markets today. It is even more short than gold and soybeans, which are heavily out of favor. It takes a brave investor to go long when the rest of the market is so heavily short.
Jul 09, 2018 | www.nakedcapitalism.com
So this has become a popular recession indicator that has cropped up a lot in the discussions of various Fed governors since last year. Today, the two-year yield closed at 2.55% and the 10-year yield at 2.84%. The spread between them was just 29 basis points, the lowest since before the Financial Crisis.
The chart below shows the yield curves on December 14, 2016, when the Fed got serious about raising rates (black line); and today (red line). Note how the red line has "flattened" between the two-year and the 10-year markers, and how the spread has narrowed to just 29 basis points:
... ... ...
So just in the nick of time, with the spread between the two-year and the 10-year yields approaching zero, the Fed begins the process of throwing out that indicator and replacing it with a new indicator it came up with that doesn't suffer from these distortions.And I have to agree that the Fed's gyrations over the past 10 years have distorted the markets, have muddled the calculations, have surgically removed "fundamentals" as a consideration for the markets, and have brainwashed the markets into believing that the Fed will always bail them out at the smallest dip. And the yield curve, reflecting all those distortions to some extent, might have become worthless as an indicator of anything other than those distortions.
ambrit , July 7, 2018 at 5:22 am
Skip Intro , July 8, 2018 at 1:32 amIsn't the Fed theoretically independent? Why then should they take cognizance of what the President, or, for that matter, any politician wants? The Feds behaviour over the last decade has demonstrated institutional capture in its' purest form. Everything for the financial sector and nothing for the "Main Street" sector.
The Fed is carrying out a grand experiment. Do these 'Quaint Quant Quotients' have a measurable relationship to the 'Real World' or do they not? My criteria for how well this 'realignment' amongst the 'Financial Stars' works out is going to be the severity of the next "Recession."
jrs , July 8, 2018 at 1:53 amTo be fair, Obama himself was provided by Citigroup.
skippy , July 8, 2018 at 2:33 amI guess a possibility is the Fed let's the economy get really bad (not that we haven't seen that recently even but it could be worse) in order to punish Trump. Yea but people are going to suffer and die in the next recession, they not only already do in recessions anyway, but there is literally no economic slack in most people's lives anymore. Yea this whole economic system is screwy as can be, but if they produce mass unemployment we need a guaranteed income at that point just to keep people from dying.
Jim Haygood , July 7, 2018 at 9:08 amPlease jrs read about the broader ideological opinions of those that forwarded a UBI or GI, same mob wrt the Chicago plan.
Jim Haygood , July 7, 2018 at 9:38 am"(Don't Fear) the Yield Curve" is the title of the staff paper, riffing on "(Don't Fear) the Reaper" by Blue Oyster Cult which evidently still exerts a powerful sway on the Fed's balding eggheads 42 years on.
What distinguishes this model is its use of an interest rate dear to the hearts of economists but absent from bond market quotes: the forward rate . Or as the Blue Oyster Cult fanboys explain:
The current level of the forward rate 6 quarters ahead is inferred from the yields to maturity on Treasury notes maturing 6 quarters from now and 7 quarters from now. In particular, it is the rate that would have to be earned on a 3-month Treasury bill purchased six quarters from now that would equate the results from two investment strategies: simply investing in a Treasury note that matures 7 quarters from now versus investing in a Treasury note that matures 6 quarters from now and reinvesting proceeds in that 3-month Treasury bill.
Not a big deal to calculate -- so voracious is Big Gov's appetite for borrowing as we approach the promised land of "trillion dollar deficits forever" that 2-year T-notes are auctioned monthly, meaning there's always a handy pair of notes with maturities 18 and 21 months ahead whose yields can be used to derive the 6q7q forward rate for the long end of the spread.
The joke is likely to be on the Fed, though. As their chart shows, the 0-6q forward spread is volatile, and could well lurch down to meet the 2y10y spread any time. Moreover, despite the June 28th date on the staff paper, the chart is stale, showing a 0.5%-plus value for the 2y10y spread which last existed several months ago.
In other words, prepare to hoist the Fedsters on their own forward-rate petard.
And they ran to us
Then they started to fly
They looked backward and said goodbye
They had become like we are-- (Don't Fear) the Reaper
Synoia , July 7, 2018 at 1:31 pmFrom the WSJ's Treasury page, the yield on a note due 12/31/2019 is 2.470%, while the 3/31/2020 note yields 2.511%. Yield on the current 3mo T-bill is 1.951%.
http://wsj.com/mdc/public/page/mdc_bonds.html?mod=topnav_2_3020
Doing a little exponential maff, we can derive a 6q7q forward rate of 2.76%, for a spread of 0.81% over the current 3mo T-bill. This compares to a 2y10y spread of only 0.28%.
So according to the Fed's shiny new moved goalpost, there's room for three more rate hikes, whereas the old goalpost would've allowed just one.
Carry on, lads
Jim Haygood , July 7, 2018 at 2:14 pmIf the policy is not supported by the understanding of the evidence, change the understanding.
Seems very reasonable. For witchcraft.
See -- she floats = A Witch! Kill her.
See– she sinks = Not a witch. Dies.Outcome -- as desired.
aka: Tell the Boss what he wants to hear.
Chauncey Gardiner , July 7, 2018 at 3:04 pmWe're gonna hold the Boss responsible with our own data. Here are the traditional 2y10y and new 6q7q fwd yield curves for 2018:
First one to hit the x-axis is the crack of doom.
Note that the two curves almost coincided on Feb 9th, and could do again one day soon. :-)
Jim Haygood , July 7, 2018 at 4:13 pmIt is well within the Fed's capabilities to sell Treasury and Agency bonds with maturities concentrated in the long end of the yield curve. Were the Fed to do that, particularly against a backdrop of deep corporate tax cuts and the resultant increased supply of Treasury debt, what is likely to happen to mortgage rates, real estate and collateral values?
I suspect the people complaining loudest about this emergent Fed policy are those who have benefited most from both longtime negative real interest rates and a positively sloping yield curve. Those were lucrative monetary policy features for them over the past nine years.
bruce wilder , July 7, 2018 at 10:49 amOne more note in the Fed's chart, the new 6q7q fwd spread dips below zero during the Russia/LTCM crisis in 1998, whereas the 2y10y spread didn't.
So it's not quite as reliable. When both go negative, it's " game ovahhhhh "
Blue Pilgrim , July 7, 2018 at 12:12 pmI have long been annoyed by the way Fed staff / hobbyists blithely treat the yield curve as just another "indicator", as if they were forecasting the weather from changes in barometric pressure or temperature.
Seeking a forecasting crystal in a calculated "forward" rate, supposedly mirroring "expectations" of (a representative?) investors reflects a world view that imagines economic actors confidently act on expectations that they believe will be fulfilled. It is not taking uncertainty seriously.
The yield curve has worked not thru magic, but because it reflects a fundamental mechanism of sorts that drives credit and the transformation of maturities: that some key institutions borrow short and lend long, to coin a phrase, in the creation of credit that typically drives the expansion of business activity. Inverting the yield curve forces the contraction of credit by institutions that hedge a borrow short, lend long strategy with Treasuries.
It probably is not lost on those with a memory of past cycles that speculation about whether things will be different this time with regard to the yield curve qua indicator emerges regularly from Fed hobbyshops near the end of very long expansions. If memory serves the Cleveland Fed research shop circulated such speculation in the 2005-7 period.
Admittedly, I haven't had my coffee yet, but I think I may have reached a conclusion: a country whose economic system can't be understood in an hour is doomed to failure.
Nov 29, 2017 | economistsview.typepad.com
Christopher H. , November 25, 2017 at 12:54 PM
https://www.nytimes.com/2017/11/22/business/economy/fed-interest-rates.htmlGibbon1 -> Christopher H.... , November 26, 2017 at 04:12 AMFed gonna raise rates:
"A minority of Fed officials, however, have become increasingly forceful in registering their concerns. Those officials are more worried about moving too fast than too slow. They fear that the persistence of sluggish inflation could damage the economy, for example, by permanently eroding public expectations about the future pace of inflation.
The minutes said that some of those officials are reluctant to vote for additional rate increases until they are convinced that inflation is indeed gaining strength.
The officials "indicated that their decision about whether to increase the target range in the near term would depend importantly on whether the upcoming economic data boosted their confidence that inflation was headed toward the Committee's objective.""
Some dissents? I hope so.
[sluggish inflation could damage the economy, for example, by permanently eroding public expectations about the future pace of inflation.]RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to Christopher H.... , November 26, 2017 at 11:04 AMLow inflation means no way to get out from under debt via refinancing. If people won't take debt how will late stage capitalists make money?
"... permanently eroding public expectations about the future pace of inflation..."Christopher H. said in reply to RC AKA Darryl, Ron... , November 26, 2017 at 12:27 PM[The public, being voting age people at large and all working people and so on, really would rather not expect any inflation at all. It usually does not work out for them all that well since food prices and other headline inflation goods often rise ahead of wages and core inflation goods. The public is not going to bail us out of this one. Poor and lower middle income people do not even have mortgages to refinance. Economic illiteracy among the public is not our friend. The establishment however cannot afford to make the public more economically literate for fear they will understand how the balance of trade over the last forty year has ripped them off.]
"It usually does not work out for them all that well since food prices and other headline inflation goods often rise ahead of wages and core inflation goods."Christopher H. said in reply to RC AKA Darryl, Ron... , November 26, 2017 at 12:34 PMPeople also don't like being taxed to pay for infrastructure and public services.
Except for older voters, most people in advanced nations have never experienced moderate inflation.
If macro policy was done entirely by fiscal policy/better trade policy and interest rates were left alone, we'd still see higher inflation after years of running the economy hot.
I just think that had the government did more fiscal/monetary policy after the financial crisis and allowed inflation to run over target instead of being paranoid about accelerating inflation, the recovery would have been much quicker and people would have been much happier even with a little inflation. Hillary would have won and inflation expectations would be higher among people who think about such things.RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to Christopher H.... , November 26, 2017 at 01:44 PMOH, I totally agree with you. But getting the public aroused about inflation that is too low is entirely a different thing.ilsm -> Christopher H.... , November 26, 2017 at 02:08 PMInflation means you pay the "loan*" with ever "cheaper" dollars from your fixed labor input receiving higher wages, more dollars.Julio -> ilsm... , November 26, 2017 at 09:05 PMAlso inflation means your "collateral" is worth more dollars than the original note.
That went awry post 2000 for whatever reasons, longer run root causes than we know.
*makes sense not to add to the loan, aka the "American dream"+.
+need post mortem and eulogy!*
*'make America great again' is a eulogy of sorts.
"*'make America great again' is a eulogy of sorts."cm -> RC AKA Darryl, Ron... , November 26, 2017 at 06:32 PM
[Classic.]When sellers of groceries, household goods, utility services, etc. can successfully raise prices, then shouldn't one think there is still untapped consumer surplus? People with "extra money" will probably pay more, what do people with no extra money do? Buy less, substitute down, forgo other more discretionary expenses? Shift other expenses to loaned money? Furniture and appliances have always had financing programs, not obvious that more is bought on loan.cm -> cm... , November 26, 2017 at 06:34 PM
OTOH where I'm currently shopping, it seems grocery prices were stable over the last year. OTOH "sales" and other frequent short term price variations are of a larger magnitude than inflation, so it's hard to tell. But a number of years ago I have definitely noticed YOY price moves - not so now.RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to cm... , November 27, 2017 at 05:02 AMGrocery stores operate with very thing margins. Retail prices rise when wholesale prices rise. Rising transportation fuel costs can push wholesale grocery prices, but a lot of food prices has to do with supply variances due to weather. Demand is not very price elastic on staples, but luxury demand can fall severely with rising prices. Chuck roast is more of a staple for many people. Filet mignon is a luxury for most people. Or maybe milk is a staple and candy is a luxury most of the time.RC AKA Darryl, Ron said in reply to RC AKA Darryl, Ron... , November 27, 2017 at 05:02 AM"...THIN margins..."
Bloomberg Business
Citigroup analysts led by Anindya Basu point out that spreads on the CDX HY, as the index is known, are currently pricing in an expected loss of 21.2 percent, which translates into something like 22 defaults over the next five years if one assumes zero recovery for investors. That is a pretty big number once you consider that a total of 41 CDX HY constituents have defaulted since the index really began trading in 2005, equating to about 3.72 defaults per year. A big chunk of those defaults (17) occurred in 2009 in the aftermath of the financial crisis.
What to make of it all? Actual recoveries during corporate default cycles tend to be higher than the worst-case scenario of zero percent. In fact, they average somewhere in the 26 percent range, which would imply 29 defaults over the next five years instead of 41.
So what? you might say. The CDX HY includes but one default cycle, and those types of analyses tend to underestimate the peril of tail risk scenarios (hello, subprime crisis). Citi has an answer for that, too. Using spreads from the cash bond market going back to 1991, they forecast the default rate over the next 12 months to be something more like 5 percent to 5.5 percent. (For comparison, the rating agency Moody's is currently forecasting a 3.77 percent default rate.)
blogs.barrons.com
,,,,The Vanguard Core Bond Fund, unveiled in a filing with regulators on Monday, is being billed as an actively managed alternative to index funds like the Total Bond Market fund (VBMFX, VBTLX, BND). Its launch, slated for the first three months of 2016, would coincide with a period of great uncertainty in the bond markets. The Fed could mull its next interest-rate hike as soon as March.
... ... ...
Daniel Wiener, editor of the Independent Adviser for Vanguard Investors newsletter and a close watcher of all things Vanguard, was quick to note that the fund could invest in bonds of "any quality." The new fund's fine print shows leeway for Vanguard's portfolio managers to plunk up to 5% of the portfolio in junk bonds. Some 30% of the fund could fall into "medium-quality" bonds.
Vanguard's existing offering in junk debt, the Vanguard High-Yield Corporate Fund (VWEHX, VWEAX), is managed by Wellington Management Company.
Says Wiener: "Vanguard has never offered lesser-quality bond funds run by its internal group. The junk portion of the Core Bond product will be a first."
peakoilbarrel.com
Jeffrey J. Brown, 12/13/2015 at 4:06 pmInteresting WSJ article (do a Google Search for the title, for access). Last week, the Journal noted that Chesapeake bonds that traded at 80¢ on the dollar a few months ago were currently trading at 30¢ to 40¢ on the dollar. I suspect that there are some huge losses on the books of a lot of pension funds.WSJ: The Liquidity Trap That's Spooking Bond Funds
The specter of a destabilizing run on debt is haunting marketsThe debt world is haunted by a specter-of a destabilizing run on markets.
Last week, this took on more form even if there weren't concrete signs of panic. Only one mutual fund manager, Third Avenue Management, has said it would halt redemptions to forestall having to dispose of assets in a fire sale. The rest of the industry has been quick to say that while redemptions are elevated, particularly in high-yield bond funds, there doesn't seem to be a rush to for the exits.
Still, growing angst comes as the oil-price rout continues and the U.S. Federal Reserve appears ready to raise rates. This has investors worried-and starting to ask the fearful question: "Who's next?"
Goldman Sachs, for one, put out a note Friday warning Franklin Resources "is most at risk" given the large high-yield holdings of its funds, poor performance and large outflows. On Friday, its shares fell sharply. Meanwhile, there were unusually large declines Friday in the value of exchange-traded funds that track high-yield debt.
The idea of a "run" on mutual funds might sound strange. Typically, runs are associated with highly leveraged banks engaged in maturity transformation, funding long-term loans with short-term debt. Nearly all the programs designed to avoid destabilizing runs-from deposit insurance to the Fed's discount window to liquidity requirements-are built for banks. But unleveraged investors, including mutual funds, can also give rise to runs. That is because there is a liquidity mismatch in mutual funds that hold relatively illiquid assets funded by investors entitled to daily redemptions.
naked capitalism
MikeNY December 12, 2015 at 6:41 amtimmy December 12, 2015 at 9:39 amYes, junk is usually the canary in the coal mine. The HY market melted in the Summer of 2008, months before equities noticed what was going on. The question really is how much contagion there will be: how many CDS have been written on the distressed names, who holds them, etc. My instinct tells me that there are considerably less CDS on junk than were written on MBS, due to the smaller market, the lower liquidity and (supposed) credit quality. But how much has that changed since 2008? I dunno.
One thing I do know: it's like the movie "Groundhog Day". The Fed always overstimulates, and there always follows a crash. Are there any bubbles left to blow, to 'reflate' assets next time?
Jim Haygood December 12, 2015 at 1:39 pmYour remark on written CDS is important. While it may be difficult to get liquidity on distressed names, it is less so on credit tiers above that or on indices. I'm sure there is some on junk, yes, but the real opportunity for spec CDS is (perhaps, was) on the BBB space which is the largest category in the investment grade market and is more liquid. While it may take awhile for distressed trading to creep up the credit ratings to the larger and more liquid names (specifically, since the definition of liquidity seems to be important on NC: the size of the specific issues' float, approximated with average daily volume), they will also have larger moves because potential fallen angels are repriced aggressively in an unstable market. The other thing about CDS is that they are most often delta-hedged which requires dealers to sell proxy's as the CDS go deeper into the money. The one restraining factor is that once a crisis is in motion, I think its going to be difficult for specs to get more CDS on their books. This strategy is purely directional (this is not an ETF NAV arb), essentially owning out of the money puts with minimal cost of carry.
Mike Sparrow December 12, 2015 at 3:48 pm'Their investing strategy – putting high-risk investments into a mutual fund – seems like exactly what not to do.'
It cuts two ways. Junk ETFs such as JNK and HYG have badly underperformed their benchmarks, owing to buying and selling in an illiquid market to replicate an index. Whereas actively managed junk mutual funds have the flexibility to deviate from index holdings in ways that can add a couple of hundred basis points a year.
That said, both junk ETFs and junk mutual funds are offering daily liquidity, while holding underlying securities that may trade once a week, or have no bids at all. As David Dayen observes, this sets up the risk of a bank run when investors get spooked.
Take a look at the "power dive" chart of TFCIX (Third Avenue Focused Credit Fund) - Aiieeeeee!
http://bigcharts.marketwatch.com/quickchart/quickchart.asp?symb=tfcix&insttype=&freq=&show=
Now the question is contagion. Morningstar shows that 48% of TFCIX's portfolio was below B rating, and 41% had no bond rating. Most junk funds don't have THAT ugly a portfolio. But when the herd starts to stampede, fine distinctions can get lost in the dust cloud from the thundering hooves.
Over to you, J-Yel. Do you feel lucky, cherie? Well, do you?
Keith December 12, 2015 at 7:27 amThere is no CDS. There just isn't less, there is none. The stock market has pretty much ignored it as well except that its move from 13000 to 18000 has temporarily stalled. I suspect by the spring, this will be old news.
I think we make errors here, not understanding this particular type of financial speculation is "anti-growth" in general. This would probably blow most of the minds on this board.
Keith December 12, 2015 at 7:29 amMany years ago when Alan Greenspan first proposed using monetary policy to control economies, the critics said this was far too broad a brush.
After the dot.com crash Alan Greenspan loosened monetary policy to get the economy going again. The broad brush effect stoked a housing boom.
When he tightened interest rates, to cool down the economy, the broad brush effect burst the housing bubble. The teaser rate mortgages unfortunately introduced enough of a delay so that cause and effect were too far apart to see the consequences of interest rate rises as they were occurring.
The end result 2008.
With this total failure of monetary policy to control an economy and a clear demonstration of the broad brush effect behind us, everyone decided to use the same idea after 2008.
Interest rates are at rock bottom around the globe, with trillions of QE pumped into the global economy.
The broad brush effect has blown bubbles everywhere.
"9 August 2007 – BNP Paribas freeze three of their funds, indicating that they have no way of valuing the complex assets inside them known as collateralised debt obligations (CDOs), or packages of sub-prime loans. It is the first major bank to acknowledge the risk of exposure to sub-prime mortgage markets. Adam Applegarth (right), Northern Rock's chief executive, later says that it was "the day the world changed"
10th December 2015 – "Moments ago, we learned courtesy of the head of Mutual Fund Research at Morningstar, Russ Kinnel, that the next leg of the junk bond crisis has officially arrived, after Third Avenue announced it has blocked investor redemptions from its high yield-heavy Focused Credit Fund, which according to the company has entered a "Plan of Liquidation" effective December 9."
When investor's can't get their money out of funds they panic.Central Bank low interest rate policies encourage investors to look at risky environments to get a reasonable return
Pre-2007 – Sub-prime based complex financial instruments
Now – Junk bondsThe ball is rolling and the second hedge fund has closed its doors, investors money is trapped in a world of loss.
"Here Is "Gate" #2: $1.3 Billion Hedge Fund Founded By Ex-Bear Stearns Traders, Just Suspended Redemptions"
We know the world is downing in debt and Greece is the best example I can think of that shows the reluctance to admit the debt is unsustainable.
Housing booms and busts across the globe ……
Those bankers have saturated the world with their debt products.
Skippy December 12, 2015 at 7:41 amLinks (which will probably require moderation)
- http://www.theguardian.com/business/2012/aug/07/credit-crunch-boom-bust-timeline
- http://www.zerohedge.com/news/2015-12-10/next-leg-junk-bond-crisis-third-avenue-focused-credit-fund-gates-redemptions-liquida
- http://www.zerohedge.com/news/2015-12-11/here-gate-2-13-billion-stone-lion-capital-suspends-redemptions
Quality of instruments impaired by corruption has a more deleterious effect than quantities of could ever imagine…
David December 12, 2015 at 10:33 am
tegnost December 12, 2015 at 10:52 am"Those bankers have saturated the world with their debt products."
I'm no apologist for Banksters but people bought this "stuff" as the Stuffies.
whether you call it greed or desperation in the face of zero yield – at the end of the day the horizon was short since the last debacle.
getting 2 & 20 or whatever the comp arrangement was for those who are motivated by greed – 2% of $2 Billion yields at least $40 million a year for 5 years or $200 million – not bad for ten guys or less – obviously not fiduciaries – bouncing from Bear to Tudor to Third Ave with no change in the model yields predictable results
I put forth the proposition the "people" deserve their fate – the tea leaves were all there to see
Ian December 12, 2015 at 2:24 pmYour apology is flawed because it assumes equal access to information among investors as well as assuming all investors have the same objective. Institutional investors have different goals than hedge funds for example. The people you refer to have been fleeced that's just ok with you. As to tea leaves the people have been steeped in recovery stories for years.
Ian December 12, 2015 at 2:29 pmAlso fails to recognize the collateral damage caused towards the people that did not directly participate. It is very hard to say that they deserve their fate in this context, in that they were largely powerless to stop it to begin with, at a reasonable level.
I guess you qualified that with focusing solely on the people who bought it. Did not read fully.
Timmy December 12, 2015 at 8:34 am
Jim Haygood December 12, 2015 at 4:25 pmWait, so speculators are shorting big bond positions of distressed funds? No way, hope they aren't doing this to ETF's. Jeez, didn't see this coming. I guess having the positions of big ETF's published daily might assist the speculators.
Timmy December 12, 2015 at 4:51 pmYesterday HYG closed at a 0.76% discount to NAV, while JNK closed at a 0.68% discount (values from Morningstar). These are wider discounts than ETF managers like to see.
The arbitrage mechanism of buying the discounted ETF shares, redeeming them for the underlying, and then selling the bonds at full value for an instant 0.76% gain is supposed to kick in now.
But sell … to whom?
tegnost December 12, 2015 at 9:15 amThe misperception is that the ETF junk trade is an arb right now. Its not, its directional. The discipline to bring NAV's in line with underlying value will only kick in at much wider levels because traders are still long (and putting on more of) the "widener" because they anticipate higher levels of vol going forward.
Actually have already been bracing myself as demand for labor fell off a cliff at the end of sept., and I'm guessing it's stories such as this that makes my customers tighten their belts....
nat scientist December 12, 2015 at 9:55 am
craazyboy December 12, 2015 at 4:26 pm"Some say the world will end in fire
Some say in ice
From what I've tasted of desire
I hold with those who favor (fire) INFLATION
But if it had to (perish) REFINANCE twice,
I think I know enough of (hate) ZIRP RATES
To say that for destruction (ice) NO BID
Is also great
And would suffice."Marty Whitman now gets Robert Frost.
Christer Kamb December 12, 2015 at 1:44 pmAll those junk companies could just declare bankruptcy and start over. That's the way it's supposed to work. Just ask The Donald. Then it would be like that movie where Bruce Willis saved the earth from an asteroid strike. 'Course there was only one asteroid in that movie. Instead, we have World War Z with zombies all over the place!
But maybe JYell will buy all the junk bonds, burn them, and then the dollar will crash and we can all get jobs?
MikeNY December 12, 2015 at 4:25 pmMikeNY said;
"The HY market melted in the Summer of 2008, months before equities noticed what was going on."
Not really. HYG market were in a downtrend during summer of 2007, together with the stockmarket. Also in the 2008 summer both markets were in a severe meltdown. This time around the HYG´s started their downtrend from summer 2014 with the 1:st leg down to dec same year. 2:nd leg is now running in which the stockmarket joined.
Your right, HYG´s seems to be the canaries here! But, from august this year they seems to go in different directions. Or are they?
You're right, it was earlier than Summer 2008, now I think about it.
What I do remember (and I can't remember whether it was Spring of 2008 or earlier), was that HY spreads had gapped out at least a couple of hundred bps, and equities were still at or near all-time highs. I remember sitting in a meeting with a couple I-bankers, who chuckled ruefully "equities haven't a clue".
The received wisdom on the Street is that the bond market is smarter than the equity market. And, at last in my career, it was true, at least as far as downturns went.
Jul 20, 2015 | Zero Hedge
Two months ago, in "ETF Issuers Quietly Prepare For Meltdown With Billions In Emergency Liquidity," we outlined the rather disconcerting circumstances that have led some large fund managers to quietly line up emergency liquidity facilities that can be tapped in the event of a sudden retail exodus from bond funds."The biggest providers of exchange-traded funds, which have been funneling billions of investor dollars into some little-traded corners of the bond market, are bolstering bank credit lines for cash to tap in the event of a market meltdown. Vanguard Group, Guggenheim Investments and First Trust are among U.S. fund companies that have lined up new bank guarantees or expanded ones they already had, recent company filings show," Reuters reported at the time, in a story we suspect did not get the attention it deserved.
At a base level, these precautionary measures are the result of the interplay between central bank policy and the unintended consequences of the post-crisis regulatory regime. ZIRP creates a hunt a for yield and simultaneously incentivizes companies (especially cash strapped companies) to tap the bond market while borrowing costs remain artificially suppressed. Clearly, this is a self-fulfilling prophecy. The longer rates on risk free assets remain near, at, or even below zero, the more demand there is for new corporate issuance (the rationale being that at least corporate credit offers some semblance of yield). More demand means rates on corporate credit are driven still lower, and once yields on high grade issues get close to the lower limit, yield-starved investors are then herded into HY.
All of this supply in the primary market comes at a time when liquidity in the secondary market for corporate credit is non-existent thanks to the shrinking dealer books that resulted from the government's (maybe) well-meaning attempt to crack down on prop trading. The result: a crowded theatre with a tiny exit.
This situation has been exacerbated by the proliferation of bond ETFs which have allowed retail investors to pile into corners of the fixed income world where they might not belong.
All of the above can be summarized as follows.
"MF assets too large versus dealer inventories" (via Citi)...
... clear evidence of "structural damage in corporate bond trading liquidity" (via JP Morgan)...
... and the rapid growth of bond funds in the post-crisis world (via BIS)...
So given the above, the question is this: if something were to spook the market - a rate hike cycle for instance, or an October revolver raid on HY energy names, or an exogenous geopolitical shock - causing an exodus from these funds, what would happen to prices if fund managers were suddenly forced to transact in size in an illiquid secondary market in order to meet redemptions?
"Nothing good", is the answer.
The solution is to avoid selling the underlying bonds - even when investors are selling their shares in the funds.
But how is this possible?
To a certain extent, outflows in one fund can be offset by inflows to another. These "diversifiable flows" are one happy byproduct of the great ETF proliferation. Here's a refresher on how this works courtesy of Barclays.
* * *
Portfolio Products Replace Dealer Inventory
While diversifiable flows limit the risks to portfolio managers in principle, the reality of the high yield market is more complicated. Managers have specific views on tenor, callability, sectors, covenants, and, most importantly, individual credits, such that actually finding buyers for specific bonds can be quite difficult. In the pre-crisis period, dealers ran large inventories that effectively facilitated the netting of flows across funds (Figure 1). A fund with an outflow would sell bonds into the dealer community, and funds with outflows would buy bonds out of the dealer inventory. When inventory is large, the fact that the specific bonds bought and sold did not match was largely irrelevant. Funds with outflows could sell the bonds of their choice, and the funds with inflows could pick investments from the large variety of inventory held by dealers.
The matching problem has become more acute as dealer inventories have declined. Even funds can net flows in principle, dealers are much less willing to warehouse bonds, and are much more likely to buy only when they believe they can quickly offload the risk. Under this scenario, the fact that flows can theoretically be netted is of little practical use to fund managers – actually netting individual bonds is extremely difficult, particularly in the short time frame required by funds offering daily liquidity to end investors.
This is where portfolio products come in. Investors can use portfolio products to fund outflows/invest inflows immediately and execute the necessary single-name bond trades over time as liquidity in the underlying bond market allows (Figure 2). In this scenario, funds with inflows and outflows simply exchange portfolio products, sidestepping the immediate need to trade single-name corporate bonds.
* * *
Ok great, so ETFs provide a kind of "phantom" liquidity if you will. There are two problems with this:
- It only works when flows are diversifiable. Once flows become unidirectional, it all goes out the window.
- It makes the underlying markets even more illiquid.
Here's how we put it last month in "How Fund Managers Use ETF Phantom Liquidity To Avert A Meltdown":
In other words, if I'm a fund manager, the idea that ETFs provide liquidity rests on the assumption that when I experience outflows, someone else will be experiencing inflows and thus I can sell ETFs and avoid offloading my bonds into an illiquid corporate credit market. Put another way: I am depending on new money coming into the market to fund redemptions from previous investors who are exiting the market, all so that I can avoid liquidating assets that are declining in value and that I believe will be difficult to sell. There's a term for that kind of business. It's called a ponzi scheme and just like all other ponzi schemes, when the new money dries up (so, for example, when HY bond ETF flows are all headed in the wrong direction), the only way to meet redemptions is to get what I can for the assets I have and when the market for those assets is thin (as the secondary market for corporate credit most certainly is), I may incur substantial losses.
Note also that the more often ETFs are used as a way of avoiding the underlying bond market, the more illiquid that market becomes, making the situation still more precarious in the event of a panic.
So what is a fund manager to do?
This is where we come full circle to the emergency liquidity lines mentioned at the outset. In order to avoid tapping the underlying illiquid bond market in a situation where flows are unidirectional, fund managers may instead pay out redemptions in borrowed cash.
This is, to quote Citi's Matt King, "creative destruction destroyed."
Only worse.
That is, this represents the willful delay of a long overdue episode of creative destruction layered atop another delay of the much needed Schumpeterian endgame. Stripping out the metaphysics and philosophy references, that can be translated as follows: this strategy is yet another example of delaying the inevitable. If fund managers are forced to tap these liquidity lines it likely means investors have found a reason to sell en masse and if that reason turns out to be something that permanently impairs the value of the underlying bonds (as opposed to a transitory, irrational panic) then all the funds are doing by borrowing to meet redemptions is employing leverage to stave off the recognition of losses, which is ironically the same thing (in principle anyway) that the companies whose bonds they're holding have done to stay in business. It's a delay-and-pray scheme designed to avoid selling the debt of companies whose similar delay-and-pray schemes have run their course.
In closing, it's important to note that no fund manager in the world will be able to line up enough emergency liquidity protection to avoid tapping the corporate credit market in the event of panic selling in the increasingly crowded market for bond funds.
In other words, when the exodus comes, the illiquidity that's been chasing markets for the better part of seven years will finally catch up, and at that point, all bets are officially off.
Economist's View
Stephen G. Cecchetti and Kermit L. Schoenholtz (sort of a follow up on the claim that financial reform is working -- perhaps -- but as noted in the post below this one there is more to do):An Open Letter to Bill McNabb, CEO of Vanguard Group: Dear Mr. McNabb,We find your WSJ op-ed (Wednesday, May 6) misleading, short-sighted, self-serving, and very disappointing.Vanguard has been in the forefront of providing low-cost, reliable access to U.S. and global capital markets to millions of customers, including ourselves. Following the financial crisis of 2007-2009, the firm naturally should be a leader in promoting a more resilient financial system. Your op-ed sadly goes in the opposite direction.Let's start with the most stunning example: your defense of money market mutual funds. MMMFs are simply banks masquerading as professionally managed investment products. Like banks, they engage in liquidity and maturity transformation. Like banks, they faced runs in 2008 that ended only when the federal government provided a guarantee that put taxpayers at risk. Even with that guarantee, the government still had to support many healthy U.S. corporations with household names that – having previously relied on MMMF purchases of their commercial paper – suddenly faced a severe credit crunch. And, to limit a fire sale amidst the crisis, the Federal Reserve had to provide special funding to buyers to help MMMFs unload their assets.Unsurprisingly, fund sponsors and their clients – both creditors and borrowers – want to keep these opaque federal subsidies (especially the implicit guarantees that only become explicit and transparent in a crisis). Like them, you make the false, but popular claim that power-hungry regulators (who wish to limit the subsidies that make future crises more likely) are attacking (taxing!) Main Street instead of Wall Street.In fact, the investment company industry captured its primary regulator long ago, and hasn't let go. The Securities and Exchange Commission's 2014 "reform" of MMMFs is exhibit A. It almost surely makes these funds more, not less, liable to runs (see here and here). And – what a surprise – Congress seems to find protecting U.S. taxpayers from contingent liabilities (like implicit financial guarantees to your industry) less attractive than the largesse of financial lobbyists. Even the voluminous Dodd-Frank Act didn't address MMMFs! :After quite a bit more, they conclude with:
As the CEO of one of the largest mutual fund companies in the world that is dedicated to serving and protecting small investors, you should be in the vanguard of advocating reforms that enhance stability.Instead of complaining about regulation under the guise of protecting Main Street, you should highlight the vulnerabilities in our financial system and make the case for efficient regulation that treats all activities equally. You should also promote investment vehicles that are likely to prove robust in a crisis, while warning about existing products that probably won't be.Only greater resilience in the system can make investors confident that capital markets here and elsewhere will remain strong. That is in Vanguard's interest, too.Sincerely,Stephen G. Cecchetti and Kermit L. Schoenholtzanne -> anne:Stephen Cecchetti and Kermit Schoenholtz are intent on undermining the most important stock and bond investment vehicle for moderately wealthy investors. Vanguard sets the finest of examples for the entire investment industry.
pgl -> anne:
Maybe you are being paid by Vanguard but you are wrong. You are not qualified to comment on financial economics. Stephen Cecchetti and Kermit Schoenholtz are.
And they are not trying to undermine anyone. They are simply telling the truth. Repeat your garbage all you want but it is garbage.
mulp -> anne:
anne:Anne, unless you call the FDIC bailout of the money market funds, and the Fed providing liquidity to them in 2008-9 totally wrong and you should have suffered losses in your holding in MMMF as they marketed to market (breaking the buck) and froze withdrawals until they could liquidate their holdings, or alternatively, declared bankruptcy, then you are totally bought into the free lunch economics of Friedman, Reagan, and all the bank lobbyists dependent on government handling the losses while they reap the profits.
I remember the debate in the late 60s and early 70s on money market funds. We (the People) were assured that MMFs would never be seen as banks by any one investing in them because everyone would know the MMF would someday lose value and in the process freeze the assets for some length of time until the fund could be liquidated.
In other words, not one person putting money in a MMF would see it as a bank that pays higher interest. More importantly, no business or corporation would ever confuse a MMF with a bank.
In 2008, it is clear that the promises made four decades earlier to allow unsophisticated investors access money market funds without lengthy notice of intent to withdraw funds was all a lie, or a belief in tinker bell, pixie dust, and free lunches.
The money market funds should have been left to collapse in 2008 to destroy all faith in them as safe for individuals to use, and in the process, "destroy trillions in wealth" held by tens of millions of upper middle class workers.
I would have lost more than I did in 2008, but the demand for greater government control of the financial sector plus greater social safety nets would have followed.
This is the first time I've seen someone besides me state that mutual funds are banks as we knew them in the 60s, except they pay nothing for the protection of FDIC and Federal Reserve membership.
anne:http://www.nytimes.com/2015/05/10/your-money/fees-on-mutual-funds-fall-thank-yourself.html
May 9, 2015
Fees on Mutual Funds Fall. Thank Yourself.
By JEFF SOMMERWall Street is reaping mounting revenue from mutual funds and exchange-traded funds, yet investors are paying lower fees.
That sounds like a good deal for the millions of people who use the funds to invest their savings, and a great deal for the companies that run and sell the funds.
But that win-win situation is not quite as benign as it would seem. Many investors are still - often unwittingly - paying huge fees that cut into retirement savings.
A new Morningstar study offers an excellent explanation of what is happening. The report, "2015 Fee Study: Investors Are Driving Expense Ratios Down," found that, by one measure, mutual fund and E.T.F. fees paid by individual investors had dropped significantly - 27 percent - over the last 10 years. But it isn't mainly because Wall Street fund managers have been reducing fees. The study found that investors have been voting with their feet, moving money from expensive funds into cheaper ones, like index funds. That drives down the asset-weighted cost of mutual funds, skewing the statistics.
"It's not mainly thanks to the efforts of the fund companies," Michael Rawson, an author of the Morningstar study, said in an interview. "It's mainly because people have gravitated toward lower-cost funds."
There's a good reason for the migration to lower-cost funds: They tend to outperform higher-cost ones. As I've written recently, most actively managed mutual funds don't beat the market; those that do beat it rarely manage the feat consistently. Many consumers have gotten the message. Of the 100 lowest-cost funds on the market in March, 95 were index funds that merely try to match the market, not beat it, according to an unpublished study by the Bogle Financial Markets Research Center. Many investors have chosen index funds.
Yet because of the peculiar economics of the asset management industry, fund companies are still doing great. The companies that run the funds have been reaping outsize rewards because as fund assets have grown - thanks in part to the market's terrific performance over the last six years - the companies' own costs have declined.
That's because of economies of scale that the companies don't share fully with customers. "The cost of individual funds has dropped, but the assets have gotten so much bigger that the companies' revenue from fees has grown tremendously," Mr. Rawson said. "They could be sharing more of those revenues with consumers, but they're not."
Using publicly available documents, the Morningstar researchers estimated that in 2014, fee revenue from all stock and bond mutual funds and E.T.F.s reached a record high of $88 billion, up from $50 billion a decade earlier. Assets under management grew 143 percent, and industry fee revenue surged more than 75 percent. The asset-weighted expense ratio - the funds' publicly declared expenses divided by the actual money that investors put into them - declined, too, but only by 27 percent. "The industry - rather than fund shareholders - has benefited most," the report said. Mr. Rawson, a Morningstar analyst, wrote the report with Ben Johnson, director of global E.T.F. research at the company.
The details are fresh, but the economic machine that propels the asset management business has been whirring along for decades. In a telephone interview last week, John C. Bogle, the founder of Vanguard, the industry's low-cost leader, said that in some ways, running a fund company is like operating a factory. As you ramp up production, it becomes cheaper to produce additional items because important costs - fixed costs - don't rise.
For an asset management company, he said, a stock or bond portfolio is the core product and the intellectual exercise of selecting stocks and bonds for it is a fixed cost. "When you set up and run the portfolio, it's not much more expensive to do it when your fund has, say, $1 billion in assets, than when it had only $30 million," Mr. Bogle said.
"Unless you cut your fees drastically, you're going to generate a lot more money for your company as assets grow," Mr. Bogle said. "But do you think the industry wants you to understand that? Absolutely not. Most fund companies aren't passing those savings on to investors."
Vanguard, which is owned by shareholders of its funds, passes along most of the savings. Morningstar found that Vanguard's average asset-weighted expense ratio in 2014 was 0.14 percent, lower than any of the other top asset management companies and lower than 0.64, the current asset-weighted expense ratio for all funds.
Mr. Bogle says companies should charge a modest, flat fee for setting up a portfolio - not a percentage of assets, charged annually, which is the current practice - and give fund investors the rest of the money. That would not generate the splendid profits that asset management companies and their owners have enjoyed, however.
No wonder that in a rising market, shares of publicly traded asset management companies tend to outperform their own stock portfolios. For example, since the beginning of March 2009, the start of the current bull market, through April, the stock of BlackRock, the giant E.T.F. company, returned 27.1 percent, annualized, compared with 20.8 percent annualized in the iShares Core S&P 500 E.T.F., a BlackRock fund that tracks the Standard & Poor's 500-stock index, according to Bloomberg. You would have been better off investing in BlackRock, the company, than in its own S.&.P. 500 index fund.
Why should mutual fund and E.T.F. investors care about the economics of fund expenses? Because it's the dark side of compounding, a force that can be magical when it works in your favor:.
https://personal.vanguard.com/us/funds/snapshot?FundId=0040&FundIntExt=INT#hist%3A%3Atab=1&tab=1
Vanguard 500 Stock Index Fund
Average annual returns as of 3/31/2015
3/31/2014 ( 12.56%)
3/30/2012 ( 15.93)
3/31/2010 ( 14.29)
3/31/2005 ( 7.89)08/31/1976 ( 11.05)
https://personal.vanguard.com/us/funds/snapshot?FundId=0028&FundIntExt=INT#hist%3A%3Atab=1&tab=1Vanguard Long-Term Investment-Grade Bond Fund
Average annual returns as of 3/31/2015
3/31/2014 ( 14.54%)
3/30/2012 ( 8.42)
3/31/2010 ( 10.34)
3/31/2005 ( 7.49)07/09/1973 ( 8.71)
anne -> anne:
This is what Vanguard has meant for modestly wealthy conservative long term investments since the 1970s. From Warren Buffett to David Swenson, the chief investment officer at Yale, Vanguard has been the recommended vehicle for ordinary stock and bond investors.
Harming Vanguard would be a tragedy.
anne -> anne:
"Harming Vanguard would be a tragedy."
The point is harming Vanguard would be harming the ordinary investors who in effect own Vanguard since Vanguard is indeed a "mutual" fund company, a company owned by fund investors.
Dan Kervick -> anne:
anne -> Dan Kervick:The well-being of modestly wealthy long-term investors is only one factor to consider in relation to the well-being of the entire US and global economy. Shouldn't we broaden the discussion?
Vanguard forms a model for investment well-being in the United States.
Bob:
Anne, having liquidity requirements is not a tax on investors. When McNabb represents it as such, he is lying. There are no new fees or taxes imposed. It just requires that stock funds hold a percentage of assets in safe bonds in order to handle redemptions in panic situation rather than rely on taxpayer bailouts.
Investors are still entitled to 100% of the returns from the fund. Yes, it is true that the total return may be somewhat less because bond returns are typically less than stock returns. However, that isn't a tax or fee on investors.
Almost no investors maintain a 100% stock portfolio. The typical investor my have anywhere from 20% to 80% bonds. So with the liquidity proposal, some portion of the bond assets they hold anyway will be in their stock fund. They can adjust their stock vs bond allocation accordingly, taking into account the bonds held in their stock fund. After this adjustment, they will receive exactly the same total portfolio return as previously.
The idea that this is a tax or fee is simply a lie. Investors still receive 100% of their investment return.
Dan Kervick -> anne:
JohnH: I don't believe Vanguard needs any liquidity requirements because none of its investments use leverage. If money is needed, they would just sell the assets at the current market value and disburse the proceeds.
Well, it seems prima facie plausible that the ability of some firms to deliver very high returns at low cost is due to the amount they have invested in high-risk, high-yield assets. An economy filled with many such firms is going to be an economy with a higher level of systemic risk. If we want a financially safer world, then some rich people are going to have to get richer much more slowly than they did in the past.MMMFs are a little different, because there is the presumption that that value of each share will always be $1, which it will be if short term treasuries are kept to term. In case of a run, the Fed could also buy the treasuries and keep them a few weeks to maturity, as they do under QE.
For funds that use leverage, the risk of a run is entirely different:
Longtooth:
My interpretation of Anne's issue is that she simply favors individualism's credo for the "moderately wealthy" over the rest of our society, and rationalizes her position by believing (in faith) that Vanguard is immune to failure and thus would not be a participant in any new liquidity meltdown, ergo the nation's taxpayers should shoulder the burden of for profit financial investors when such financial markets fail.
I'm not sure what Anne's position is/was related to the meltdown just past.. but she's caught on the horns of dilemma --- either taxpayer's bail out private investors or they suffer an even greater financial and economic calamity.
The whole point of Cecchetti & Schoenholtz open letter is that a) Vanguard is not immune, and b) taxpayers should NOT be placed on the horns of that dilemma again, and thus the Vanguard letter was indeed self-serving and misleading.
EMichael -> Longtooth:
Perfect.
McMike:
Well, the critiques may be technically accurate enough as far as they go.
But I fail to see how attacking one of the last pockets of low-fee, consumer-facing investment helps anyone in the long run, except those who wish to herd all money into complex, opaque, high-fee vehicles.
Money Market "reform" may have found some reasonable-sounding talking points on which to promote itself, but stepping back, one cannot help but see it is simply one more wave in the voracious plunder and elimination of any and all alternatives to the relentless and jealous Wall Street flim flam machine.
anne:
A democratic investment company is a company that is investor owned, that offers the finest quality long term stock and bond funds with minimal transactions or turnover at low management cost for investors with $10,000. For those men and women who prefer to deal with a Goldman Sachs, a suggest giving that company a call and finding the difference.
The idea that a Warren Buffett is paid by Vanguard for recommending Vanguard only shows a failure to understand that Vanguard is owned by investors and there are no payments made to financial advisers for recommending the company.
DeDude -> anne:
If you think the leadership if Vanguard is controlled by and serving its investors - then you need to get out of the Ivory tower a little more.
Leadership in any Wall Street company are always serving themselves first, second and third. It is just that some of them are better at hiding that fact than others.
DeDude:
As much as Vanguard is trying to sell itself as the investors friend on Wall street, their leadership is just as much a part of the Wall street vampire tribe as the rest of them. Yes, they suck less less blood from each victim, but they are still blood-suckers. When I see Vanguard offering a fund that restrict its investments to companies that compensate CEOs less than average (for that industry and size), then I will know they have left the blood-sucker tribe. The one product that would truly serve the interest of investors is not available from any investment company, because as useful as it would be for us it is dangerous for them.
anne:
The descent to profane and violent language on this thread, the descent to intimidation and bullying, is intolerable, horrifying, and meant only to destroy this thread and this blog.
EMichael -> anne:
Personally, I think the constant repetition of a Edwardian rant about language is "intolerable, horrifying, and meant only to destroy this thread and this blog."
As Keynes said, "words ought to be a little wild".
Syaloch -> EMichael:
Amen to that.
Syaloch -> anne:
Am I missing something? Neither "vampire" nor "blood-sucker" is profanity -- unless you mean it in the sense of blasphemous, i.e. criticism of something sacred.
Do you think that this "class of people" who work on Wall Street are holy deities and therefore beyond reproach?
You attitudes toward Vanguard certainly seem to point in that direction:anne -> Syaloch:
These very terms were used to characterize and dehumanize a class of people in the 1930s. These are terrible, fearful terms to use to describe and stereotype people.
anne:
The use of profanity and a metaphor from the 1930s in describing a class of people is intolerable. Paul Krugman made a serious mistake in using a 1930s metaphor in description, both for the dismissing of the decency of the humanness of an entire class of people and for setting an example as to use of the metaphor.
Millions of people were methodically murdered during the 1930s in the wake of a campaign to stereotypically deny their decency, to deny their humanness by using dehumanizing metaphors to describe them.
likbez -> anne:
While behavior that you mentioned are unacceptable, a part of the blame is on you: you demonstrated a perfect example of the psychology of rentier, Anna.
Rentier capitalism is a term used to describe the belief in economic practices of parasitic monopolization of access to any kind of property, and gaining significant amounts of profit without contribution to society.
DeDude:No, I think people are just having a little fun with your stuttering failure to address the issues. However, I will stop now (before being called a Nazi again – but don't think your bullying has worked, its just that I am tired)
DrDick -> DeDude:
Nothing I love more than passive-aggressive bullies, but that is Anne's schtick.
likbez
The key question to Anne is whether Vanguard is really better for unmanaged funds then ETFs. You need to provides us with solid evidence or all your post with belong to the category that Prince Hamlet defined as:
The lady doth protest too much, methinks.
And for managed funds Vanguard experienced several high profile disasters such as with their flagship Primecap fund around 2008. In this sense there is not much to talk about here. Thir managed funds is just a typical example of "go with the crowd" approach.
Issue of fees was important in 90th. But now IMHO Vanguard belongs to "also run" category: for each Vanguard fund you probably can find other fund or ETF with comparable fees.
So why you so adamant in defending Vanguard Anne? It' just one of Wall Street sharks which was broght to the surface by establishing 401K in 1978
P.S. I also consider Vanguard to be among more decent category of Wall Street sharks. But it is still a shark.
Apr 11, 2015 | Zero Hedge
Submitted by Raul Ilargi Meijer via The Automatic Earth blog,
That title may be a bit much, granted, because never is a very long time. I might instead have said "The American Consumer Won't Be Back For A Very Long Time". Still, I simply don't see any time in the future that would see Americans start spending again at a rate anywhere near what would be required for an economic recovery. Looks pretty infinity and beyond to me.
However, that is by no means a generally accepted point of view in the financial press. There's reality, and then there's whatever it is they're smoking, and never the twain shall meet. Admittedly, my title may be a bit provocative, but in my view not nearly as provocative, if not offensive, as Peter Coy's at Bloomberg, who named his latest effort "US Consumers Will Open Their Wallets Soon Enough".
I know, sometimes they make it just too easy to whackamole 'em down and into the ground. But even then, these issues must be addressed time and again until people begin to understand, and quit making the wrong decisions for the wrong reasons. People have a right to know what's truly happening to their lives, and their societies. And they're not nearly getting enough of it through the 'official' press. So here goes nothing:
US Consumers Will Open Their Wallets Soon Enough
People are constantly exhorted to save, but as soon as they do, economists pop up to complain they aren't spending enough to keep the economy growing. A new blogger named Ben Bernanke wrote on April 1 that there's still a "global savings glut." Two days later the Bureau of Labor Statistics announced the weakest job growth since 2013, which economists quickly attributed to soft consumer spending.
The first problem with Coy's thesis is that even if people open their wallets, far too many of them will find there's nothing there. And Bernanke simply doesn't understand what savings are. His ideas through the past decade+ about a Chinese savings glut were always way off the mark, and his global – or American – savings glut theory is, if possible, even more wrong. In the minds of the world's Bernankes, there's no such thing as people opening their wallets to find them empty. If they don't spend, they must be saving. That there's a third option, that of not having any dollars to spend, is for all intents and purposes ignored.
The U.S. personal savings rate-5.8% in February-is the highest since 2012. "After years of spending as if there were no tomorrow, consumers are now saving like there is a tomorrow," Richard Moody, chief economist at Regions Financial, wrote to clients in March. Saving too much really can be a problem when spending is weak.
The little man inside, when I read things like that, tells me this is nonsense. So I decided to look up how the US personal savings rate is calculated. Turns out, it's another one of those whacky goal-seeked government numbers. At least, that's what I make of it. Mainly, though not even exclusively, because of things like this, from a site called Take A Smart Step:
[The personal savings rate in] November 2012 was 3.6%, this is not even close to where we need to be for financial health. This savings rate barely gives us enough to handle emergencies, and makes us as a nation weaker. The government calculates the personal savings rate as the difference between the after tax income and consumption of Americans. So they include not only retirement savings, but debt repayments, college savings, emergency fund savings, anything that was not spent.Making paying off your debt (i.e. money you've already spent) count towards your savings is a practice fraught with questionable consequences. But useful for economists, and accountants alike, no doubt. The problem with it is that it hides reality behind a veil. Because debt repayments are not really savings at all; people are not free to spend what they put into paying off debt, on something else, like iPads, cars or trinkets. Not even on hookers or crack cocaine, for that matter.
For the vast majority of what is paid off in debt, there's no such thing as free choices. People pay off debt because they must. Or, to look at it from another, wide lens, angle, Americans would have to stop servicing their debt payments if they want to 'start spending' again.
Going through the numbers from various sources, I can see that the US personal savings rate is presently some 5.8% of pre-tax income, and debt repayment is close to 10% of disposable -after tax – income. I'm still trying to make those stats rhyme. But no matter how you read and interpret them, it should be clear that debt repayments are a large part of 'official' savings. Even if they really shouldn't be counted as such.
Of what remains in real savings, retirement/pension savings must necessarily be a substantial percentage, and it would be weird to call those things 'saving like there is a tomorrow', if only because they are about, well, tomorrow. But that seems to be the new normal: creating the impression that saving any money at all is somehow detrimental to the economy. A truly crazy notion, if you ask me. Let's get back to Bloomberg's Coy:
There are only two things you can do with a dollar, after all: spend it or save it. If you spend it, great-that's money in someone else's pocket.
In someone else's pocket, but no longer in yours. Why would that be so great? It's only great if that someone has added value to something by doing productive work, not if you simply swap paper assets.
If you save it, the financial system is supposed to recycle your dollar into productive investment with loans for new houses, factories, software, and research and development.
That notion of 'the financial system is supposed to' refers to theories such as those that Bernanke and his ilk 'believe' in. Theories that have no practical value. What is normal for many everyday Americans is crippling debt levels, and no such thing is recognized in these theories. After all, according to them, whatever amount of dollars you get in, you either spend or save them. And if you use them to pay off previously incurred debt, you're supposedly actually saving, even though you no longer have possession of the money in any way, shape or sense, nor a choice of what to spend it on.
But if no one's in the mood to invest more and interest rates are already as low as they can go (as they are in much of the world), the compulsion to save can sap demand and throw people out of work. For the U.S. economy, the good news is that the jump in the personal savings rate is probably no more than a blip. Three economists from Deutsche Bank Securities in New York explained why in a March 25 report called 'U.S. Consumers: Still Shopping, Not Dropping'. While noting a "deceleration" in consumer spending, they wrote, "we think that concerns about the outlook for the consumer are overstated." Their model of the U.S. economy predicts the savings rate will fall to 3% to 3.5% by 2017.
Oh sweet lord. Now a falling savings rate has become a beneficial thing, even when and where savings are very low. Not saving will allegedly save the economy. How did that happen? If we may presume that debt repayments will continue virtually unabated, and there seems to be little reason to think otherwise, this means that by 2017 there will be just about nothing saved at all anymore in America. Which means there'd be very little left of the 'If you save it, the financial system is supposed to recycle your dollar into productive investment'.
The only 'growth' perspective America has left is to grow its debt levels continually, continuously and arguably exponentially.
Other economists have also concluded that the spending dropoff is temporary, which is why the slowdown in job growth, to just 126,000 in March, didn't set off many alarm bells. "Consumer spending is starting to look more and more like a coiled spring," says Guy Berger, U.S. economist at RBS Securities. One sign that consumers aren't retrenching: On April 7 the Federal Reserve reported that consumer credit rose $15.5 billion in February, in line with the recent past.
They got deeper into debt, and this is a sign they're not 'retrenching'? A coiled spring? Really?
According to Deutsche Bank Securities, the first reason to think consumers will resume spending is that their incomes are rising. Annual growth in average hourly earnings has averaged about 2% since 2010, which isn't great but does exceed inflation. With more people working as well, aggregate payroll outlays are up 4.9% from the past year, according to Bureau of Labor Statistics data.
The rises in stock and home prices should make consumers more willing to live a little, say the Deutsche Bank authors. They calculate that households' net worth is almost 6.5 times consumers' disposable personal income. That's the highest ratio since before the housing crash.
But that last bit is arguably all due to QE induced asset bubbles. Not an argument the author would make, I know, but nevertheless. Coincidentally, another Bloomberg article published the same day as the one we're delving in here is called:Why Your Wages Could Be Depressed for a Lot Longer Than You Think. Perhaps the respective authors should have a sit down.
No question, the high savings rate depresses spending in the short run. Purchases of durable goods, from cars to couches, remain well below their 60-year average share of GDP. But all that saving helps consumers get their finances in order, which will allow them to satisfy pent-up demand for that sweet new Ford F-150.
No no no: they just paid off part of their debts. How can that possibly mean they'll go out and get a new F-150? In real life, they spent their money instead of saving it. Either way, they don't have it any longer to spend on a F-150. It would mean they need to get into new debt. On top of what they still have left over even AFTER paying down part of it.
Fed data show that financial obligations including debt service, rent, and auto leases are about their lowest in comparison to disposable income since 1981.
Hmm. According to Wikipedia, "Household debt as a % of disposable income rose from 68% in 1980 to a peak of 128% in 2007, prior to dropping to 112% by 2011." It's about 105% today. So that's just a very weird statement. Someone's wrong, very wrong, and I think I know who that would be. Maybe Peter Coy conveniently ignores mortgage payments when he talks about "financial obligations including debt service, rent, and auto leases"?!
When consumers are ready to borrow more, it won't hurt that, according to the Fed's survey of banks' senior loan officers, banks are easing lending standards.
See? That's what I said: they can only spend if they acquire new debt. They're just getting rid of the last batch, and it's going mighty slowly at that. Lest we forget, when debt as a percentage of income falls, that is due to quite an extent to people failing to make any debt payments at all, and losing their homes and cars. This is a dead economic model. This model is pining for the fjords.
These factors add up to an optimistic consumer.
Oh, c'mon. What is that statement based on? That 'sky high' savings rate that is really just poor slobs paying off what they can in debt repayments so they won't get hit with even more fees and fines?
What I think these factors add up to, is a delusional reporter. There is no excess saving. It's ludicrous. As far as people have any money at all, they're using it to pay down their previously incurred debts. And that gets tallied into their savings rate by the government's creative accounting methods. That's all there is to the whole story. But it will, regardless, induce a few more poor souls to sign up for more mortgages and car loans and feel like happy American consumers on their way down into the maelstrom.
It's sad, it really is. Maybe we should first of all stop referring to the American people as 'consumers'. That might help.
Mar 19, 2015 | Zero Hedge
The biggest issue facing the financial system today is the US Dollar rally.
The Fed and other Central Banks are trying to maintain the illusion that they have everything in control by talking about interest rates, but the reality is that the US Dollar carry trade is ABOVE $9 trillion in size. That is almost as big as ALL of the money printing that occurred between 2009 and 2013.
And it's imploding as we write this.
Globally, the world is awash in borrowed money… most of it in US Dollars. The US Dollar carry trade is north of $9 trillion… literally than the economies of Germany and Japan COMBINED.
When you BORROW in US Dollars you are effectively SHORTING the US Dollar. So when the US Dollar rallies… you have to cover your SHORT or you blow up.
And the US Dollar has been rallying… HARD. Indeed, the move that began in July 2014 is already larger par in scope with that which occurred during the 2008 meltdown.
Moreover, this move has occurred with little to no rest. The US Dollar barely corrected 2% after rallying a stunning 16+% in a matter of months before beginning its next leg up.
You only get these sorts of moves when the stuff hits the fan. CNBC and the others are babbling about the Fed's FOMC changes, but all of that is just a distraction from the fact that a $9+ trillion carry trade, arguably the largest carry trade in history, has begun to blow up.
Rate hikes, QE, all of this stuff is minor in comparison to the carnage the US Dollar is having on the financial system. Take a look at the impact it's having on emerging market currencies.
... ... ...
Mar 18, 2015 | Zero Hedge
There was a time when Zoltan Poszar was the most important person at the Fed (and Treasury), because he was likely the only person in the government's employ who grasped the enormity and complexity of the then-$30 or so trillion US shadow banking system. A quick refresh of his bio from the Institute for New Economic Thinking:Mr. Pozsar has been deeply involved in the response to the global financial crisis and the ensuing policy debate. He joined the Federal Reserve Bank of New York in August 2008 in charge of market intelligence for securitized credit markets and served as point person on market developments for senior Federal Reserve, U.S. Treasury and White House officials throughout the crisis; played an instrumental role in building the TALF to backstop the ABS market; and pioneered the mapping of the shadow banking system which inspired the FSB's effort to monitor and regulate shadow banking globally. Prior to Credit Suisse, Mr. Pozsar was a senior adviser to the U.S. Department of the Treasury, where he advised the Office of Debt Management and the Office of Financial Research, and served as Treasury's liaison to the FSB on matters of financial innovation. He also worked with the Federal Reserve Board on improving the U.S. Flow of Funds Accounts.
While Zoltan is currently working in the private sector at Credit Suisse, he is perhaps best known for laying out, back in 2009, the full topographical map of the US shadow banking system in all its flow of assets (or is that contra-assets when it is a repo) beauty.
Which is also why we bring him up, because in a much welcome follow up to his previous work title "A Macro View of Shadow Banking" which we will discuss further in the coming days because it is not only Zoltan's shadow banking magnum opus and must read for anyone who wants to get up to speed with all the latest development in the unregulated shadow banking space, but because Poszar also provides perhaps what is the most important chart which explains why the Fed is so very terrified of even the smallest possible incremental rate hike of 0.25%.
Specifically, we look at Poszar's findings about the implied leverage within the fixed income asset space in America's just a little levered buyside community. This is what he says:
Although no precise measures are available, the presence of leverage among hedge funds with credit and fixed income strategies has been recognized since the LTCM crisis (see Figure 21), as is leverage in separate accounts in the asset management complex.
While hedge funds and separate accounts are allowed to use leverage liberally – in fact, leverage is the sine qua non of these investment vehicles – it is widely underappreciated that bond mutual funds that are typically thought of as unlevered and long-only also have considerable room to use leverage.
The extent to which this room to use leverage is utilized is up to bond portfolio managers to decide, and it is not uncommon for the largest bond funds to maximize the leverage they may bear in their portfolio within the limits allowed by the Investment Company Act of 1940, and the SEC's interpretation of the portfolio leverage and concentration incurred through the use of derivatives.
However, the creep of leverage into what are traditionally thought of as long-only bond funds was missed by the mainstream economics literature and textbooks entirely. For example, recent works that identify asset managers as the core intermediaries behind the "second phase of global liquidity" focus solely on indirect forms of leverage (FX mismatches) embedded in bond portfolios through holdings of dollar-denominated emerging market sovereign and corporate bonds (see Shin, 2013).
Other works state even more explicitly the widely-held assumption that fixed income mutual funds are unlevered, and analyze episodes of market volatility induced by redemptions without any regard to how direct forms of leverage embedded in fixed income mutual funds may amplify volatility during periods of rising redemptions (see for example Feroli, Kashyap, Schoenholtz and Shin, 2014, Chapter 1 of the International Monetary Fund's October 2014 Global Financial Stability Report, Chapter 6 of the BIS' 84th Annual Report, and Brown, Dattels and Frieda, 2014 (forthcoming)).
But all of these views sit uncomfortably with the hard evidence presented above, and recent revelations about "perceived" alphas (see Gross, 2014b) and price action in the interest rate derivative markets amidst soaring redemptions from the largest bond portfolio in the global financial ecosystem – the PIMCO Total Return Fund (see Mackenzie and Meyer, 2014). More concretely, a look at the portfolio of this specific fund provides good examples of the forms of leverage discussed above.
...
More broadly, the above example demonstrates the evolution of the traditional core product of the asset management industry – long-only, relative-return funds – as it came under pressure from two directions: from hedge funds, offering absolute return strategies, and from passive index-replication products in the form of low-cost exchange traded funds (ETFs). Core-satellite investment mandates became the trend, with hedge funds providing alpha and index-replication vehicles delivering beta at low cost. Traditional asset managers responded to this challenge a number of ways: some by launching their own, internal hedge funds, and some by incorporating into their core products many of the alternative investment techniques used by the hedge funds. These industry trends were the sources of competitive push that drove the above-mentioned creep of leverage into the industry's traditional, long-only, relative-return bond funds (and hence the rise of levered betas), all designed to stem the flow of assets to the hedge fund competition and command higher fees as the profitability of traditional core products was squeezed (see Bank of New York, 2011 as well as Haldane, 2014).
And visually:
In short, what Poszar is saying is that in a world in which the traditional broker-dealers and banks have indeed reduced leverage and instead use $2.5 trillion in Fed reserves as fungible collateral against which to buy credit derivatives (for example as in the case of JPM's CIO office and its attempt to corner the IG9 market) the buyside community, which as we have long discussed has largely avoided equities due to fears of a spectacular market implosion (and certainly minimized levered exposure in the space with the exception of several prominent HFT participants) has instead been forced to chase after fixed income products. And chase with leverage that would make one's head spin as can be seen in the outlier chart above.
And while Poszar may be quite correct in stating that most have missed the leverage creep he observes above...
Perhaps the key reasons why economists have missed the creep of leverage into the traditionally long-only world of fixed income mutual funds are the conceptual gaps in the way in which the U.S. Financial Accounts (formerly the Flow of Funds) depict the global financial ecosystem, and by extension, the limited mental map it gives to economists who use it to understand asset prices.
... one entity that does understand all this and grasps the momentuous implications of even the smallest quantum of interest rate increase, is the entity where Poszar previously worked: the US Treasury and the Federal Reserve itself.
And so, the next time someone asks "why is Yellen so terrified of even the smallest possible rate hike", show them this chart above and explain that the Fed vividly remembers what heppened when LTCM blew up. What the Fed doesn't want, is not one but one thousand LTCMs going off at exactly the same time in what is now the world's most levered trade...
strannickSo the dollar isnt going up because of America's sound fundamentals? But rather because its newly minted QE is being used to make leveraged, unhedged gambling bets in derivatives markets (ie. CDOs that cant be paid by counter parties like AIG to losers like MF Global) by primary dealers as repo collateral instead of being released into the economy and increasinging the money velocity?
So the Fed is lying when they say they will soon raise interest rates? Even though raising interest rates .25 % would add 100s of billions in interest to the over 18 trillion dollar debt?
So there is a quadrillion dollar hidden -shadow- banking system beyond the site of Congress and investors at large? That is potentially worse than a 1000 Lehmans?
So then shouldn't we be using our overvalued dollars to buy suppressed under valued gold
waterwitch
I found this helpful:
http://www.barclayhedge.com/research/educational-articles/hedge-fund-str...
ZerOhead
Crap... It's just like the movie SPEED with Sandra Bullock and Keanu Reeves back in '94 when a former banker rigs a bus loaded with muppets to explode unless he get's paid a million$$ ransom.
If Yellen let's the speed fall below 50 MPH then the bomb goes off and everyone dies.
Meanwhile she's desperately looking for an off-ramp called ECONOMIC GROWTH but it ain't there... and now she's running out of road and there's a hole in her gas tank...
SWRichmond
we look at Poszar's findings about the implied leverage within the fixed income asset space
Do you have any idea what the avg rate on the 10 year bond is?
Of course it is about leverage, it has always been about leverage. There are two ways for control freaks to fight a deleveraging: 1) print money, and 2) re-lever. And since the fixed income markets are by far the largest, guess where the leverage (mostly in the form of swaps) was placed?
And in order to keep this leverage from blowing up, interest rates have to stay zero, forever. This is not rocket science. Neither, however, is it reality, but that is what they are trying to do.
Totentänzerlied
1. Average all-time historical return is 0 or negative. Inflation beyond a few tenths of a percent only became a standard phenomenon during the industrial age. This is one of the key points of metallism and one of the reasons monetarists and chartalists (more like charlatans) hate metallism.
2. Savers should not have their money in the bank (or brokerage) if they don't want the banks to use it.
To my knowledge the long-run average coupon on government debt in all places was 3%-5% or less, it was the preferred asset class (in addition to farmland, of course) of the rentier parasites of recent centuries. This high rate is part of why we got national income taxes; careful what you wish for.
There is no point in calling fiat currency stolen, any more than there is in calling a unicorn stolen. It is all debt, not money. The theft begins as soon as it is loaned into existence. Beyond that, the interest means it by nature requires theft from the future.
alphamentalist
wake up! look at the jefferies numbers of the other day. it is nearly impossible for banks to make money under these conditions. sure they saw some MTM on their rates books back in '10/11/12, but the rest of "earnings" for years running has been from mark-to-fantasy, headcount reductions, buybacks, offshoring, and loss avoidance (delaying foreclosures and repossessions on NPLs). this the-Fed-is-saving-the-banksters meme, while popular, doesn't fit the observable realities. fed policy is--as tiny timmah geithner confessed--the best progressive economics in action.
it is direct monetary financing of our bloated federal government. when you see a person doing something most people infer the motivation for the action is the reward for the action. in the case of the fed we need to adjust our optics to understand they are doing things not to be rewarded but to avoid consequences (like the Dutch boy with his finger in the dike, no Yellen pun intended). what would happen if they allowed a return to market economics?
the federal government would have to fund its ever growing shortfall in the rates market. that would probably be possible at first, but the higher rates would slow the remains of the "economy", which would increase demand for services AND retard tax receipts, which would increase the funding shortfall, which would push up rates, which would choke the economy, which would...well, you get the picture. without the Fed, the overlevered federal candy machine would quickly tear itself apart.
I think the Fed is going to try to raise in order to re-set the shock absorbers before the coming sell off in order to maintain at least the illusion they can stimulate the economy. but it is too little, too late. we will quickly be back to the Fed protecting the politicos by trying to slow the collapse. (to keep this simple I have avoided the obvious asset-inflation scheme as a tool to keep large donors happy, but even analyzing that will bring you back to the same place: the Fed must protect the politicians or die trying.) this is the slow motion death rattle of America's nanny state.
kaiserhoff
This is a very popular view, but it is wrong. We are talking about fractions of a percent. Declining oil prices have given them an undeserved window, in which to begin normalization.
It's true there is no exit strategy. There never was. This is their one last chance to let market rates emerge without complete chaos. They are too stupid to take it. Unfortunately, the consequences will fall on us all.
tahoebumsmith
WTFRLYThe FED has over 4 Trillion on their balance sheets now compared to 852 billion in 11/08.. The US Government has over 17 Trillion dollars of debt compared to 9.23 Trillion in 11/08... need I say more? That is unless they don't have to pay interest> Were all Japanese now and if inflation forces the 0% interest Ponzi to raise interest rates you might just as well bring the whole herd of deer out Tyler because it will be carnage
9/11 Truth: Judges shocked by first time seeing video of WTC 7 collapse in Denmark court
walküre
KuriousKat"Magic" number 7
US is run by gangsters. Greatest criminal enterprise ever conceived in the history of man.
MATA HAIRYThe hellicopters will come but they won't be dropping money.
Some folx ain't waitin till September..
coming to a theater near you.
http://news.yahoo.com/police-car-burnt-windows-smashed-start-anti-ecb-06...
Frankfurt (AFP) - Violent clashes between anti-capitalist protesters and German police left dozens injured and a trail of destruction in Germany's financial capital as the European Central Bank opened its new headquarters Wednesday.
Draghi, addressing some 100 invited guests at a low-key ceremony, rejected blame for the suffering brought by budget cuts and austerity policies amid the financial crisis in Europe.
kchriscum...those are europeans rising up against their masters. Not americans.
Americans are cattle and will never do so. At least white americans never will.
yogibear"There was a time when Zoltan Poszar was the most important person at the Fed (and Treasury), because he was likely the only person in the government's employ who grasped the enormity and complexity of the then-$30 or so trillion US shadow banking system."
The FedRes is NOT a part of the governmnet, but a PRIVATE branch of the PRIVATE Zionist banking cabal that owns and controls the DC US.
The FedRes only wants to comprehend the ramifications of their actions the same as a thief does. And like a thief, they wish to keep their loot, and to remain free to thieve more in the future.
The banksters need to repay us. Guillotine the Fed. Audit the heads.
LOL, the Federal Reserve can't raise rates.
Just BS the markets for months and later years.
The markets may have just figured it out.
Nov 21, 2014 | Bloomberg
Junk bond investors have a bad case of the jitters. Every bit of bad news is whipsawing prices, with bonds tumbling as much as 50 percent in a single day.
"We've seen some flash crashes in the market," saidHenry Craik-White, a senior investment analyst at ECM Asset Management in London, which oversees $8 billion. "If you get caught on the wrong side of a name, you can get severely punished in this market."
Investors are rattled because they're concerned that a lack of liquidity in the bond market will make it impossible for them to sell holdings in response to negative headlines. Trading dropped about 70 percent since 2008, with a corporate bond that changed hands almost five times a day a decade ago now only being sold once a day on average, according to Royal Bank of Scotland Group Plc.
Alarms started ringing in September with the collapse of British retailer Phones 4u Ltd. after Vodafone Group Plc and EE Ltd. refused to renew contracts. The retailer shut its business and sought creditor protection on Sept. 15, sending the company's payment-in-kind bonds down to 1.9 pence on the pound, according to data compiled by Bloomberg.
Nov. 30, 2014 | money.cnn.com
One man's junk bonds might be another man's treasure.
Dramatic swings in the junk bond market often provide a valuable warning to investors. During times of turmoil, investors pile into ultra-safe U.S. government debt and rotate away from far riskier junk bonds.
That swing away from junk bonds often happens shortly before stock market downturns.
"High yield does provide useful sell signals to equity investors," Barclays analysts concluded in a recent report.
Barclays combed through the past dozen years of data. The warning signal they found is a 30% or greater increase in the spread between Treasuries and junk bonds before a dip.
History is a guide: Consider 2002. The "spread," or gap between the yields of junk bonds and Treasuries, spiked in July that summer after WorldCom defaulted on its debt and US Airways signaled it was filing for bankruptcy.
Investors who sold stocks based on the turbulence in the high-yield debt market would have escaped a 14% nosedive in the S&P 500 over the next 10 days.
"Had equity investors heeded the warning being sent from high yield, significant losses may have been avoided," Barclays wrote.
While the stock market bounced back from that 2002 episode pretty quickly, the same can't be said about when the sell signal was triggered five years later.
Junk bond spreads surged in June 2007 as two Bear Stearns hedge funds dropped a bomb on investors about massive losses in subprime mortgage assets.
Despite the alarm bells ringing in the credit markets, the S&P 500 set all-time highs as late as the fall of 2007. But then stocks began a long descent as it came to light that many more firms had similar subprime mortgage problems.
Many investors clearly wish they listened to that early warning from junk bonds.
Barclays said equity investors should "position defensively" the next time junk bonds start to go haywire. That doesn't necessarily mean dumping stocks altogether. After all, the stock market eventually bounced back from each of the sell-offs Barclays examined.
Instead, lower volatility sectors like consumer staples and utilities could provide investors with cover during a potential storm. The analysis found that after the sell signal was triggered, these sectors outperformed higher-turbulence ones like materials and energy.
finance.yahoo.com
Bottom of oil prices is not seen yet. Last time in 1986 oil fall $35 to $10. Most of the damage in oil price decline behind us. But not oil speculators were washed out.
Marginal producers will go out of business. They are highly leveled and they will have problems in refinancing their debt. There will some ripple affects on financial market. Increased volatility is probably coming in 2015. Fed intend to raise rate.
High yield bond market will be affected.
Lehmann: Yes. We watch the market and the diversity of securities in that market. And we try to stay diversified. But one of the things about the preferred market is that it's really quite complex. We've identified seven different categories of what's called preferreds.And the majority of the preferreds are actually bonds. They're not stock at all. Then you have your foreign preferreds, which get dividend treatment just like a common stock in the U.S. There is a real diversity of selection, which is one of the reasons our newsletter is quite successful. Because it addresses that market and points out these differences.
Forbes: In terms of the high-yield bonds, junk bonds as we call them, you make, again, a counterintuitive case that the huge issuance which some people thought of, "Oh, my gosh. This is a bubble out there." You say, "Well, in many cases, that's actually a sign of strength."
Lehmann: Yes, I do. I think that people aren't doing their homework when they malign the high-yield market. Because they look at these spreads between investment grade, below investment grade in the past and they say, "Well, no, these spreads are so small now that the risk is not counted in."
But I think the risk is dramatically changing by all this new issuance. Because you have to look at, really, the purpose for the bond issue, not just who's issuing it. And if a company is issuing high-yield bonds at lower interest rates to replace, for example, existing dead issues or to replace bank loans, that's a tremendous strength in the other balance sheet.
Because it gives them more borrowing capacity from the banks in the future if and when they need it, and when they can't issue bonds anymore. So, actual survival chances are greatly enhanced by this volume of new issuance. The junk bonds were high risk when they were being used to make risky new acquisitions or to buy back stock. But when you're using it to buttress your balance sheet, the way it's being done today, I think that there's a real positive to the market.
Forbes: You also make an interesting case, and you cite Bank of America, where the credit rating agencies end up giving a low grade, even though in reality it's investment grade.
Lehmann: Yes. This is sort of a technical factor that distorts the market, where because somebody like Bank of America, that has four or five tiers of debt, different levels of seniority, those levels are rated by the rating agencies based on their claim in a bankruptcy situation, which would make sense except if you say, "Well, Bank of America isn't going to go into bankruptcy. And it's an A-rated at the top" So, you look at it and you say, "Well, that's their chance at bankruptcy," which is pretty close to nothing. And therefore, why wouldn't you invest in their lower-rated paper? Because you're not worried about their claim in bankruptcy and you can collect an extra 100 – 200 basis points of yield.
Forbes: You make the point that in some of these companies, look at what the senior debt is rated at and that, in effect, is what you should look at the junior.
Lehmann: Well, that's what we tend to do. We think that the term junk is really detrimental to making an investment decision. They're anything but junk.
Forbes: High-dividend stocks: You think there are some that we should look at. Everyone says go for dividends. But you make the point 2% versus 6%. But there are some like Altria that you think are worth looking at. Are there other ones? Altria do you still like?Lehmann: There are quite a few. The tobacco companies are good. Some of the shipping companies, some of the LLPs and the master limited partnerships. These are all good categories, especially when you're concerned about interest rates going up. They offer a lot more protection than a fixed-rate 30-year bond, for example.
Forbes: One of the things you make the point in terms of comparing junk and investment-grade bonds is that results are skewed because investment-grade bonds have a longer maturity than traditional junk bonds do.
Lehmann: Yes. That's one of the things. We don't tend to look at the maturity of the issues so much because in the case of high-yield bonds and in the case of our audience, which is individual investors, they're not buying a bond necessarily to hold it to maturity. They're buying it because it's a good yield now. But their life span is not going to be the length of that bond issue. They're in a different analysis position relative to what they want to buy.
Forbes: Municipal bonds, which covers a multitude of sins.
Lehmann: Of sins, yes.
Forbes: How do you look at munis today?
Lehmann: For my audience, I've always discouraged them from buying municipal bonds. Because I think that your investment decision should be based on rates of return that you can achieve. For years, I was mystified as to why retired individuals and such who were in a very low tax category were buying municipal bonds.
And somebody finally gave me an explanation of why they do that. And it's basically, they say, "I want to simplify my life. I don't want to have to worry about making a tax return and having a big payment in April. I just take all this tax-free income and I don't have to file a tax return."
Well, that's the worst reason I could think of to buy municipal bonds. And as we've seen over time now, the quality of municipalities is deteriorating significantly. And I don't think the market really reflects tha
Forbes: Let's quickly hit - because a lot of people do buy these things, even if for the wrong reasons - your quick assessment of Detroit, the proposed settlement there.
Lehmann: I think Detroit is a real beginning of what may turn out to be a wave of similar-type situations. There is new ground being broken in terms of Chapter 9 bankruptcies in that case. And a lot of municipalities, I'm sure, are sitting on the sidelines watching this and saying, "Does this become a viable option to me?"
But I think more importantly is the fact that for all of these municipalities, the unions, who are usually the major claimants in this situation because of pension and health care, unfunded benefits, they need to watch this very closely. Because we're seeing that their rights are being terminated and having to be renegotiated. And they are going to be much more flexible, I think, to avoid a Chapter 9 bankruptcy than they have been in the past. And so that's probably one of the positives that's going to come out of the Detroit bankruptcy.
Forbes: Another large issue out there: Puerto Rico. Is that still a wing and a prayer? There's over $70 billion of issuance.
Lehmann: Puerto Rico, there's no question that that is going to end up as a tragedy. There is no way that they can meet that debt level. And it's only a question of the mechanics of, basically, how they will shorten off the debt. We see that this last bond issue and the market was very receptive to it.
But if you probably looked at who was buying that, it was the people who were looking at that bond issue as generating the funds by which they can make the interest payment on their $70 billion. Because the amount that was put out was just about what was needed for that. And I don't know how many times you can play that game. But eventually, even with all the reforms that the new governor is promising, it's just gotten way beyond the capabilities of the island to service that debt.
Forbes: So, would you tell individuals, "Lick your wounds and fight another day"?
Lehmann: I would say to them, "Look very closely at any municipal funds you hold and how much Puerto Rico paper is in there. Because it's going to take a major hit." And the same for tobacco bonds.
Forbes: I'm going to ask you about tobacco bonds, another thing, you might say, going up in smoke.
Lehmann: Yes. That's one of those where the original basis for the issuance of many of these bonds was a study that was done in the '70s when this agreement was reached. When the original agreement was reached here, some projections about cigarette consumptions over the next 30, 40 years were made.And, of course, making a five-year projection, never mind a 40-year projection, is ridiculous. But the market needs something. And they all signed onto this thing. And now we're seeing that cigarette consumption is dropping at a much greater rate than anybody had projected. And many of them are zero-coupon issues. And, consequently, those people are just trading in paper that will never pay off at maturity.
Forbes: A lot of people live in Florida. What about the so-called dirt bonds?
Lehmann: The dirt bonds is kind of a controversial thing there. Most of the dirt bonds were bought by mutual fund families and they didn't do a hell of a good job of scrutinizing.
Forbes: Just to explain, these are housing developments.
Lehmann: Yes. These are community development districts, or housing developments, where any developer can go out and buy 1,000 acres of land, get a mortgage on it, and get all his money out of it, and then issue a $20 million bond issue or a $50 million bond issue to build infrastructure.
This was going hot and heavy in Florida until 2005, when, of course, the collapse came in the real estate market. And they continued to build out and spend all that money because they had raised it and they didn't have any money in the deal. They'd taken their investment out through the bank loans. And, so, when they finished the infrastructure deal and it got to the point where they would have to start paying the assessments, they all said no. They let the thing default. And it has been laying in limbo. And you would've thought there would've been a wave of lawsuits as a result of that. But the mutual funds that bought these bonds were so exposed themselves for having bought them in the first place without really doing a good due diligence exam of this thing. Because it should have been obvious earlier that this was going to end badly.
Forbes: You add it up all together, Detroit, Puerto Rico, tobacco bonds, dirt bonds.
Lehmann: A lot of money.
Forbes: Munis are a minefield.
Lehmann: Tobacco bonds alone is $100 billion. That's a huge chunk of the market. Puerto Rico is $70 billion. These are just the big ones. There are hundreds of municipalities with unfunded pension liabilities and health care who are in the same boat, just their numbers are smaller.
http://www.zerohedge.com/news/2014-09-26/its-dollar-stupid To claim that this is the market at work makes no sense anymore. Today central banks, for all intents and purposes, are the market.
Our overall impression is that the Fed has given up on the US economy, in the sense that it realizes – and mind you, this may go back quite a while - that without constant and ongoing life-support, the economy is down for the count.
And eternal life-support is not an option, even Keynesian economists understand that. Add to this that the "real" economy was never a Fed priority in the first place, but a side-issue, and it becomes easier to understand why Yellen et al choose to do what they do, and when.
When the full taper is finalized next month, and without rate rises and a higher dollar, the real US economy would start shining through, and what's more important - for the Fed, Washington and Wall Street - the big banks would start 'suffering' again.
07/25/2014 | zerohedge.com
As we have been highlighting for a few weeks, something is rotten in high-yield credit markets. This week, the mainstream media is starting to catch on as major divergences in performance (high-yield bond spreads are 30-40bps off their cycle tights from just prior to MH17 even as stocks rally to new record highs) and technicals weaken.
However, as BofA warns, flows follow returns and this week saw the biggest outflows from high-yield funds in more than a year. Investment grade bonds saw notable inflows as investors chose up-in-quality, rather than reach-for-yield, for the first time in years... equity investors, pay attention.
High yield credit markets have been overvalued for a record period of time...
On Tuesday, analysts at Ned Davis Research recommended that investors begin to sell high-yield bonds, partly because they look pricey and partly because performance has been flagging. "Investors are no longer being compensated for the additional risk in high-yield bonds," they wrote.
High yield credit markets are majorly diverging from stocks...
"Geopolitical risk is causing a pause," said Frank Ossino, senior portfolio manager at Newfleet Asset Management in Hartford, Conn., which oversees $12.9 billion. Investors tend to flee riskier assets during times of turmoil.
High yield credit markets are suffering major outflows...
Outflows from high yield funds and ETFs accelerated last week to $2.46bn following a sizable $1.85bn outflow in the prior week. Both of these outflows are the largest since the "taper tantrum"episode in the summer of last year.
"We're not seeing massive outflows yet, but at some point that's going to change," warned Phil Blancato, chief executive at Ladenburg Thalmann Asset Management, which oversees about $2 billion.
He said he is steering clear of high-yield exchange-traded funds in large part due to concerns about how they will fare in a downturn.
* * *
Between a sudden shift to a preference for "strong" balance sheet companies over "weak" balance sheet companies (the end of the dash for trash trade), and this rotation from high-yield to investment-grade, it is clear that investors are positioning defensively up-in-quality ending the constant reach-for-yield trade of the last 5 years.
Why should 'equity' investors care? The last few years' gains in stocks have been thanks massively to record amounts of buybacks (juicing EPS and also providing a non-economic bid to the market no matter what happens). This financial engineering - for even the worst of the worst credit - has been enabled by massive inflows into high-yield and leveraged loan funds, lowering funding costs and allowing CFOs to destroy/releverage their firms all in the goal of raising the share price.
Simply put - equity prices cannot rally for long without the support of high-yield credit markets - never have, never will - as they are both 'arbitrageable' bets on the same capital structure. There can be a divergence at the end of a cycle as managers get over their skis with leverage and the high yield credit market decides it has had enough risk-taking... but it only ends with equity and credit weakening together. That is the credit cycle... it cycles.
2014-04-30 | Bloomberg
The U.S. drive for energy independence is backed by a surge in junk-rated borrowing that's been as vital as the technological breakthroughs that enabled the drilling spree. While the high-yield debt market has doubled in size since the end of 2004, the amount issued by exploration and production companies has grown nine-fold, according to Barclays Plc. That's what keeps the shale revolution going even as companies spend money faster than they make it.
"There's a lot of Kool-Aid that's being drunk now by investors," Tim Gramatovich, who helps manage more than $800 million as chief investment officer of Santa Barbara, California-based Peritus Asset Management LLC. "People lose their discipline. They stop doing the math. They stop doing the accounting. They're just dreaming the dream, and that's what's happening with the shale boom."
... ... ...
Spending Treadmill
"Who can, or will want to, fund the drilling of millions of acres and hundreds of thousands of wells at an ongoing loss?" Ivan Sandrea, a research associate at the Oxford Institute for Energy Studies in England, wrote in a report last month. "The benevolence of the U.S. capital markets cannot last forever."
The spending never stops, said Virendra Chauhan, an oil analyst with Energy Aspects in London. Since output from shale wells drops sharply in the first year, producers have to keep drilling more and more wells to maintain production. That means selling off assets and borrowing more money.
"The whole boom in shale is really a treadmill of capital spending and debt," Chauhan said.
Access to the high-yield bond market has enabled shale drillers to spend more money than they bring in. Junk-rated exploration and production companies spent $2.11 for every $1 earned last year, according to a Barclays analysis of 37 firms.
...
"It's a perfect set-up for investors to lose a lot of money," Gramatovich said. "The model is unsustainable."
Many top bond investors, including Doubleline's Jeffrey Gundlach, believe high-yield bonds are overvalued after a long run.Vanguard High-Yield Corporate Fund Admiral Shares
- Symbol: VWEAX
YTD 1 Yr 3 Yr 5 Yr 10 Yr +3.26% +5.63% +8.41% +14.60% +7.06%
By Wolf Richter, a San Francisco based executive, entrepreneur, start up specialist, and author, with extensive international work experience. Cross posted from Testosterone Pit.When Blackstone's global head of private equity, Joseph Baratta, said Thursday night that "we" were "in the middle of an epic credit bubble," the likes of which he hadn't seen in his career, he knew whereof he spoke.
Junk bond issuance hit an all-time record of $47.6 billion in September, edging out the prior record, set in September last year, of $46.8 billion, according to S&P Capital IQ/LCD. Year to date, issuance amounted to $255 billion, blowing away last year's volume for this period of $243 billion. The year 2012, already in a bubble, set an all-time record with $346 billion. This year, if the Fed keeps the money flowing and forgets about that taper business, junk bond issuance will beat that record handily.
Junk-bond funds got clobbered in July and August as retail investors briefly opened their eyes and realized what they had on their hands and fled, and they went looking for yield elsewhere, but there was still no yield in reasonable places, and so they held their noses and picked up these reeking junk-bond funds again. Cash inflow doubled over the last week to $3.1 billion, the most in ten weeks.
These retail investors were fired up by the Fed's refusal to taper even a little bit, giving rise to the hope that it might actually never taper, that this is truly QE Infinity, Wall Street's wet dream come true – on the theory that the Fed is mortally afraid that any taper would blow over the sky-high financial-markets house of cards it has constructed over the last five years. And the retail cash returned to these junk-bond funds and just about refilled the hole that had been dug during the summer.
"The cost of a high-yield bond on an absolute coupon basis is as low as it's ever been," explained Baratta, king of Blackstone's $53 billion in private equity assets. Even the riskiest companies are selling the riskiest bonds at low yields. The September frenzy hit the upper end too and set a new record: companies sold $145.7 billion in investment-grade bonds in the US. And Baratta complained that valuations "relative to the growth prospects are out of whack right now."
These "growth prospects" look grim, with corporate revenues barely keeping up with inflation, and with earnings growth, despite all-out financial engineering, getting decimated. On October 1 last year, earnings estimates for the third quarter 2013 still saw a growth of 15.9%. As of Friday, estimated earnings growth had plunged to 4.6%, dropping 20 basis points per week in August and 10 basis points per week in September. And they may still be too optimistic.
Meanwhile, earnings growth estimates for the fourth quarter have barely budged since August and remain at the deliriously lofty level of 11.1%, pulled up largely by financials, whose earnings growth is still pegged at a breath-taking 25.7%, based on the assumption that the Fed will continue to feed them.
But financials are having some, let's say, issues. The five biggest banks alone face a $1 billion cut in earnings from just the past month, based on a big decline in fixed-income trading revenues – with our special friend, JPMorgan, eating more than half of it. There had been "hopes of a final trading flurry in the last few weeks of the quarter," the FT observed, but those hopes have now been squashed.
Then there is the death of the mortgage refi bubble that has been hammering banks, with number one mortgage lender Wells Fargo suffering the most. Four banks have so far announced 7,000 layoffs in their mortgage divisions. JPMorgan confessed that it would lose money in its mortgage business in the second half. On top of that, JPMorgan is contemplating $11 billion in legal settlements for its various mortgage scams. And earnings at financials are still expected to grow 25.7% in the fourth quarter?
"Out of whack" is what Baratta called this phenomenon of sky-high valuations in relationship to grim growth prospects.
Earnings estimates have been slow in coming down. And the stock market, supposedly forward looking and focused on corporate revenues and earnings, has been completely blind to them. It follows the mantra that fundamentals no longer matter. All that matters is the Fed. A shift that has become the Fed's most glorious accomplishment. And the Fed continues to feed Wall Street with $85 billion a month.
Yet in this glorious environment where there is no gravity for stocks and even junk bonds, the smart money is selling hand over fist, unloading whatever they can, however they can. Record junk bond issuance is just one aspect.
from Mexicosusan the otherIt looks like one of the consequences of QE has been to drive investors into increasingly high-risk investments in quest of yield. I don't see how this can end well.
Our current era seems to resemble the 1890 to 1914 era in many ways, poised as it was on the precipice of three decades of world-wide war and depression. When the rentier's quest for yield blows up in their faces, the quest for scapegoats will begin.
As Jacques Barzun asks in From Dawn to Decadence,
how can it be that in retrospect the period was seen as an ideal time deserving to be called la belle epoque? … Here it is enough to say that the intellectual and artistic elites, and to a certain extent high society, lived in their world of creation, criticism, and delight in the new. They were aware of the crises, no doubt, but after one or two had gone by gave little thought to what they might still cause. At any rate, those engaged in high art and science took little notice.
[....]
The haughty ignorance of social and political facts enables us to understand why the cultivated classes reacted as they did when war came: several hundred intellectuals in Germany signed a manifesto denouncing "the other side" as if betrayed by a friend and brother. It was immediately answered, with a like rhethoric, by several hundred of the French. The enemy's purpose must be wicked since we are innocent.
[....]
Overnight, en masses like so many sheep, they turned into rabid superpatriots….
Looking over the roster of great names in literature, painting, music, philosophy, science, and social science, one cannot think of more than half a dozen or so who did not spout all the catchphrases of absue and vainglory….
Freud wrote of "giving all his libido" to Austria-Hungary. The historians and social scientists - Lamprecht, Meinecke, Max Weber, Lavisse, Aulard, Durkheim, Tawney - all found in the materials of their field good arguments in praise of war or reasons to excoriate the enemy. Arnold Toynbee wrote volumes of atrocity propaganda…
And everywhere the clergy were the most rabid glorifiers of the struggle and inciters to hatred. The Brotherhood of Man and the Thou Shalt Not Kill were no longer preachable…. They enlisted God: "He is certainly on our side, because our goals are sinless and our hearts are pure."
The most moderate said: "Kill but do not hate." One English preacher spoke of "the wrath of the Lamb" and another speculated that although Jesus would not have become a combatant, he would have enlisted in the Medical Corps.
MonetaRight. And it is still just as terrifying to know that history dictates, proves, that we are all totally nuts.
MikeNYThe market is forward looking in pricing positive or negative delusions. I regularly look at page 21 of this report: http://research.stlouisfed.org/publications/net/ The market has a hard time noticing drops in earnings. It usually takes a few quarters of dropping corporate profits to GDP before the market really reacts. Right now, the ratio is still at an all-time high so we probably still have a few more quarters of optimistic delusions… but the debt market is usually faster on the trigger. Code Name DFunctionally, the Fed believes that the only cure for a burst bubble is a bigger bubble - so this comes as no suprise. They appear to be wilfully blind that, in an era of plutocratic concentration of wealth, the old supply-side nostrums don't work.
The economic model is broken, and until we have a large redistribution of wealth in America, it will stay broken. The bi-partisan focus on 'growth' is a red herring, a distraction, so that we don't have a conversation about the real problem.
TimRBut they don't believe in bubbles. Any more than they believe in evolution, global warming, or that the poor can only afford to take weekend trips to the Bahamas.
Moneta…"before the Fed turns off its crazy money spigot"
"if the Fed keeps the money flowing and forgets about that taper business"
"And the Fed continues to feed Wall Street with $85 billion a month."
I'm still confused about QE. In a recent podcast with Stephanie Kelton and Warren Mosler (at neweconomicperspectives.org ), Mosler says, IIRC "..but QE doesn't flood the market with money." He describes QE as (correct me if I'm wrong) just shifting assets from the banks' savings account at the Fed, to their checking account at the Fed (although these accounts are called Treasuries and Reserves, they amount to savings/checking accounts.)
In the Randy Wray podcast (also at newecon), he says if QE ended, there would be a brief turmoil in the markets, and then investors would realize it didn't really make any difference.
Mosler also says that far from increasing the money supply, QE actually *removes* money from the economy, by turning interest-bearing assets into non-interest-bearing assets. And just because they're more liquid, doesn't mean people will run out and spend them into the economy. (One question I have on this aspect of it: what mechanism lets the Fed convert other parties' bonds to reserves, is it voluntary or involuntary for those bond-holders?)
I'm still looking for a really lucid source that describes in detail what's going on with QE. Mosler is great but I can't find an article by him drilling down into some of the details that are still unclear to me.
But posts like this throw me off, given Mosler's seeming authority and expertise. Is Wolf Richter just speaking in some shorthand, or does he not know what he's talking about wrt QE?
Dan KervickFor example:
The Fed decides to buys MBS… Pimco might be the seller… then Pimco ends up with cash which permits it to buy something else… government bonds, newer MBS, high yield, etc? So part of this money ends up in the economy and another part moves around across pension plans.
With low velocity, I would say that a lot of this money is just flowing up into the large DB plans.
MonetaRight, but because that MBS that once belonged to Pimco now belongs to the Fed, that cash flows attached to the MBS that would have gone to Pimco go to the Fed instead. So over time, about as much money is drained out of the private sector to the Fed as was injected into the private sector by the Fed's purchase.
susan the otherNot really because the new security that replaces the MBS has coupons also. Furthermore, if those MBS were backed by delinquent mortgages, no money would have been flowing anyway. Also, because the pension plans got propped up, pension benefit cheques are still being sent to retirees.
However, one thing is for sure, money is getting parked…
instead of having dollars move hand to hand, government must generate more dollars of debt to generate GDP.Sufferin'SuccotashBut the bottom line is that capitalism, not just our brand of gangster capitalism, is dead in the water. Capitalism relies on skimming from somewhere – excessive growth; trashing the environment; screwing labor, etc. Nothing is going to revive it now. We are "in crisis" because the old economy is useless and we will be here for a long time, years, maybe decades. So what's a Fed Head to do? Just keep the money circulating as much as possible. Life support. It is, however, a life support system that left out all but the very rich. So it will not save them either. Poetic justice. And Congress? Forget it.
markfThe situation resembles that editorial cartoon back in the late 1920s showing an endless belt with money flowing from Germany to France as reparations, from France to the US as repayment of war debts, then from the US back to Germany as loans.
Something in it for everybody (snicker)!
craazyboy"I'm still confused about QE."
You're not alone.
I've read articles by people explaining in incomprehensible (to me) detail, either why it's great, or why it's terrible.
and none of them seem to be able to write an explanation without using words and acronyms that I suspect many people don't understand.
They're talking to each other I suppose.
my simple question is, who is getting the credits, the money, and what are they using it for?
Where's it ending up? Is it going into the stock market?
is there a simple, layman's explanation for this? without any insider jargon?
Moneta"The Fed Winged It"
participant-observer-observedQE is good if it props up confidence and stops the world from imploding (which it did) but is bad if it generates a drop in confidence by squeezing out industry (which it is increasingly doing).
Go look at the balance sheets of the large consumer discretionary stocks over the last 1-2 years, compare it to the stock prices and tell me that their activity inspires confidence in future economic growth.
markfDIY QE education via "Quantitative Easing Explained" with 5.6 million views since 11/2010!
http://www.youtube.com/watch?v=PTUY16CkS-k
And "Quantitative Easity Revisited"
http://www.youtube.com/watch?v=oGIvw7T0GPI
I wonder if NC readers find anything false in these.
Code Name Dthanks.
ian"I'm still confused about QE. In a recent podcast with Stephanie Kelton and Warren Mosler (at neweconomicperspectives.org), Mosler says, IIRC
"..but QE doesn't flood the market with money." He describes QE as (correct me if I'm wrong) just shifting assets from the banks' savings account at the Fed, to their checking account at the Fed (although these accounts are called Treasuries and Reserves, they amount to savings/checking accounts.)"
Ha ha! That's a good one. The guy probably even believes it too.
Creating money is actually quite easy. *Poof* I just created a million Dubies. Want to see me do it again? *Poof*, another million Dubies. But the trick is getting some one to take my Dubies in trade for goods and services. In fact, my Dubies can't even be called a currency until they are accepted as a medium of exchange. I haven't actually made any Dubies, until I spend them into existence.
But there is another quirk here. If I was to accept a Dubie in exchange for something, as I was the originator of the Dubie, then the Dubie poofs into the same nothingness from whence it came. And this would only make sense, if I can create Dubis at will, than by definition a Dubie must have zero value to me. So every Dubie I take back, regardless of what I do with it later, effectively removes it from the economy.
Thus the amount of currency in circulation becomes a balance equation; if I spend more Dubies than I accept in trade, then the supply of Dubies is growing in the broader economy.
For the good old US of A, the one who poof's US dollars into existence isn't the US Treasury as you might think, but the Federal Reserve. This is why the government has this national debt because they have to schlep it like the rest of us.
So when the Fed "buys" any thing; from toilet paper for the office to trillions in mortgage backed securities, it is buying it with dollars that were poofed into existence. Regardless of the mumbo-jumbo they try to peddle about over-all balance sheets.
That gives you the fed's side of the story. But with Quantitative Easing, there is the other side of the store that is told by the too-big-too-fail-banks.
The Fed's theory about "the liquidity crises" is that the banks had a ton of assets that had temporally been devalued in price, thanks to the "great recession". (Snic- oh you just got to love that spin.) But once the recovery takes hold, and the economy is always in recovery, than all of those mortgage backed securities will snap back in value, and even start turning a profit again.
So to tide things over, the Federal Reserve basically buys bank-generated assets, such as mortgage backed securities, and holds them for later. When things recover, the Fed will start selling the assets back to the bank. So they aren't running those printing presses to cause the next Weimar Hyperinflation… oh no this is only temporary. See how clever they are?
Of course, now the 2B2F banks have an incentive to create worthless paper assets, knowing full well the Fed will buy them – no questions asked. And the FED doesn't risk any thing because it's the one that created to dollars in the first place. Indeed, they seem to have a preference for the junk as they are the only ones who will buy it. The Federal Reserve has basically become the consumer of last resort. The banks then have all that brand new free cash to play with which they can used to go gambling in the great global casino called the stock market. Or better yet, they can use those new dollars to create even MORE worthless assets with which to sell to the fed.
That is basically what is happening. The rest of the mumbo-jumbo you hear is just gibberish to try and obfuscate and conceal that this is actually happening, or more likely in an effort to puff themselves up and make themselves look… well…competent. All though I suspect they set there self delusionary image a lot higher than that. It's good to have goals I suppose.
So where is the hyper-inflation you may be asking? Well, it turns out that you don't create hyper-inflation by simply flooding the market with a currency you just printed. Why this is… is complicated. It's also some what off topic.
But there is another explanation. As I said before, a currency has to be spent into existence. But the fed isn't actually spending it, but rather simply making transfers in exchange for fiscal assets that are as equally made up. The 2b2fb take their new cash and "invest" them into other paper assets, which are also fabricated from out of thin air, and which value expands only because other 2b2fb are taking their new Fed cash and trying to buy the same paper assets.
Because the banks are basically creating assets to be sold to the fed, the 2b2fb have basically become a defacto extension of the fed. And like the fed, every dollar the 2b2fb take in – effectively disappears from the economy, regardless of what their balance sheet shows or how they chose to invest it in the stock market or other speculative bubbles.
Despite all the talk of Taper, the reality is that the fed CAN'T stop quantitative easing or the whole thing will simply implodes. But nor is all of the new fed money contributing to the economy because its all going to making more money through financing.
"Mosler also says that far from increasing the money supply, QE actually *removes* money from the economy, by turning interest-bearing assets into non-interest-bearing assets. And just because they're more liquid, doesn't mean people will run out and spend them into the economy. (One question I have on this aspect of it: what mechanism lets the Fed convert other parties' bonds to reserves, is it voluntary or involuntary for those bond-holders?)"
Well Mosler is not entirely wrong, but not for the reason he states. (FYI: Interest baring assets do not add currency to the economy.) Remember that balance sheet equation? If the fed spends more money than it takes in, then it is expanding the money supply. But if the 2b2fb have become extensions of the Federal Reserve because they in effect create money out of thin air, then they also have the consequence of destroying the money that they take onto their balance sheets. It then becomes a question of weather the 2b2fbs are spending more money then they are collecting.
As for the last part of your question… I have…. no clue.
Moneta"Despite all the talk of Taper, the reality is that the fed CAN'T stop quantitative easing or the whole thing will simply implodes."
Of course, that's the best reason for stopping it. Do it now, or do it later, with later being much worse.
Walter MapThe debt situation is worse now than it was in 2008. So if the Fed did not let stuff default then, why would it start now?
IMO, the Fed taper will depend on the ROW crumbling first.
skippyAnd the stock market, supposedly forward looking and focused on corporate revenues and earnings, has been completely blind to them. It follows the mantra that fundamentals no longer matter. All that matters is the Fed. A shift that has become the Fed's most glorious accomplishment. And the Fed continues to feed Wall Street with $85 billion a month.
Since 2008, Obama's policies and the Fed's policies have succeeded in reinflating the financial industry at the cost of an enormous amount of debt. The status quo has been preserved, but the real economy has been cannibalized and not restored. There have been no reforms, ensuring a repeat of the 2008 meltdown at an even greater scale. Wall St. is more out-of-control than ever.
Debt will allow you to ignore the fundamentals and put off the reckoning, but only for so long. That time is running out, and the rats are cashing in and jumping ship:
But now the smart money is scrambling to issue paper … before the Fed turns off its crazy money spigot
This will all end in tears.
MonetaSomething about rumor control a la Jim Rickards and any next event requiring an IMF SDR thingy… ouch.
MikeNYMany seem to think that QE was for the elite only. But it has also been for the benefit of the top 10-15%. Those with a pension.
90% of DBs are something like 30% underfunded. Without QE, I can imagine how many write-offs they would have had to do. How even more underfunded plans would have been.
Then, some propose having the government print, print, print without issuing debt… makes one wonder what these underfunded plans would buy! More corporate bonds based on easy printing? If we chose to go this route, chances are all plans would have to go pay-as-you-go. That would mean HUGE upheaval in the markets. The people would hate the elite even more… revolutions often start when the top 10-15% get angry but these QEs have been neutering them.
MonetaThe benefit of QE to pension funds depends on the asset mix. Equities have recovered, but fixed income yields have evaporated. So the Fed is forcing pension funds into a riskier asset mix (equities, alternative investments) as opposed to traditional I-grade corporates and treasuries.
I suggest QE is merely kicking the can wrt to pension funds, because what QE has done is to accelerate a decade or more of equity gains into the last couple of years. The hope was that the economy would attain "escape velocity" and justify the multiples and historically high profit margins.
As Ben Inker at GMO has written, this hope is justified only if the majority of American willingly embrace serfdom.
minimusYup. But they still got another good 4-5 years of bond gains and bailouts and QE propped up equities. It has probably given most DB pensioner n extra 5-10 years of benefits.
With no bailouts and QE, there would have been write-offs in bonds and equities would not have moved up as much. DB plans would have had to cut.
The reality is the leaders do not want to be the ones telling the top 10-15% that they are broke. They will do whatever it takes to just let it happen through what appears like market forces. That's what is great with being able to blame a central bank, it's impersonal.
Also, they probably intuitively know that the real trouble will come when those DBs go bust.
allcoppedoutCredit bubbles are marked by the use of a ton of leverage in the corporate sector, usually in the form of a wave of mega-LBOs. In the late 1990s and in 2005-2006, there was a new giant LBO announcement splashed across the front page of the Wall Street Journal practically every other day. That was a tell-tale sign of a credit bubble, a sign that was followed by a collapse of the credit markets in 2001-2002 and in 2008-2009. The absence of mega-LBOs in the current market suggests we are not in a credit bubble.
But I can see why this guy Baratta is complaining. In a "normal" environment, he would take a company private at a low multiple to EBITDA, use cost-cutting and fast economic growth to grow EBITDA, and then sell the company back to the public at a higher multiple. Boo hoo, multiples aren't low enough to ensure he will double his money at every one else's expense. Too bad.
I like the idea of there being a simple answer to QE or the world financial system. Let's face it, economics must be simple or the buffoons we elect wouldn't be able to understand it.
In principle QE sounds like it matters where you stack your money, almost as if moving it around the vault has some kind of 'astrological effect' on the real economy. Anyone who believes this should send their life savings to ACOPONZI (Cayman Offshore Secure Holdings) Inc before Jupiter next blinks. Send with complete power of attorney – we don't want regulatory red tape getting in the way of profits …
In ACOPONZI I'd no doubt start by lying to you – triple your money in months and such. QE started with a lie – it was to boost loans to the real economy and so on. I'm ex-cop and saw hundreds of scams as 'simple' as QE. A good one to look at now is the rip-off of US municipals – http://www.rollingstone.com/politics/news/the-scam-wall-street-learned-from-the-mafia-20120620
I generally found juries immune to fraudsters and their lawyers and this holds in the US municipals case. I think we need to 'go cop' to see that QE is really just a simple scam. As in the case Tabbi reports, we the public are the losers and a small few have been facilitated in looting. We need to boil it down to Cui Bono.
The banking system clearly could not be supported by different astrological positioning of money. In the Carrolo trial wiretaps clearly demonstrate the simple scam.
I guess QE somehow facilitates drawing fresh money in the Ponzi and the hiding of losses in an 888 account. The defense is that this is for the good of us all because otherwise the sky will fall. What we need to understand this is not the espoused theory of QE but the money trail and transaction transcripts of its theory-in-practice.
Our municipalities had plenty of well-qualified and well-paid lawyers and accountants, but were ripped off by a simple scam. The Fed and BoE have lots of well-qualified people too. QE will turn out to be a simple scam. We don't need complex explanations, but do need evidence of the transactions it has allowed. Anyone really want to bet on who is holding the debt parcel?
Economist's View
Matt Young
Matt Younghttp://www.reuters.com/article/2013/10/01/us-debtceiling-dimon-idUSBRE99002020131001
(Reuters) - JP Morgan chief executive Jamie Dimon is headed for a scheduled meeting, along with other bank executives, with President Barack Obama on Wednesday, the Wall Street Journal reported.While talking to WSJ, an industry participant said concern over the debt ceiling battle would be raised during the meeting.
------------
On the first day of shut down my true love gave to me
One JP Morgan CEOMatt YoungWolf Richter: Bubble Trouble: Record Junk Bond Issuance, A Barrage Of IPOs, "Out Of Whack" Valuations, And Grim Earnings Growth
By Wolf Richter, a San Francisco based executive, entrepreneur, start up specialist, and author, with extensive international work experience. Cross posted from Testosterone Pit.
When Blackstone's global head of private equity, Joseph Baratta, said Thursday night that "we" were "in the middle of an epic credit bubble," the likes of which he hadn't seen in his career, he knew whereof he spoke.
Junk bond issuance hit an all-time record of $47.6 billion in September, edging out the prior record, set in September last year, of $46.8 billion, according to S&P Capital IQ/LCD. Year to date, issuance amounted to $255 billion, blowing away last year's volume for this period of $243 billion. The year 2012, already in a bubble, set an all-time record with $346 billion. This year, if the Fed keeps the money flowing and forgets about that taper business, junk bond issuance will beat that record handily.
Junk-bond funds got clobbered in July and August as retail investors briefly opened their eyes and realized what they had on their hands and fled, and they went looking for yield elsewhere, but there was still no yield in reasonable places, and so they held their noses and picked up these reeking junk-bond funds again. Cash inflow doubled over the last week to $3.1 billion, the most in ten weeks.
--------------
I wonder if Dimon and Obama will notice that ginormous bubble in the market?Matt YoungBloomberg:
U.S. stock-index futures advanced, signaling the Standard & Poor's 500 Index will rebound from a three-week low, as investors weighed the impact of the first partial government shutdown in 17 years.
Merck & Co. jumped 2.9 percent after the company announced an overhaul that will eliminate 8,500 workers. Under Armour Inc. increased 0.9 percent as JPMorgan Chase & Co. upgraded the maker of workout clothing. Symantec Corp. lost 2 percent after saying its chief financial officer left.
--------------
Shutdown? What shutdown?Fred C. DobbsYesterday, ED.gov provided its annual update - this time to the 2010 three year and 2011 two year cohorts - and to nobody's major surprise, learned that things just got even worse. To wit: "The national two-year cohort default rate rose from 9.1 percent for FY 2010 to 10 percent for FY 2011. The three-year cohort default rate rose from 13.4 percent for FY 2009 to 14.7 percent for FY 2010." Putting this in context, according to Bloomberg defaults have risen to the highest level since 1995.
-----------
This is what has been driving JP Morgan out of the business for the past few months.(True Believers are always Right.)
Conservatives With a Cause: 'We're Right' http://nyti.ms/15HBDIb
NYT - September 30, 2013 - ASHLEY PARKERWASHINGTON - ... Senator Harry Reid, the Nevada Democrat and majority leader, had his own colorful, if somewhat skewed, metaphor about why much of the government was about to grind to halt in a take-no-political-prisoners fight over what is essentially a simple six-week funding bill, attributing it to the emergence of a "banana Republican mind-set."
Mr. Reid's language was evocative, and the implication was serious. With Democrats controlling the White House and Senate and with millions of dollars spent getting the health care law to the starting line, what gives House Republicans the idea that they can triumph in their push to repeal, or at least delay, the Affordable Care Act when so many veteran voices in their party see it as an unwinnable fight?
"Because we're right, simply because we're right," said Representative Steve King, Republican of Iowa, one of the most conservative of House lawmakers. "We can recover from a political squabble, but we can never recover from Obamacare."
Representative Raúl Labrador, Republican of Idaho and one of the original proponents of the so-called Defund Obamacare movement, was similarly sanguine. "We can always win," he said Monday afternoon, as he jogged up the stairs to a closed-door conference meeting, where House Republicans gathered to plot their next move.
Representative Pete Sessions, Republican of Texas and chairman of the House Rules Committee, hinted that Republicans were unlikely to give up without at least another round since they see their campaign against the health care law as something of a higher quest. And many, if not most, people they talk to - colleagues, friendly constituents, activists, members of advocacy groups - reinforce that opinion, bolstering their belief that they are on the right side not just ideologically, but morally as well.
"This isn't the end of the road, guys," Mr. Sessions said with a grin. "This is halftime." ...
Market Realist
Fund flows rebound
Fund flows rebounded significantly last week, reaching $1.4 billion versus $0.4 billion the week before. While this value is still below the huge $1.7 billion spike the week prior, it certainly shows that investors are still willing-at least for one last week-to speculate on bonds.
Nonetheless, as we've discussed, the statements by three Fed presidents are likely to dampen investor excitement.
August slowdown?
August is usually a slow month, though this year, investors have pushed well into August, squeezing the last yield of the bond market (BND). The strong volumes from last week, though, may be the result of several issuers piling in before most of the dealmakers go on vacation.
If issuance volumes drop by the end of this week, the secondary market is likely to slow down as well. By the time the August vacation is over, the September tapering will be upon us. So right now may be a good time to hedge or get out.
Read on to see how the high yield bond market has behaved recently.
Continue to Part 4: Downside potential in September for high-yield bonds
But after August comes September, along with more tapering concerns, budget discussions, and debt ceiling hype. High yield bonds (HYG) are unlikely to move significantly higher in August, and September will only bring a wild ride of volatility with significant downside potential.
The high yield market (JNK) volume was extremely bullish last week, to say the least
The fund flows for last week once again plummeted as investors remove cash from bonds ahead of the FOMC meeting.Fund flows are key in determining the sentiment of investors towards a given asset class. Weekly fund flows measure how much cash investors put into and remove from mutual funds focused on investing in high yield bonds.
The $3.3 billion outflow last week follows an all-time high outflow of $4.6 billion the prior week. The year to date outflows are now $6.3 billion, after been positive just two weeks before. This strong reversal towards the negative side emphasizes how investors fled the asset class in anticipation of rising interest rates.
Investors averse to high duration
The fixed coupon of bonds makes them sensitive to changes in interest rates, causing the price of the bonds to fall as interest rates rise. Since the rise in interest rates is imminent, investors have been trying to off-load their exposure to bonds.
The upcoming Federal Open Market Committee (FOMC) will have Federal Reserve Chair Ben Bernanke issue a statement of their outlook on the economy and interest rates. If his message hints at an earlier than expected tapering of the expansionary monetary policy, then rates will go up. The Federal Reserve has been buying over $80 billion in long term Treasury and mortgage bonds, artificially increasing the demand and causing interest rates to fall. When these actions are removed, the rates will slingshot back up.
GETTING PERSONAL: Seeking a Less Rocky Road in Corporate Bonds
Jul 29, 2013 | ETRADE(This article was originally published Friday.)
--Managers find investment-grade bonds attractive
--Some high-quality bond funds holding up better
--Despite risks, investors jump back into junk
By Murray ColemanYield-starved fund investors ready to move back into more risky corners of corporate bond markets might first want to pause and catch their breath, which is what many investment advisers are doing.
Instead of loading up on so-called high yield, or junk, they're taking advantage of greater opportunities in higher-rated issues.
Since a sharp sell-off in bonds from mid-May through late June, investment-grade corporates are looking more attractive by some valuation measures. With prices moving inversely to yields, such high-quality fare are also sporting more appealing income streams.
"We're finding investment-grade corporates to be a good place to hide out as bond markets search for some sort of equilibrium," says Lucas Turton, chief investment officer at Windham Capital Management in Boston with $1.2 billion in assets.
In mid-June, portfolio managers at the advisory firm started to slash holdings in junk exchange-traded funds. At the same time, they began adding to investment-grade corporate positions. A current favorite is the Vanguard Short-Term Corporate Bond ETF (VCSH).
With tapering of the Federal Reserve's massive bond-buying program and historically low interest rates still a concern, Mr. Turton says that "it just doesn't seem like a good time now to court more risk by moving too deeply into high-yield bonds."
While junk funds could be setting up for a stronger second-half, advisers point to several overhanging clouds.
"Although we expect better performance from high-yield bonds compared to investment-grade over the next several quarters, market volatility is also likely to be higher," says Guy LeBas, chief fixed-income strategist at Janney Montgomery Scott LLC.
The speculative U.S. bond market's default rate is on-pace to increase to 3.2% by November, Moody's Investors Service predicted earlier this week. That would be up from the second quarter's 2.9%, but still well below the 4.5% average since 1993.
"They're a more boring choice, but investment-grade corporates are standing on a little less scorched earth than high-yield bonds," says Daniele Donahoe, chief investment officer at Rinehart Wealth Management in Charlotte, N.C., with $300 million in assets.
Investors remain tentative about lower yielding parts of the corporate-bonds landscape, according to data from market researcher IndexUniverse. Since late June, net inflow into U.S. investment-grade corporate bond ETFs was at $203 million by mid-week, still far from replenishing a previous 30-day period of heavy losses.
At the same time, investors are returning to junk-bond funds in force. Since policy makers began reassuring markets about their economic stimulus plans, more than $2.9 billion has flowed into junk bond ETFs.
Investors are largely neglecting higher-quality bond funds, some of which are actually holding up better than their junk rivals, Ms. Donahoe says. One of her favorite picks is the iShares Intermediate Credit Bond ETF (CIU). While its returns dropped 3.57% from May 22 through June 25, the iShares 7-10 Year Treasury Bond ETF (IEF) lost 4.21%. Also, the iShares iBoxx High Yield Corporate Bond ETF (HYG) slumped by 4.59%.
"This sell-off was duration-based and investors need to be aware that big differences exist even within bond funds that are classified as intermediate-term," Ms. Donahoe says.
The biggest player in the field by assets, the $19.3 billion iShares iBoxx Investment Grade Corporate Bond ETF (LQD), has a weighted average maturity more than twice that of the iShares Credit Bond fund. It fell 6.07% in the pullback.
As long as defaults remain below long-term averages and a relatively low-rate environment persists, investors trying to live on fixed incomes should use all of the tools at their disposal, says Wes Moss, chief investment strategist at $1.1 billion Capital Investment Advisors in Atlanta.
His idea: Stick with investment-grade corporates at the longer-end of the intermediate curve like the iShares Investment Grade Corporate ETF. It has a distribution yield of 3.90%, more than the shorter-termed iShares Credit Bond ETF's 2.69%.
While higher credit quality corporates typically produce lower income streams, Mr. Moss says that many high-yield bond ETFs come with relatively low durations, which are measures of interest rate sensitivity.
The iShares High Yield ETF, for example, has a duration of 4.1 years with a yield of 6.45%.
"We're using high-yield bonds in combination with investment-grade securities to lower portfolio durations," Mr. Moss says. "It's really the best of both worlds. We're generating higher income and still keeping interest rate risks at bay."
(Murray Coleman is a wealth management columnist who writes about investing in exchange-traded funds and new trends in mutual funds. He can be reached at: [email protected])
Subscribe to WSJ: http://online.wsj.com?mod=djnwires
Zero Hedge
Do Not Panic!! This is orderly...
The current decline in the high yield market, now at 30 trading days, has been the fastest since the end of the 2008 recession, with yields widening 159 bp. Only the July - October 2011 market decline had a greater ultimate magnitude than the current period.
As we noted here:Panafrican Funk...Remember - and it's important - there is no rotation that drives high-yield credit spreads wider without punishing equities. They are liabilities on the same capital structure and rise and fall in a highly correlated (well non-linear co-dependence) manner as the underlying business risk rises and falls.
Do not, repeat do not, see high yield credit weakness as a sign of rotation to stocks - if the credit cycle has turned then stocks are set to fall. And bear in mind that while HY yields are at all-time lows, spreads are not and in fact being short stocks relative to credit makes more sense if you are you are a bear on the credit cycle here.
The only problem being that the epic flows that sustained a credit market at non-economic levels for so long will exit in a hurry.
nope-1004http://seekingalpha.com/article/1521072-s-p-500-stock-dividend-yields-vs-10-year-treasury
Pretty good article showing the collapse of the stock div arb. Dividend stocks are going to get fucking pummeled.
Yes, there are occasionally people on the Fool that are not completely stupid.
The big indicator prior to the 2008 market meltdown was the corporate bond market. Appears to be happening again, but will this time be different? Dunno.cougar_wPlease do not worry. 10 yr. creepin' to 2.61 currently.
ETFChannel.com
In trading on Tuesday, shares of the High-Yield Municipal Index ETF (AMEX: HYD) entered into oversold territory, changing hands as low as $32.08 per share. We define oversold territory using the Relative Strength Index, or RSI, which is a technical analysis indicator used to measure momentum on a scale of zero to 100. A stock is considered to be oversold if the RSI reading falls below 30.
In the case of High-Yield Municipal Index, the RSI reading has hit 22.9 - by comparison, the RSI reading for the S&P 500 is currently 54.3.
A bullish investor could look at HYD's 22.9 reading as a sign that the recent heavy selling is in the process of exhausting itself, and begin to look for entry point opportunities on the buy side.
Looking at a chart of one year performance (below), HYD's low point in its 52 week range is $31.42 per share, with $33.57 as the 52 week high point - that compares with a last trade of $32.10. High-Yield Municipal Index shares are currently trading down about 2% on the day.
June 04, 2013 | Businessweek
Pacific Investment Management Co.'s Bill Gross, manager of the world's biggest bond fund (PTTRX), said the Federal Reserve's zero-bound interest rate policy and quantitative easing programs are becoming more of a problem for an economy that needs structural reforms.
The Fed's polices are "desperately attempting to cure an economy that requires structural as opposed to monetary solutions," Gross wrote in his monthly investment outlook posted on Newport Beach, California-based Pimco's website today. "Central banks -- including today's superquant Kuroda, leading the Bank of Japan -- seem to believe that higher and higher asset prices produced necessarily by more and more QE check writing will inevitably stimulate real economic growth via the spillover wealth effect."
The Fed is purchasing $85 billion a month in Treasuries and mortgage debt as part of its third round of quantitative easing, which began after it dropped its benchmark rate to almost zero to lift the economy out of recession. The central bank cut its target rate for overnight loans to a range of zero to 0.25 percent in December of 2008.
Global Stimulus
Haruhiko Kuroda, governor of the BOJ, is pursuing unprecedented stimulus to jolt Japan out of deflation. The European Central Bank cut its benchmark rate by 0.25 percentage point to a record 0.5 percent on May 2, and speculation has mounted that the Bank of England will increase its bond-buying target after Mark Carney takes over as governor next month.
The Fed holds more than $3 trillion in assets on its balance sheet as a result of three rounds of quantitative easing, up from about $900 billion in 2007.
"Low yields, low carry, future low expected returns have increasingly negative effects on the real economy," Gross wrote. "Credit expansion in the private economy is restricted by an expanding Fed balance sheet and the limits on Treasury" repurchase agreements.
Gross advised investors reduce risk and carry-related assets, referring to assets that have a higher perceived risk than securities such as Treasuries or longer-term debt.
Past Predictions
Gross said May 16 that fixed income's three-decade bull market "was over." He said on May 31 that Pimco likes Treasuries (USGG10YR) that mature in five to 10 years, as there will be "no tapering for now."
Yields on 10-year Treasuries rose 46 basis points in May, including a jump of 16 basis points, or 0.16 percentage point, on May 28, as a report showing consumer confidence climbed to the highest in more than five years bolstered speculation the Fed would scale back its purchases. Gross's Pimco Total Return Fund (PTTRX), the world's largest mutual fund, declined 1.9 percent in May, the biggest monthly loss since September 2008.
The performance (PTTRX) of the $293 billion Total Return Fund puts it behind 94 percent of similarly managed funds through May 30, according to data compiled by Bloomberg. The fund's allocation to Treasuries has hindered performance as government-debt securities declined.
U.S. government debt tumbled 2 percent last month, the most since December 2009, according to Bank of America Merrill Lynch indexes. Employment gains and increases in housing and consumer confidence suggested the recovery in the U.S. economy, the world's largest, is gaining momentum.
Global bond markets posted their biggest monthly losses in nine years in May. The Bank of America Merrill Lynch Global Broad Market Index, which tracks more than $40 trillion of bonds, fell 1.5 percent.
Gross raised the holdings of Treasuries in his flagship fund to 39 percent as of April 30, the highest level since July 2010, from 33 percent as of March 31. He's increased the proportion of U.S. government securities every month this year since February. In 2011, Gross's fund lost an estimated $5 billion to withdrawals, according to Morningstar Inc., after he eliminated U.S. Treasuries early in the year and missed a rally.
Pimco, a unit of the Munich-based insurer Allianz SE, managed $2.04 trillion in assets as of March 31.
To contact the reporters on this story: Liz Capo McCormick in New York at [email protected]
To contact the editors responsible for this story: Dave Liedtka at [email protected]
Yahoo! Finance
Junk bond issuance is at record highs this year-and thus at the greatest danger should yields start rising.
Companies around the world have issued $254 billion in high-yield debt this year, a number that includes $130.6 billion from the U.S., according to the latest numbers from Dealogic.
Global issuance is up a stunning 53 percent from the same period in 2012 and has accounted for 9 percent of the total deals in the debt capital markets space-also a record and fully one-third higher than last year's pace.
The U.S. issuance has increased 24 percent over the previous year. Record issuance also has come from the U.K., China, Russia-and debt-plagued Italy, which despite being at the center of the European sovereign debt crisis has seen $7 billion hit the junk bond market this year, Dealogic said.
Because junk bonds have a history of trading in tandem with the stock market , it's not a big surprise to see issuance swell.
The Standard & Poor's 500 (^GSPC) has surged nearly 16 percent this year, and the high-yield market has followed. The Barclays U.S. Corporate High Yield Index returned 4.75 percent through April.
But with investors beginning to fear that the Federal Reserve may stage an early exit from its monetary stimulus programs, fears are growing that junk bonds could take a hit.
"On the surface, things look pretty good in the high yield market," Citigroup analysts said in a report. "Digging a little deeper, however, we see some troubling signs."
All that supply is beginning to take a toll on the secondary market-where those who buy the bonds from issuers go to trade them-and there are signs that demand is waning.
The two leading exchange-traded funds for junk-the SPDR Barclays High Yield Bond (JNK) and the iShares iBoxx $ High-Yield Corporate Bond (HYG)-sustained a combined $660 million in outflows last week, the second-worst of any class after emerging markets, according to IndexUniverse.
Mutual funds saw a similar trend, with $581 million in high-yield redemptions, the worst week since November, according to Thomson Reuters.
Citi said the monthly total looks like it will be the largest high-yield selling since at least November 2008.
Where the market goes from here is likely dependent on the Fed.
Some Open Market Committee members indicated at the last meeting that a gradual decrease of the central bank's $85 billion a month in purchases of Treasurys and mortgage-backed securities would be warranted as early as June.
In response, Treasury yields have jumped upwards, and some firms-Goldman Sachs, in particular-are asserting that these could be the early days of the bond bull market's demise.
"We've been bullish on high yield since September and will not change our view based on these developments, because we believe the market has overreacted to the Fed's comments," Citi said. "They highlight, however, the challenge for the FOMC and the risk of a policy misstep."
The biggest potential misstep: A move by the Fed that would startle markets, push investors away from riskier bonds and send yield spreads wider.
All that issuance suddenly would find a tougher marketplace, driving up yields and making borrowing for lower-credit companies significantly more expensive from the current yields which slipped below 5 percent in May.
Citi said the exodus from high-yield has been due to "an expectation of faster liquidity withdrawal from the Fed" and warned that "as this occurs, capital flows are likely to turn negative, in our view, thereby limiting access to funding and maybe even increasing default concerns."
As evidence mounts that a mid-year slowdown is taking place in the world economy, the next few days will offer a clearer glimpse of how that will impinge on policymaking and buoyant financial markets.
... ... ...
Some poor business surveys from China have also had an impact, suggesting the world's No.2 economy is struggling for momentum.
... ... ...
"The underlying momentum in the global economy is weaker than it should be at this point of the economic cycle, five years after the global crisis," said Lena Komileva, director of G+ Economics consultancy in London.
"We have yet to see evidence of a convincing, self-sustained positive feedback loop between real growth and market value inflation."
... ... ...
Growth is still proving to be elusive for the euro zone economy, largely thanks to the extent of the budget austerity taking place across the continent.
... ... ...
March 5, 2013 | Barrons.com
Pimco's Bill Gross was on Bloomberg TV today, where he was asked whether junk-bonds – currently yielding 5.81% on average at a spread of 4.98 percentage points over Treasuries – continue to make sense if risk premiums fall further given the market's inherent risk. Here's Gross:
Are [spreads] less rational at 4 or 3 [percentage points]? Certainly. We know, and history would prove that in the high-yield market that as the exuberance follows through, that defaults begin to increase. That's one of the pieces of the puzzle that Jeremy Stein, the Fed governor, pointed out in his paper where he spoke to irrational exuberance. So defaults are coming, it's just a question of how extensive they are. And if they're only at a 2-3% pace, which is where they are now, and if you get a normal recovery, then you're still left with a 3-4% return at today's levels. If you squeeze it a little bit more, then you're getting closer to that cash [return] number, that is really a point of little return.
Asia Times
... We could think of that as the yield on fixed-interest investments which compete with equities, or - more realistically - as the borrowing cost to buy corporate cash flows.
That has come down to the lowest level in history, thanks to the Federal Reserve. It costs junk-rated single-B borrowers only 6% on average to issue new 10-year debt. It's hard to compare the yield on single-B securities with prospective earning s on stocks. Single-B borrowers are likely to default. The time value of money argument becomes confusing because the future default rate is unknown.
But if you are a private equity fund buying a traded company, as Brazil's 3G Capital and Warren Buffett bought Heinz last week, the likelihood of default has a totally different meaning: that's the likelihood that you will default to people who lent money to you. As much as it hurts to default, it hurts a lot more to be on the receiving end of a default. As one industry giant told me years ago: "High yield bonds are there to be sold, not bought."
Exhibit 5: Junk bonds at lowest yields on record
Why are junk bond yields at all-time lows? There are two big reasons. The first is that the economy has been more cartelized, less entrepreneurial and less risky. The bad news is always someone's good news. During the 1990s, disruptive new technologies turned a lot of stable franchises to junk - literally, in the case of some telephone company bonds. The Facebook misfire and Apple's fall from grace point up the sclerotic character of the economy. No-one need worry about entrepreneurial challengers. They have nothing to do with the price of ketchup.
And the second is that the Federal Reserve has vacuumed up a vast amount of risk into its own portfolio (by purchasing longer-term Treasuries and mortgage-backed securities), leaving the market chronically short of yield.
Private equity firms can borrow at the lowest yields on record and lever up the earnings of stable corporations like Heinz, extracting the difference between the cost of financing and the levered earnings yield. That makes the equity of predictable companies like Heinz valuable.
Early last month, Fed Governor Jeremy Stein gave a speech titled Overheating in Credit Markets: Origins, Measurement, and Policy Responses that raised the question of whether or not we might be seeing a bubble, and if so what might be done about it.
You've probably heard a lot of talk about the aggressive lengths that money managers are going to to "reach for yield" in the context of this ultra low-rates environment.
Stein didn't sound too fearful yet, but the overall concern is that we could be setting up another credit bubble, just like before the recent crash.
In the latest version of their US Interest Rates Strategist letter, Morgan Stanley's Vincent Reinhart and Matthew Hornbach look at the scene in corporate credit and determine that the market might be "modestly rich" rather than straight-up "overheated."
Three charts from their work stand out, that nicely call into question the idea of a bubble.
First, although junk bond (or high-yield) yields are at record lows, actual spreads (where those yields are relative to risk-free Treasuries) remain well off their lowest levels.
The chart is a little bit noisy for the unfamiliar, but the line to watch here is the green line, which shows the average high-yield spread, or the average difference between what high-yield credit pays and what risk-free Treasuries pay. The current difference is about 500 basis points, well above the less then 300 basis points that we saw pre-crisis.
The next chart shows what companies are doing with the proceeds of their high-yield borrowing. Whereas in 2007, high-yield debt issuance was going to things like leveraged buyouts and other acquisitions, these days the proceeds are going overwhelmingly to refinance old debt, which is just really prudent financial management.
And then finally, the underlying condition of high-yield debt issuers is in better shape these days. They have more cash relative to debt, suggesting that their credits are fundamentally safer.
None of this is to suggest that there aren't causes for concern. And you should read Jeremy Stein's speech (here) but the evidence of a raging bubble in this space has to be tempered by signs that prices aren't totally out of whack, and issuers of high-yield debt aren't going crazy.
February 27, 2013 | WSJ.com
"On a scale of 1-10 measuring asset price 'irrationality', we are probably at a 6 and moving in an upward direction," Gross writes in his March investment outlook. "Corporate credit and high yield bonds are somewhat exuberantly and irrationally priced. Spreads are tight, corporate profit margins are at record peaks with room to fall, and the economy is still fragile."
But Mr. Gross doesn't recommend selling en masse, only lowering return expectations. After double-digit returns on junk bonds last year, he says 3%-to-4% returns are more likely this year. Prices are too high and yields are simply too low for the market to continue delivering such high returns.
Mr. Gross-often dubbed "the Bond King"-spends much of his March outlook referring back to a Feb. 7 speech from Federal Reserve governor Jeremy Stein, who expressed concern that "we are seeing a fairly significant pattern of reaching-for-yield behavior emerging in corporate credit."
For Mr. Gross, those comments harked back to the famous "irrational exuberance" talk in 1996 from former Fed chief Alan Greenspan. Now, as then, the market is trying to determine whether certain assets are overvalued and what to do about it.
His conclusion: be cautious.
"We join with Governor Stein and perhaps Alan Greenspan in encouraging not an exit but a reduced expectation," he says. "Be rational, be optimistic if so inclined, but temper it with a commonsensical conclusion that we have seen something similar to this before, and that previous outcomes seldom matched the exuberance."
Mr. Gross's comments come a day after Fed chairman Ben Bernanke weighed in on the question of overheated markets in his speech to Congress on Tuesday. "Although a long period of low rates could encourage excessive risk-taking … we do not see the potential costs of the increased risk-taking in some financial markets as outweighing the benefits of promoting a stronger economic recovery and more-rapid job creation," the chairman said.
The value of 200 days average is 5.99 or $.09 below the value on Feb 11 closing. 1000 days average is 5.58.
At the beginning of 2004 (also four years from previous recession, junk dropped from 6.40 to 6.15. After then it went downhill to 3.90 in December 2008.
Economist's View
Binyamin Appelbaum:
Fed Official Sees Tension in Some Credit Markets, by Binyamin Appelbaum, NY Times: Some credit markets are showing signs of overheating as investors take larger risks in response to the persistence of low interest rates... Fed Governor Jeremy Stein, highlighted a surge in junk bond issues, the popularity of certain kinds of real estate investment trusts and shifts in bank balance sheets as areas the central bank is watching closely...Mr. Stein gave no indication that the Fed is contemplating any change in its aggressive efforts to hold down interest rates. Rather, he described the overheating as a trend that might require a response if it intensified over the next 18 months. But the speech nonetheless underscored that the Fed increasingly regards bubbles, rather than inflation, as the most likely negative consequence of its efforts to reduce unemployment by stimulating growth. ...Central bankers historically have been skeptical that asset bubbles can be identified or prevented from popping. Moreover, they tend to regard financial regulation as the appropriate means to prevent excessive speculation and not changes in monetary policy ... But the crisis has forced central bankers to reconsider both the importance of financial stability and the role of monetary policy. ...And he closed on a cautionary note. "Decisions will inevitably have to be made in an environment of significant uncertainty," he said. "Waiting for decisive proof of market overheating may amount to an implicit policy of inaction on this dimension."With fiscal policy moving in the wrong direction -- deficit reduction rather than employment enhancing stimulus, e.g. infrastructure -- if monetary policymakers begin getting skittish, then the unemployed will lose the one institution that seemed to actually care about their struggles. Not good.
Jan 28, 2013 | Forbes
Junk bonds: talk about an awful description for non-investment grade debt. And we all thought B's an high C's in school were above average.
In some cases, they are.
The ugly junk bonds of old have now become the more palatable high yield bonds of today. In a low interest rate environment like we have now, high yield is a Godsend. These companies are high yield for a reason, of course. Their debt is riskier. Credit analysts look at the corporate balance and income sheets and gauge whether or not a company has enough money to cover its short term maturing debt while paying interest on its long term loans, and still manage to grow as a company. Those who can barely cover it are always considered high yield.
Yet, high yield issuers are doing pretty good as an investment class.
In fact, for the third year in a row the default rate for non-investment grade bonds stood at 1.9 percent, Fitch Ratings said Monday in a special report. That's higher than the 1.5 percent default rate last year, but still well below the historic average default rate of 4.9 percent.
Thirty-two issuers defaulted on $20.5 billion in bonds last year, compared with 29 issuers and $15.9 billion in 2011. The year produced a considerable number of large defaults, though, including bankrupt firms like Edison Mission Energy ($3.7 billion), Residential Capital ($2.8 billion), ATP Oil and Gas ($1.5 billion) and struggling names like Energy Future Holdings ($1.8 billion), also on the cusp of Chapter 11.
Fitch Ratings projected that the default rate in 2013 will be similar to last year's. If Energy Future Holdings goes under, then it could push the rate up higher due to the company's size. Plus, with the U.S. economy still running on easy money, the constructive outlook for defaults is heavily dependent on steady, if not, stellar macro conditions, today's report stated. Fitch is projecting U.S. GDP growth of 2.3 percent in 2013, assuming political discord in Washington does not have a material impact on the economy.
Fitch believes that the default rate on high yield debt would "at least double if the economy slides back into recession or very low growth."
Junk bond funds have been relatively quiet this year. State Street's $40 billion Barclays High Yield Bond (JNK) exchange traded fund is up 1.58 percent year-to-date ending, while the S&P 500 is up 5.3 percent. By comparison, JNK is beating the Barclays 3-7 Year Treasury Bond Fund (IEI), which is down 0.5 percent year-to-date. Over the past 12 months, the JNK bond ETF rose 4.79 percent to IEI's 0.4 percent "low yield/risk-free" gain.
Last year's riskiest sectors were the paper and pulp industry (7.7% default rate), utilities (10.5%), consumer products (4.7%), transportation (4.4%) and banks (3.3%).
High yield issuance topped $300 billion in 2012. The majority of that was used to refinance existing debt and by the end of 2012, 80 percent of market volume ($1.13 trillion) consisted of bonds sold since 2009. Beyond pushing out debt maturities last year, high yield borrowers in 2012 saw a decline in their interest rates as demand for their bonds rose. Higher demand for bonds, means higher bond prices. Higher bond prices, of course, means lower interest rates for the one's issuing the debt. The weighted average interest rate offered slipped to 7.99 percent from a higher yielding 8.27 percent at the beginning of 2012. As a result, issuance began to move more aggressively down the rating scale as companies felt they had a better chance to find a lender at lower cost. From July to year-end, the volume of 'CCC' rated new bond issues rose 54 percent and made up 18 percent of overall junk bond issuance.
The Junk in JNKs Trunk
Company Sector Coupon*
HCA Holdings Healthcare services 6.5%
Sprint Nextel Telecommunications 9.0%
First Data Business services 12.62%
Energy Future Utilities 10%
Samson Investment Co. Energy 9.75%
Community Health Sys Healthcare services 8.0%
Ally Financial Banking 8.3%
FMG Resources Metals & mining 7.0%
Everest Acquisition Oil & gas 9.37%
Dish DBS Broadcasting services 6.75%*Coupon, for the non-bond lords among us, is the yield offered at issuance. Current yield almost always differs from the coupon rate as bond prices fluctuate.
Jan 26, 2013 | Forbes
Earlier this month, the yield on the average junk bond dropped below 6% for the first time ever. Because of this, many investors think that yields can't go any lower and that interest rates will reverse in 2013.
Here's four reasons why they are wrong:
Reason number 1: Junk bond credit spreads are not anywhere near all time historical lows.
In addition to the interest rate a particular type of bond (ie. high yield, investment grade etc) is paying, bond traders will look at how that rate compares to treasuries. This comparison enables traders to understand if a category of bonds is expensive or cheap given the current level of overall interest rates.
The below chart shows the difference in yield between the average high yield bond, and a treasury of the same maturity. This is what is known as the high yield credit spread. (You can learn more about credit spreads here.)
As you can see from the above chart, while junk bond yields are at all time lows, the high yield credit spread is nowhere near an all time low. In fact, there were two extended periods of time since 1996 (which is as far back as the Fed's data goes), that the high yield credit spread was around 2.5%. This means at its current level of 5%, the high yield credit spread would have to drop another 2.5% before hitting a new all time low.
Reason Number 2: Corporate Default Rates are near an all time low
As you can see from the below chart, the average default rate on corporate bonds is around 4%. That compares to the current default rate of around 1.1%. So, while junk bond yields are at historic lows, so is the corporate default rate.
Reason number 3: Yield starved bond managers are going to start to leverage up.
This one I got from a recent presentation by bond guru Jeffrey Gundlach. In his view the Junk bond market is not yet in a bubble. Normally, a bubble is partially caused by investors increasing their leverage, which has not yet happened. He does think however that bond managers are going to start adding leverage to try and juice whatever yield they can out of this low yield environment.
When this happens it will have the same effect as if a lot of new money and demand was coming into the market. While this will likely inflate a junk bond bubble in the future, it is likely to send yields even lower in the near term. A recent article in the Wall Street Journal confirms that this is already starting.
Reason number 4: Everyone thinks there is a bubble in junk bonds.
Learn Bonds publishes a piece called The Best of the Bond Market, where we link to all the best bond market stories from around the web each trading day. There have been so many stories about the "bubble in junk bonds" that I have had to tell the writer to start leaving some of them out. If we included them all then half the stories in the piece would be the same story calling for a bubble in junk bonds.
From my experience when everyone thinks a market is going to go in one direction, that market has a nasty habit of heading in the exact opposite direction.
For another idea on how to increase yields in this low yield environment read our article Dividend Investing for Bond Investors here.
Forbes
When you invest in risk, you want the reward, right? Yet, emerging market and high yield bonds in general have underperformed safety all year. The trend, says David Sherman, manager of the RiverPark Short Term High Yield (RPHYX) bond fund could be drawing to a close.
"Although the high yield market sentiment often is correlated to the equity market, the space has gotten very beaten up. Unless Europe and the U.S. address their balance sheets and provide world leadership to rebuild confidence, I suspect high yield will outperform equities over the next 12 months," Sherman says.
"Investors can earn a yield-to-maturity on an average duration of around 3 years in high yield in excess of 12% on a diversified portfolio rated B/B- with Debt/EBITDA of under 4.5 times," he says.
The Merrill Lynch High Yield Master II Bond Index ended the third quarter down 1.69%, the worst quarterly performance since the third quarter of 2008 and the fourth worst performing quarter since September 1986.
The risk trade had investors pouring into Treasury bonds. Outflows of high yield bonds and ETF funds totaled $10.4 billion in August and September, roughly 0.34% of the market's actual size, according to Lipper.
As a result of the sell-off in the quarter, Sherman thinks high yield is now undervalued given the current low interest rate environment. Plus, a weak outlook in the U.S. and Europe, coupled with slower growth in China, means the global economy will likely "muddle through" the next 12 months, making high yield bonds a defensive investment class with equity like upside, Sherman says. In a worst case scenario, such as a double dip recession, high yield would get clobbered.
High yield bond spreads soared in 2008 by more than 400% to more than 700 basis points over Treasurys before declining in 2009. Spreads over Treasurys is now around 170% of the TSY yields. Last month, average interest rates on high yielding corporate debt stood at 8.84% compared to 1.9% for 10 year TSYs.
"I don't like Treasurys, but that doesn't mean U.S. government bond prices will continue to retreat," he says. Ten year bond prices have fallen below par after trading well into the 120s for all of September.
"It is hard to fight the Fed and herd behavior. We had a pretty significant short on 10 year Treasurys, which we ultimately threw in the towel. I shorted the Treasury yield thinking lack of political leadership from Washington, the U.S. debt ceiling, and the general continued deterioration of the U.S. balance sheet would demand a higher real interest rate by lenders. I was surprised that after S&P downgrade, the UST rallied," he said.
Bank of America bonds. While an advocate of high yield corporate debt, Sherman warns investors away from Bank of America bonds yielding over 5%. "I wouldn't touch them just from a fundamental risk versus reward perspective," he says.
"Bank of America takes credit, trading, and operating risk every day and employs significant leverage. Any tiny mistake is magnified. I don't like the idea of being at the bottom of the capital structure since depositors are senior to me in which I make limited upside but the downside is horrible. Maybe an interesting stock investment because you enjoy the spoils of success with similar downside risks as bondholders. But as a bondholder with a capped upside on a financial institution business model, 'no thank you'."
See: For Fixed Income Investors, Another Way To Beat Treasurys
Google matched content |
[May 31, 2021] Yes inflation is transitionary. Thos only question is transitionary to what level? Published on May 31, 2021 | www.wsj.com
[May 09, 2021] CPI Is A Lie! We can't trust CPI to tell us the truth about inflation by Peter Schiff Published on May 04, 2021 | www.zerohedge.com
[Apr 27, 2021] The biggest lesson for the leveraged finance market from the late 1990s is that no amount of equity can salvage a bad business model and by extension issued junk bonds Published on Apr 27, 2021 | www.wsj.com
[Apr 09, 2021] Inflation might be the way out of the debt crisis Published on Apr 09, 2021 | finance.yahoo.com
PIMCO Insights - Investment Outlook
Society
Groupthink : Two Party System as Polyarchy : Corruption of Regulators : Bureaucracies : Understanding Micromanagers and Control Freaks : Toxic Managers : Harvard Mafia : Diplomatic Communication : Surviving a Bad Performance Review : Insufficient Retirement Funds as Immanent Problem of Neoliberal Regime : PseudoScience : Who Rules America : Neoliberalism : The Iron Law of Oligarchy : Libertarian Philosophy
Quotes
War and Peace : Skeptical Finance : John Kenneth Galbraith :Talleyrand : Oscar Wilde : Otto Von Bismarck : Keynes : George Carlin : Skeptics : Propaganda : SE quotes : Language Design and Programming Quotes : Random IT-related quotes : Somerset Maugham : Marcus Aurelius : Kurt Vonnegut : Eric Hoffer : Winston Churchill : Napoleon Bonaparte : Ambrose Bierce : Bernard Shaw : Mark Twain Quotes
Bulletin:
Vol 25, No.12 (December, 2013) Rational Fools vs. Efficient Crooks The efficient markets hypothesis : Political Skeptic Bulletin, 2013 : Unemployment Bulletin, 2010 : Vol 23, No.10 (October, 2011) An observation about corporate security departments : Slightly Skeptical Euromaydan Chronicles, June 2014 : Greenspan legacy bulletin, 2008 : Vol 25, No.10 (October, 2013) Cryptolocker Trojan (Win32/Crilock.A) : Vol 25, No.08 (August, 2013) Cloud providers as intelligence collection hubs : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2010 : Inequality Bulletin, 2009 : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2008 : Copyleft Problems Bulletin, 2004 : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2011 : Energy Bulletin, 2010 : Malware Protection Bulletin, 2010 : Vol 26, No.1 (January, 2013) Object-Oriented Cult : Political Skeptic Bulletin, 2011 : Vol 23, No.11 (November, 2011) Softpanorama classification of sysadmin horror stories : Vol 25, No.05 (May, 2013) Corporate bullshit as a communication method : Vol 25, No.06 (June, 2013) A Note on the Relationship of Brooks Law and Conway Law
History:
Fifty glorious years (1950-2000): the triumph of the US computer engineering : Donald Knuth : TAoCP and its Influence of Computer Science : Richard Stallman : Linus Torvalds : Larry Wall : John K. Ousterhout : CTSS : Multix OS Unix History : Unix shell history : VI editor : History of pipes concept : Solaris : MS DOS : Programming Languages History : PL/1 : Simula 67 : C : History of GCC development : Scripting Languages : Perl history : OS History : Mail : DNS : SSH : CPU Instruction Sets : SPARC systems 1987-2006 : Norton Commander : Norton Utilities : Norton Ghost : Frontpage history : Malware Defense History : GNU Screen : OSS early history
Classic books:
The Peter Principle : Parkinson Law : 1984 : The Mythical Man-Month : How to Solve It by George Polya : The Art of Computer Programming : The Elements of Programming Style : The Unix Hater’s Handbook : The Jargon file : The True Believer : Programming Pearls : The Good Soldier Svejk : The Power Elite
Most popular humor pages:
Manifest of the Softpanorama IT Slacker Society : Ten Commandments of the IT Slackers Society : Computer Humor Collection : BSD Logo Story : The Cuckoo's Egg : IT Slang : C++ Humor : ARE YOU A BBS ADDICT? : The Perl Purity Test : Object oriented programmers of all nations : Financial Humor : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2008 : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2010 : The Most Comprehensive Collection of Editor-related Humor : Programming Language Humor : Goldman Sachs related humor : Greenspan humor : C Humor : Scripting Humor : Real Programmers Humor : Web Humor : GPL-related Humor : OFM Humor : Politically Incorrect Humor : IDS Humor : "Linux Sucks" Humor : Russian Musical Humor : Best Russian Programmer Humor : Microsoft plans to buy Catholic Church : Richard Stallman Related Humor : Admin Humor : Perl-related Humor : Linus Torvalds Related humor : PseudoScience Related Humor : Networking Humor : Shell Humor : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2011 : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2012 : Financial Humor Bulletin, 2013 : Java Humor : Software Engineering Humor : Sun Solaris Related Humor : Education Humor : IBM Humor : Assembler-related Humor : VIM Humor : Computer Viruses Humor : Bright tomorrow is rescheduled to a day after tomorrow : Classic Computer Humor
The Last but not Least Technology is dominated by two types of people: those who understand what they do not manage and those who manage what they do not understand ~Archibald Putt. Ph.D
Copyright © 1996-2021 by Softpanorama Society. www.softpanorama.org was initially created as a service to the (now defunct) UN Sustainable Development Networking Programme (SDNP) without any remuneration. This document is an industrial compilation designed and created exclusively for educational use and is distributed under the Softpanorama Content License. Original materials copyright belong to respective owners. Quotes are made for educational purposes only in compliance with the fair use doctrine.
FAIR USE NOTICE This site contains copyrighted material the use of which has not always been specifically authorized by the copyright owner. We are making such material available to advance understanding of computer science, IT technology, economic, scientific, and social issues. We believe this constitutes a 'fair use' of any such copyrighted material as provided by section 107 of the US Copyright Law according to which such material can be distributed without profit exclusively for research and educational purposes.
This is a Spartan WHYFF (We Help You For Free) site written by people for whom English is not a native language. Grammar and spelling errors should be expected. The site contain some broken links as it develops like a living tree...
|
You can use PayPal to to buy a cup of coffee for authors of this site |
Disclaimer:
The statements, views and opinions presented on this web page are those of the author (or referenced source) and are not endorsed by, nor do they necessarily reflect, the opinions of the Softpanorama society. We do not warrant the correctness of the information provided or its fitness for any purpose. The site uses AdSense so you need to be aware of Google privacy policy. You you do not want to be tracked by Google please disable Javascript for this site. This site is perfectly usable without Javascript.
Last modified: July, 29, 2021
Fun fact,
The mean 'seed' fund runs at around 120% gross and you would think one would do a 'hedged' book, you know, at best 100% leverage, maybe 120% gross in extreme periods right ?
Saw a fund yesterday, small, about XYZ MM under management, running on 197% gross and 300% net. Yes, you are reading that correct. US Institutional qualified, with more than 10 accounts.
Now either I'm getting really old, or my idea of risk management is totally shot to shit at this stage in my career, but this guy was balls deep in fixed credit and swaps. Refused to give over his VaR metrics, or altman score, but had a stupidly great sharpe ratio. Some days, when I think about how some junk companies inflate by 20% a day, I think about this guy, and his fund.
And I wonder, what if this is the new normal. If Bill, Leon, George.... old crew is working away, and there are a whole bunch of wingnuts like this ZYZ nutter who are chasing yield with every risk hedged to keep below your Prime guidebook, but in reality are running at ratios Myron Sholes would have shit himself at.
Just a food for thought.
Toten is 100% correct, risk free is a economic concept derived from post-war 1918 sov. growth rates vs. the real 400 years of economic history; While Case Shiller's often trot out CAPE model works great at predicting rate moves using smoothing, that whole thing assumes underlying growth conditions which are not normal; namely a baby boom, accretive fixed capital rates, technical revolutions every 5 to 10 years and monetary stability. Throw CAPE into some funky currency wars, like the 1750's with only 3 varables ? busted like TRIPS.
Fed policy is going to give stability, which we expected
Now the rest needs to come from the rest of the world. Arguably the US technocrats are more inclusive and forward looking than the fractionalized govts in Japan (no offense Abe!) so Fiscal policy, has a fighting chance of at least respecting the structural reforms required by US gov, lest major allies switch to RNB; creating the bi-material system Austrians badly want. Where RNB is the 'silver' and UST is the 'gold standard'.
If they fail to act, and US corps/US Trading partners will continue to plan outlays for tax management & accretive ROE's to optimize their USD purchasing power, and will invest abroad. Which is pretty much what happened when economic powers dropped gold or bi-standard switching the last time this happened; when the world had a band of iron to every corner of the globe.
In this scenario, US investors can certainly rely on price stability, but as Janet Yellen said in press scrum today: the world is responsible for their own portfolios and yield valuations. Fed does not promise a risk free rate, nor does it target a risk free rate; only inflation & job growth.
As ZH has spoke about ad nausum, job quality is shit, and projected tax planning & wage growth, when millennials hit 40 is going to be nowhere close to sustaining the AA rating of the USA, let alone its G8+7 trade allies. So until we see 57% of U-5 semi-attached workers actually get with something approaching post-war wage & family formation rates, achieving a 8% risk free world is beyond us. Which is where a Fiscal & technocratic solution comes into play; and requires a global coordinated effort which is inclusive of all the key countries. The alternative ? They'll just fuck off and hit up China, turning a blind eye to middle kingdom 2.0, which was a key behind the dead global growth post- 1 AD, and likely even pre-1AD given Chinas total inability to govern that cesspit since the Bronze Age.
In this scenario, I think back to that tool, and his reach for yield hyper-LTCM trading vehicle. When that martingale hits zilch, what happens to them? Will it matter at that point ? Will credit origination matter at all when NIRP becomes accepted as a cost of trade, and we simply trade in 1 oligarchy and swap in UST? where the UST becomes a scarce form of barter like gold was in 1500 ?
Will Primes and Institutional investors be able to tell the difference between technical and productive growth at that point ? Or will the fear of risk, or perhaps the lack of education on industry specific risk lead to a total lack of interest in exploration & moonshot capital ?
Fun fact, the cotton gin is thought to have been 'invented' in at least 5 instances in history, but it only was when some Jews with a some funny names decided to arb their trade float for a merchant capital fund. This was amid a raging stagflation enviroment, and it worked out well for us since 1680.
If we are staring down the barrel of another 40 year stagnation ecosystem (at least), and if we assume Washington/NATO gridlock extends as long as the Holy Roman Empire's decline; we could be in for a good long time of NIRP.
On an end note. ZH lobbied for 'healthy' deflation for 4 years, and now its happening. You cant have a rate hike, and price deflation at the same time. We are done with the Keynsian real time lab study, and now we're onto the Austrian study:
Austrians propose that Federal reserve money printing is the bane of all evil, and the Fed is the sole originator of all credit default which starts the busines cycle. The fed is now accomodative, and neutral, as 'the market' desired. Now its time for the Austrian system to prove money is all locked into one closed economic system; and fixed capital can thrive in a liquidity moderating system.
Our current economic model based on the 1929-1941 experiment proved flawed, so lets see what happens. Ball is in 'the market' and ZH's court to prove this works, in my view.
And for the little meth-Myrons out there, lets hope this NIRP works. If 92/95 happens (it still could with the natural move in rates down by currency flight to USD; esp if ECB is limit bound by QE assets), that is our best solution out. And Gold is at best, a marginal utility vehicle for wealth preservation; which makes Goldbugging a moot point if we're arguging (happily I might add) for creative wealth destruction to prosperity.
TLDR:
- Credit risk is a passing fad, they will flame out if growth is going to its pre-1880 level of stangation to -3% for most of Europe; without Antilla's creative destruction no less. Its about 10x worse today than when Rockstar did his very well done study on shadow risk, and how its warping leins & economic momentum.
- USA's trade partners will eventually conclude its a bad trade partner due how a strong dollar is killing both domestic wealth effects, and the USA's increasing protectionism, USA global policy becomes inert as the USA Dol & T's become a Giffen good
- Last time something barbaric happened, large debts and a useless Technocratic fiscal govt. had their way with the world, we ended up with a badly FUBAR Europe, and all 14 eras of Chinese society.
- Settle in, unless the last 2 generate something constructive; you are all fucked. But thats good for doom porn lovers.
- Yellen looks at the same shit as ZH. In fact, she straight up said she knows it just as well as TD1, and until you see the same numbers they do, which they do, and real time u-5 wages and job quality improves, forcasts changed, because Saudi Arabia had a Taper Tantrum, and while inflation is one part of the puzzle, data dependance is just as transparent as a post on ZH.
And to hike rates would bail out wall st. Pensions, at the further expense of 'the middle class', and pretty much the entire world. As predicted.